Oracle 10g Guide
Oracle 10g Guide
December 2003
Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Fundamentals, 10g Release 1 (10.1) Part No. B10795-01 Copyright 1996, 2003 Oracle Corporation. All rights reserved. Primary Authors: Drew Adams, Eric Paapanen M. Cowan, R. Moran, J. Russell, R. Strohm
Contributing Authors:
Contributors: D. Alpern, G. Arora, C. Barclay, D. Bronnikov, T. Chang, M. Davidson, G. Doherty, D. Elson, A. Ganesh, M. Hartstein, J. Huang, N. Jain, R. Jenkins Jr., S. Kotsovolos, S. Kumar, C. Lei, D. Lorentz, R. Murthy, R. Pang, B. Sinha, S. Vemuri, W. Wang, D. Wong, A. Yalamanchi, Q. Yu Graphic Designer: V. Moore The Programs (which include both the software and documentation) contain proprietary information of Oracle Corporation; they are provided under a license agreement containing restrictions on use and disclosure and are also protected by copyright, patent and other intellectual and industrial property laws. Reverse engineering, disassembly or decompilation of the Programs, except to the extent required to obtain interoperability with other independently created software or as specified by law, is prohibited. The information contained in this document is subject to change without notice. If you find any problems in the documentation, please report them to us in writing. Oracle Corporation does not warrant that this document is error-free. Except as may be expressly permitted in your license agreement for these Programs, no part of these Programs may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, for any purpose, without the express written permission of Oracle Corporation. If the Programs are delivered to the U.S. Government or anyone licensing or using the programs on behalf of the U.S. Government, the following notice is applicable: Restricted Rights Notice Programs delivered subject to the DOD FAR Supplement are "commercial computer software" and use, duplication, and disclosure of the Programs, including documentation, shall be subject to the licensing restrictions set forth in the applicable Oracle license agreement. Otherwise, Programs delivered subject to the Federal Acquisition Regulations are "restricted computer software" and use, duplication, and disclosure of the Programs shall be subject to the restrictions in FAR 52.227-19, Commercial Computer Software - Restricted Rights (June, 1987). Oracle Corporation, 500 Oracle Parkway, Redwood City, CA 94065. The Programs are not intended for use in any nuclear, aviation, mass transit, medical, or other inherently dangerous applications. It shall be the licensee's responsibility to take all appropriate fail-safe, backup, redundancy, and other measures to ensure the safe use of such applications if the Programs are used for such purposes, and Oracle Corporation disclaims liability for any damages caused by such use of the Programs. Oracle is a registered trademark, and ConText, Oracle Store, Oracle8i, Oracle9i, PL/SQL, Pro*COBOL, Pro*C, Pro*C/C++, SQL*Net, and SQL*Plus are trademarks or registered trademarks of Oracle Corporation. Other names may be trademarks of their respective owners.
Contents
Send Us Your Comments ................................................................................................................ xxv Preface....................................................................................................................................................... xxvii
Audience ............................................................................................................................................ xxvii Organization....................................................................................................................................... xxix Related Documentation .................................................................................................................... xxxi Conventions....................................................................................................................................... xxxiii Documentation Accessibility .......................................................................................................... xxxv
Part I 1
Programmatic Environments
Overview of Developing an Oracle Database Application........................................................ Overview of PL/SQL .......................................................................................................................... A Simple PL/SQL Example ........................................................................................................ Advantages of PL/SQL ............................................................................................................... Full Support for SQL............................................................................................................. Tight Integration with Oracle Database............................................................................. Better Performance................................................................................................................ 1-2 1-3 1-4 1-5 1-5 1-5 1-5
iii
Higher Productivity .............................................................................................................. Scalability................................................................................................................................ Maintainability....................................................................................................................... PL/SQL Support for Object-Oriented Programming ...................................................... Object Types .................................................................................................................... Collections ....................................................................................................................... Portability ............................................................................................................................... Security.................................................................................................................................... Built-In Packages for Application Development .............................................................. Built-In Packages for Server Management......................................................................... Built-In Packages for Distributed Database Access.......................................................... Overview of Java Support Built Into the Database...................................................................... Overview of Oracle JVM.............................................................................................................. Overview of Oracle Extensions to JDBC ................................................................................... JDBC Thin Driver................................................................................................................. JDBC OCI Driver ................................................................................................................. JDBC Server-Side Internal Driver ..................................................................................... Oracle Database Extensions to JDBC Standards ............................................................. Sample JDBC 2.0 Program.................................................................................................. Sample Pre-2.0 JDBC Program .......................................................................................... JDBC in SQLJ Applications ................................................................................................ Overview of Oracle SQLJ........................................................................................................... Benefits of SQLJ ................................................................................................................... Comparing SQLJ with JDBC .............................................................................................. SQLJ Stored Procedures in the Server .............................................................................. Overview of Oracle JPublisher ................................................................................................. Overview of Java Stored Procedures ....................................................................................... Overview of Database Web Services ....................................................................................... Database as a Web Service Provider................................................................................. Database as a Web Service Consumer.............................................................................. Overview of Writing Procedures and Functions in Java ...................................................... Overview of Writing Database Triggers in Java ............................................................. Why Use Java for Stored Procedures and Triggers? ...................................................... Overview of Pro*C/C++ ................................................................................................................... How You Implement a Pro*C/C++ Application ...................................................................
1-6 1-6 1-6 1-6 1-6 1-7 1-7 1-7 1-7 1-8 1-8 1-8 1-8 1-9 1-10 1-10 1-11 1-11 1-12 1-12 1-13 1-13 1-15 1-15 1-16 1-17 1-17 1-17 1-18 1-18 1-19 1-19 1-19 1-20 1-20
iv
Highlights of Pro*C/C++ Features .......................................................................................... Overview of Pro*COBOL................................................................................................................ How You Implement a Pro*COBOL Application.................................................................. Highlights of Pro*COBOL Features......................................................................................... Overview of OCI and OCCI ........................................................................................................... Advantages of OCI ..................................................................................................................... Parts of the OCI........................................................................................................................... Procedural and Non-Procedural Elements ............................................................................. Building an OCI Application .................................................................................................... Overview of Oracle Data Provider for .NET (ODP.NET).......................................................... Using ODP.NET in a Simple Application ............................................................................... Overview of Oracle Objects for OLE (OO4O) ............................................................................ OO4O Automation Server......................................................................................................... OO4O Object Model................................................................................................................... OraSession ............................................................................................................................ OraServer.............................................................................................................................. OraDatabase ......................................................................................................................... OraDynaset........................................................................................................................... OraField ................................................................................................................................ OraMetaData and OraMDAttribute ................................................................................. OraParameters and OraParameter ................................................................................... OraParamArray ................................................................................................................... OraSQLStmt ......................................................................................................................... OraAQ................................................................................................................................... OraAQMsg ........................................................................................................................... OraAQAgent ....................................................................................................................... Support for Oracle LOB and Object Datatypes ...................................................................... OraBLOB and OraCLOB .................................................................................................... OraBFILE .............................................................................................................................. Oracle Data Control.................................................................................................................... Oracle Objects for OLE C++ Class Library ............................................................................. Additional Sources of Information .......................................................................................... Choosing a Programming Environment....................................................................................... Choosing Whether to Use OCI or a Precompiler................................................................... Using Built-In Packages and Libraries ....................................................................................
1-21 1-23 1-23 1-24 1-25 1-26 1-27 1-27 1-28 1-29 1-29 1-30 1-31 1-32 1-33 1-33 1-34 1-34 1-35 1-35 1-35 1-36 1-36 1-36 1-37 1-37 1-37 1-38 1-38 1-39 1-39 1-39 1-40 1-40 1-41
Java Compared to PL/SQL ....................................................................................................... PL/SQL Is Optimized for Database Access..................................................................... PL/SQL Is Integrated with the Database......................................................................... Both Java and PL/SQL Have Object-Oriented Features................................................ Java Is Used for Open Distributed Applications ............................................................
Part II 2
Selecting a Datatype
Summary of Oracle Built-In Datatypes .......................................................................................... Representing Character Data............................................................................................................ Column Lengths for Single-Byte and Multibyte Character Sets..................................... Implicit Conversion Between CHAR/VARCHAR2 and NCHAR/NVARCHAR2 .. Comparison Semantics ....................................................................................................... Representing Numeric Data with Number and Floating-Point Datatypes ........................... Floating-Point Number System Concepts............................................................................... About Floating-Point Formats .................................................................................................. Representing Special Values with Native Floating-Point Formats ..................................... Behavior of Special Values for Native Floating-Point Datatypes................................. Rounding of Native Floating-Point Datatypes....................................................................... Comparison Operators for Native Floating-Point Datatypes .............................................. Arithmetic Operators for Native Floating-Point Datatypes ................................................. Conversion Functions for Native Floating-Point Datatypes ................................................ Exceptions for Native Floating-Point Datatypes.................................................................... Client Interfaces for Native Floating-Point Datatypes .......................................................... SQL Native Floating-Point Datatypes .............................................................................. OCI Native Floating-Point Datatypes SQLT_BFLOAT and SQLT_BDOUBLE.......... Native Floating-Point Datatypes Supported in Oracle OBJECT Types....................... Pro*C/C++ Support for Native Floating-Point Datatypes............................................ Storing Data Using the NUMBER Datatype ........................................................................... Representing Date and Time Data ................................................................................................ Date Format ................................................................................................................................. Checking If Two DATE Values Refer to the Same Day ................................................. Displaying the Current Date and Time ............................................................................ Setting SYSDATE to a Constant Value ............................................................................. 2-2 2-8 2-9 2-10 2-10 2-11 2-12 2-12 2-14 2-15 2-15 2-16 2-16 2-16 2-17 2-18 2-18 2-18 2-18 2-19 2-19 2-20 2-21 2-21 2-21 2-21
vi
Printing a Date with BC/AD Notation ............................................................................ Time Format ................................................................................................................................ Performing Date Arithmetic .............................................................................................. Converting Between Datetime Types............................................................................... Handling Time Zones ......................................................................................................... Importing and Exporting Datetime Types ...................................................................... Establishing Year 2000 Compliance......................................................................................... Oracle Server Year 2000 Compliance ............................................................................... Centuries and the Year 2000 .............................................................................................. Examples of The RR Date Format ..................................................................................... Examples of The CC Date Format..................................................................................... Storing Dates in Character Datatypes .............................................................................. Viewing Date Settings......................................................................................................... Altering Date Settings......................................................................................................... Troubleshooting Y2K Problems in Applications ............................................................ Representing Conditional Expressions as Data.......................................................................... Representing Geographic Coordinate Data ................................................................................ Representing Image, Audio, and Video Data.............................................................................. Representing Searchable Text Data............................................................................................... Representing Large Amounts of Data .......................................................................................... Using RAW and LONG RAW Datatypes ............................................................................... Addressing Rows Directly with the ROWID Datatype ............................................................ Extended ROWID Format .................................................................................................. Different Forms of the ROWID ......................................................................................... ROWID Pseudocolumn ............................................................................................... Internal ROWID ........................................................................................................... External Character ROWID ........................................................................................ External Binary ROWID.............................................................................................. ROWID Migration and Compatibility Issues.................................................................. Accessing Oracle Database Version 7 from an Oracle9i Client ............................. Accessing an Oracle9i Database from a Client of Oracle Database Version 7 .... Import and Export........................................................................................................ ANSI/ISO, DB2, and SQL/DS Datatypes .................................................................................... How Oracle Database Converts Datatypes ................................................................................. Datatype Conversion During Assignments............................................................................
2-21 2-22 2-22 2-23 2-23 2-24 2-24 2-25 2-25 2-26 2-27 2-27 2-28 2-29 2-29 2-32 2-33 2-33 2-34 2-34 2-35 2-36 2-36 2-37 2-37 2-37 2-37 2-38 2-38 2-39 2-39 2-39 2-39 2-40 2-41
vii
Datatype Conversion During Expression Evaluation ........................................................... 2-43 Representing Dynamically Typed Data ....................................................................................... 2-44 Representing XML Data .................................................................................................................. 2-47
viii
Restrictions on CHECK Constraints ........................................................................................ Designing CHECK Constraints ................................................................................................ Rules for Multiple CHECK Constraints ................................................................................. Choosing Between CHECK and NOT NULL Integrity Constraints .................................. Examples of Defining Integrity Constraints .............................................................................. Example: Defining Integrity Constraints with the CREATE TABLE Command.............. Example: Defining Constraints with the ALTER TABLE Command ................................. Privileges Required to Create Constraints ............................................................................. Naming Integrity Constraints .................................................................................................. Enabling and Disabling Integrity Constraints ........................................................................... Why Disable Constraints? ................................................................................................. About Exceptions to Integrity Constraints ...................................................................... Enabling Constraints .......................................................................................................... Creating Disabled Constraints ......................................................................................... Enabling and Disabling Existing Integrity Constraints ........................................................ Enabling Existing Constraints .......................................................................................... Disabling Existing Constraints ......................................................................................... Tip: Using the Data Dictionary to Find Constraints ...................................................... Guidelines for Enabling and Disabling Key Integrity Constraints ..................................... Fixing Constraint Exceptions ................................................................................................... Altering Integrity Constraints ........................................................................................................ Renaming Integrity Constraints ............................................................................................... Dropping Integrity Constraints ..................................................................................................... Managing FOREIGN KEY Integrity Constraints ...................................................................... Datatypes and Names for Foreign Key Columns .................................................................. Limit on Columns in Composite Foreign Keys...................................................................... Foreign Key References Primary Key by Default .................................................................. Privileges Required to Create FOREIGN KEY Integrity Constraints ................................. Choosing How Foreign Keys Enforce Referential Integrity ................................................ Viewing Definitions of Integrity Constraints ............................................................................ Examples of Defining Integrity Constraints ........................................................................... Example 1: Listing All of Your Accessible Constraints .......................................... Example 2: Distinguishing NOT NULL Constraints from CHECK Constraints Example 3: Listing Column Names that Constitute an Integrity Constraint ......
3-16 3-16 3-17 3-17 3-17 3-18 3-18 3-19 3-19 3-19 3-20 3-20 3-20 3-21 3-21 3-21 3-22 3-22 3-23 3-23 3-23 3-24 3-25 3-26 3-26 3-26 3-26 3-27 3-27 3-28 3-28 3-29 3-30 3-30
ix
Cancelling Cursors .................................................................................................................... Locking Data Explicitly .................................................................................................................. Choosing a Locking Strategy ................................................................................................... When to Lock with ROW SHARE and ROW EXCLUSIVE Mode ............................... When to Lock with SHARE Mode .................................................................................... When to Lock with SHARE ROW EXCLUSIVE Mode .................................................. When to Lock in EXCLUSIVE Mode ................................................................................ Privileges Required ............................................................................................................ Letting Oracle Database Control Table Locking.................................................................... Explicitly Acquiring Row Locks .............................................................................................. About User Locks.............................................................................................................................. When to Use User Locks............................................................................................................ Example of a User Lock ............................................................................................................. Viewing and Monitoring Locks................................................................................................ Using Serializable Transactions for Concurrency Control ...................................................... How Serializable Transactions Interact................................................................................... Setting the Isolation Level of a Transaction............................................................................ The INITRANS Parameter ................................................................................................ Referential Integrity and Serializable Transactions............................................................... Using SELECT FOR UPDATE ........................................................................................... READ COMMITTED and SERIALIZABLE Isolation............................................................ Transaction Set Consistency .............................................................................................. Comparison of READ COMMITTED and SERIALIZABLE Transactions .................. Choosing an Isolation Level for Transactions ................................................................. Application Tips for Transactions............................................................................................ Autonomous Transactions............................................................................................................... Examples of Autonomous Transactions ................................................................................. Entering a Buy Order.......................................................................................................... Example: Making a Bank Withdrawal ............................................................................. Defining Autonomous Transactions........................................................................................ Restrictions on Autonomous Transactions ............................................................................. Resuming Execution After a Storage Error Condition .............................................................. What Operations Can Be Resumed After an Error Condition? ........................................... Limitations on Resuming Operations After an Error Condition......................................... Writing an Application to Handle Suspended Storage Allocation .....................................
5-10 5-10 5-11 5-12 5-12 5-14 5-15 5-15 5-15 5-16 5-17 5-18 5-18 5-19 5-19 5-21 5-23 5-23 5-23 5-24 5-25 5-25 5-26 5-27 5-28 5-28 5-32 5-32 5-33 5-36 5-37 5-38 5-38 5-38 5-39
xi
xii
xiii
Remote Dependencies .................................................................................................................... Timestamps.................................................................................................................................. Disadvantages of the Timestamp Model ........................................................................ Signatures .................................................................................................................................... When Does a Signature Change? ...................................................................................... Modes............................................................................................................................. Default Parameter Values ........................................................................................... Examples of Changing Procedure Signatures ................................................................. Controlling Remote Dependencies ......................................................................................... Dependency Resolution...................................................................................................... Suggestions for Managing Dependencies........................................................................ Cursor Variables ............................................................................................................................... Declaring and Opening Cursor Variables .............................................................................. Examples of Cursor Variables................................................................................................... Fetching Data ....................................................................................................................... Implementing Variant Records ......................................................................................... Handling PL/SQL Compile-Time Errors ...................................................................................... Handling Run-Time PL/SQL Errors .............................................................................................. Declaring Exceptions and Exception Handling Routines .................................................... Unhandled Exceptions .............................................................................................................. Handling Errors in Distributed Queries ................................................................................. Handling Errors in Remote Procedures ................................................................................. Debugging Stored Procedures........................................................................................................ Calling Stored Procedures............................................................................................................... A Procedure or Trigger Calling Another Procedure ...................................................... Interactively Calling Procedures From Oracle Database Tools ................................... Calling Procedures within 3GL Applications ................................................................ Name Resolution When Calling Procedures ................................................................... Privileges Required to Execute a Procedure ................................................................... Specifying Values for Procedure Arguments ................................................................. Calling Remote Procedures ............................................................................................................ Remote Procedure Calls and Parameter Values ............................................................. Referencing Remote Objects .............................................................................................. Synonyms for Procedures and Packages ................................................................................ Calling Stored Functions from SQL Expressions .......................................................................
7-21 7-21 7-22 7-23 7-25 7-25 7-26 7-26 7-28 7-29 7-29 7-30 7-31 7-31 7-31 7-32 7-33 7-35 7-36 7-38 7-38 7-38 7-40 7-43 7-43 7-44 7-45 7-45 7-45 7-46 7-47 7-47 7-48 7-49 7-50
xiv
Using PL/SQL Functions ......................................................................................................... Syntax for SQL Calling a PL/SQL Function........................................................................... Naming Conventions ................................................................................................................. Name Precedence ................................................................................................................ Example of Calling a PL/SQL Function from SQL................................................. Arguments ........................................................................................................................... Using Default Values .......................................................................................................... Privileges .............................................................................................................................. Requirements for Calling PL/SQL Functions from SQL Expressions................................ Controlling Side Effects ............................................................................................................. Restrictions ........................................................................................................................... Declaring a Function ........................................................................................................... Parallel Query and Parallel DML...................................................................................... PRAGMA RESTRICT_REFERENCES for Backward Compatibility......................... Using the Keyword TRUST ........................................................................................ Differences between Static and Dynamic SQL Statements. ................................... Overloading Packaged PL/SQL Functions.............................................................. Serially Reusable PL/SQL Packages........................................................................................ Package States ...................................................................................................................... Why Serially Reusable Packages? ..................................................................................... Syntax of Serially Reusable Packages............................................................................... Semantics of Serially Reusable Packages ......................................................................... Examples of Serially Reusable Packages.......................................................................... Example 1: How Package Variables Act Across Call Boundaries......................... Example 2: How Package Variables Act Across Call Boundaries......................... Example 3: Open Cursors in Serially Reusable Packages at Call Boundaries..... Returning Large Amounts of Data from a Function .................................................................. Coding Your Own Aggregate Functions ......................................................................................
7-50 7-51 7-51 7-52 7-52 7-53 7-53 7-54 7-54 7-55 7-55 7-56 7-57 7-59 7-61 7-62 7-63 7-63 7-63 7-64 7-64 7-65 7-65 7-65 7-66 7-68 7-69 7-71
xv
Loading External C Procedures .................................................................................................. Publishing External Procedures ..................................................................................................... The AS LANGUAGE Clause for Java Class Methods ........................................................... The AS LANGUAGE Clause for External C Procedures ...................................................... LIBRARY............................................................................................................................... NAME ................................................................................................................................... LANGUAGE ........................................................................................................................ CALLING STANDARD...................................................................................................... WITH CONTEXT................................................................................................................. PARAMETERS..................................................................................................................... AGENT IN ............................................................................................................................ Publishing Java Class Methods ..................................................................................................... Publishing External C Procedures ................................................................................................. Locations of Call Specifications..................................................................................................... Example: Locating a Call Specification in a PL/SQL Package Body ........................... Example: Locating a Call Specification in an Object Type Specification..................... Example: Locating a Call Specification in an Object Type Body .................................. Passing Parameters to External C Procedures with Call Specifications................................. Specifying Datatypes.................................................................................................................. External Datatype Mappings .................................................................................................... BY VALUE/REFERENCE for IN and IN OUT Parameter Modes ...................................... The PARAMETERS Clause ....................................................................................................... Overriding Default Datatype Mapping................................................................................... Specifying Properties ................................................................................................................. INDICATOR......................................................................................................................... LENGTH and MAXLEN .................................................................................................... CHARSETID and CHARSETFORM ................................................................................. Repositioning Parameters .................................................................................................. Using SELF ........................................................................................................................... Passing Parameters by Reference...................................................................................... WITH CONTEXT................................................................................................................. Inter-Language Parameter Mode Mappings ................................................................... Executing External Procedures with the CALL Statement........................................................ Preconditions for External Procedures .................................................................................... Privileges of External Procedures .....................................................................................
8-5 8-10 8-12 8-12 8-12 8-12 8-12 8-12 8-13 8-13 8-13 8-13 8-14 8-14 8-15 8-16 8-16 8-18 8-19 8-21 8-23 8-24 8-25 8-25 8-27 8-27 8-28 8-29 8-29 8-32 8-33 8-33 8-33 8-34 8-35
xvi
Managing Permissions ....................................................................................................... Creating Synonyms for External Procedures .................................................................. CALL Statement Syntax............................................................................................................. Calling Java Class Methods....................................................................................................... How the Database Server Calls External C Procedures........................................................ Handling Errors and Exceptions in Multi-Language Programs .............................................. Generic Compile Time Call specification Errors.................................................................... C Exception Handling................................................................................................................ Using Service Procedures with External C Procedures ............................................................. OCIExtProcAllocCallMemory ........................................................................................... OCIExtProcRaiseExcp......................................................................................................... OCIExtProcRaiseExcpWithMsg ........................................................................................ Doing Callbacks with External C Procedures ............................................................................. OCIExtProcGetEnv ............................................................................................................. Object Support for OCI Callbacks ............................................................................................ Restrictions on Callbacks........................................................................................................... Debugging External Procedures............................................................................................... Using Package DEBUG_EXTPROC .................................................................................. Demo Program............................................................................................................................ Guidelines for External C Procedures ..................................................................................... Restrictions on External C Procedures ....................................................................................
8-35 8-35 8-36 8-36 8-37 8-38 8-38 8-38 8-38 8-38 8-44 8-46 8-47 8-47 8-48 8-49 8-50 8-51 8-51 8-51 8-53
Part III 9
Using Triggers
Designing Triggers ............................................................................................................................. Creating Triggers ................................................................................................................................ Types of Triggers .......................................................................................................................... Overview of System Events ................................................................................................. Getting the Attributes of System Events............................................................................ Naming Triggers .......................................................................................................................... When Is the Trigger Fired? ......................................................................................................... Do Import and SQL*Loader Fire Triggers? ....................................................................... How Column Lists Affect UPDATE Triggers .................................................................. Controlling When a Trigger Is Fired (BEFORE and AFTER Options) ................................. 9-2 9-2 9-3 9-4 9-4 9-4 9-5 9-5 9-6 9-6
xvii
Ordering of Triggers .................................................................................................................... Modifying Complex Views (INSTEAD OF Triggers).............................................................. Views that Require INSTEAD OF Triggers ....................................................................... INSTEAD OF Trigger Example ......................................................................................... Object Views and INSTEAD OF Triggers ........................................................................ Triggers on Nested Table View Columns ........................................................................ Firing Triggers One or Many Times (FOR EACH ROW Option) ....................................... Firing Triggers Based on Conditions (WHEN Clause) ........................................................ Coding the Trigger Body ................................................................................................................ Example: Monitoring Logons with a Trigger........................................................... Example: Calling a Java Procedure from a Trigger................................................. Accessing Column Values in Row Triggers ........................................................................... Example: Modifying LOB Columns with a Trigger ....................................................... INSTEAD OF Triggers on Nested Table View Columns............................................... Avoiding Name Conflicts with Triggers (REFERENCING Option) ........................... Detecting the DML Operation That Fired a Trigger....................................................... Error Conditions and Exceptions in the Trigger Body .................................................. Triggers and Handling Remote Exceptions ........................................................................... Restrictions on Creating Triggers ............................................................................................ Who Is the Trigger User? ........................................................................................................... Privileges Needed to Work with Triggers ............................................................................. Compiling Triggers .......................................................................................................................... Dependencies for Triggers ....................................................................................................... Recompiling Triggers ................................................................................................................ Modifying Triggers .......................................................................................................................... Debugging Triggers ................................................................................................................... Enabling and Disabling Triggers................................................................................................... Enabling Triggers ....................................................................................................................... Disabling Triggers ..................................................................................................................... Viewing Information About Triggers .......................................................................................... Examples of Trigger Applications ................................................................................................ Auditing with Triggers: Example .................................................................................... Integrity Constraints and Triggers: Examples ................................................................ Referential Integrity Using Triggers ................................................................................ Foreign Key Trigger for Child Table .........................................................................
9-7 9-8 9-9 9-10 9-11 9-12 9-13 9-14 9-15 9-15 9-16 9-17 9-18 9-18 9-19 9-19 9-20 9-20 9-21 9-25 9-26 9-26 9-27 9-27 9-28 9-28 9-28 9-28 9-29 9-29 9-31 9-32 9-37 9-38 9-39
xviii
UPDATE and DELETE RESTRICT Trigger for Parent Table ............................... UPDATE and DELETE SET NULL Triggers for Parent Table: Example ............ DELETE Cascade Trigger for Parent Table: Example............................................. UPDATE Cascade Trigger for Parent Table: Example ........................................... Trigger for Complex Check Constraints: Example ........................................................ Complex Security Authorizations and Triggers: Example ........................................... Transparent Event Logging and Triggers........................................................................ Derived Column Values and Triggers: Example ........................................................... Building Complex Updatable Views Using Triggers: Example ................................... Tracking System Events Using Triggers .......................................................................... Fine-Grained Access Control Using Triggers: Example......................................... CALL Syntax................................................................................................................. Responding to System Events through Triggers .......................................................................
9-40 9-41 9-41 9-42 9-43 9-45 9-46 9-46 9-47 9-49 9-49 9-50 9-50
10
11
Part IV 12
xix
Basic String Matching with Regular Expressions .................................................................. 12-5 Regular Expression Operations on Subexpressions .............................................................. 12-5 Regular Expression Operator and Metacharacter Usage...................................................... 12-5
13
xx
Syntax of PL/SQL Server Page Elements ............................................................................. Page Directive .................................................................................................................... Procedure Directive .......................................................................................................... Parameter Directive .......................................................................................................... Include Directive ............................................................................................................... Declaration Block............................................................................................................... Code Block (Scriptlet) ....................................................................................................... Expression Block................................................................................................................ Loading the PL/SQL Server Page into the Database as a Stored Procedure................... Running a PL/SQL Server Page Through a URL ................................................................ Sample PSP URLs .............................................................................................................. Examples of PL/SQL Server Pages........................................................................................ Sample Table ...................................................................................................................... Dumping the Sample Table ............................................................................................. Printing the Sample Table using a Loop ........................................................................ Allowing a User Selection ................................................................................................ Sample HTML Form to Call a PL/SQL Server Page.................................................... Debugging PL/SQL Server Page Problems.......................................................................... Putting an Application using PL/SQL Server Pages into Production ............................. Enabling PL/SQL Web Applications for XML ..........................................................................
13-27 13-27 13-27 13-28 13-28 13-28 13-28 13-29 13-29 13-30 13-30 13-31 13-31 13-32 13-32 13-33 13-35 13-38 13-39 13-41
14
15
xxi
Using ORA_ROWSCN .................................................................................................................... Using Flashback Version Query................................................................................................... Using Flashback Transaction Query ........................................................................................... Flashback Transaction Query and Flashback Version Query: Example........................... Flashback Tips ................................................................................................................................. Flashback Tips Performance ................................................................................................ Flashback Tips General .........................................................................................................
16
xxii
Troubleshooting XA Applications............................................................................................... XA Trace Files ........................................................................................................................... The xa_open string DbgFl ................................................................................................ Trace File Locations........................................................................................................... Trace File Examples.................................................................................................................. In-Doubt or Pending Transactions......................................................................................... Oracle Database SYS Account Tables .................................................................................... XA Issues and Restrictions............................................................................................................ Changes to Oracle XA Support .................................................................................................... XA Changes from Release 8.0 to Release 8.1 ........................................................................ XA Changes from Release 7.3 to Release 8.0 ........................................................................ Session Caching Is No Longer Needed .......................................................................... Dynamic Registration Is Supported ............................................................................... Loosely Coupled Transaction Branches Are Supported ............................................. SQLLIB Is Not Needed for OCI Applications ............................................................... No Installation Script Is Needed to Run XA ................................................................. XA Library Use with Oracle Real Application Clusters Option on All Platforms .. Transaction Recovery for Oracle Real Application Clusters Has Been Improved .. Both Global and Local Transactions Are Possible ........................................................ The xa_open String Has Been Modified.........................................................................
16-24 16-24 16-24 16-25 16-25 16-26 16-26 16-27 16-32 16-32 16-32 16-33 16-33 16-33 16-34 16-34 16-34 16-34 16-34 16-35
Index
xxiii
xxiv
Oracle Corporation welcomes your comments and suggestions on the quality and usefulness of this document. Your input is an important part of the information used for revision.
I I I I I
Did you find any errors? Is the information clearly presented? Do you need more information? If so, where? Are the examples correct? Do you need more examples? What features did you like most?
If you find any errors or have any other suggestions for improvement, please indicate the document title and part number, and the chapter, section, and page number (if available). You can send comments to us in the following ways: Electronic mail: [email protected] I FAX: (650) 506-7227 Attn: Server Technologies Documentation Manager I Postal service: Oracle Corporation Server Technologies Documentation 500 Oracle Parkway, Mailstop 4op11 Redwood Shores, CA 94065 USA If you would like a reply, please give your name, address, telephone number, and (optionally) electronic mail address.
I
If you have problems with the software, please contact your local Oracle Support Services.
xxv
xxvi
Preface
The Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Fundamentals describes basic application development features of Oracle Database 10g. Information in this guide applies to features that work the same on all supported platforms, and does not include system-specific information. This preface contains these topics:
I I I I I
Audience
Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Fundamentals is intended for programmers developing new applications or converting existing applications to run in the Oracle Database environment. This book will also be valuable to systems analysts, project managers, and others interested in the development of database applications. This guide assumes that you have a working knowledge of application programming, and that you are familiar with the use of Structured Query Language (SQL) to access information in relational database systems. Certain sections of this guide also assume a knowledge of the basic concepts of object-oriented programming.
xxvii
Programming in SQL. Your primary source of information for this is the Oracle Database SQL Reference. In the Oracle Data Warehousing Guide,you can find information about advanced query techniques, to perform analysis and retrieve data in a single query, Interfacing to SQL through other languages, such as PL/SQL, Java, or C/C++. Sources of information about these other languages include:
I I I I I
PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference Oracle Database Java Developer's Guide Pro*C/C++ Programmer's Guide Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide and Oracle C++ Call Interface Programmer's Guide Oracle Objects for OLE C++ Class Library Developer's Guide Oracle COM Automation Feature Developer's Guide
I I I
Setting up interactions and mappings between multiple language environments, as described in "Calling External Procedures" on page 8-1. Working with schema objects. You might design part or all of a schema, and write code to fit into an existing schema. You can get full details in Oracle Database Administrator's Guide. Interfacing with the database administrator to make sure that the schema can be backed up and restored, for example after a system failure or when moving between a staging machine and a production machine. Building application logic into the database itself, in the form of stored procedures, constraints, and triggers, to allow multiple applications to reuse application logic and code that checks and cleans up errors. For information on these database features, see "Using Procedures and Packages" on page 7-1, "Maintaining Data Integrity Through Constraints" on page 3-1, and "Using Triggers" on page 9-1. Some degree of performance tuning. The database administrator might help here. You can find more information in PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference, PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference, and Oracle Database Performance Tuning Guide.
xxviii
Some amount of database administration, if you need to maintain your own development or test system. You can learn about administration in the Oracle Database Administrator's Guide. Debugging and interpreting error messages. See "Related Documentation" on page xxxi. Making your application available over the network, particularly over the Internet or company intranet. You can get an overview in "Developing Web Applications with PL/SQL" on page 13-1, and full details covering various languages and technologies in the Oracle Application Server documentation. Designing the class structure and choosing object-oriented methodologies, if your application is object-oriented. For more information, see Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Object-Relational Features, PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference, and Oracle Database Java Developer's Guide.
Organization
This document contains:
Part I: Introduction
This part introduces several ways that you can write Oracle Database applications. You might need to use more than one language or development environment for a single application. Some database features are only supported by, or are easier to access from, certain languages. Chapter 1, "Programmatic Environments" This chapter outlines the strengths of the languages, development environments, and APIs that Oracle Database provides.
xxix
Chapter 2, "Selecting a Datatype" This chapter explains how to represent your business data in the database. The datatypes include fixed- and variable-length character strings, numeric data, dates, raw binary data, and row identifiers (ROWIDs). Chapter 3, "Maintaining Data Integrity Through Constraints" This chapter explains how to use constraints to move error-checking logic out of your application and into the database. Chapter 4, "Selecting an Index Strategy" This chapter explains how to choose the best indexing strategy for your application. Chapter 5, "How Oracle Database Processes SQL Statements" This chapter explains SQL topics such as commits, cursors, and locking that you can take advantage of in your applications. Chapter 6, "Coding Dynamic SQL Statements" This chapter describes dynamic SQL, compares native dynamic SQL to the DBMS_ SQL package, and explains when to use dynamic SQL. Chapter 7, "Using Procedures and Packages" This chapter explains how to store reusable procedures in the database, and how to group procedures into packages. Chapter 8, "Calling External Procedures" This chapter explains how to code the bodies of computation intensive procedures in languages other than PL/SQL.
xxx
Chapter 10, "Working With System Events" This chapter explains how to retrieve information, such as the user ID and database name, about the event that fires a trigger. Chapter 11, "Using the Publish-Subscribe Model for Applications" This chapter introduces the Oracle Database model for asynchronous communication, also known as messaging or queuing.
Related Documentation
For more information, see these Oracle resources.
I
Use the PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference to learn PL/SQL and to get a complete description of the PL/SQL high-level programming language, which is Oracle's procedural extension to SQL.
xxxi
The Oracle Call Interface (OCI) is described in Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide and Oracle C++ Call Interface Programmer's Guide. You can use the OCI to build third-generation language (3GL) applications that access the Oracle Database.
The Oracle Database Security Guide discusses security features of the database that application developers and database administrators need to be aware of. Oracle also provides the Pro* series of precompilers, which allow you to embed SQL and PL/SQL in your application programs. If you write 3GL application programs in C, C++, COBOL, or FORTRAN that incorporate embedded SQL, then refer to the corresponding precompiler manual. For example, if you program in C or C++, then refer to the Pro*C/C++ Programmer's Guide. Oracle Developer/2000 is a cooperative development environment that provides several tools including a form builder, reporting tools, and a debugging environment for PL/SQL. Refer to the appropriate Oracle Developer/2000 documentation if you use this product. For SQL information, see the Oracle Database SQL Reference and Oracle Database Administrator's Guide. For basic Oracle Database concepts, see Oracle Database Concepts. For developing applications that manipulate XML data, see Oracle XML Developer's Kit Programmer's Guide and Oracle XML DB Developer's Guide. Oracle Database error message documentation is available only in HTML. If you have access only to the Oracle Documentation CD, you can browse the error messages by range. After you find the specific range, use your browser's "find in page" feature to locate the specific message. When connected to the Internet, you can search for a specific error message using the error message search feature of the Oracle Database online documentation. Many of the examples in this book use the sample schemas of the seed database, which is installed by default when you install Oracle. Refer to Oracle Database Sample Schemas for information on how these schemas were created and how you can use them yourself. Printed documentation is available for sale in the Oracle Store at
http://oraclestore.oracle.com/
To download free release notes, installation documentation, white papers, or other collateral, visit the Oracle Technology Network (OTN). You must register online before using OTN; registration is free and can be done at
xxxii
http://otn.oracle.com/membership/
If you already have a username and password for OTN, then you can go directly to the documentation section of the OTN Web site at
http://otn.oracle.com/documentation/
Conventions
This section describes the conventions used in the text and code examples of this documentation set. It describes:
I I
Conventions in Text
We use various conventions in text to help you more quickly identify special terms. The following table describes those conventions and provides examples of their use.
Convention Bold Meaning Example
Bold typeface indicates terms that are When you specify this clause, you create an defined in the text or terms that appear in index-organized table. a glossary, or both. Italic typeface indicates book titles or emphasis. Oracle Database Concepts Ensure that the recovery catalog and target database do not reside on the same disk. You can specify this clause only for a NUMBER column. You can back up the database by using the BACKUP command. Query the TABLE_NAME column in the USER_ TABLES data dictionary view. Use the DBMS_STATS.GENERATE_STATS procedure.
Italics
Uppercase monospace typeface indicates elements supplied by the system. Such elements include parameters, privileges, datatypes, RMAN keywords, SQL keywords, SQL*Plus or utility commands, packages and methods, as well as system-supplied column names, database objects and structures, usernames, and roles.
xxxiii
Meaning Lowercase monospace typeface indicates executable, filenames, directory names, and sample user-supplied elements. Such elements include computer and database names, net service names, and connect identifiers, as well as user-supplied database objects and structures, column names, packages and classes, usernames and roles, program units, and parameter values.
Example Enter sqlplus to open SQL*Plus. The password is specified in the orapwd file. Back up the datafiles and control files in the /disk1/oracle/dbs directory. The department_id, department_name, and location_id columns are in the hr.departments table. Set the QUERY_REWRITE_ENABLED initialization parameter to true.
Note: Some programmatic elements use a Connect as oe user. mixture of UPPERCASE and lowercase. Enter these elements as shown. The JRepUtil class implements these methods. lowercase monospace (fixed-width font) italic Lowercase monospace italic font represents placeholders or variables. You can specify the parallel_clause. Run Uold_release.SQL where old_ release refers to the release you installed prior to upgrading.
The following table describes typographic conventions used in code examples and provides examples of their use.
Convention [] Meaning Brackets enclose one or more optional items. Do not enter the brackets. Example DECIMAL (digits [ , precision ])
{} |
Braces enclose two or more items, one of {ENABLE | DISABLE} which is required. Do not enter the braces. A vertical bar represents a choice of two {ENABLE | DISABLE} or more options within brackets or braces. [COMPRESS | NOCOMPRESS] Enter one of the options. Do not enter the vertical bar.
xxxiv
Convention ...
Example
That we have omitted parts of the code that are not directly related to the example That you can repeat a portion of the code
. . . Other notation
Vertical ellipsis points indicate that we have omitted several lines of code not directly related to the example. You must enter symbols other than brackets, braces, vertical bars, and ellipsis points as shown. Italicized text indicates placeholders or variables for which you must supply particular values. Uppercase typeface indicates elements supplied by the system. We show these terms in uppercase in order to distinguish them from terms you define. Unless terms appear in brackets, enter them in the order and with the spelling shown. However, because these terms are not case sensitive, you can enter them in lowercase. Lowercase typeface indicates programmatic elements that you supply. For example, lowercase indicates names of tables, columns, or files. acctbal NUMBER(11,2); acct CONSTANT NUMBER(4) := 3; CONNECT SYSTEM/system_password DB_NAME = database_name SELECT last_name, employee_id FROM employees; SELECT * FROM USER_TABLES; DROP TABLE hr.employees;
Italics
UPPERCASE
lowercase
CREATE USER mjones IDENTIFIED BY Note: Some programmatic elements use a ty3MU9; mixture of UPPERCASE and lowercase. Enter these elements as shown.
Documentation Accessibility
Our goal is to make Oracle products, services, and supporting documentation accessible, with good usability, to the disabled community. To that end, our documentation includes features that make information available to users of assistive technology. This documentation is available in HTML format, and contains markup to facilitate access by the disabled community. Standards will continue to
xxxv
evolve over time, and Oracle is actively engaged with other market-leading technology vendors to address technical obstacles so that our documentation can be accessible to all of our customers. For additional information, visit the Oracle Accessibility Program Web site at
http://www.oracle.com/accessibility/
Accessibility of Code Examples in Documentation JAWS, a Windows screen reader, may not always correctly read the code examples in this document. The conventions for writing code require that closing braces should appear on an otherwise empty line; however, JAWS may not always read a line of text that consists solely of a bracket or brace. Accessibility of Links to External Web Sites in Documentation This documentation may contain links to Web sites of other companies or organizations that Oracle does not own or control. Oracle neither evaluates nor makes any representations regarding the accessibility of these Web sites.
xxxvi
Regular Expression Support A set of SQL functions introduced in this release let you perform queries and manipulate string data using regular expressions. See Chapter 12, "Using Regular Expressions With Oracle Database" for more information.
Oracle Expression Filter Oracle Expression Filter lets you store conditional expressions in a column that you can use in the WHERE clause of a database query. See "Representing Conditional Expressions as Data" on page 2-32 for more information.
See Also: Oracle Database SQL Reference
Native floating-point datatypes Column datatypes BINARY_FLOAT and BINARY_DOUBLE are introduced in this release. These datatypes provide an alternative to using the Oracle NUMBER datatype, with the following benefits:
I
xxxvii
I I
Faster arithmetic operations Support for numerical algorithms specified in the IEEE 754 Standard
Support for native floating-point datatypes in bind and fetch operations is provided for the following client interfaces:
I I I I I I
Terabyte-Size Large Object (LOB) support This release provides support for terabyte-size LOB values (from 8 to 128 terabytes) in the following programmatic environments:
I I I
You can store and manipulate LOB (BLOB, CLOB, and NCLOB) datatypes larger than 4GB.
See Also: For details on terabyte-size LOB support:
I I
Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide
Flashback This release has new and enhanced flashback features. You can now do the following:
I
xxxviii
Obtain the SQL undo syntax for a row, to perform row-level flashback operations. Perform remote queries of past data.
See Also: Chapter 15, "Using Flashback Features"
Oracle Data Provider for .NET Oracle Data Provider for .NET (ODP.NET) is a new programmatic environment that implements a data provider for Oracle Database. It uses APIs native to Oracle Database to offer fast and reliable access from any .NET application to database features and data. ODP.NET also uses and inherits classes and interfaces available in the Microsoft .NET Framework Class Library.
See Also: Oracle Data Provider for .NET Developer's Guide
Enhancements to Flashback Query You can perform an Oracle Flashback Query using the AS OF clause of the SELECT statement rather than going through the DBMS_FLASHBACK package. This technique is very flexible, allowing you to perform joins, set operations, subqueries, and views using different date/time or SCN settings for each table in the query. You can also restore or capture past data by using a Flashback Query inside an INSERT or CREATE TABLE AS SELECT statement.
See Also: "Using Flashback Features" on page 15-1
Using PL/SQL Records in INSERT and UPDATE Statements When you represent related data items using a PL/SQL record, you can perform insert and update operations using the entire record, instead of specifying each record field separately.
See Also: PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference
xxxix
If a data management application experiences problems because it tries to create a constraint when the constraint already exists, you can rename the existing constraint to avoid the conflict. If you track down a constraint with a cryptic system-generated name, you can give it a descriptive name to make it easier to enable and disable later.
See Also: "Renaming Integrity Constraints" on page 3-24
I
Enhanced support for NCHAR, NVARCHAR2, and NCLOB types These globalization-support types can now be used as attributes of SQL and PL/SQL object types, and in PL/SQL collection types such as varrays and nested tables.
New XML programming capabilities New and enhanced built-in types, such as XMLType and XDBURIType, let you delegate XML parsing, storage, and retrieval to the database.
See Also: Oracle XML DB Developer's Guide
Enhanced UTL_FILE package The UTL_FILE package has a number of new functions for performing popular file operations. You can seek, auto-flush, read and write binary data, delete files, change file permissions, and more. Use the CREATE DIRECTORY statement (using double quotation marks around any lowercase names), rather than the UTL_FILE_DIR initialization parameter.
See Also: PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference for details about these enhancements
User-defined constructors You can now override the system default constructor for an object type with your own constructor function.
See Also: PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference
Access to LOB data within triggers You can access or change LOB data within BEFORE and INSTEAD OF triggers, using the :NEW variable.
xl
page 9-18
I
Synonyms for types You can now define synonyms for types.
See Also: Oracle Database Administrator's Guide for details on creating synonyms
Scrollable cursors in Pro*C/C++ applications Scrollable cursors let you move forward and backward through the result set in a Pro*C/C++ application.
See Also: "Highlights of Pro*C/C++ Features" on page 1-21
Support for Connection Pooling in Pro*C/C++ The Connection Pool feature in Pro*C/C++ helps you optimize the performance of Pro*C/C++ applications.
See Also: "Highlights of Pro*C/C++ Features" on page 1-21
Better linking in online documentation Many of the cross-references from this book to other books have been made more specific, so that they link to a particular place within another book rather than to its table of contents. If you are reading a printed copy of this book, you can find the online equivalent, with full search capability, at http://otn.oracle.com/documentation/.
xli
I I I
Oracle Application Server now includes Oracle Application Server Containers for J2EE (OC4J). Migrate any existing applications that use the following technologies in the database to OC4J: servlets, JSP pages, EJBs, and CORBA objects. To develop new applications using EJBs or CORBA, you must use the J2EE components that are part of Oracle Application Server. EJBs and CORBA are no longer supported within the database. You can still access the database from these components using Oracle Application Server as a middle-tier. You can still write Java stored procedures and Java methods for object types within database applications. For more information on OC4J, visit the Oracle Application Server documentation pages at:
http://otn.oracle.com/documentation/
See Also:
I
Integration of SQL and PL/SQL parsers PL/SQL now supports the complete range of syntax for SQL statements, such as INSERT, UPDATE, DELETE, and so on. If you received errors for valid SQL syntax in PL/SQL programs before, those statements should now work. Because of more consistent error-checking, you might find that some invalid code is now found at compile time instead of producing an error at runtime, or vice versa. You might need to change the source code as part of the migration procedure.
See Also: Oracle Database Upgrade Guide for details on the
xlii
Resumable Storage Allocation When an application encounters some kinds of storage allocation errors, it can suspend operations and take action such as resolving the problem or notifying an operator. The operation can be resumed when storage is added or freed.
See Also: "Resuming Execution After a Storage Error Condition" on page 5-38
Flashback This release has new and enhanced flashback features. You can now do the following:
I I
Query the transaction history of a row. Obtain the SQL undo syntax for a row, to perform row-level flashback operations. Perform remote queries of past data.
See Also: "Using Flashback Features" on page 15-1
WITH Clause for Reusing Complex Subqueries Rather than repeat a complex subquery, you can give it a name and refer to that name multiple times within the same query. This is convenient for coding; it also helps the optimizer find common code that can be optimized.
See Also: Oracle Database Administrator's Guide for details on creating synonyms
New Date and Time Types The new datatype TIMESTAMP records time values including fractional seconds. New datatypes TIMESTAMP WITH TIME ZONE and TIMESTAMP WITH LOCAL TIME ZONE allow you to adjust date and time values to account for time zone differences. You can specify whether the time zone observes daylight savings time. New datatypes INTERVAL DAY TO SECOND and INTERVAL YEAR TO MONTH represent differences between two date and time values, simplifying date arithmetic.
xliii
See Also:
I I
"Summary of Oracle Built-In Datatypes" on page 2-2 "Representing Date and Time Data" on page 2-20
Better Integration of LOB Datatypes You can use character functions on CLOB and NCLOB types. You can treat BLOB types as RAWs. Conversions between LOBs and other types are much simpler now, particularly when converting from LONG to LOB types.
See Also:
I I I
"Representing Large Amounts of Data" on page 2-34 "How Oracle Database Converts Datatypes" on page 2-40 "Representing Character Data" on page 2-8
Improved Globalization and National Language Support Data can be stored in Unicode format using fixed-width or variable-width character sets. String handling and storage declarations can be specified using character lengths, where the number of bytes is computed for you, or explicit byte lengths. You can set up the entire database to use the same length semantics for strings, or specify the settings for individual procedures; this setting is remembered if a procedure is invalidated.
See Also: "Representing Character Data" on page 2-8
Enhancements to Bulk Operations You can now perform bulk SQL operations, such as bulk fetches, using native dynamic SQL (the EXECUTE IMMEDIATE statement). You can perform bulk insert or update operations that continue despite errors on some rows, then examine the individual row problems after the operation is complete.
See Also: "Overview of Bulk Binds" on page 7-17
Improved Support for PL/SQL Web Applications The UTL_HTTP and UTL_SMTP packages have a number of enhancements, such as letting you access password-protected Web pages, and sending e-mail with attachments.
xliv
See Also: Chapter 13, "Developing Web Applications with PL/SQL" on page 13-1
I
Native Compilation of PL/SQL Code Improve performance by compiling Oracle-supplied and user-written stored procedures into native executables, using typical C development tools. This setting is saved, so that the procedure is compiled the same way if it is later invalidated.
See Also: "Compiling PL/SQL Procedures for Native Execution" on page 7-21
Oracle C++ Call Interface (OCCI) API The OCCI API lets you write fast, low-level database applications using C++. It is similar to the Oracle Call Interface (OCI) API.
See Also: "Overview of OCI and OCCI" on page 1-25
Secure Application Roles In Oracle9i, application developers no longer need to secure a role by embedding passwords inside applications. They can create application roles and specify which PL/SQL package is authorized to enable the roles. Application roles enabled by PL/SQL packages are called secure application roles.
Creating Application Contexts You can create an application context by entering a command like:
CREATE CONTEXT Order_entry USING Apps.Oe_ctx;
Alternatively, you can use Oracle Policy Manager to create an application context.
I
Dedicated External Procedure Agents You can run external procedure agents (the EXTPROC entry in tnsnames.ora) under different instances of Oracle Database or on entirely separate machines. This lets you configure external procedures more robustly, so that if one external procedure fails, other external procedures can continue running in a different agent process.
xlv
See Also:
I I
"Loading External C Procedures" on page 8-5 "Publishing External Procedures" on page 8-10
xlvi
Part I
Introduction to Application Development Features of Oracle Database
This part introduces application development features of Oracle Database. It contains the following chapter:
I
1
Programmatic Environments
This chapter contains these topics:
I I I I I I I I I
Overview of Developing an Oracle Database Application Overview of PL/SQL Overview of Java Support Built Into the Database Overview of Pro*C/C++ Overview of Pro*COBOL Overview of OCI and OCCI Overview of Oracle Data Provider for .NET (ODP.NET) Overview of Oracle Objects for OLE (OO4O) Choosing a Programming Environment
Programmatic Environments
1-1
Client/Server Model
In a traditional client/server program, the code of your application runs on a machine other than the database server. Database calls are transmitted from this client machine to the database server. Data is transmitted from the client to the server for insert and update operations, and returned from the server to the client for query operations. The data is processed on the client machine. Client/server programs are typically written using precompilers, where SQL statements are embedded within the code of another language such as C, C++, or COBOL.
Server-Side Coding
You can develop application logic that resides entirely inside the database, using triggers that are executed automatically when changes occur in the database, or stored procedures that are called explicitly. Off-loading the work from your application lets you reuse code that performs verification and cleanup, and control database operations from a variety of clients. For example, by making stored procedures callable through a Web server, you can construct a Web-based user interface that performs the same functions as a client/server application.
User Interface
The interface that your application displays to end users depends on the technology behind the application, as well as the needs of the users themselves. Experienced users might enter SQL commands that are passed on to the database. Novice users might be shown a graphical user interface that uses the graphics libraries of the
1-2
Overview of PL/SQL
client system (such as Windows or X-Windows). Any of these traditional user interfaces can also be provided in a Web browser using HTML and Java.
Overview of PL/SQL
PL/SQL is Oracle's procedural extension to SQL, the standard database access language. An advanced 4GL (fourth-generation programming language1), PL/SQL offers seamless SQL access, tight integration with Oracle Database and associated tools, portability, security, and modern software engineering features such as data encapsulation, overloading, exception handling, and information hiding. With PL/SQL, you can manipulate data with SQL statements, and control program flow with procedural constructs such as IF-THEN and LOOP. You can also declare constants and variables, define procedures and functions, use collections and object types, and trap run-time errors. Applications written using any of the Oracle programmatic interfaces can call PL/SQL stored procedures and send blocks of PL/SQL code to the server for execution. 3GL (third-generation programming language2) applications can access
1
4GL: An "application specific" language, with built-in treatment of an application domain. PL/SQL and SQL have built-in treatment of the database domain.
Programmatic Environments
1-3
Overview of PL/SQL
PL/SQL scalar and composite datatypes through host variables and implicit datatype conversion. Because it runs inside the database, PL/SQL code is very efficient for data-intensive operations, and minimizes network traffic in client/server applications. PL/SQL's tight integration with Oracle Developer lets you develop the client and server components of your application in the same language, then partition the components for optimal performance and scalability. Also, Oracle's Web Forms lets you deploy your applications in a multitier Internet or intranet environment without modifying a single line of code.
See Also: PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference
3GL: A language designed to be easier than assembler language for a human to understand. It includes things like named variables. Unlike 4GL, it is not specific to a particular application domain.
1-4
Overview of PL/SQL
Advantages of PL/SQL
PL/SQL is a completely portable, high-performance transaction processing language that offers the following advantages:
Better Performance
If your application is database intensive, you can use PL/SQL blocks to group SQL statements before sending them to Oracle Database for execution. This can drastically reduce the communication overhead between your application and Oracle Database. PL/SQL stored procedures are compiled once and stored in executable form, so procedure calls are quick and efficient. A single call can start a compute-intensive stored procedure, reducing network traffic and improving round-trip response times. Executable code is automatically cached and shared among users, lowering memory requirements and invocation overhead.
Programmatic Environments
1-5
Overview of PL/SQL
Higher Productivity
PL/SQL adds procedural capabilities, such as Oracle Forms and Oracle Reports. For example, you can use an entire PL/SQL block in an Oracle Forms trigger instead of multiple trigger steps, macros, or user exits. PL/SQL is the same in all environments. As soon as you master PL/SQL with one Oracle tool, you can transfer your knowledge to others, and so multiply the productivity gains. For example, scripts written with one tool can be used by other tools.
Scalability
PL/SQL stored procedures increase scalability by centralizing application processing on the server. Automatic dependency tracking helps you develop scalable applications. The shared memory facilities of the shared server (formerly known as Multi-Threaded Server or MTS) enable Oracle Database to support many thousands of concurrent users on a single node. For more scalability, you can use the Oracle Connection Manager to multiplex network connections.
Maintainability
Once validated, a PL/SQL stored procedure can be used with confidence in any number of applications. If its definition changes, only the procedure is affected, not the applications that call it. This simplifies maintenance and enhancement. Also, maintaining a procedure on the server is easier than maintaining copies on various client machines.
1-6
Overview of PL/SQL
Collections A collection is an ordered group of elements, all of the same type (for example, the grades for a class of students). Each element has a unique subscript that determines its position in the collection. PL/SQL offers two kinds of collections: nested tables and varrays (short for variable-size arrays). Collections work like the set, queue, stack, and hash table data structures found in most third-generation programming languages. Collections can store instances of an object type and can also be attributes of an object type. Collections can be passed as parameters. So, you can use them to move columns of data into and out of database tables or between client-side applications and stored subprograms. You can define collection types in a PL/SQL package, then use the same types across many applications.
Portability
Applications written in PL/SQL can run on any operating system and hardware platform where Oracle Database runs. You can write portable program libraries and reuse them in different environments.
Security
PL/SQL stored procedures let you divide application logic between the client and the server, to prevent client applications from manipulating sensitive Oracle Database data. Database triggers written in PL/SQL can prevent applications from making certain updates, and can audit user queries. You can restrict access to Oracle Database data by allowing users to manipulate it only through stored procedures that have a restricted set of privileges. For example, you can grant users access to a procedure that updates a table, but not grant them access to the table itself.
See Also: Oracle Database Security Guide for details on database
security features
DBMS_PIPE is used to communicate between sessions. DBMS_ALERT is used to broadcast alerts to users. DBMS_LOCK and DBMS_TRANSACTION are used for lock and transaction management. DBMS_AQ is used for Advanced Queuing. DBMS_LOB is used to manipulate large objects.
I I
Programmatic Environments
1-7
I I I
DBMS_ROWID is used for employing ROWID values. UTL_RAW is the RAW facility. UTL_REF is for work with REF values.
DBMS_SESSION is for session management by DBAs. DBMS_SPACE and DBMS_SHARED_POOL provide space information and reserve shared pool resources. DBMS_JOB is used to schedule jobs in the server.
Oracle Database Concepts for background information about Java and how the database supports it Oracle Database Java Developer's Guide Oracle Database JDBC Developer's Guide and Reference Oracle Database JPublisher User's Guide
I I I
1-8
Any database session can activate a dedicated JVM. All sessions share the same JVM code and statics; however, private states for any given session are held, and subsequently garbage collected, in an individual session space. This design provides the following benefits:
I
Java applications have the same session isolation and data integrity as SQL operations. There is no need to run Java in a separate process for data integrity. Oracle JVM is a robust JVM with a small memory footprint. The JVM has the same linear SMP scalability as the database and can support thousands of concurrent Java sessions.
I I I
Oracle JVM works consistently with every platform supported by Oracle Database. Java applications that you develop using Oracle JVM can be ported to any supported platform easily. Oracle JVM includes a deployment-time native compiler that enables Java code to be compiled once, stored in executable form, shared among users, and invoked more quickly and efficiently. Security features of the database are also available using Oracle JVM. Java classes must be loaded in a database schema (using Oracle JDeveloper, a third-party IDE, SQL*Plus, or the loadjava utility) before they can be invoked. Java class invocation is secured and controlled through database authentication and authorization, Java 2 security, and invoker's or definer's rights.
Type 1. A JDBC-ODBC bridge. Software must be installed on client systems. Type 2. Has Native methods (calls C or C++) and Java methods. Software must be installed on the client. Type 3. Pure Java. The client uses sockets to call middleware on the server. Type 4. The most pure Java solution. Talks directly to the database using Java sockets.
I I
Programmatic Environments
1-9
JDBC is based on the X/Open SQL Call Level Interface, and complies with the SQL92 Entry Level standard. You can use JDBC to do dynamic SQL. Dynamic SQL means that the embedded SQL statement to be executed is not known before the application is run, and requires input to build the statement. The drivers that are implemented by Oracle have extensions to the capabilities in the JDBC standard that was defined by Sun Microsystems. Oracle's implementations of JDBC drivers are described next. Oracle Database support of and extensions to various levels of the JDBC standard are described in "Oracle Database Extensions to JDBC Standards" on page 1-11.
1-10
The OCI driver is not appropriate for Java applets, because it uses a C library that is platform-specific and cannot be downloaded into a Web browser. It is usable in J2EE components running in middle-tier application servers, such as Oracle Application Server. Oracle Application Server provides middleware services and tools that support access between applications and browsers.
Support for Oracle datatypes Performance enhancement by row prefetching Performance enhancement by execution batching Specification of query column types to save round-trips Control of DatabaseMetaData calls
Oracle Database supports all APIs from the JDBC 2.0 standard, including the core APIs, optional packages, and numerous extensions. Some of the highlights include datasources, JTA and distributed transactions. Oracle Database supports these features from the JDBC 3.0 standard:
I I I I
Support for JDK 1.4. Toggling between local and global transactions. Transaction savepoints. Reuse of prepared statements by connection pools.
class JdbcTest { public static void main (String args []) throws SQLException { // Load Oracle driver DriverManager.registerDriver (new oracle.jdbc.OracleDriver()); // Connect to the local database Connection conn = DriverManager.getConnection ("jdbc:oracle:thin:@myhost:1521:orcl", "scott", "tiger"); // Query the employee names Statement stmt = conn.createStatement (); ResultSet rset = stmt.executeQuery ("SELECT ENAME FROM EMP");
1-12
// Print the name out while (rset.next ()) System.out.println (rset.getString (1)); // Close the result set, statement, and the connection rset.close(); stmt.close(); conn.close(); } }
One Oracle Database extension to the JDBC drivers is a form of the getConnection() method that uses a Properties object. The Properties object lets you specify user, password, and database information as well as row prefetching and execution batching. To use the OCI driver in this code, replace the Connection statement with:
Connection conn = DriverManager.getConnection ("jdbc:oracle:oci8:@MyHostString", "scott", "tiger");
where MyHostString is an entry in the TNSNAMES.ORA file. If you are creating an applet, the getConnection() and registerDriver() strings will be different.
Note: The term "SQLJ," when used in this manual, refers to the
Oracle SQLJ implementation, including Oracle SQLJ extensions. Oracle Database provides a translator and a run time driver to support SQLJ. The SQLJ translator is 100% pure Java and is portable to any JVM that is compliant with JDK version 1.1 or higher. The Oracle SQLJ translator performs the following tasks:
I
Translates SQLJ source to Java code with calls to the SQLJ run time driver. The SQLJ translator converts the source code to pure Java source code, and can check the syntax and semantics of static SQL statements against a database schema and verify the type compatibility of host variables with SQL types. Compiles the generated Java code using the Java compiler. (Optional) Creates profiles for the target database. SQLJ generates "profile" files with customization specific to Oracle Database.
I I
Oracle Database supports SQLJ stored procedures, functions, and triggers which execute in the Oracle JVM. SQLJ is integrated with JDeveloper. Source-level debugging support for SQLJ is available in JDeveloper. Here is an example of a simple SQLJ executable statement, which returns one value because empno is unique in the emp table:
String name; #sql { SELECT first_name INTO :name FROM employees WHERE employee_id=112 }; System.out.println("Name is " + name + ", employee number = " + employee_id);
Each host variable (or qualified name or complex Java host expression) included in a SQL expression is preceded by a colon (:). Other SQLJ statements are declarative (they declare Java types). For example, you can declare an iterator (a construct related to a database cursor) for queries that retrieve many values, as follows:
#sql iterator EmpIter (String EmpNam, int EmpNumb);
See Also: For more examples and details on Oracle SQLJ syntax:
I I
Oracle Database JPublisher User's Guide Sample SQLJ code available on the Oracle Technology Network Web site: http://otn.oracle.com/
1-14
Benefits of SQLJ
Oracle SQLJ extensions to Java allow rapid development and easy maintenance of applications that perform database operations through embedded SQL. In particular, Oracle SQLJ:
I
Provides a concise, legible mechanism for database access from static SQL. Most SQL in applications is static. SQLJ provides more concise and less error-prone static SQL constructs than JDBC does. Checks static SQL at translate time. Provides an SQL Checker module for verification of syntax and semantics at translate-time. Provides flexible deployment configurations. This makes it possible to implement SQLJ on the client or database side or in the middle tier. Supports a software standard. SQLJ is an effort of a group of vendors and will be supported by all of them. Applications can access multiple database vendors. Provides source code portability. Executables can be used with all of the vendors' DBMSs if the code does not rely on any vendor-specific features. Enforces a uniform programming style for the clients and the servers. Integrates the SQLJ translator with Oracle JDeveloper, a graphical IDE that provides SQLJ translation, Java compilation, profile customizing, and debugging at the source code level, all in one step. Includes Oracle type extensions. Datatypes supported include: LOB datatypes, ROWID, REF CURSOR, VARRAY, nested table, user-defined object types, RAW, and NUMBER.
I I
I I
SQLJ source code is more concise than equivalent JDBC source code. SQLJ uses database connections to type-check static SQL code. JDBC, being a completely dynamic API, does not.
SQLJ provides strong typing of query outputs and return parameters and allows type-checking on calls. JDBC passes values to and from SQL without compile-time type checking. SQLJ programs allow direct embedding of Java bind expressions within SQL statements. JDBC requires a separate get or set statement for each bind variable and specifies the binding by position number. SQLJ provides simplified rules for calling SQL stored procedures and functions. For example, the following JDBC excerpt requires a generic call to a stored procedure or function, in this case fun, to have the following syntax. (This examples shows SQL92 and Oracle JDBC syntaxes. Both are allowed.)
prepStmt.prepareCall("{call fun(?,?)}"); //stored procedure SQL92 prepStmt.prepareCall("{? = call fun(?,?)}"); //stored function SQL92 prepStmt.prepareCall("begin fun(:1,:2);end;"); //stored procedure Oracle prepStmt.prepareCall("begin :1 := fun(:2,:3);end;");//stored func Oracle
SQLJ source files can contain JDBC calls. SQLJ and JDBC are interoperable. Oracle JPublisher generates custom Java classes to be used in your SQLJ or JDBC application for mappings to Oracle object types and collections. Java and PL/SQL stored procedures can be used interchangeably.
Translate, compile, and customize the SQLJ source code on a client and load the generated classes and resources into the server with the loadjava utility. The classes are typically stored in a Java archive (.jar) file. Load the SQLJ source code into the server, also using loadjava, where it is translated and compiled by the server's embedded translator.
1-16
See Also: Oracle Database JPublisher User's Guide for more information on using stored procedures with Oracle SQLJ
Web Services Description Language (WSDL)A standard format for creating an XML document that specifies the operations and parameters, including parameter types, provided by a Web service. In addition, a WSDL document
describes the location, the transport protocol, and the invocation style for the Web service.
I
Simple Object Access Protocol (SOAP) messagingAn XML-based message protocol used by Web services. SOAP does not prescribe a specific transport mechanism, such as HTTP, FTP, SMTP, or JMS; however, most Web services accept messages using HTTP or HTTPS. Universal Description, Discovery, and Integration (UDDI) business registryA directory that businesses use to list Web services on the internet. The UDDI registry is often compared to a telephone directory, listing unique identifiers (white pages), business categories (yellow pages), and how to bind to a service protocol (green pages).
Web services can use a variety of techniques and protocols. For example, dispatching can happen in a synchronous (typical) or asynchronous manner, invocation can be performed in RPC-style (a single operation with arguments is sent and a response returned) or in message style (a one-way SOAP document exchange), and different encoding rules can be used (literal or encoded). When calling a Web service, you may know everything about it beforehand (static invocation), or you can discover its operations and transport endpoints on the fly (dynamic invocation).
Exposes PL/SQL as well as Java stored procedures Exposes SQL Queries and DML statements Exposes XML operations using existing and emerging XML APIs such as XSU, SQL/X, and XQuery. Exposes Advanced Queuing queues and operations Enables deferred invocation of database operations
I I
1-18
For example, when business data is available dynamically from an external Web service, your database application might need to:
I I
Fire a trigger on a data value received from a Web service. Monitor and query dynamic data over time, such as stock prices, mortgage interest rates, currency exchange rates, or atmospheric data.
SQL CALL statements. Embedded SQL CALL statements. PL/SQL blocks, subprograms and packages. DML statements (INSERT, UPDATE, DELETE, and SELECT). Oracle development tools such as OCI, Pro*C/C++ and Oracle Developer. Oracle Java interfaces such as JDBC, SQLJ statements, CORBA, and Enterprise Java Beans. Method calls from object types.
Stored procedures and triggers are compiled once, are easy to use and maintain, and require less memory and computing overhead. Network bottlenecks are avoided, and response time is improved. Distributed applications are easier to build and use. Computation-bound procedures run faster in the server.
Overview of Pro*C/C++
Data access can be controlled by letting users have only stored procedures and triggers that execute with their definer's privileges instead of invoker's rights. PL/SQL and Java stored procedures can call each other. Java in the server follows the Java language specification and can use the SQLJ standard, so that databases other than Oracle Database are also supported. Stored procedures and triggers can be reused in different applications as well as different geographic sites.
I I
Overview of Pro*C/C++
The Pro*C/C++ precompiler is a software tool that allows the programmer to embed SQL statements in a C or C++ source file. Pro*C/C++ reads the source file as input and outputs a C or C++ source file that replaces the embedded SQL statements with Oracle runtime library calls, and is then compiled by the C or C++ compiler. When there are errors found during the precompilation or the subsequent compilation, modify your precompiler input file and re-run the two steps.
1-20
Overview of Pro*C/C++
/* Select columns ename, sal, and comm given the user's input for empno. */ EXEC SQL SELECT ename, sal, comm INTO :emprec INDICATOR :emprec_ind FROM emp WHERE empno = :emp_number; ...
The embedded SELECT statement is only slightly different from an interactive (SQL*Plus) SELECT statement. Every embedded SQL statement begins with EXEC SQL. The colon (:), precedes every host (C) variable. The returned values of data and indicators (set when the data value is NULL or character columns have been truncated) can be stored in structs (such as in the preceding code fragment), in arrays, or in arrays of structs. Multiple result set values are handled very simply in a manner that resembles the case shown, where there is only one result, because of the unique employee number. You use the actual names of columns and tables in embedded SQL. Use the default precompiler option values, or you can enter values which give you control over the use of resources, how errors are reported, the formatting of output, and how cursors (which correspond to a particular connection or SQL statement) are managed. Cursors are used when there are multiple result set values. Enter the options either in a configuration file, on the command line, or in-line inside your source code with a special statement that begins with EXEC ORACLE. If there are no errors found, you can then compile, link, and execute the output source file, like any other C program that you write. Use the precompiler to create server database access from clients that can be on many different platforms. Pro*C/C++ allows you the freedom to design your own user interfaces and to add database access to existing applications. Before writing your embedded SQL statements, you may want to test interactive versions of the SQL in SQL*Plus. You then make only minor changes to start testing your embedded SQL application.
You can write your application in either C or C++. You can write multithreaded programs if your platform supports a threads package. Concurrent connections are supported in either single-threaded or multithreaded applications.
Overview of Pro*C/C++
You can improve performance by embedding PL/SQL blocks. These blocks can call functions or procedures in Java or PL/SQL that are written by you or provided in Oracle Database packages. Using precompiler options, you can check the syntax and semantics of your SQL or PL/SQL statements during precompilation, as well as at runtime. You can call stored PL/SQL and Java subprograms. Modules written in COBOL or in C can be called from Pro*C/C++. External C procedures in shared libraries are callable by your program. You can conditionally precompile sections of your code so that they can execute in different environments. You can use arrays, or structures, or arrays of structures as host and indicator variables in your code to improve performance. You can deal with errors and warnings so that data integrity is guaranteed. As a programmer, you control how errors are handled. Your program can convert between internal datatypes and C language datatypes. The Oracle Call Interface (OCI) and Oracle C++ Call Interface (OCCI), lower-level C and C++ interfaces, are available for use in your precompiler source. Pro*C/C++ supports dynamic SQL, a technique that allows users to input variable values and statement syntax. Pro*C/C++ can use special SQL statements to manipulate tables containing user-defined object types. An Object Type Translator (OTT) will map the object types and named collection types in your database to structures and headers that you will then include in your source. Two kinds of collection types, nested tables and VARRAY, are supported with a set of SQL statements that allow a high degree of control over data. Large Objects (LOBs: CLOB, NCLOB, and BFILE datatypes) are accessed by another set of SQL statements. A new ANSI SQL standard for dynamic SQL is supported for new applications, so that you can execute SQL statements with a varying number of host variables. An older technique for dynamic SQL is still usable by pre-existing applications. Globalization support lets you use multibyte characters and UCS2 Unicode data.
1-22
Overview of Pro*COBOL
Using scrollable cursors, you can move backward and forward through a result set. For example, you can fetch the last row of the result set, or jump forward or backward to an absolute or relative position within the result set. A connection pool is a group of physical connections to a database that can be shared by several named connections. Enabling the connection pool option can help to optimize the performance of Pro*C/C++ application. The connection pool option is not enabled by default.
Overview of Pro*COBOL
The Pro*COBOL precompiler is a software tool that allows the programmer to embed SQL statements in a COBOL source code file. Pro*COBOL reads the source file as input and outputs a COBOL source file that replaces the embedded SQL statements with Oracle Database runtime library calls, and is then compiled by the COBOL compiler. When there are errors found during the precompilation or the subsequent compilation, modify your precompiler input file and re-run the two steps.
Overview of Pro*COBOL
The embedded SELECT statement is only slightly different from an interactive (SQL*Plus) SELECT statement. Every embedded SQL statement begins with EXEC SQL. The colon (:) precedes every host (COBOL) variable. The SQL statement is terminated by END-EXEC. The returned values of data and indicators (set when the data value is NULL or character columns have been truncated) can be stored in group items (such as in the preceding code fragment), in tables, or in tables of group items. Multiple result set values are handled very simply in a manner that resembles the case shown, where there is only one result, given the unique employee number. You use the actual names of columns and tables in embedded SQL. Use the default precompiler option values, or enter values that give you control over the use of resources, how errors are reported, the formatting of output, and how cursors are managed (cursors correspond to a particular connection or SQL statement). Enter the options in a configuration file, on the command line, or in-line inside your source code with a special statement that begins with EXEC ORACLE. If there are no errors found, you can then compile, link, and execute the output source file, like any other COBOL program that you write. Use the precompiler to create server database access from clients that can be on many different platforms. Pro*COBOL allows you the freedom to design your own user interfaces and to add database access to existing COBOL applications. The embedded SQL statements available conform to an ANSI standard, so that you can access data from many databases in a program, including remote servers networked through Oracle Net. Before writing your embedded SQL statements, you may want to test interactive versions of the SQL in SQL*Plus. You then make only minor changes to start testing your embedded SQL application.
You can call stored PL/SQL or Java subprograms. You can improve performance by embedding PL/SQL blocks. These blocks can call PL/SQL functions or procedures written by you or provided in Oracle Database packages.
1-24
Precompiler options allow you to define how cursors, errors, syntax-checking, file formats, and so on, are handled. Using precompiler options, you can check the syntax and semantics of your SQL or PL/SQL statements during precompilation, as well as at runtime. You can conditionally precompile sections of your code so that they can execute in different environments. Use tables, or group items, or tables of group items as host and indicator variables in your code to improve performance. You can program how errors and warnings are handled, so that data integrity is guaranteed. Pro*COBOL supports dynamic SQL, a technique that allows users to input variable values and statement syntax.
See Also: Pro*COBOL Programmer's Guide for complete details
Improved performance and scalability through the efficient use of system memory and network connectivity Consistent interfaces for dynamic session and transaction management in a two-tier client/server or multitier environment N-tiered authentication Comprehensive support for application development using Oracle objects Access to external databases Ability to develop applications that service an increasing number of users and requests without additional hardware investments
I I I I
OCI lets you manipulate data and schemas in a database using a host programming language, such as C. OCCI is an object-oriented interface suitable for use with C++. These APIs provide a library of standard database access and retrieval functions in the form of a dynamic runtime library (OCILIB) that can be linked in an application
at runtime. This eliminates the need to embed SQL or PL/SQL within 3GL programs.
See Also: For more information about OCI and OCCI calls:
I I I I I
Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide Oracle C++ Call Interface Programmer's Guide Oracle Streams Advanced Queuing User's Guide and Reference Oracle Database Globalization Support Guide Oracle Data Cartridge Developer's Guide
Advantages of OCI
OCI provides significant advantages over other methods of accessing Oracle Database:
I I I
More fine-grained control over all aspects of the application design. High degree of control over program execution. Use of familiar 3GL programming techniques and application development tools such as browsers and debuggers. Support of dynamic SQL, method 4. Availability on the broadest range of platforms of all the Oracle programmatic interfaces. Dynamic bind and define using callbacks. Describe functionality to expose layers of server metadata. Asynchronous event notification for registered client applications. Enhanced array data manipulation language (DML) capability for array INSERTs, UPDATEs, and DELETEs. Ability to associate a commit request with an execute to reduce round-trips. Optimization for queries using transparent prefetch buffers to reduce round-trips. Thread safety, so you do not have to implement mutual exclusion (mutex) locks on OCI handles. The server connection in nonblocking mode means that control returns to the OCI code when a call is still executing or could not complete.
I I
I I I I
I I
1-26
OCI relational functions, for managing database access and processing SQL statements OCI navigational functions, for manipulating objects retrieved from an Oracle Database OCI datatype mapping and manipulation functions, for manipulating data attributes of Oracle types OCI external procedure functions, for writing C callbacks from PL/SQL
In a non-procedural language program, the set of data to be operated on is specified, but what operations will be performed and how the operations are to be carried out is not specified. The non-procedural nature of SQL makes it an easy language to learn and to use to perform database transactions. It is also the standard language used to access and manipulate data in modern relational and object-relational database systems. In a procedural language program, the execution of most statements depends on previous or subsequent statements and on control structures, such as loops or conditional branches, which are not available in SQL. The procedural nature of these languages makes them more complex than SQL, but it also makes them very flexible and powerful.
The combination of both non-procedural and procedural language elements in an OCI program provides easy access to Oracle Database in a structured programming environment. The OCI supports all SQL data definition, data manipulation, query, and transaction control facilities that are available through Oracle Database. For example, an OCI program can run a query against Oracle Database. The queries can require the program to supply data to the database using input (bind) variables, as follows:
SELECT name FROM employees WHERE empno = :empnumber
In the preceding SQL statement,:empnumber is a placeholder for a value that will be supplied by the application. You can alternatively use PL/SQL, Oracle's procedural extension to SQL. The applications you develop can be more powerful and flexible than applications written in SQL alone. The OCI also provides facilities for accessing and manipulating objects in Oracle Database.
Source Files
Object Files
OCI Library
Host Linker
Application
Object Server
some platforms to include other libraries, in addition to the OCI library. Check your Oracle platform-specific documentation for further information about extra libraries that may be required.
1-28
BASE\ORACLE_HOME\ODP.NET\Samples.
OO4O "In-Process" Automation Server Oracle Data Control Oracle Objects for OLE C++ Class Library
1-30
COM/DCOM OO4O In-Process Automation Server Oracle Client Libraries (OCI, CORE, NLS)
Oracle Database
multitiered application server environments such as Web server applications in Microsoft Internet Information Server (IIS) or Microsoft Transaction Server (MTS). Features include:
I
Support for execution of PL/SQL and Java stored procedures, and PL/SQL anonymous blocks. This includes support for Oracle datatypes used as parameters to stored procedures, including PL/SQL cursors. See "Support for Oracle LOB and Object Datatypes" on page 1-37. Support for scrollable and updatable cursors for easy and efficient access to result sets of queries. Thread-safe objects and Connection Pool Management Facility for developing efficient Web server applications. Full support for Oracle object-relational and LOB datatypes. Full support for Advanced Queuing. Support for array inserts and updates. Support for Microsoft Transaction Server (MTS).
I I I I
1-32
OraMetaData
OraMDAttribute
OraSQLStmt
OraAQ
OraAQMsg
OraSession
An OraSession object manages collections of OraDatabase, OraConnection, and OraDynaset objects used within an application. Typically, a single OraSession object is created for each application, but you can create named OraSession objects for shared use within and between applications. The OraSession object is the top-most object for an application. It is the only object created by the CreateObject VB/VBA API and not by an Oracle Objects for OLE method. The following code fragment shows how to create an OraSession object:
Dim OraSession as Object Set OraSession = CreateObject("OracleInProcServer.XOraSession")
OraServer
OraServer represents a physical network connection to Oracle Database. The OraServer interface is introduced to expose the connection-multiplexing feature provided in the Oracle Call Interface. After an OraServer object is created, multiple user sessions (OraDatabase) can be attached to it by invoking the OpenDatabase method. This feature is particularly useful for application
components, such as Internet Information Server (IIS), that use Oracle Objects for OLE in n-tier distributed environments. The use of connection multiplexing when accessing Oracle Database with a large number of user sessions active can help reduce server processing and resource requirements while improving server scalability. OraServer is used to share a single connection across multiple OraDatabase objects (multiplexing), whereas each OraDatabase obtained from an OraSession has its own physical connection.
OraDatabase
An OraDatabase interface adds additional methods for controlling transactions and creating interfaces representing of Oracle object types. Attributes of schema objects can be retrieved using the Describe method of the OraDatabase interface. In releases prior to Oracle8i, an OraDatabase object is created by invoking the OpenDatabase method of an OraSession interface. The Oracle Net alias, user name, and password are passed as arguments to this method. In Oracle8i and later, invocation of this method results in implicit creation of an OraServer object. An OraDatabase object can also be created using the OpenDatabase method of the OraServer interface. Transaction control methods are available at the OraDatabase (user session) level. Transactions may be started as Read-Write (default), Serializable, or Read-only. Transaction control methods include:
I I I
For example:
UserSession.BeginTrans(OO4O_TXN_READ_WRITE) UserSession.ExecuteSQL("delete emp where empno = 1234") UserSession.CommitTrans
OraDynaset
An OraDynaset object permits browsing and updating of data created from a SQL SELECT statement.
1-34
The OraDynaset object can be thought of as a cursor, although in actuality several real cursors may be used to implement the semantics of OraDynaset. An OraDynaset object automatically maintains a local cache of data fetched from the server and transparently implements scrollable cursors within the browse data. Large queries may require significant local disk space; application developers are encouraged to refine queries to limit disk usage.
OraField
An OraField object represents a single column or data item within a row of a dynaset. If the current row is being updated, then the OraField object represents the currently updated value, although the value may not yet have been committed to the database. Assignment to the Value property of a field is permitted only if a record is being edited (using Edit) or a new record is being added (using AddNew). Other attempts to assign data to a field's Value property results in an error.
Metadata Attribute Name Metadata Attribute Value Flag specifying whether the Value is another OraMetaData object
The OraMDAttribute objects contained in the OraMetaData object can be accessed by subscripting using ordinal integers or by using the name of the property. Referencing a subscript that is not in the collection results in the return of a NULL OraMDAttribute object.
to SQL and PL/SQL statements of other objects (as noted in the object descriptions), by using the parameter name as a placeholder in the SQL or PL/SQL statement. Such use of parameters can simplify dynamic queries and increase program performance.
OraParamArray
An OraParamArray object represents an array-type bind variable in a SQL statement or PL/SQL block, as opposed to a scalar-type bind variable represented by the OraParameter object. OraParamArray objects are created, accessed, and removed indirectly through the OraParameters collection of an OraDatabase object. Each OraParamArray object has an identifying name and an associated value.
OraSQLStmt
An OraSQLStmt object represents a single SQL statement. Use the CreateSQL method to create an OraSQLStmt object from an OraDatabase object. During create and refresh, OraSQLStmt objects automatically bind all relevant, enabled input parameters to the specified SQL statement, using the parameter names as placeholders in the SQL statement. This can improve the performance of SQL statement execution without re-parsing the SQL statement. The OraSQLStmt object can be used later to execute the same query using a different value for the :SALARY placeholder. This is done as follows (updateStmt is the OraSQLStmt object here):
OraDatabase.Parameters("SALARY").value = 200000 updateStmt.Parameters("ENAME").value = "KING" updateStmt.Refresh
OraAQ
An OraAQ object is instantiated by invoking the CreateAQ method of the OraDatabase interface. It represents a queue that is present in the database. Oracle Objects for OLE provides interfaces for accessing Oracle Advanced Queuing (AQ) feature. It makes AQ accessible from popular COM-based development environments such as Visual Basic. For a detailed description of Oracle Advanced Queuing, refer to Oracle Streams Advanced Queuing User's Guide and Reference.
1-36
OraAQMsg
The OraAQMsg object encapsulates the message to be enqueued or dequeued. The message can be of any user-defined or raw type. For a detailed description of Oracle Advanced Queuing, refer to Oracle Streams Advanced Queuing User's Guide and Reference.
OraAQAgent
The OraAQAgent object represents a message recipient and is only valid for queues that allow multiple consumers. It is a child of OraAQMsg. An OraAQAgent object can be instantiated by invoking the AQAgent method. For example:
Set agent = qMsg.AQAgent(name)
An OraAQAgent object can also be instantiated by invoking the AddRecipient method. For example:
Set agent = qMsg.AddRecipient(name, address, protocol).
OraCLOB
OraBFILE
OraBFILE
The OraBFile interface in Oracle Objects for OLE provides methods for performing operations on large database objects of datatype BFILE. BFILE objects are large binary data objects stored in operating system files outside of the database tablespaces.
1-38
Oracle Objects for OLE Help Oracle Objects for OLE C++ Class Library Help
To view examples of how to use Oracle Objects for OLE, see the samples located in the ORACLE_HOME\OO4O directory of the Oracle Database installation. Additional OO4O examples can be found in the following Oracle publications:
I I I
Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects Oracle Streams Advanced Queuing User's Guide and Reference PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference
Review the preceding overviews and the manuals for each environment. Read the platform-specific manual that explains which compilers are approved for use with your platforms. If a particular language does not provide a feature you need, remember that PL/SQL and Java stored procedures can both be called from code written in any of the languages in this chapter. Stored procedures include triggers and object type methods. External procedures written in C can be called from OCI, Java, PL/SQL or SQL. The external procedure itself can call back into the database using either SQL, OCI, or Pro*C (but not C++).
Pro*COBOL does not support object types or collection types, while Pro*C/C++ does. SQLJ does not support dynamic SQL the way that JDBC does.
OCI provides more detailed control over multiplexing and migrating sessions. OCI provides dynamic bind and define using callbacks that can be used for any arbitrary structure, including lists. OCI has many calls to handle metadata. OCI allows asynchronous event notifications to be received by a client application. It provides a means for clients to generate notifications for propagation to other clients. OCI allows DML statements to use arrays to complete as many iterations as possible before returning any error messages.
I I
1-40
OCI calls for special purposes include Advanced Queuing, globalization support, Data Cartridges, and support of the date and time datatypes. OCI calls can be embedded in a Pro*C/C++ application.
1-42
Part II
Designing the Database
This part contains the following chapters:
I I I I I I I
Chapter 2, "Selecting a Datatype" Chapter 3, "Maintaining Data Integrity Through Constraints" Chapter 4, "Selecting an Index Strategy" Chapter 5, "How Oracle Database Processes SQL Statements" Chapter 6, "Coding Dynamic SQL Statements" Chapter 7, "Using Procedures and Packages" Chapter 8, "Calling External Procedures"
2
Selecting a Datatype
This chapter discusses how to use Oracle built-in datatypes in applications. Topics include:
I I I I I I I I I I I I I I
Summary of Oracle Built-In Datatypes Representing Character Data Representing Numeric Data with Number and Floating-Point Datatypes Representing Date and Time Data Representing Conditional Expressions as Data Representing Geographic Coordinate Data Representing Image, Audio, and Video Data Representing Searchable Text Data Representing Large Amounts of Data Addressing Rows Directly with the ROWID Datatype ANSI/ISO, DB2, and SQL/DS Datatypes How Oracle Database Converts Datatypes Representing Dynamically Typed Data Representing XML Data
Selecting a Datatype
2-1
See Also:
I
Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Object-Relational Features for information about more complex types, such as object types, varrays, and nested tables Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects for information about LOB datatypes PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference for information about the PL/SQL datatypes. Many SQL datatypes are the same or similar in PL/SQL.
Character datatypes CHAR NCHAR VARCHAR2 and VARCHAR (synonymous with VARCHAR2) NVARCHAR2 CLOB NCLOB LONG
2-2
INTERVAL YEAR TO MONTH TIMESTAMP TIMESTAMP WITH TIME ZONE TIMESTAMP WITH LOCAL TIME ZONE
Oracle Database SQL Reference for general descriptions of these datatypes Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects for information about the LOB datatypes
Selecting a Datatype
2-3
Table 21 Datatype
Summary of Oracle Built-In Datatypes Description Fixed-length character data of length size bytes or characters. Column Length / Default Values Fixed for every row in the table (with trailing blanks); maximum size is 2000 bytes per row, default size is 1 byte per row. When neither BYTE nor CHAR is specified, the setting of NLS_LENGTH_ SEMANTICS at the time of column creation determines which is used. Consider the character set (single-byte or multibyte) before setting size. Variable for each row, up to 4000 bytes per row. When neither BYTE nor CHAR is specified, the setting of NLS_LENGTH_ SEMANTICS at the time of column creation determines which is used. Consider the character set (single-byte or multibyte) before setting size. Fixed for every row in the table (with trailing blanks). The upper limit is 2000 bytes per row. Default size is 1 character.
Variable-length character data, with maximum length size bytes or characters. BYTE or CHAR indicates that the column has byte or character semantics, respectively. A size must be specified.
NCHAR [(size)]
Fixed-length Unicode character data of length size characters. The number of bytes is twice this number for the AL16UTF16 encoding and 3 times this number for the UTF8 encoding.)
NVARCHAR2 (size)
Variable-length Unicode Variable for each row. The character data of maximum upper limit is 4000 bytes length size characters. The per row. number of bytes may be up to 2 times size for a the AL16UTF16 encoding and 3 times this number for the UTF8 encoding. A size must be specified.
2-4
Table 21 (Cont.) Summary of Oracle Built-In Datatypes Datatype CLOB Description Single-byte or multibyte character data. Both fixed-width and variable-width character sets are supported, and both use the CHAR character set. Unicode national character set (NCHAR) data. Both fixed-width and variable-width character sets are supported, and both use the NCHAR character set. Variable-length character data. Provided for backward compatibility. 32-bit floating-point number. 64-bit floating-point number. Variable-length numeric data. Precision prec is the the total number of digits; scale scale is the number of digits to the right of the decimal point. Precision can range from 1 to 38. Scale can range from -84 to 127. With precision specified, this is a floating-point number; with no precision specified, it is a fixed-point number. Column Length / Default Values Up to 232 - 1 bytes * (database block size), or 4 gigabytes * block size.1 See Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects. Up to 232 - 1 bytes * (database block size), or 4 gigabytes * block size. 1 See Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects. Variable for each row in the table, up to 231 - 1 bytes, or 2 gigabytes, per row. 4 bytes. 8 bytes. Variable for each row. The maximum space available for a given column is 21 bytes per row.
NCLOB
LONG
Selecting a Datatype
2-5
Table 21 (Cont.) Summary of Oracle Built-In Datatypes Datatype DATE Description Fixed-length date and time data, ranging from Jan. 1, 4712 B.C.E. to Dec. 31, 9999 C.E. Column Length / Default Values Fixed at 7 bytes for each row in the table. Default format is a string (such as DD-MON-RR) specified by the NLS_DATE_FORMAT parameter.
A period of time, Fixed at 5 bytes. represented as years and months. The yr_prec is the number of digits in the YEAR field of the date. The precision can be from 0 to 9, and defaults to 2 digits. A period of time, Fixed at 11 bytes. represented as days, hours, minutes, and seconds. The day_prec and frac_sec_ prec are the number of digits in the DAY and the fractional SECOND fields of the date, respectively. These precision values can each be from 0 to 9, and they default to 2 digits for day_ prec and 6 digits for frac_sec_prec. A value representing a date and time, including fractional seconds. (The exact resolution depends on the operating system clock.) The frac_sec_prec specifies the number of digits in the fractional second part of the SECOND date field. The frac_sec_ prec can be from 0 to 9, and defaults to 6 digits. Varies from 7 to 11 bytes, depending on the precision. The default is determined by the NLS_ TIMESTAMP_FORMAT initialization parameter.
TIMESTAMP [(frac_sec_prec)]
2-6
Table 21 (Cont.) Summary of Oracle Built-In Datatypes Datatype TIMESTAMP [(frac_sec_prec)] WITH TIME ZONE Description A value representing a date and time, plus an associated time zone setting. The time zone can be an offset from UTC, such as '-5:0', or a region name, such as 'US/Pacific'. The frac_sec_prec is as for datatype TIMESTAMP. TIMESTAMP [(frac_sec_prec)] WITH LOCAL TIME ZONE Similar to TIMESTAMP WITH TIME ZONE, except that the data is normalized to the database time zone when stored, and adjusted to match the client's time zone when retrieved. The frac_sec_prec is as for datatype TIMESTAMP. BLOB Unstructured binary data. Up to 232 - 1 bytes * (database block size), or 4 gigabytes * block size.1 See Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects. The referenced file can be up to 232 - 1 bytes * (database block size), or 4 gigabytes * block size.1 See Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects. Varies from 7 to 11 bytes, depending on frac_ sec_prec. The default is determined by the NLS_ TIMESTAMP_FORMAT initialization parameter. Column Length / Default Values Fixed at 13 bytes. The default is determined by the NLS_TIMESTAMP_ TZ_FORMAT initialization parameter.
BFILE
Address of a binary file stored outside the database. Enables byte-stream I/O access to external LOBs residing on the database server.
RAW (size)
Variable-length raw binary Variable for each row in data. A size, which is the the table, up to 2000 bytes maximum number of bytes, per row. must be specified. Provided for backward compatibility.
Selecting a Datatype
2-7
Table 21 (Cont.) Summary of Oracle Built-In Datatypes Datatype LONG RAW Description Variable-length raw binary data. Provided for backward compatibility. Base 64 binary data representing a row address. Used primarily for values returned by the ROWID pseudocolumn. Base 64 binary data representing the logical address of a row in an index-organized table. The optional size is the number of bytes in a column of type UROWID. Column Length / Default Values Variable for each row in the table, up to 231 - 1 bytes, or 2 gigabytes, per row. Fixed at 10 bytes (extended ROWID) or 6 bytes (restricted ROWID) for each row in the table. Maximum size and default are both 4000 bytes.
ROWID
UROWID [(size)]
Prior to Oracle Database 10g, the limit was 4 gigabytes, not 4 gigabytes*blocksize.
CHAR and NCHAR datatypes store fixed-length character strings. VARCHAR2 and NVARCHAR2 datatypes store variable-length character strings. (The VARCHAR datatype is synonymous with the VARCHAR2 datatype.) NCHAR and NVARCHAR2 datatypes store Unicode character data only. CLOB and NCLOB datatypes store single-byte and multibyte character strings of up to four gigabytes.
See Also: Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects
I I
The LONG datatype stores variable-length character strings containing up to two gigabytes, but with many restrictions. This datatype is provided only for backward compatibility with existing applications. In general, new applications should use CLOB and NCLOB datatypes to store large amounts of character data, and BLOB and BFILE to store large amounts of binary data.
2-8
See Also:
I
Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects for information on LOB datatypes (including CLOB and NCLOB datatypes) and information on migrating from LONG to LOB datatypes Oracle Database SQL Reference for details on restrictions on LONG datatypes
When deciding which datatype to use for a column that will store alphanumeric data in a table, consider the following points of distinction:
I
Space usage To store data more efficiently, use the VARCHAR2 datatype. The CHAR datatype blank-pads and stores trailing blanks up to a fixed column length for all column values, while the VARCHAR2 datatype does not add any extra blanks. Comparison semantics Use the CHAR datatype when you require ANSI compatibility in comparison semantics (when trailing blanks are not important in string comparisons). Use the VARCHAR2 when trailing blanks are important in string comparisons. Future compatibility The CHAR and VARCHAR2 datatypes are and will always be fully supported. At this time, the VARCHAR datatype automatically corresponds to the VARCHAR2 datatype and is reserved for future use.
CHAR, VARCHAR2, and LONG data is automatically converted by the NLS_LANGUAGE parameter from the database character set to the character set defined for the user session, if these are different.
Selecting a Datatype
2-9
-- BIOGRAPHY can represent 2000 characters in any Unicode-representable -- language. -- The exact encoding depends on the national character set, but the column can -- contain multibyte values even if the database character set is single-byte. BIOGRAPHY NVARCHAR2(2000); -- The representation of COMMENT, as 2000 bytes or 2000 characters, depends -- on the initialization parameter NLS_LENGTH_SEMANTICS. COMMENT VARCHAR2(2000);
When using a multibyte database character encoding scheme, consider carefully the space required for tables with character columns. If the database character encoding scheme is single-byte, then the number of bytes and the number of characters in a column is the same. If it is multibyte, then there generally is no such correspondence. A character might consist of one or more bytes, depending upon the specific multibyte encoding scheme and whether shift-in/shift-out control codes are present. To avoid overflowing buffers, specify data as NCHAR or NVARCHAR2 if it might use a Unicode encoding that is different from the database character set.
See Also:
I I
Comparison Semantics
Oracle Database compares CHAR and NCHAR values using blank-padded comparison semantics. If two values have different character lengths, then Oracle Database adds space characters at the end of the shorter value, until the two values are the same length. Oracle Database then compares the values character by character up to the first character that differs. The value with the greater character in the first differing position is considered greater. Two values that differ only in the number of trailing blanks are thus considered equal. Oracle Database compares VARCHAR2 and NVARCHAR2 values using non-padded comparison semantics. Two values are considered equal only if they have the same
2-10
characters and are of equal length. Oracle Database compares the values character-by-character up to the first character that differs. The value with the greater character in that position is considered greater. If one value is a prefix of the other, then it is considered less ("abc" < "abcxyz") Because Oracle Database blank-pads values stored in CHAR columns but not in VARCHAR2 columns, a value stored in a VARCHAR2 column may take up less space than if it were stored in a CHAR column. For this reason, a full table scan on a large table containing VARCHAR2 columns may read fewer data blocks than a full table scan on a table containing the same data stored in CHAR columns. If your application often performs full table scans on large tables containing character data, then you might be able to improve performance by storing this data in VARCHAR2 columns rather than in CHAR columns. However, performance is not the only factor to consider when deciding which of these datatypes to use. Oracle Database uses different semantics to compare values of each datatype. You might choose one datatype over the other if your application is sensitive to the differences between these semantics. For example, if you want Oracle Database to ignore trailing blanks when comparing character values, then you must store these values in CHAR columns.
See Also: Oracle Database SQL Reference for more information on
The BINARY_FLOAT and BINARY_DOUBLE datatypes store floating-point data in the 32-bit IEEE 754 format and the double precision 64-bit IEEE 754 format respectively. Compared to the Oracle NUMBER datatype, arithmetic operations on floating-point data are usually faster for BINARY_FLOAT and BINARY_DOUBLE. Also, high-precision values require less space when stored as BINARY_FLOAT and BINARY_DOUBLE. In client interfaces supported by Oracle Database, arithmetic operations on BINARY_FLOAT and BINARY_DOUBLE datatypes are performed by the native instruction set supplied by the hardware vendor. The term native floating-point datatypes is used here to refer to datatypes including BINARY_FLOAT and
2-12
(-1)s 2E (b0 b1 b2 ... bp-1) where s = 0 or 1 E = any integer between Emin and Emax, inclusive (see Table 22) bi = 0 or 1; the sequence of bits represents a number in base 2 The leading bit of the significand, b0, must be set (1), except for subnormal numbers (explained later). Consequently, the leading bit is not actually stored. Consequently, the formats provide N bits of precision, although only N-1 bits are stored.
Note: The IEEE 754 specification also defines extended
single-precision and extended double-precision formats, which are not supported by Oracle Database. The parameters for these formats are listed in Table 22, and the storage parameters for the formats are listed in Table 23. The in-memory formats for single-precision and double-precision datatypes are specified by IEEE 754.
Table 22 Parameter p Emin Emax Summary of Format Parameters Single-precision (32-bit) 24 -126 +127 Double-precision (64-bit) 53 -1022 +1023
Table 23 Datatype
Summary of Storage Parameters Sign bits 1 1 Exponent bits 8 11 Significand bits 24 (23 stored) 53 (52 stored) Total bits 32 64
single-precision double-precision
A significand is normalized when the leading bit of the significand is set. IEEE 754 defines denormal or subnormal values as numbers that are too small to be represented with an implied leading set bit in the significand. The number is too
small because its exponent would be too large if its significand were normalized to have an implied leading bit set. IEEE 754 formats support subnormal values. Subnormal values preserve the following property: if: x - y == 0.0 (using floating-point subtraction) then: x == y Table 24 shows the range and precision of the required formats in the IEEE 754 standard and those of Oracle NUMBER. Range limits are expressed here in terms of positive numbers; they also apply to the absolute value of a negative number. (The notation "number e exponent" used here stands for number multiplied by 10 raised to the exponent power: number . 10 exponent.)
Table 24 Range and Precision Range and Precision of IEEE 754 formats Single-precision 32-bit1 Double-precision 64-bit1 Oracle NUMBER Datatype
Max positive normal 3.40282347e+38 number Min positive normal number Max positive subnormal number Min positive subnormal number Precision (decimal digits)
1
1.7976931348623157 < 1.0e126 e+308 2.2250738585072014 1.0e-130 e-308 2.2250738585072009 not applicable e-308 4.9406564584124654 not applicable e-324 15 - 17 38 - 40
These numbers are quoted from the IEEE Numerical Computation Guide.
2-14
are enabled and disabled. Oracle Database does not allow exceptions to be enabled; the database behavior is that specified by IEEE 754 for when exceptions are disabled. In particular, no distinction is made between signalling NaNs and quiet NaNs. Programmers using Oracle Call Interface can retrieve NaN values from Oracle Database; whether a retrieved NaN value is signalling or quiet is dependent on the client platform and beyond the control of Oracle Database. IEEE 754 does not define the bit pattern for either type of NaN. Positive infinity, negative infinity, positive zero, and negative zero are each represented by a specific bit pattern. Ignoring signs, there are five classes of values: zero, subnormal, normal, infinity and NaN. The first four classes are ordered as: zero < subnormal < normal < infinity In IEEE 754, NaN is unordered with other classes of special values and with itself.
All NaNs are quiet. IEEE 754 exceptions are not raised. NaN is ordered: all non-NaN < NaN any NaN == any other NaN
I I
-0 is converted to +0. All NaNs are converted to the same bit pattern.
See Also: "Comparison Operators for Native Floating-Point Datatypes" on page 2-16 for more information on NaN compared to other values
Comparisons ignore the sign of zero (-0 is equal to, not less than, +0). In Oracle Database, NaN is equal to itself. NaN is greater than everything except itself. That is, NaN == NaN and NaN > x, unless x is NaN.
See Also: "Behavior of Special Values for Native Floating-Point Datatypes" on page 2-15 for more information on comparison results, ordering, and other behaviors of special values
2-16
the conversion. Exceptions can be raised during conversion. The following conversions can be done:
I I I I I
float to double double to float float/double to decimal (string) decimal (string) to float/double float/double to integer valued float/double
2-18
Pro*C/C++ supports the native float and native double datatypes using the column datatypes BINARY_FLOAT and BINARY_DOUBLE. These datatypes can be used in the same way the Oracle NUMBER datatype is used. You can bind the native C/C++ datatypes float and double to BINARY_FLOAT and BINARY_ DOUBLE types respectively. To do so, set the Pro*C/C++ precompiler command line option NATIVE_TYPES to Y (yes) when you compile your application.
Or, you can specify a precision (total number of digits) and scale (number of digits to the right of the decimal point):
price NUMBER (8, 2)
Although not required, specifying precision and scale helps to identify bad input values. If a precision is not specified, the column stores values as they are provided. Table 25 shows examples of how data different scale factors affect storage.
Table 25 Input Data 7,456,123.89 7,456,123.89 7,456,123.89 7,456,123.89 7,456,123.89 7,456,123.89 How Scale Factors Affect Numeric Data Storage Specified As NUMBER NUMBER (9) NUMBER (9,2) NUMBER (9,1) NUMBER (6) NUMBER (7, -2) Stored As 7456123.89 7456124 7456123.89 7456123.9 (not accepted; value exceeds precision) 7456100
See Also: Oracle Database Concepts for information about the internal format for the NUMBER datatype
2-20
Date Format
For input and output of dates, the standard Oracle Database default date format is DD-MON-RR. For example:
'13-NOV-92'
To change this default date format on an instance-wide basis, use the NLS_DATE_ FORMAT parameter. To change the format during a session, use the ALTER SESSION statement. To enter dates that are not in the current default date format, use the TO_ DATE function with a format mask. For example:
TO_DATE ('November 13, 1992', 'MONTH DD, YYYY')
See Also: Oracle Database Concepts for information about Julian dates. Oracle Database Julian dates might not be compatible with Julian dates generated by other date algorithms.
Be careful using a date format like DD-MON-YY. The YY indicates the year in the current century. For example, 31-DEC-92 is December 31, 2092, not 1992 as you might expect. If you want to indicate years in any century other than the current one, use a different format mask, such as the default RR.
SYSDATE --------24-JAN-02 SQL> -- Adding BC to the format string prints the date with BC or AD SQL> -- as appropriate. SQL> SELECT TO_CHAR(SYSDATE, 'DD-MON-YYYY BC') FROM DUAL; TO_CHAR(SYSDAT -------------24-JAN-2002 AD
Time Format
Time is stored in 24-hour format, HH24:MI:SS. By default, the time in a DATE column is 12:00:00 A.M. (midnight) if no time portion is entered, or if the DATE is truncated. In a time-only entry, the date portion defaults to the first day of the current month. To enter the time portion of a date, use the TO_DATE function with a format mask indicating the time portion, as in:
INSERT INTO Birthdays_tab (bname, bday) VALUES ('ANNIE',TO_DATE('13-NOV-92 10:56 A.M.','DD-MON-YY HH:MI A.M.'));
Note: You may need to set up the following data structures for
ADD_MONTHS SYSDATE SYSTIMESTAMP TRUNC. When applied to a DATE value, it trims off the time portion so that it represents the very beginning of the day (the stroke of midnight). By truncating
2-22
two DATE values and comparing them, you can check whether they refer to the same day. You can also use TRUNC along with a GROUP BY clause to produce daily totals.
I I
Arithmetic operators such as + and -. INTERVAL datatype. To represent constants when performing date arithmetic, you can use the INTERVAL datatype rather than performing your own calculations. For example, you might add or subtract INTERVAL constants from DATE values, or subtract two DATE values and compare the result to an INTERVAL. Comparison operators such as >, <, =, and BETWEEN.
EXTRACT NUMTODSINTERVAL NUMTOYMINTERVAL TO_DATE (and its opposite, TO_CHAR) TO_DSINTERVAL TO_TIMESTAMP TO_TIMESTAMP_TZ TO_YMINTERVAL
See Also:
function
I I I I I I I
Process date information before, during, and after 1st January 2000 without error. This entails accepting date input, providing date output, storing date information and performing calculation on dates or portions of dates. Provide services as published in its documentation before, during and after 1st January 2000 without changes in operation resulting from the advent of the new century. Respond to two-digit date input in a way that resolves ambiguity as to the century in a clearly defined manner. Manage the leap year occurring in the year 2000 according to the quad-centennial rule.
These criteria are a superset of the Year 2000 conformance requirements set out by the British Standards Institute in DISC PD-2000-1, A Definition of Year 2000 Conformity Requirements.
2-24
You can warrant your application as Y2K compliant only if you have validated its conformance at all three of the following system levels:
I I
Hardware System software, including databases, transaction processors and operating systems Application software, from third parties or developed in-house
"Troubleshooting Y2K Problems in Applications" on page 2-29). For this reason, you should review and test your code with regard to years in different centuries.
If the current year is in the second half of the century (50 - 99), and a two-digit year between 00 and 49 is entered, this will be stored as a "next century" year. For example, 02 entered in 1996 will be stored as 2002. If the current year is in the second half of the century (50 - 99), and a two-digit year between 50 and 99 is entered, this will be stored as a "current century" year. For example, 97 entered in 1996 will be stored as 1997. If the current year is in the first half of the century (00 - 49), and a two-digit year between 00 and 49 is entered, this will be stored as a "current century" year. For example, 02 entered in 2001 will be stored as 2002. If the current year is in the first half of the century (00 - 49), and a two-digit year between 50 and 99 is entered, this will be stored as a "previous century" year. For example, 97 entered in 2001 will be stored as 1997.
The RR date format is available for inserting and updating DATE data in the database. It is not required for retrieval or query of data already stored in the database as Oracle Database has always stored the YEAR component of a date in its four-digit form. Here is an example of the RR usage:
INSERT INTO employees (employee_id, department_id, hire_date) VALUES (9999, 20, TO_DATE(01-jan-03, DD-MON-RR)); INSERT INTO employees (employee_id, department_id, hire_date) VALUES (8888, 20, TO_DATE(01-jan-67, DD-MON-RR)); SELECT employee_id, department_id, TO_CHAR(hire_date, DD-MON-YYYY) hire_date FROM employees;
2-26
The CC date format element of the TO_CHAR function sets the century value to one greater than the first two digits of a four-digit year (for example, 20 from 1900). For years that are a multiple of 100, this is not the true century. Strictly speaking, the century of year 1900 is not the twentieth century (which began in 1901) but rather the nineteenth century. The following workaround computes the correct century for any Common Era (CE, formerly known as AD) date. If Hiredate is a CE date for which you want the true century, use the following expression:
SELECT DECODE (TO_CHAR (Hiredate, 'YY'), '00', TO_CHAR (Hiredate - 366, 'CC'), TO_CHAR (Hiredate, 'CC')) FROM Emp_tab;
This expression works as follows: Get the last two digits of the year. If these are 00, then this is a year in which the Oracle Database century is one year too large, so compute a date in the preceding year (whose Oracle Database century is the desired true century). Otherwise, use the Oracle Database century.
See Also: Oracle Database SQL Reference for more information
century information or, with certain constraints, by using the RR date format when interpreting the string as a date. If you are creating a new application, or if you are modifying an application to ensure that dates stored as character strings are Year 2000 compliant, convert character datatype dates to the DATE datatype. If this is not feasible, store the dates in a form that is language- and format-independent, and that handles full years. For example, use SYYYY/MM/DD plus the time element as HH24:MI:SS if necessary. Note that dates stored in this form must be converted to the correct external format whenever they are received or displayed. The format SYYYY/MM/DD HH24:MI:SS has the following advantages:
I I I
It is language-independent in that the months are numeric. It contains the full four-digit year, so centuries are explicit. The time is represented fully. Since the most significant elements occur first, character-based sort operations process the dates correctly.
V$NLS_DATABASE_PARAMETERS shows instance-wide Globalization Support parameters, whether or not the values were explicitly declared in the initialization parameter file. NLS_SESSION_PARAMETERS shows current session values, which may have been changed by ALTER SESSION.
To see the available values for time zone region and time zone abbreviation, you can query the view V$TIMEZONE_NAMES. A format mask is a character that describes the format of DATE or NUMBER data stored in a character string. You may use the format model as an argument of the TO_CHAR or TO_DATE function for one of the following:
I I
To specify the format for Oracle Database to use in returning a value. To specify the format for a value you have specified for Oracle Database to store.
Note: The format mask does not change the internal
2-28
Set the Client side, such as the Windows NT registry and Unix environment variables. Set the session using ALTER SESSION SET NLS_DATE_FORMAT. To change the date format for the session, issue the following SQL command:
ALTER SESSION SET NLS_DATE_FORMAT = 'DD-MON-RR'
3.
Set the Server using the NLS_DATE_FORMAT parameter in your initialization file, init.ora. To change the default date format for the entire database, edit file init.ora to include the following
NLS_DATE_FORMAT = DD-MON-RR
The NLS_DATE_FORMAT setting relies on this order. For a client/server application, NLS_DATE_FORMAT must be set on both the server and the client.
Caution:
Changing this parameter at the database level will change all existing date fields, as described. Make changes at the session level, unless all users and all currently running applications process dates in the range 1950-2049.
Y2K Example: 4-Digit Years Mixed with 2-Digit Years Your application may be designed to store a 4-digit year, but the code may allow for the incorrect storage of 2-digit year rows with the 4-digit year rows. This will lead to unpredictable results for queries by date if the date columns contains dates earlier than 1900. To deal with this problem, have your application check for rows that contain dates earlier than 1900, and then adjust for this. Y2K Example: Wide Range of Years Stored as Two Digits Examine your applications to determine if it processes dates prior to 1950 or later than 2049, and stores the year as only two digits. If both conditions are met, your application should not use the RR format, but should instead expand the 2-digit year YY into a 4-digit year YYYY, and store the 4-digit year in the database. Y2K Example: Handling Feb. 29, 2000 The following unusual error helps illuminate the interaction between NLS_DATE_ FORMAT and the Oracle Database RR format mask. The following is a syntactically correct statement, but it contains a logical flaw:
SELECT TO_CHAR(TO_DATE(LAST_DAY('01-FEB-00'),'DD-MON-RR'),'MM/DD/RRRR') FROM DUAL;
This query returns 02/28/2000. This is consistent with the defined behavior of the RR format mask, but it is incorrect because the year 2000 is a leap year. The problem is that the operation is using the default NLS_DATE_FORMAT, which is DD-MON-YY. If the NLS_DATE_FORMAT is changed to DD-MON-RR, then the same select returns 02/29/2000, which is the correct value. Let us evaluate the query asOracle Database does. The first function processed is the innermost function, LAST_DAY. Because NLS_DATE_FORMAT is YY, this correctly returns 2/28, because it is using the year 1900 to evaluate the expression. The value 2/28 is then returned to the next outer function. So, the TO_DATE and TO_CHAR functions format the value 02/28/00 using the RR and RRRR format masks, and display the result as 02/28/2000. If SELECT LAST_DAY('01-FEB-00') FROM DUAL is issued, the result changes depending on the NLS_DATE_FORMAT. With YY, the LAST_DAY returned is 28-Feb-00 because the year is interpreted as 1900. With RR, the LAST_DAY returned is 29-Feb-00 because the year is interpreted as 2000. The year 1900 is not a leap year, but the year 2000 is.
2-30
Y2K Example: Implicit Date Conversion within DECODE If you use the DECODE function with a third argument that is NULL or of datatype datatype CHAR or VARCHAR2, Oracle Database converts the return value to datatype VARCHAR2. Therefore, the following statement inserts date 31.12.1900:
INSERT INTO destination_table (date_column) SELECT DECODE('31.12.2000', '00000000', NULL, TO_DATE('31.12.2000','DD.MM.YYYY')) FROM DUAL;
In these examples, the third argument in the DECODE argument list is a NULL value, so Oracle Database implicitly converted the DATE value to a VARCHAR2 string using the default format mask. This is DD-MON-YY, which drops the first two digits of the year.
Note: When inserting the record into a table, Oracle Database
implicitly converts the string into a date, using the last two digits of the current year. To ensure the correct year is interpreted, set NLS_ DATE_FORMAT using RR or YYYY. Y2K Example: Partitioning Tables Based on DATE Columns When you create a partitioned table using a DATE datatype column in the partition key, use a 4-digit year to specify date ranges. For example:
CREATE TABLE stock_xactions (stock_symbol CHAR(5), stock_series CHAR(1), num_shares NUMBER(10), price NUMBER(5,2), trade_date DATE) STORAGE (INITIAL 100K NEXT 50K) LOGGING PARTITION BY RANGE (trade_date) (PARTITION sx1992 VALUES LESS THAN (TO_DATE('01-JAN-1993','DD-MON-YYYY')) TABLESPACE ts0 NOLOGGING, PARTITION sx1993 VALUES LESS THAN (TO_DATE('01-JAN-1994','DD-MON-YYYY')) TABLESPACE ts1, PARTITION sx1994 VALUES LESS THAN (TO_DATE('01-JAN-1995','DD-MON-YYYY'))
TABLESPACE ts2);
Y2K Example: Views Defined Using 2-Digit Years Oracle Database views depend on the session state. In particular, a predicate with a 2-digit year is allowed in a view. For example:
WHERE col > '12-MAY-99'
Next, you associate the attribute set with the expression set stored in the database column TRADER.INTEREST as follows:
BEGIN dbms_expfil.assign_attribute_set (attr_set => 'Ticker', expr_tab => 'Traders', expr_col => 'Interest'); END;
2-32
This places a constraint on the INTEREST column that ensures the column stores valid conditional expressions. You can then populate the table with trader names, email addresses and conditional expressions that represents a stock the trader is interested in at a particular price:
INSERT INTO Traders (Name, Email, Interest) VALUES ('Scott', '[email protected]', 'SYMBOL = ''ABC'' and PRICE > 25');
At this point, you can use the EVALUATE operator to identify the conditional expressions that evaluate to TRUE for a given data item. For example, the following query can be issued to return all the traders who are interested in a given stock quote (Symbol='ABC', Price=31, Change=5.2):
SELECT Name, Email FROM Traders WHERE EVALUATE (Interest, 'Symbol=>''ABC'', Price=>31, Change=>5.2') = 1;
To speed up a query like this one, you can optionally create an Oracle Expression Filter index on the INTEREST column.
See Also: Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Expression Filter for details on Oracle Expression Filter
CLOB
NCLOB
BFILE
Datatype for storing Large Objects in the operating system's file system, outside of the database files or tablespace. Note that the BFILE type is read-only; other LOB types are read/write. BFILE objects are also sometimes referred to as external LOBs.
An instance of type BLOB, CLOB, or NCLOB can exist as either a persistent LOB instance or a temporary LOB instance. Persistent and temporary instances differ as follows:
I I
A temporary LOB instance is declared in the scope of your application. A persistent LOB instance is created and stored in the database.
2-34
With the exception of declaring, freeing, creating, and committing, operations on persistent and temporary LOB instances are performed the same way. For more details on using LOBs in applications, see the Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects.
Note: In earlier releases, the LONG, RAW, and LONG RAW datatypes were typically used to store large amounts of data. Use of these types is no longer recommended for new development. If your application still uses these types, migrate your application to use LOB types. See the Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide Large Objects
binary LOB (BLOB) columns and convert LONG columns to character LOB (CLOB or NCLOB) columns. LOB columns are subject to far fewer restrictions than LONG and LONG RAW columns.
See Also:
I
See Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects for information about the BLOB and BFILE datatypes See the Oracle Database SQL Reference for restrictions on LONG and LONG RAW datatypes
The RAW and LONG RAW datatypes store data that is not interpreted by Oracle Database (that is, not converted when moving data between different systems). These datatypes are intended for binary data and byte strings. For example, LONG RAW can store graphics, sound, documents, and arrays of binary data; the interpretation is dependent on the use. Oracle Net and the Export and Import utilities do not perform character conversion when transmitting RAW or LONG RAW data. When Oracle Database automatically converts RAW or LONG RAW data to and from CHAR data (as is the case when entering RAW data as a literal in an INSERT statement), the data is represented as one hexadecimal character representing the bit pattern for every four bits of RAW data.
For example, one byte of RAW data with bits 11001011 is displayed and entered as CB. LONG RAW data cannot be indexed, but RAW data can be indexed.
See Also: Oracle Database SQL Reference for restrictions on LONG
Data object (segment) identifier Datafile identifier Block identifier Row identifier
The data object identifier is an identification number that Oracle Database assigns to schema objects, such as nonpartitioned tables or partitions. For example:
SELECT DATA_OBJECT_ID FROM ALL_OBJECTS WHERE OWNER = 'SCOTT' AND OBJECT_NAME = 'EMP_TAB';
This query returns the data object identifier for the EMP_TAB table in the SCOTT schema.
2-36
See Also: PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference for information about using the DBMS_ROWID package functions to get the data object identifier in other ways
This command returns the ROWID pseudocolumn of the row of the EMP_TAB table that satisfies the query, and inserts it into the T1 table. Internal ROWID The internal ROWID is an internal structure that holds information that the server code needs to access a row. The restricted internal ROWID is 6 bytes on most platforms; the extended ROWID is 10 bytes on these platforms. External Character ROWID The extended ROWID pseudocolumn is returned to the client in the form of an 18-character string (for example, "AAAA8mAALAAAAQkAAA"), which represents a base 64 encoding of the components of the extended ROWID in a four-piece format, OOOOOOFFFBBBBBBRRR:
I
OOOOOO: The data object number identifies the database segment (AAAA8m in the example). Schema objects in the same segment, such as a cluster of tables, have the same data object number. FFF: The datafile that contains the row (file AAL in the example). File numbers are unique within a database. BBBBBB: The data block that contains the row (block AAAAQk in the example). Block numbers are relative to their datafile, not tablespace. Therefore, two rows with identical block numbers could reside in two different datafiles of the same tablespace. RRR: The row in the block (row AAA in the example).
There is no need to decode the external ROWID; you can use the functions in the DBMS_ROWID package to obtain the individual components of the extended ROWID.
See Also: PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference for information about the DBMS_ROWID package
The restricted ROWID pseudocolumn is returned to the client in the form of an 18-character string with a hexadecimal encoding of the datablock, row, and datafile components of the ROWID. External Binary ROWID Some client applications use a binary form of the ROWID. For example, OCI and some precompiler applications can map the ROWID to a 3GL structure on bind or define calls. The size of the binary ROWID is the same for extended and restricted ROWIDs. The information for the extended ROWID is included in an unused field of the restricted ROWID structure. The format of the extended binary ROWID, expressed as a C struct, is:
struct riddef { ub4 ridobjnum; /* data obj#--this field is unused in restricted ROWIDs */ ub2 ridfilenum; ub1 filler; ub4 ridblocknum; ub2 ridslotnum; }
It is possible for a client of Oracle Database version 7 to access a more recent database, and vice versa. A client in this sense could be a remote database accessing a server using database links, or a client 3GL or 4GL application accessing a server.
See Also: PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference and Oracle Database Upgrade Guide for more information on the ROWID_TO_EXTENDED function
2-38
Accessing Oracle Database Version 7 from an Oracle9i Client The ROWID values that are returned are always restricted ROWIDs. Also, Oracle9i returns restricted ROWID values to a database server for Oracle Database version 7. The following ROWID functionality works when accessing a server for Oracle Database version 7:
I I I I
Selecting a ROWID and using the obtained value in a WHERE clause WHERE CURRENT OF cursor operations Storing ROWIDs in user columns of ROWID or CHAR type Interpreting ROWIDs using the hexadecimal encoding (not recommended use the DBMS_ROWID functions)
Accessing an Oracle9i Database from a Client of Oracle Database Version 7 Oracle9i returns ROWIDs in the extended format. This means that you can only:
I I I
Select a ROWID and use it in a WHERE clause Use WHERE CURRENT OF cursor operations Store ROWIDs in user columns of CHAR(18) datatype
Import and Export It is not possible for a client of Oracle Database version 7 to import a table from a later version that has a ROWID column (not the ROWID pseudocolumn), if any row of the table contains an extended ROWID value.
ANSI SQL Datatype CHARACTER (n), CHAR (n) NUMERIC (p,s), DECIMAL (p,s), DEC (p,s)
Table 27 (Cont.) ANSI Datatype Conversions to Oracle Datatypes ANSI SQL Datatype INTEGER, INT, SMALLINT FLOAT (p) REAL DOUBLE PRECISION CHARACTER VARYING(n), CHAR VARYING(n) TIMESTAMP TIMESTAMP WITH TIME ZONE Oracle Datatype NUMBER (38) FLOAT (p) FLOAT (63) FLOAT (126) VARCHAR2 (n) TIMESTAMP TIMESTAMP WITH TIME ZONE
DB2 or SQL/DS Datatype CHARACTER (n) VARCHAR (n) LONG VARCHAR DECIMAL (p,s) INTEGER, SMALLINT FLOAT (p) DATE TIMESTAMP
The datatypes TIME, GRAPHIC, VARGRAPHIC, and LONG VARGRAPHIC of IBM products SQL/DS and DB2 have no corresponding Oracle datatype, and they cannot be used.
2-40
datatypes. However, Oracle Database can use the following functions to automatically convert data to the expected datatype:
I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I
TO_NUMBER() TO_BINARY_FLOAT() TO_BINARY_DOUBLE() TO_CHAR() TO_NCHAR() TO_DATE() HEXTORAW() RAWTOHEX() RAWTONHEX() ROWIDTOCHAR() ROWIDTONCHAR() CHARTOROWID() TO_CLOB() TO_NCLOB() TO_BLOB() TO_RAW()
Implicit datatype conversions work according to the rules explained in "Datatype Conversion During Assignments".
See Also: Oracle Database SQL Reference for details about datatype
conversion
VARCHAR2, NVARCHAR2, CHAR, or NCHAR to NUMBER NUMBER to BINARY_FLOAT, BINARY_DOUBLE, or NVARCHAR2 BINARY_FLOAT to NUMBER, BINARY_DOUBLE, CHAR, VARCHAR, or VARCHAR2
BINARY_DOUBLE to NUMBER, BINARY_FLOAT, CHAR, VARCHAR, or VARCHAR2 VARCHAR2, NVARCHAR2, CHAR, or NCHAR to DATE DATE to VARCHAR2 or NVARCHAR2 VARCHAR2, NVARCHAR2, CHAR, or NCHAR to ROWID ROWID to VARCHAR2 or NVARCHAR2 VARCHAR2, NVARCHAR2, CHAR, NCHAR, or LONG to CLOB VARCHAR2, NVARCHAR2, CHAR, NCHAR, or LONG to NCLOB CLOB to CHAR, NCHAR, VARCHAR2, NVARCHAR2, and LONG NCLOB to CHAR, NCHAR, VARCHAR2, NVARCHAR2, and LONG NVARCHAR2, NCHAR, or BLOB to RAW RAW to BLOB VARCHAR2 or CHAR to HEX HEX to VARCHAR2
I I I I I I I I I I I I
The assignment succeeds if Oracle Database can convert the datatype of the value used in the assignment to that of the assignment target. For the examples in the following list, assume a package with a public variable and a table declared as in the following statements:
CREATE PACKAGE Test_Pack AS var1 CHAR(5); END; CREATE TABLE Table1_tab (col1 NUMBER);
I
variable := expression The datatype of expression must be either the same as, or convertible to, the datatype of variable. For example, Oracle Database automatically converts the data provided in the following assignment within the body of a stored procedure:
VAR1 := 0;
INSERT INTO Table1_tab VALUES (expression1, expression2, ...) The datatypes of expression1, expression2, and so on, must be either the same as, or convertible to, the datatypes of the corresponding columns in Table1_tab. For example, Oracle Database automatically converts the data provided in the following INSERT statement for Table1_tab:
2-42
UPDATE Table1_tab SET column = expression The datatype of expression must be either the same as, or convertible to, the datatype of column. For example, Oracle Database automatically converts the data provided in the following UPDATE statement issued against Table1_tab:
UPDATE Table1_tab SET col1 = '30';
SELECT column INTO variable FROM Table1_tab The datatype of column must be either the same as, or convertible to, the datatype of variable. For example, Oracle Database automatically converts data selected from the table before assigning it to the variable in the following statement:
SELECT Col1 INTO Var1 FROM Table1_tab WHERE Col1 = 30;
Character to NUMBER conversions succeed only if the character string represents a valid number. Character to DATE conversions succeed only if the character string satisfies the session default format, which is specified by the initialization parameter NLS_DATE_FORMAT. Some common types of expressions follow:
I
In general, Oracle Database uses the rule for expression evaluation when a datatype conversion is needed in places not covered by the rule for assignment conversions. In assignments of the form:
variable := expression
Oracle Database first evaluates expression using the conversion rules for expressions; expression can be as simple or complex as desired. If it succeeds, then the evaluation of expression results in a single value and datatype. Then, Oracle Database tries to assign this value to the target variable using the conversion rules for assignments.
2-44
-- This example defines and executes a PL/SQL procedure that -- uses methods built into SYS.ANYDATA to access information about -- data stored in a SYS.ANYDATA table column. DROP TYPE Employee FORCE; DROP TABLE mytab; CREATE OR REPLACE TYPE Employee AS OBJECT ( empno NUMBER, ename VARCHAR2(10) ); / CREATE TABLE mytab ( id NUMBER, data SYS.ANYDATA ); INSERT INTO mytab VALUES (1, SYS.ANYDATA.ConvertNumber(5)); INSERT INTO mytab VALUES (2, SYS.ANYDATA.ConvertObject(Employee(5555, 'john'))); commit; CREATE OR REPLACE procedure P IS CURSOR cur IS SELECT id, data FROM mytab; v_id mytab.id%TYPE; v_data mytab.data%TYPE; v_type SYS.ANYTYPE; v_typecode PLS_INTEGER; v_typename VARCHAR2(60); v_dummy PLS_INTEGER; v_n NUMBER; v_employee Employee; non_null_anytype_for_NUMBER exception; unknown_typename exception; BEGIN OPEN cur; LOOP FETCH cur INTO v_id, v_data; EXIT WHEN cur%NOTFOUND; /* The typecode is a number that signifies what type is represented by v_data. GetType also produces a value of type SYS.AnyType with methods you can call to find precision and scale of a number, length of a string, and so on. */ v_typecode := v_data.GetType ( v_type /* OUT */ ); /* Now we compare the typecode against constants from DBMS_TYPES to see what kind of data we have, and decide how to display it. */ CASE v_typecode WHEN Dbms_Types.Typecode_NUMBER THEN IF v_type IS NOT NULL -- This condition should never happen, but we check just in case.
THEN RAISE non_null_anytype_for_NUMBER; END IF; -- For each type, there is a Get method. v_dummy := v_data.GetNUMBER ( v_n /* OUT */ ); Dbms_Output.Put_Line ( To_Char(v_id) || ': NUMBER = ' || To_Char(v_n) ); WHEN Dbms_Types.Typecode_Object THEN v_typename := v_data.GetTypeName(); -- An object type's name is qualified with the schema name. IF v_typename NOT IN ( 'SCOTT.EMPLOYEE' ) -- If we encounter any object type besides EMPLOYEE, raise an exception. THEN RAISE unknown_typename; END IF; v_dummy := v_data.GetObject ( v_employee /* OUT */ ); Dbms_Output.Put_Line ( To_Char(v_id) || ': user-defined type = ' || v_typename || ' ( ' || v_employee.empno || ', ' || v_employee.ename || ' )' ); END CASE; END LOOP; CLOSE cur; EXCEPTION WHEN non_null_anytype_for_NUMBER THEN RAISE_Application_Error ( -20000, 'Paradox: the return AnyType instance FROM GetType ' || 'should be NULL for all but user-defined types' ); WHEN unknown_typename THEN RAISE_Application_Error ( -20000, 'Unknown user-defined type ' || v_typename || ' - program written to handle only SCOTT.EMPLOYEE' ); END; / -- The query and the procedure P in the preceding code sample -- produce output like the following: SQL> SELECT t.data.gettypename() FROM mytab t; T.DATA.GETTYPENAME() -------------------------------------------------------------------------------SYS.NUMBER SCOTT.EMPLOYEE SQL> EXEC P; 1: NUMBER = 5 2: user-defined type = SCOTT.EMPLOYEE ( 5555, john )
2-46
You can access the same features through the OCI interface, using the OCIType, OCIAnyData, and OCIAnyDataSet interfaces.
See Also:
PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference for details about the DBMS_ TYPES package Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Object-Relational Features for information and examples using the ANYDATA, ANYDATASET, and ANYTYPE types Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide for details about the OCI interfaces
Oracle XML DB Developer's Guide for details about the XMLType datatype Oracle XML Developer's Kit Programmer's Guide for information about all aspects of working with XML Oracle Database SQL Reference for information about the SYS_ XMLGEN and SYS_XMLAGG functions
2-48
3
Maintaining Data Integrity Through Constraints
This chapter explains how to enforce the business rules associated with your database and prevent the entry of invalid information into tables by using integrity constraints. Topics include the following:
I I I I I I I I I I I I
Overview of Integrity Constraints Enforcing Referential Integrity with Constraints Managing Constraints That Have Associated Indexes Guidelines for Indexing Foreign Keys About Referential Integrity in a Distributed Database When to Use CHECK Integrity Constraints Examples of Defining Integrity Constraints Enabling and Disabling Integrity Constraints Altering Integrity Constraints Dropping Integrity Constraints Managing FOREIGN KEY Integrity Constraints Viewing Definitions of Integrity Constraints
3-1
Then, create a rule that every department listed in the employee table must match one of the values in the department table:
ALTER TABLE Emp_tab ADD FOREIGN KEY (Deptno) REFERENCES Dept_tab(Deptno);
When you add a new employee record to the table, Oracle Database automatically checks that its department number appears in the department table. To enforce this rule without integrity constraints, you can use a trigger to query the department table and test that each new employee's department is valid. But this method is less reliable than the integrity constraint. SELECT in Oracle Database uses "consistent read", so the query might miss uncommitted changes from other transactions.
3-2
Constraints use existing indexes where possible, rather than creating new ones. Unique and primary keys can use non-unique as well as unique indexes. They can even use just the first few columns of non-unique indexes. At most one unique or primary key can use each non-unique index. The column orders in the index and the constraint do not need to match. If you need to check whether an index is used by a constraint, for example when you want to drop the index, the object number of the index used by a unique or primary key constraint is stored in CDEF$.ENABLED for that constraint. It is not shown in any catalog view.
I I I
You should almost always index foreign keys; the database does not do this for you automatically.
3-3
values in the UNIQUE key; this combination of data integrity rules eliminates the possibility that any new row' data will ever attempt to conflict with an existing row's data. Because Oracle Database indexes do not store keys that are all null, if you want to allow index-only scans of the table or some other operation that requires indexing all rows, you must put a NOT NULL constraint on at least one indexed column.
See Also: "Defining Relationships Between Parent and Child Tables" on page 3-10
Table EMPLOYEES
ID 100 101 102 103 LNAME King Kochhar De Hann Hunold JOB AD_PRES AD_VP AD_VP IT_PROG MGR 100 100 102 HIREDATE 17JUN87 21SEP89 13JAN93 03JAN90 SAL 24000 17000 17000 9000 COMM DEPTNO 90 90 90 60
NOT NULL Constraint (no row may contain a null value for this column)
Absence of NOT NULL Constraint (any row can contain a null for this column)
3-4
Depending upon your business rules, you might use default values to represent zero or false, or leave the default values as NULL to signify an unknown value. Defaults are also useful when you use a view to make a subset of a table's columns visible. For example, you might allow users to insert rows through a view. The base table might also have a column named INSERTER, not included in the definition of the view, to log the user that inserts each row. To record the user name automatically, define a default value that calls the USER function:
CREATE TABLE ( value1 value2 inserter ); audit_trail NUMBER, VARCHAR2(32), VARCHAR2(30) DEFAULT USER
3-5
Whenever practical, use a column containing a sequence number. It is a simple way to satisfy all the other guidelines. Choose a column whose data values are unique, because the purpose of a primary key is to uniquely identify each row of the table. Choose a column whose data values are never changed. A primary key value is only used to identify a row in the table, and its data should never be used for any other purpose. Therefore, primary key values should rarely or never be changed. Choose a column that does not contain any nulls. A PRIMARY KEY constraint, by definition, does not allow any row to contain a null in any column that is part of the primary key. Choose a column that is short and numeric. Short primary keys are easy to type. You can use sequence numbers to easily generate numeric primary keys. Minimize your use of composite primary keys. Although composite primary keys are allowed, they do not satisfy all of the other recommendations. For example, composite primary key values are long and cannot be assigned by sequence numbers.
3-6
Table DEPARTMENTS
DEPID 10 20 30 40 DNAME Administration Marketing Purchasing Human Resources LOC 1700 1800 1700 2400
INSERT INTO 50 MARKETING 1700 This row violates the UNIQUE key constraint, because "MARKETING" is already present in another row; therefore, it is not allowed in the table. This row is allowed because a null value is entered for the DNAME column; however, if a NOT NULL constraint is also defined on the DNAME column, this row is not allowed.
60
2400
a composite UNIQUE key constraint (UNIQUE key constraints allow NULL values). Some examples of good unique keys include:
I
An employee social security number (the primary key might be the employee number) A truck license plate number (the primary key might be the truck number) A customer phone number, consisting of the two columns AREA_CODE and LOCAL_PHONE (the primary key might be the customer number) A department name and location (the primary key might be the department number)
I I
3-7
Although you can declare constraints on views, such constraints do not help maintain data integrity. Instead, they are used to enable query rewrites on queries involving views, which helps performance with materialized views and other data warehousing features. Such constraints are always declared with the DISABLE keyword, and you cannot use the VALIDATE keyword. The constraints are never enforced, and there is no associated index.
See Also: Oracle Data Warehousing Guide for information on query rewrite, materialized views, and the performance reasons for declaring constraints on views
on page 3-10 for information on defining additional integrity constraints, including the foreign key Figure 33 shows a foreign key defined on the department number. It guarantees that every value in this column must match a value in the primary key of the department table. This constraint prevents erroneous department numbers from getting into the employee table. Foreign keys can be comprised of multiple columns. Such a composite foreign key must reference a composite primary or unique key of the exact same structure, with the same number of columns and the same datatypes. Because composite primary and unique keys are limited to 32 columns, a composite foreign key is also limited to 32 columns.
3-8
Table DEPARTMENTS
DEPID 10 20 30 40 DNAME Administration Marketing Purchasing Human Resources LOC 1700 1800 1700 2400
Foreign Key (values in dependent table must match a value in unique key or primary key of referenced table)
Table EMPLOYEES
ID 100 101 102 103 LNAME King Kochhar De Hann Hunold JOB AD_PRES AD_VP AD_VP IT_PROG MGR 100 100 102 HIREDATE 17JUN87 21SEP89 13JAN93 03JAN90 SAL 24000 17000 17000 9000 COMM DEPTNO 90 90 90 60
This row violates the referential constraint because "50" is not present in the referenced table's primary key; therefore, the row is not allowed in the table.
556
CRICKET
PU_CLERK
31OCT96
5000
This row is allowed in the table because a null value is entered in the DEPTNO column; however, if a not null constraint is also defined for this column, this row is not allowed.
3-9
By default (without any NOT NULL or CHECK clauses), the FOREIGN KEY constraint enforces the "match none" rule for composite foreign keys in the ANSI/ISO standard. To enforce the match full rule for NULL values in composite foreign keys, which requires that all components of the key be NULL or all be non-NULL, define a CHECK constraint that allows only all nulls or all non-nulls in the composite foreign key. For example, with a composite key comprised of columns A, B, and C:
CHECK ((A IS NULL AND B IS NULL AND C IS NULL) OR (A IS NOT NULL AND B IS NOT NULL AND C IS NOT NULL))
In general, it is not possible to use declarative referential integrity to enforce the match partial rule for NULL values in composite foreign keys, which requires the non-NULL portions of the key to appear in the corresponding portions in the primary or unique key of a single row in the referenced table. You can often use triggers to handle this case, as described in Chapter 9, "Using Triggers".
3-10
Any number of rows in the child table can reference the same parent key value, so this model establishes a one-to-many relationship between the parent and foreign keys. However, each row in the child table must have a reference to a parent key value; the absence of a value (a null) in the foreign key is not allowed. The same example in the previous section can be used to illustrate such a relationship. However, in this case, employees must have a reference to a specific department. UNIQUE Constraint on the Foreign Key When a UNIQUE constraint is defined on the foreign key, only one row in the child table can reference a given parent key value. This model allows nulls in the foreign key. This model establishes a one-to-one relationship between the parent and foreign keys that allows undetermined values (nulls) in the foreign key. For example, assume that the employee table had a column named MEMBERNO, referring to an employee membership number in the company insurance plan. Also, a table named INSURANCE has a primary key named MEMBERNO, and other columns of the table keep respective information relating to an employee insurance policy. The MEMBERNO in the employee table should be both a foreign key and a unique key:
I
To enforce referential integrity rules between the EMP_TAB and INSURANCE tables (the FOREIGN KEY constraint) To guarantee that each employee has a unique membership number (the UNIQUE key constraint)
UNIQUE and NOT NULL Constraints on the Foreign Key When both UNIQUE and NOT NULL constraints are defined on the foreign key, only one row in the child table can reference a given parent key value, and because NULL values are not allowed in the foreign key, each row in the child table must explicitly reference a value in the parent key. This model establishes a one-to-one relationship between the parent and foreign keys that does not allow undetermined values (nulls) in the foreign key. If you expand the previous example by adding a NOT NULL constraint on the MEMBERNO column of the employee table, in addition to guaranteeing that each employee has a unique membership number, you also ensure that no undetermined values (nulls) are allowed in the MEMBERNO column of the employee table.
The SET CONSTRAINTS setting lasts for the duration of the transaction, or until another SET CONSTRAINTS statement resets the mode.
See Also: Oracle Database SQL Reference for more details on SET
CONSTRAINTS
Tables are snapshots. Some tables contain a large amount of data being manipulated by another application, which may or may not return the data in the same order. Update cascade operations on foreign keys.
Ensure Constraints Are Created Deferrable After you have identified and selected the appropriate tables, make sure their FOREIGN, UNIQUE and PRIMARY key constraints are created deferrable. You can do so by issuing statements similar to the following:
CREATE TABLE dept ( deptno NUMBER PRIMARY KEY, dname VARCHAR2 (30) ); CREATE TABLE emp ( empno NUMBER, ename VARCHAR2 (30), deptno NUMBER REFERENCES (dept), CONSTRAINT epk PRIMARY KEY (empno) DEFERRABLE, CONSTRAINT efk FOREIGN KEY (deptno) REFERENCES (dept.deptno) DEFERRABLE);
3-12
dept VALUES (10, 'Accounting'); dept VALUES (20, 'SALES'); emp VALUES (1, 'Corleone', 10); emp VALUES (2, 'Costanza', 20);
SET CONSTRAINT efk DEFERRED; UPDATE dept SET deptno = deptno + 10 WHERE deptno = 20; SELECT * from emp ORDER BY deptno; EMPNO ENAME DEPTNO ------------------ ------1 Corleone 10 2 Costanza 20 UPDATE emp SET deptno = deptno + 10 WHERE deptno = 20; SELECT * FROM emp ORDER BY deptno; EMPNO ----1 2 COMMIT; ENAME -------------Corleone Costanza DEPTNO ------10 30
Set All Constraints Deferred Within the application that manipulates the data, you must set all constraints deferred before you begin processing any data. Use the following DML statement to set all constraints deferred:
SET CONSTRAINTS ALL DEFERRED;
Note: The SET CONSTRAINTS statement applies only to the current transaction. The defaults specified when you create a constraint remain as long as the constraint exists. The ALTER SESSION SET CONSTRAINTS statement applies for the current session only.
Check the Commit (Optional) You can check for constraint violations before committing by issuing the SET CONSTRAINTS ALL IMMEDIATE statement just before issuing the COMMIT. If there are any problems with a constraint, this statement will fail and the constraint causing the error will be identified. If you commit while constraints are violated, the transaction will be rolled back and you will receive an error message.
Minimizing Space and Time Overhead for Indexes Associated with Constraints
When Oracle Database uses a unique index to enforce a constraint, and constraints associated with the unique index are dropped or disabled, the index is dropped. To preserve the statistics associated with the index (because, for example, it would take a long time to re-create it), you can specify the KEEP INDEX clause on the DROP command for the constraint. While enabled foreign keys reference a PRIMARY or UNIQUE key, you cannot disable or drop the PRIMARY or UNIQUE key constraint or the index.
Note: UNIQUE and PRIMARY keys with deferrable constraints
must all use non-unique indexes. To reuse existing indexes when creating unique and primary key constraints, you can include USING INDEX in the constraint clause. For example:
CREATE TABLE b ( b1 INTEGER, b2 INTEGER, CONSTRAINT unique1 (b1, b2) USING INDEX (CREATE UNIQUE INDEX b_index on b(b1, b2), CONSTRAINT unique2 (b1, b2) USING INDEX b_index );
3-14
Note:
If you decide to define referential integrity across the nodes of a distributed database using triggers, be aware that network failures can make both the parent table and the child table inaccessible. For example, assume that the child table is in the SALES database, and the parent table is in the HQ database. If the network connection between the two databases fails, then some DML statements against the child table (those that insert rows or update a foreign key value) cannot proceed, because the referential integrity triggers must have access to the parent table in the HQ database.
A CHECK constraint on employee salaries so that no salary value is greater than 10000. A CHECK constraint on department locations so that only the locations "BOSTON", "NEW YORK", and "DALLAS" are allowed.
A CHECK constraint on the salary and commissions columns to prevent the commission from being larger than the salary.
The condition must be a boolean expression that can be evaluated using the values in the row being inserted or updated. The condition cannot contain subqueries or sequences. The condition cannot include the SYSDATE, UID, USER, or USERENV SQL functions. The condition cannot contain the pseudocolumns LEVEL, PRIOR, or ROWNUM.
See Also: Oracle Database SQL Reference for an explanation of
I I
these pseudocolumns
I
At first glance, this rule may be interpreted as "do not allow a row in the employee table unless the employee salary is greater than zero or the employee commission is greater than or equal to zero." But if a row is inserted with a null salary, that row does not violate the CHECK constraint, regardless of whether or not the commission value is valid, because the entire check condition is evaluated as unknown. In this case, you can prevent such violations by placing NOT NULL integrity constraints on both the SAL and COMM columns.
3-16
Note: If you are not sure when unknown values result in NULL conditions, review the truth tables for the logical operators AND and OR in Oracle Database SQL Reference
Therefore, NOT NULL integrity constraints for a single column can, in practice, be written in two forms: using the NOT NULL constraint or a CHECK constraint. For ease of use, you should always choose to define NOT NULL integrity constraints, instead of CHECK constraints with the IS NOT NULL condition. In the case where a composite key can allow only all nulls or all values, you must use a CHECK integrity constraint. For example, the following expression of a CHECK integrity constraint allows a key value in the composite key made up of columns C1 and C2 to contain either all nulls or all values:
CHECK ((C1 IS NULL AND C2 IS NULL) OR (C1 IS NOT NULL AND C2 IS NOT NULL))
See Also: Oracle Database Administrator's Guide for information on creating and maintaining constraints for a large production database
You cannot create a validated constraint on a table if the table already contains any rows that would violate the constraint.
3-18
An integrity constraint represents an assertion about the data in a database. This assertion is always true when the constraint is enabled. The assertion may or may not be true when the constraint is disabled, because data that violates the integrity constraint can be in the database.
When loading large amounts of data into a table using SQL*Loader When performing batch operations that make massive changes to a table (such as changing each employee number by adding 1000 to the existing number) When importing or exporting one table at a time
Enabling Constraints
When you define an integrity constraint in a CREATE TABLE or ALTER TABLE statement, Oracle Database automatically enables the constraint by default. For code clarity, you can explicitly enable the constraint by including the ENABLE clause in its definition. Use this technique when creating tables that start off empty, and are populated a row at a time by individual transactions. In such cases, you want to ensure that data is consistent at all times, and the performance overhead of each DML operation is small.
3-20
The following CREATE TABLE and ALTER TABLE statements both define and enable integrity constraints:
CREATE TABLE Emp_tab ( Empno NUMBER(5) PRIMARY KEY); ALTER TABLE Emp_tab ADD PRIMARY KEY (Empno);
An ALTER TABLE statement that tries to enable an integrity constraint will fail if any existing rows of the table violate the integrity constraint. The statement is rolled back and the constraint definition is not stored and not enabled.
See Also: "Fixing Constraint Exceptions" on page 3-23 for more
Use this technique when creating tables that will be loaded with large amounts of data before anybody else accesses them, particularly if you need to cleanse data after loading it, or need to fill empty columns with sequence numbers or parent/child relationships. An ALTER TABLE statement that defines and disables an integrity constraints never fails, because its rule is not enforced.
Enable a disabled constraint, using the ENABLE clause. Disable an enabled constraint, using the DISABLE clause.
The following statements are examples of statements that enable disabled integrity constraints:
ALTER TABLE Dept_tab ENABLE CONSTRAINT Dname_ukey; ALTER TABLE Dept_tab ENABLE PRIMARY KEY ENABLE UNIQUE (Dname) ENABLE UNIQUE (Loc);
An ALTER TABLE statement that attempts to enable an integrity constraint fails if any of the table rows violate the integrity constraint. The statement is rolled back and the constraint is not enabled.
See Also: "Fixing Constraint Exceptions" on page 3-23 for more
3-22
See Also: Oracle Database Administrator's Guide and "Managing FOREIGN KEY Integrity Constraints" on page 3-26
3-24
prompt Enter table name to find its primary key: accept table_name select constraint_name from user_constraints where table_name = upper(&table_name.) and constraint_type = P; prompt Enter new name for its primary key: accept new_constraint set serveroutput on declare -- USER_CONSTRAINTS.CONSTRAINT_NAME is declared as VARCHAR2(30). -- Using %TYPE here protects us if the length changes in a future release. constraint_name user_constraints.constraint_name%type; begin select constraint_name into constraint_name from user_constraints where table_name = upper(&table_name.) and constraint_type = P; dbms_output.put_line(The primary key for || upper(&table_name.) || is: || constraint_name); execute immediate alter table &table_name. rename constraint || constraint_name || to &new_constraint.; end; /
DROP PRIMARY KEY, DROP CONSTRAINT Dept_fkey; DROP TABLE Emp_tab CASCADE CONSTRAINTS;
When dropping UNIQUE, PRIMARY KEY, and FOREIGN KEY integrity constraints, you should be aware of several important issues and prerequisites. UNIQUE and PRIMARY KEY constraints are usually managed by the database administrator.
See Also: Oracle Database Administrator's Guide and "Managing FOREIGN KEY Integrity Constraints" on page 3-26
3-26
table within parentheses. Oracle Database automatically checks to verify that this column list references a primary or unique key of the parent table. If it does not, then an informative error is returned.
The Parent Table The creator of the referential integrity constraint must own the parent table or have REFERENCES object privileges on the columns that constitute the parent key of the parent table. The Child Table The creator of the referential integrity constraint must have the ability to create tables (that is, the CREATE TABLE or CREATE ANY TABLE system privilege) or the ability to alter the child table (that is, the ALTER object privilege for the child table or the ALTER ANY TABLE system privilege).
In both cases, necessary privileges cannot be obtained through a role; they must be explicitly granted to the creator of the constraint. These restrictions allow:
I
The owner of the child table to explicitly decide which constraints are enforced and which other users can create constraints The owner of the parent table to explicitly decide if foreign keys can depend on the primary and unique keys in her tables
Prevent Delete or Update of Parent Key The default setting prevents the deletion or update of a parent key if there is a row in the child table that references the key. For example:
CREATE TABLE Emp_tab ( FOREIGN KEY (Deptno) REFERENCES Dept_tab);
Delete Child Rows When Parent Key Deleted The ON DELETE CASCADE action allows parent key data that is referenced from the child table to be deleted, but not updated. When data in the parent key is deleted, all rows in the child table that depend on the deleted parent key values are also deleted. To
specify this referential action, include the ON DELETE CASCADE option in the definition of the FOREIGN KEY constraint. For example:
CREATE TABLE Emp_tab ( FOREIGN KEY (Deptno) REFERENCES Dept_tab ON DELETE CASCADE);
I
Set Foreign Keys to Null When Parent Key Deleted The ON DELETE SET NULL action allows data that references the parent key to be deleted, but not updated. When referenced data in the parent key is deleted, all rows in the child table that depend on those parent key values have their foreign keys set to null. To specify this referential action, include the ON DELETE SET NULL option in the definition of the FOREIGN KEY constraint. For example:
CREATE TABLE Emp_tab ( FOREIGN KEY (Deptno) REFERENCES Dept_tab ON DELETE SET NULL);
You can query these views to find the names of constraints, what columns they affect, and other information to help you manage constraints.
See Also: Oracle Database Reference for information on each view
3-28
CONSTRAINT Dname_ukey UNIQUE (Dname, Loc), CONSTRAINT LOC_CHECK1 CHECK (Loc IN ('NEW YORK', 'BOSTON', 'CHICAGO'))); CREATE TABLE Emp_tab ( Empno NUMBER(5) PRIMARY KEY, Ename VARCHAR2(15) NOT NULL, Job VARCHAR2(10), Mgr NUMBER(5) CONSTRAINT Mgr_fkey REFERENCES Emp_tab ON DELETE CASCADE, Hiredate DATE, Sal NUMBER(7,2), Comm NUMBER(5,2), Deptno NUMBER(3) NOT NULL CONSTRAINT Dept_fkey REFERENCES Dept_tab);
Example 1: Listing All of Your Accessible Constraints The following query lists all constraints defined on all tables accessible to the user:
SELECT Constraint_name, Constraint_type, Table_name, R_constraint_name FROM User_constraints;
Considering the example statements at the beginning of this section, a list similar to this is returned:
CONSTRAINT_NAME --------------SYS_C00275 DNAME_UKEY LOC_CHECK1 SYS_C00278 SYS_C00279 SYS_C00280 MGR_FKEY DEPT_FKEY C P U C C C P R R TABLE_NAME ----------DEPT_TAB DEPT_TAB DEPT_TAB EMP_TAB EMP_TAB EMP_TAB EMP_TAB EMP_TAB R_CONSTRAINT_NAME ------------------
SYS_C00280 SYS_C00275
Some constraint names are user specified (such as DNAME_UKEY), while others are system specified (such as SYS_C00275). Each constraint type is denoted with a different character in the CONSTRAINT_ TYPE column. The following table summarizes the characters used for each constraint type.
Constraint Type PRIMARY KEY UNIQUE KEY FOREIGN KEY CHECK, NOT NULL
Character P U R C
"V" in the CONSTRAINT_TYPE column. This constraint type corresponds to constraints created using the WITH CHECK OPTION for views. Example 2: Distinguishing NOT NULL Constraints from CHECK Constraints In the previous example, several constraints are listed with a constraint type of C. To distinguish which constraints are NOT NULL constraints and which are CHECK constraints in the EMP_TAB and DEPT_TAB tables, submit the following query:
SELECT Constraint_name, Search_condition FROM User_constraints WHERE (Table_name = 'DEPT_TAB' OR Table_name = 'EMP_TAB') AND Constraint_type = 'C';
Considering the example CREATE TABLE statements at the beginning of this section, a list similar to this is returned:
CONSTRAINT_NAME --------------LOC_CHECK1 SYS_C00278 SYS_C00279 SEARCH_CONDITION ---------------------------------------loc IN ('NEW YORK', 'BOSTON', 'CHICAGO') ENAME IS NOT NULL DEPTNO IS NOT NULL
Notice that the following are explicitly listed in the SEARCH_CONDITION column:
I I
Example 3: Listing Column Names that Constitute an Integrity Constraint The following query lists all columns that constitute the constraints defined on all tables accessible to you, the user:
3-30
Considering the example statements at the beginning of this section, a list similar to this is returned:
CONSTRAINT_NAME --------------DEPT_FKEY DNAME_UKEY DNAME_UKEY LOC_CHECK1 MGR_FKEY SYS_C00275 SYS_C00278 SYS_C00279 SYS_C00280 TABLE_NAME ----------EMP_TAB DEPT_TAB DEPT_TAB DEPT_TAB EMP_TAB DEPT_TAB EMP_TAB EMP_TAB EMP_TAB COLUMN_NAME --------------DEPTNO DNAME LOC LOC MGR DEPTNO ENAME DEPTNO EMPNO
3-32
4
Selecting an Index Strategy
This chapter discusses considerations for using the different types of indexes in an application. The topics include:
I I I I
Guidelines for Application-Specific Indexes Creating Indexes: Basic Examples When to Use Domain Indexes When to Use Function-Based Indexes
See Also:
I
Oracle Database Administrator's Guide for information about creating and managing indexes Oracle Database Performance Tuning Guide for detailed information about using indexes Oracle Database SQL Reference for the syntax of commands to work with indexes Oracle Database Administrator's Guide for information on creating hash clusters to improve performance, as an alternative to indexing
4-1
The column is queried frequently. A referential integrity constraint exists on the column. A UNIQUE key integrity constraint exists on the column.
You can create an index on any column; however, if the column is not used in any of these situations, creating an index on the column does not increase performance and the index takes up resources unnecessarily. Although the database creates an index for you on a column with an integrity constraint, explicitly creating an index on such a column is recommended. You can use the following techniques to determine which columns are best candidates for indexing:
I
Use the EXPLAIN PLAN feature to show a theoretical execution plan of a given query statement. Use the V$SQL_PLAN view to determine the actual execution plan used for a given query statement.
Sometimes, if an index is not being used by default and it would be most efficient to use that index, you can use a query hint so that the index is used.
See Also: Oracle Database Performance Tuning Guide for information on using the V$SQL_PLAN view, the EXPLAIN PLAN statement, query hints, and measuring the performance benefits of indexes
The following sections explain how to create, alter, and drop indexes using SQL commands, and give guidelines for managing indexes.
4-2
Create a new temporary tablespace using the CREATE TABLESPACE command. Use the TEMPORARY TABLESPACE option of the ALTER USER command to make this your new temporary tablespace. Create the index using the CREATE INDEX command. Drop this tablespace using the DROP TABLESPACE command. Then use the ALTER USER command to reset your temporary tablespace to your original temporary tablespace.
Under certain conditions, you can load data into a table with the SQL*Loader "direct path load", and an index can be created as data is loaded.
See Also: Oracle Database Utilities for information on direct path
load
Create an index if you frequently want to retrieve less than about 15% of the rows in a large table. This threshold percentage varies greatly, however, according to the relative speed of a table scan and how clustered the row data is about the index key. The faster the table scan, the lower the percentage; the more clustered the row data, the higher the percentage. Index columns that are used for joins to improve join performance. Primary and unique keys automatically have indexes, but you might want to create an index on a foreign key; see Chapter 3, "Maintaining Data Integrity Through Constraints" for more information. Small tables do not require indexes; if a query is taking too long, then the table might have grown from small to large.
I I
4-3
Some columns are strong candidates for indexing. Columns with one or more of the following characteristics are good candidates for indexing:
I I I I
Values are unique in the column, or there are few duplicates. There is a wide range of values (good for regular indexes). There is a small range of values (good for bitmap indexes). The column contains many nulls, but queries often select all rows having a value. In this case, a comparison that matches all the non-null values, such as:
WHERE COL_X >= -9.99 *power(10,125)
is preferable to
WHERE COL_X IS NOT NULL
This is because the first uses an index on COL_X (assuming that COL_X is a numeric column). Columns with the following characteristics are less suitable for indexing:
I
There are many nulls in the column and you do not search on the non-null values.
LONG and LONG RAW columns cannot be indexed. The size of a single index entry cannot exceed roughly one-half (minus some overhead) of the available space in the data block. Consult with the database administrator for assistance in determining the space required by an index.
4-4
index. You can create a composite index (using several columns), and the same index can be used for queries that reference all of these columns, or just some of them. For example, assume the columns of the VENDOR_PARTS table are as shown in Figure 41.
Figure 41 The VENDOR_PARTS Table
Table VENDOR_PARTS
VEND ID 1012 1012 1012 1010 1010 1220 1012 1292 PART NO 10440 10441 457 10440 457 08300 08300 457 UNIT COST .25 .39 4.95 .27 5.10 1.33 1.19 5.28
Assume that there are five vendors, and each vendor has about 1000 parts. Suppose that the VENDOR_PARTS table is commonly queried by SQL statements such as the following:
SELECT * FROM vendor_parts WHERE part_no = 457 AND vendor_id = 1012;
To increase the performance of such queries, you might create a composite index putting the most selective column first; that is, the column with the most values:
CREATE INDEX ind_vendor_id ON vendor_parts (part_no, vendor_id);
Composite indexes speed up queries that use the leading portion of the index. So in this example, queries with WHERE clauses using only the PART_NO column also note a performance gain. Because there are only five distinct values, placing a separate index on VENDOR_ID would serve no purpose.
4-5
the DBA can periodically refresh the statistics by calling procedures like DBMS_ STATS.GATHER_TABLE_STATISTICS and DBMS_STATS.GATHER_SCHEMA_ STATISTICS.
It does not speed up queries. The table might be very small, or there might be many rows in the table but very few index entries. The queries in your applications do not use the index. The index must be dropped before being rebuilt.
I I
When you drop an index, all extents of the index's segment are returned to the containing tablespace and become available for other objects in the tablespace. Use the SQL command DROP INDEX to drop an index. For example, the following statement drops a specific named index:
DROP INDEX Emp_ename;
If you drop a table, then all associated indexes are dropped. To drop an index, the index must be contained in your schema or you must have the DROP ANY INDEX system privilege.
4-6
Oracle Database automatically creates an index to enforce a UNIQUE or PRIMARY KEY integrity constraint. In general, it is better to create such constraints to enforce uniqueness, instead of using the obsolete CREATE UNIQUE INDEX syntax. Use the SQL command CREATE INDEX to create an index. In this example, an index is created for a single column, to speed up queries that test that column:
CREATE INDEX emp_ename ON emp_tab(ename);
In this example, several storage settings are explicitly specified for the index:
CREATE INDEX emp_ename ON emp_tab(ename) TABLESPACE users STORAGE (INITIAL 20K NEXT 20k PCTINCREASE 75) PCTFREE 0 COMPUTE STATISTICS;
In this example, the index applies to two columns, to speed up queries that test either the first column or both columns:
CREATE INDEX emp_ename ON emp_tab(ename, empno) COMPUTE STATISTICS;
In this example, the query is going to sort on the function UPPER(ENAME). An index on the ENAME column itself would not speed up this operation, and it might be slow to call the function for each result row. A function-based index precomputes the result of the function for each column value, speeding up queries that use the function for searching or sorting:
CREATE INDEX emp_upper_ename ON emp_tab(UPPER(ename)) COMPUTE STATISTICS;
4-7
geographic information system, you can do much of the work simply by creating the right kind of index.
The index is more effective if you gather statistics for the table or schema, using the procedures in the DBMS_STATS package. The index cannot contain any null values. Either make sure the appropriate columns contain no null values, or use the NVL function in the index expression to substitute some other value for nulls.
The expression indexed by a function-based index can be an arithmetic expression or an expression that contains a PL/SQL function, package function, C callout, or SQL function. Function-based indexes also support linguistic sorts based on collation keys, efficient linguistic collation of SQL statements, and case-insensitive sorts. Like other indexes, function-based indexes improve query performance. For example, if you need to access a computationally complex expression often, then you can store it in an index. Then when you need to access the expression, it is already computed. You can find a detailed description of the advantages of function-based indexes in "Advantages of Function-Based Indexes" on page 4-9. Function-based indexes have all of the same properties as indexes on columns. However, unlike indexes on columns which can be used by both cost-based and rule-based optimization, function-based indexes can be used by only by cost-based optimization. Other restrictions on function-based indexes are described in "Restrictions for Function-Based Indexes" on page 4-11.
See Also:
I I
Oracle Database Concepts Oracle Database Administrator's Guide for information on creating function-based indexes
4-8
Increase the number of situations where the optimizer can perform a range scan instead of a full table scan. For example, consider the expression in this WHERE clause:
CREATE INDEX Idx ON Example_tab(Column_a + Column_b); SELECT * FROM Example_tab WHERE Column_a + Column_b < 10;
The optimizer can use a range scan for this query because the index is built on (column_a + column_b). Range scans typically produce fast response times if the predicate selects less than 15% of the rows of a large table. The optimizer can estimate how many rows are selected by expressions more accurately if the expressions are materialized in a function-based index. (Expressions of function-based indexes are represented as virtual columns and ANALYZE can build histograms on such columns.)
I
Precompute the value of a computationally intensive function and store it in the index. An index can store computationally intensive expression that you access often. When you need to access a value, it is already computed, greatly improving query execution performance. Create indexes on object columns and REF columns. Methods that describe objects can be used as functions on which to build indexes. For example, you can use the MAP method to build indexes on an object type column. Create more powerful sorts. You can perform case-insensitive sorts with the UPPER and LOWER functions, descending order sorts with the DESC keyword, and linguistic-based sorts with the NLSSORT function.
Note: Oracle Database sorts columns with the DESC keyword in descending order. Such indexes are treated as function-based indexes. Descending indexes cannot be bitmapped or reverse, and cannot be used in bitmapped optimizations. To get the DESC functionality prior to Oracle Database version 8, remove the DESC keyword from the CREATE INDEX statement.
Another function-based index calls the object method distance_from_equator for each city in the table. The method is applied to the object column Reg_Obj. A query could use this index to quickly find cities that are more than 1000 miles from the equator:
4-9
CREATE INDEX Distance_index ON Weatherdata_tab (Distance_from_equator (Reg_obj)); SELECT * FROM Weatherdata_tab WHERE (Distance_from_equator (Reg_Obj)) > '1000';
Another index stores the temperature delta and the maximum temperature. The result of the delta is sorted in descending order. A query could use this index to quickly find table rows where the temperature delta is less than 20 and the maximum temperature is greater than 75.
CREATE INDEX compare_index ON Weatherdata_tab ((Maxtemp - Mintemp) DESC, Maxtemp); SELECT * FROM Weatherdata_tab WHERE ((Maxtemp - Mintemp) < '20' AND Maxtemp > '75');
The SELECT command uses the function-based index on UPPER(e_name) to return all of the employees with name like :KEYCOL.
SELECT * FROM Emp_tab WHERE UPPER(Ename) like :KEYCOL;
The SELECT statement can either use index range scan (since the expression is a prefix of index IDX) or index fast full scan (which may be preferable if the index has specified a high parallel degree).
SELECT a FROM Fbi_tab WHERE A + B * (C - 1) < 100;
4-10
The SELECT statement selects all of the contents of the table and orders it by NAME. The rows are ordered using the German collation sequence. The Globalization Support parameters are not needed in the SELECT statement, because in a German session, NLS_SORT is set to German and NLS_COMP is set to ANSI.
SELECT * FROM Nls_tab WHERE Name IS NOT NULL ORDER BY Name;
Only cost-based optimization can use function-based indexes. Remember to call DBMS_STATS.GATHER_TABLE_STATISTICS or DBMS_STATS.GATHER_ SCHEMA_STATISTICS, for the function-based index to be effective. Any top-level or package-level PL/SQL functions that are used in the index expression must be declared as DETERMINISTIC. That is, they always return the same result given the same input, like the UPPER function. You must ensure that the subprogram really is deterministic, because Oracle Database does not check that the assertion is true. The following semantic rules demonstrate how to use the keyword DETERMINISTIC:
I I
A top level subprogram can be declared as DETERMINISTIC. A PACKAGE level subprogram can be declared as DETERMINISTIC in the PACKAGE specification but not in the PACKAGE BODY. Errors are raised if DETERMINISTIC is used inside a PACKAGE BODY. A private subprogram (declared inside another subprogram or a PACKAGE BODY) cannot be declared as DETERMINISTIC. A DETERMINISTIC subprogram can call another subprogram whether the called program is declared as DETERMINISTIC or not.
Expressions used in a function-based index cannot contain any aggregate functions. The expressions should reference only columns in a row in the table. You must analyze the table or index before the index is used. Bitmap optimizations cannot use descending indexes. Function-based indexes are not used when OR-expansion is done. The index function cannot be marked NOT NULL. To avoid a full table scan, you must ensure that the query cannot fetch null values. Function-based indexes cannot use expressions that return VARCHAR2 or RAW data types of unknown length from PL/SQL functions. A workaround is to limit the size of the function's output by indexing a substring of known length:
-- INITIALS() might return 1 letter, 2 letters, 3 letters, and so on. -- We limit the return value to 10 characters for purposes of the index. CREATE INDEX func_substr_index ON emp_tab(substr(initials(ename),1,10); -- Call SUBSTR both when creating the index and when referencing -- the function in queries. SELECT SUBSTR(initials(ename),1,10) FROM emp_tab;
I I I I
4-12
5
How Oracle Database Processes SQL Statements
This chapter describes how Oracle Database processes Structured Query Language (SQL) statements. Topics include the following:
I I I I I I I I I
Overview of SQL Statement Execution Grouping Operations into Transactions Ensuring Repeatable Reads with Read-Only Transactions Using Cursors within Applications Locking Data Explicitly About User Locks Using Serializable Transactions for Concurrency Control Autonomous Transactions Resuming Execution After a Storage Error Condition
5-1
5-2
query?
yes
describe?
yes
DESCRIBE
no
yes
bind?
no
no
more?
yes
EXECUTE PARALLELIZE
query?
yes
FETCH
more?
5-3
Use the SET TRANSACTION command with the USE ROLLBACK SEGMENT parameter to explicitly assign a transaction to an appropriate rollback segment. This can eliminate the need to dynamically allocate additional extents, which can reduce overall system performance. Use the SET TRANSACTION command with the ISOLATION LEVEL set to SERIALIZABLE to get ANSI/ISO serializable transactions.
See Also:
I I
Establish standards for writing SQL statements so that you can take advantage of shared SQL areas. Oracle Database recognizes identical SQL statements and allows them to share memory areas. This reduces memory usage on the database server and increases system throughput.
5-4
Use the ANALYZE command to collect statistics that can be used by Oracle Database to implement a cost-based approach to SQL statement optimization. You can supply additional "hints" to the optimizer as needed. Call the DBMS_APPLICATION_INFO.SET_ACTION procedure before beginning a transaction to register and name a transaction for later use when measuring performance across an application. You should specify what type of activity a transaction performs so that the system tuners can later see which transactions are taking up the most system resources. Increase user productivity and query efficiency by including user-written PL/SQL functions in SQL expressions as described in "Calling Stored Functions from SQL Expressions". Create explicit cursors when writing a PL/SQL application. When writing precompiler programs, increasing the number of cursors using MAX_OPEN_CURSORS can often reduce the frequency of parsing and improve performance.
See Also: "Using Cursors within Applications" on page 5-8
I I
Committing Transactions
To commit a transaction, use the COMMIT command. The following two statements are equivalent and commit the current transaction:
COMMIT WORK; COMMIT;
The COMMIT command lets you include the COMMENT parameter along with a comment (less than 50 characters) that provides information about the transaction being committed. This option is useful for including information about the origin of the transaction when you commit distributed transactions:
COMMIT COMMENT 'Dallas/Accts_pay/Trans_type 10B';
5-5
The WORK option of the ROLLBACK command has no function. To roll back to a savepoint defined in the current transaction, use the TO option of the ROLLBACK command. For example, either of the following statements rolls back the current transaction to the savepoint named POINT1:
SAVEPOINT Point1; ... ROLLBACK TO SAVEPOINT Point1; ROLLBACK TO Point1;
If you create a second savepoint with the same identifier as an earlier savepoint, the earlier savepoint is erased. After creating a savepoint, you can roll back to the savepoint. There is no limit on the number of active savepoints for each session. An active savepoint is one that has been specified since the last commit or rollback.
SQL Statement SAVEPOINT a; DELETE...; SAVEPOINT b; INSERT INTO...; SAVEPOINT c; UPDATE...; ROLLBACK TO c;
5-6
Table 51 (Cont.) Use of COMMIT, SAVEPOINT, and ROLLBACK SQL Statement ROLLBACK TO b; ROLLBACK TO c; INSERT INTO...; COMMIT; Results INSERT statement is rolled back, savepoint C is lost, savepoint B remains defined ORA-01086 error; savepoint C no longer defined New DML statement in this transaction Commits all actions performed by the first DML statement (the DELETE statement) and the last DML statement (the second INSERT statement) All other statements (the second and the third statements) of the transaction were rolled back before the COMMIT. The savepoint A is no longer active.
5-7
long undo information is retained. Your database administrator can specify a retention period by using the parameter UNDO_RETENTION.
See Also: Oracle Database Administrator's Guide for information on long-running queries and resumable space allocation
For example, if UNDO_RETENTION is set to 30 minutes, then all committed undo information in the system is retained for at least 30 minutes. This ensures that all queries running for 30 minutes or less, under usual circumstances, do not encounter the OER error, "snapshot too old." A read-only transaction is started with a SET TRANSACTION statement that includes the READ ONLY option. For example:
SET TRANSACTION READ ONLY;
The SET TRANSACTION statement must be the first statement of a new transaction; if any DML statements (including queries) or other non-DDL statements (such as SET ROLE) precede a SET TRANSACTION READ ONLY statement, an error is returned. Once a SET TRANSACTION READ ONLY statement successfully executes, only SELECT (without a FOR UPDATE clause), COMMIT, ROLLBACK, or non-DML statements (such as SET ROLE, ALTER SYSTEM, LOCK TABLE) are allowed in the transaction. Otherwise, an error is returned. A COMMIT, ROLLBACK, or DDL statement terminates the read-only transaction; a DDL statement causes an implicit commit of the read-only transaction and commits in its own transaction.
5-8
Each cursor requires virtual memory, so a session's total number of cursors is limited by the memory available to that process. A systemwide limit of cursors for each session is set by the initialization parameter named OPEN_CURSORS found in the parameter file (such as INIT.ORA).
See Also: Oracle Database Reference for descriptions of parameters
Explicitly creating cursors for precompiler programs can offer some advantages in tuning those applications. For example, increasing the number of cursors can often reduce the frequency of parsing and improve performance. If you know how many cursors may be required at a given time, then you can make sure you can open that many simultaneously.
The V$SQL_PLAN view contains the execution plan information for each child cursor loaded in the library cache. The V$SQL_PLAN_STATISTICS view provides execution statistics at the row source level for each child cursor.
5-9
The V$SQL_PLAN_STATISTICS_ALL view contains memory usage statistics for row sources that use SQL memory (sort or hash-join). This view concatenates information in V$SQL_PLAN with execution statistics from V$SQL_PLAN_STATISTICS and V$SQL_WORKAREA.
See Also: Oracle Database Reference for details on these views
Closing Cursors
Closing a cursor means that the information currently in the associated private area is lost and its memory is deallocated. Once a cursor is opened, it is not closed until one of the following events occurs:
I I
The user program terminates its connection to the server. If the user program is an OCI program or precompiler application, then it explicitly closes any open cursor during the execution of that program. (However, when this program terminates, any cursors remaining open are implicitly closed.)
Cancelling Cursors
Cancelling a cursor frees resources from the current fetch.The information currently in the associated private area is lost but the cursor remains open, parsed, and associated with its bind variables.
Note: You cannot cancel cursors using Pro*C or PL/SQL.
You want transaction-level read consistency or "repeatable reads"where transactions query a consistent set of data for the duration of the transaction, knowing that the data has not been changed by any other transactions. This level of consistency can be achieved by using explicit locking, read-only
5-10
A transaction requires exclusive access to a resource. To proceed with its statements, the transaction with exclusive access to a resource does not have to wait for other transactions to complete.
The automatic locking mechanisms can be overridden at the transaction level. Transactions including the following SQL commands override Oracle Database's default locking:
I I I
LOCK TABLE SELECT, including the FOR UPDATE clause SET TRANSACTION with the READ ONLY or ISOLATION LEVEL SERIALIZABLE options
Locks acquired by these statements are released after the transaction is committed or rolled back. The following sections describe each option available for overriding the default locking of Oracle Database. The initialization parameter DML_LOCKS determines the maximum number of DML locks allowed.
See Also: Oracle Database Reference for a discussion of parameters
Although the default value is usually enough, you might need to increase it if you use additional manual locks.
Caution: If you override the default locking of Oracle Database at any level, be sure that the overriding locking procedures operate correctly: Ensure that data integrity is guaranteed, data concurrency is acceptable, and deadlocks are not possible or are appropriately handled.
You can specify several tables or views to lock in the same mode; however, only a single lock mode can be specified for each LOCK TABLE statement.
Note: When a table is locked, all rows of the table are locked. No
other user can modify the table. You can also indicate if you do or do not want to wait to acquire the lock. If you specify the NOWAIT option, then you only acquire the table lock if it is immediately available. Otherwise an error is returned to notify that the lock is not available at this time. In this case, you can attempt to lock the resource at a later time. If NOWAIT is omitted, then the transaction does not proceed until the requested table lock is acquired. If the wait for a table lock is excessive, then you might want to cancel the lock operation and retry at a later time; you can code this logic into your applications.
ROW SHARE and ROW EXCLUSIVE table locks offer the highest degree of concurrency. You might use these locks if:
I
Your transaction needs to prevent another transaction from acquiring an intervening share, share row, or exclusive table lock for a table before the table can be updated in your transaction. If another transaction acquires an intervening share, share row, or exclusive table lock, no other transactions can update the table until the locking transaction commits or rolls back. Your transaction needs to prevent a table from being altered or dropped before the table can be modified later in your transaction.
SHARE table locks are rather restrictive data locks. You might use these locks if:
I
Your transaction only queries the table, and requires a consistent set of the table data for the duration of the transaction.
5-12
You can hold up other transactions that try to update the locked table, until all transactions that hold SHARE locks on the table either commit or roll back. Other transactions may acquire concurrent SHARE table locks on the same table, also allowing them the option of transaction-level read consistency.
Caution: Your transaction may or may not update the table later in the same transaction. However, if multiple transactions concurrently hold share table locks for the same table, no transaction can update the table (even if row locks are held as the result of a SELECT... FOR UPDATE statement). Therefore, if concurrent share table locks on the same table are common, updates cannot proceed and deadlocks are common. In this case, use share row exclusive or exclusive table locks instead.
For example, assume that two tables, EMP_TAB and BUDGET_TAB, require a consistent set of data in a third table, DEPT_TAB. For a given department number, you want to update the information in both of these tables, and ensure that no new members are added to the department between these two transactions. Although this scenario is quite rare, it can be accommodated by locking the DEPT_ TAB table in SHARE MODE, as shown in the following example. Because the DEPT_ TAB table is rarely updated, locking it probably does not cause many other transactions to wait long.
LOCK TABLE Dept_tab IN SHARE MODE; UPDATE Emp_tab SET sal = sal * 1.1 WHERE deptno IN (SELECT deptno FROM Dept_tab WHERE loc = 'DALLAS'); UPDATE Budget_tab SET Totsal = Totsal * 1.1 WHERE Deptno IN (SELECT Deptno FROM Dept_tab WHERE Loc = 'DALLAS'); COMMIT; /* This releases the lock */
Your transaction requires both transaction-level read consistency for the specified table and the ability to update the locked table.
5-14
You do not care if other transactions acquire explicit row locks (using SELECT... FOR UPDATE), which might make UPDATE and INSERT statements in the locking transaction wait and might cause deadlocks. You only want a single transaction to have this behavior.
Your transaction requires immediate update access to the locked table. When your transaction holds an exclusive table lock, other transactions cannot lock specific rows in the locked table. Your transaction also ensures transaction-level read consistency for the locked table until the transaction is committed or rolled back. You are not concerned about low levels of data concurrency, making transactions that request exclusive table locks wait in line to update the table sequentially.
Privileges Required
You can automatically acquire any type of table lock on tables in your schema. To acquire a table lock on a table in another schema, you must have the LOCK ANY TABLE system privilege or any object privilege (for example, SELECT or UPDATE) for the table.
See Also:
I
Oracle Database SQL Reference for information on the SET TRANSACTION statement Oracle Database SQL Reference for information on the ALTER SESSION statements
The settings for these parameters should be changed only when an instance is shut down. If multiple instances are accessing a single database, then all instances should use the same setting for these parameters.
5-16
Note: The return set for a SELECT... FOR UPDATE may change while the query is running; for example, if columns selected by the query are updated or rows are deleted after the query started. When this happens, SELECT... FOR UPDATE acquires locks on the rows that did not change, gets a new read-consistent snapshot of the table using these locks, and then restarts the query to acquire the remaining locks.
This can cause a deadlock between sessions querying the table concurrently with DML operations when rows are locked in a non-sequential order. To prevent such deadlocks, design your application so that any concurrent DML on the table does not affect the return set of the query. If this is not feasible, you may want to serialize queries in your application. When acquiring row locks with SELECT... FOR UPDATE, you can specify the NOWAIT option to indicate that you are not willing to wait to acquire the lock. If you cannot acquire then lock immediately, an error is returned to signal that the lock is not possible at this time. You can try to lock the row again later. By default, the transaction waits until the requested row lock is acquired. If the wait for a row lock is too long, you can code logic into your application to cancel the lock operation and try again later.
Provide exclusive access to a device, such as a terminal Provide application-level enforcement of read locks Detect when a lock is released and cleanup after the application Synchronize applications and enforce sequential processing
5-18
Oracle Enterprise From the Additional Monitoring Links section of the Manager 10g Database Database Performance page, click Database Locks to Control display user blocks, blocking locks, or the complete list of all database locks. Refer to Oracle 2 Day DBA for more information.
UTLLOCKT.SQL
The UTLLOCKT.SQL script displays a simple character lock wait-for graph in tree structured fashion. Using any ad hoc SQL tool (such as SQL*Plus) to execute the script, it prints the sessions in the system that are waiting for locks and the corresponding blocking locks. The location of this script file is operating system dependent. (You must have run the CATBLOCK.SQL script before using UTLLOCKT.SQL.)
database changes that they could have made if the transactions ran one after the other. Figure 52 shows a serializable transaction (B) interacting with another transaction (A). The ANSI/ISO SQL standard SQL92 defines three possible kinds of transaction interaction, and four levels of isolation that provide increasing protection against these interactions. These interactions and isolation levels are summarized in Table 53.
Table 53 Summary of ANSI Isolation Levels Dirty Read1 Possible Not possible Not possible Not possible Non-Repeatable Read2 Possible Possible Not possible Not possible Phantom Read3 Possible Possible Possible Not possible
A transaction can read uncommitted data changed by another transaction. A transaction rereads data committed by another transaction and sees the new data. A transaction can execute a query again, and discover new rows inserted by another committed transaction.
The behavior of Oracle Database with respect to these isolation levels is summarized in Table 54.
Table 54 ANSI Isolation Levels and Oracle Database Description
Oracle Database never permits "dirty reads." Although some other database products use this undesirable technique to improve thoughput, it is not required for high throughput with Oracle Database.
5-20
Table 54 (Cont.) ANSI Isolation Levels and Oracle Database Isolation Level READ COMMITTED Description
Oracle Database meets the READ COMMITTED isolation standard. This is the default mode for all Oracle Database applications. Because an Oracle Database query only sees data that was committed at the beginning of the query (the snapshot time), Oracle Database actually offers more consistency than is required by the ANSI/ISO SQL92 standards for READ COMMITTED isolation. Oracle Database does not normally support this isolation level, except as provided by SERIALIZABLE. Oracle Database does not normally support this isolation level, except as provided by SERIALIZABLE.
REPEATABLE READ
SERIALIZABLE
Commit the work executed to that point Execute additional, different, statements, perhaps after rolling back to a prior savepoint in the transaction Roll back the entire transaction and try it again
Oracle Database stores control information in each data block to manage access by concurrent transactions. To use the SERIALIZABLE isolation level, you must use the INITRANS clause of the CREATE TABLE or ALTER TABLE command to set aside storage for this control information. To use serializable mode, INITRANS must be set to at least 3.
TRANSACTION A
(arbitrary) begin work update row 2 in block 1 Issue update "too recent" for B to see
TRANSACTION B (serializable)
SET TRANSACTION ISOLATION LEVEL SERIALIZABLE read row 1 in block 1
insert row 4
commit
B can see its own changes but not the committed changes of transaction A.
re-read updated row 1 in block 1 search for row 4 (not found) read old row 2 in block 1
Failure on attempt to update row updated and committed since transaction B began TIME
5-22
TRANSACTION A
TRANSACTION B
delete parent
commit work
commit work
The read issued by transaction A does not prevent transaction B from deleting the parent row, and transaction B's query for child rows does not prevent transaction A from inserting child rows. This scenario leaves a child row in the database with no corresponding parent row. This result occurs even if both A and B are SERIALIZABLE transactions, because neither transaction prevents the other from making changes in the data it reads to check consistency. As this example shows, sometimes you must take steps to ensure that the data read by one transaction is not concurrently written by another. This requires a greater degree of transaction isolation than defined by SQL92 SERIALIZABLE mode.
Transaction A can use SELECT FOR UPDATE to query and lock the parent row and thereby prevent transaction B from deleting the row.
5-24
Transaction B can prevent Transaction A from gaining access to the parent row by reversing the order of its processing steps. Transaction B first deletes the parent row, and then rolls back if its subsequent query detects the presence of corresponding rows in the child table.
Referential integrity can also be enforced in Oracle Database using database triggers, instead of a separate query as in Transaction A. For example, an INSERT into the child table can fire a BEFORE INSERT row-level trigger to check for the corresponding parent row. The trigger queries the parent table using SELECT FOR UPDATE, ensuring that parent row (if it exists) remains in the database for the duration of the transaction inserting the child row. If the corresponding parent row does not exist, the trigger rejects the insert of the child row. SQL statements issued by a database trigger execute in the context of the SQL statement that caused the trigger to fire. All SQL statements executed within a trigger see the database in the same state as the triggering statement. Thus, in a READ COMMITTED transaction, the SQL statements in a trigger see the database as of the beginning of the triggering statement execution, and in a transaction executing in SERIALIZABLE mode, the SQL statements see the database as of the beginning of the transaction. In either case, the use of SELECT FOR UPDATE by the trigger correctly enforces referential integrity.
A collection of database tables (or any set of data) A sequence of reads of rows in those tables The set of transactions committed at any moment
An operation (a query or a transaction) is transaction set consistent if its read operations all return data written by the same set of committed transactions. When an operation is not transaction set consistent, some reads reflect the changes of one
set of transactions, and other reads reflect changes made by other transactions. Such an operation sees the database in a state that reflects no single set of committed transactions. Oracle Database transactions executing in READ COMMITTED mode are transaction-set consistent on an individual-statement basis, because all rows read by a query must be committed before the query begins. Oracle Database transactions executing in SERIALIZABLE mode are transaction set consistent on an individual-transaction basis, because all statements in a SERIALIZABLE transaction execute on an image of the database as of the beginning of the transaction. In other database systems, a single query run in READ COMMITTED mode provides results that are not transaction set consistent. The query is not transaction set consistent, because it may see only a subset of the changes made by another transaction. For example, a join of a master table with a detail table could see a master record inserted by another transaction, but not the corresponding details inserted by that transaction, or vice versa. Oracle Database's READ COMMITTED mode avoids this problem, and so provides a greater degree of consistency than read-locking systems. In read-locking systems, at the cost of preventing concurrent updates, SQL92 REPEATABLE READ isolation provides transaction set consistency at the statement level, but not at the transaction level. The absence of phantom protection means two queries issued by the same transaction can see data committed by different sets of other transactions. Only the throughput-limiting and deadlock-susceptible SERIALIZABLE mode in these systems provides transaction set consistency at the transaction level.
5-26
Table 55 (Cont.) Read Committed Versus Serializable Transaction Operation Compliant with ANSI/ISO SQL 92 Read snapshot time Transaction set consistency Row-level locking Readers block writers Writers block readers Different-row writers block writers Same-row writers block writers Waits for blocking transaction Subject to "can't serialize access" error Error after blocking transaction aborts Error after blocking transaction commits Read Committed Yes Statement Statement level Yes No No No Yes Yes No No No Serializable Yes Transaction Transaction level Yes No No No Yes Yes Yes No Yes
Autonomous Transactions
READ COMMITTED isolation can provide considerably more concurrency with a somewhat increased risk of inconsistent results (due to phantoms and non-repeatable reads) for some transactions. The SERIALIZABLE isolation level provides somewhat more consistency by protecting against phantoms and non-repeatable reads, and may be important where a read/write transaction executes a query more than once. However, SERIALIZABLE mode requires applications to check for the "can't serialize access" error, and can significantly reduce throughput in an environment with many concurrent transactions accessing the same data for update. Application logic that checks database consistency must take into account the fact that reads do not block writes in either mode.
When you get this error, roll back the current transaction and execute it again. The transaction gets a new transaction snapshot, and the operation is likely to succeed. To minimize the performance overhead of rolling back transactions and executing them again, try to put DML statements that might conflict with other concurrent transactions near the beginning of your transaction.
Autonomous Transactions
This section gives a brief overview of autonomous transactions and what you can do with them.
See Also: PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference and Chapter 9, "Using Triggers" for detailed information on autonomous transactions
At times, you may want to commit or roll back some changes to a table independently of a primary transaction's final outcome. For example, in a stock purchase transaction, you may want to commit a customer's information regardless of whether the overall stock purchase actually goes through. Or, while running that same transaction, you may want to log error messages to a debug table even if the overall transaction rolls back. Autonomous transactions allow you to do such tasks.
5-28
Autonomous Transactions
An autonomous transaction (AT) is an independent transaction started by another transaction, the main transaction (MT). It lets you suspend the main transaction, do SQL operations, commit or roll back those operations, then resume the main transaction. An autonomous transaction executes within an autonomous scope. An autonomous scope is a routine you mark with the pragma (compiler directive) AUTONOMOUS_ TRANSACTION. The pragma instructs the PL/SQL compiler to mark a routine as autonomous (independent). In this context, the term routine includes:
I I I I
Top-level (not nested) anonymous PL/SQL blocks Local, standalone, and packaged functions and procedures Methods of a SQL object type PL/SQL triggers
Figure 54 shows how control flows from the main routine (MT) to an autonomous routine (AT) and back again. As you can see, the autonomous routine can commit more than one transaction (AT1 and AT2) before control returns to the main routine.
Figure 54 Transaction Control Flow
Main Routine
PROCEDURE proc1 IS emp_id NUMBER; BEGIN emp_id := 7788; INSERT ... SELECT ... proc2; DELETE ... COMMIT; END;
Autonomous Routine
PROCEDURE proc2 IS PRAGMA AUTON... dept_id NUMBER; BEGIN dept_id := 20; UPDATE ... INSERT ... UPDATE ... COMMIT; INSERT ... INSERT ... COMMIT; END;
MT begins
MT ends
When you enter the executable section of an autonomous routine, the main routine suspends. When you exit the routine, the main routine resumes. COMMIT and ROLLBACK end the active autonomous transaction but do not exit the autonomous routine. As Figure 54 shows, when one transaction ends, the next SQL statement begins another transaction.
Autonomous Transactions
The changes autonomous transactions effect do not depend on the state or the eventual disposition of the main transaction. For example: An autonomous transaction does not see any changes made by the main transaction. When an autonomous transaction commits or rolls back, it does not affect the outcome of the main transaction.
The changes an autonomous transaction effects are visible to other transactions as soon as that autonomous transaction commits. This means that users can access the updated information without having to wait for the main transaction to commit. Autonomous transactions can start other autonomous transactions.
Figure 55 illustrates some of the possible sequences autonomous transactions can follow.
5-30
Autonomous Transactions
A main transaction scope (MT Scope) begins the main transaction, MTx. MTx invokes the first autonomous transaction scope (AT Scope1). MTx suspends. AT Scope 1 begins the transaction Tx1.1. At Scope 1 commits or rolls back Tx1.1, than ends. MTx resumes. MTx invokes AT Scope 2. MT suspends, passing control to AT Scope 2 which, initially, is performing queries. AT Scope 2 then begins Tx2.1 by, say, doing an update. AT Scope 2 commits or rolls back Tx2.1. Later, AT Scope 2 begins a second transaction, Tx2.2, then commits or rolls it back. AT Scope 2 performs a few queries, then ends, passing control back to MTx. MTx invokes AT Scope 3. MTx suspends, AT Scope 3 begins. AT Scope 3 begins Tx3.1 which, in turn, invokes AT Scope 4. Tx3.1 suspends, AT Scope 4 begins. AT Scope 4 begins Tx4.1, commits or rolls it back, then ends. AT Scope 3 resumes. AT Scope 3 commits or rolls back Tx3.1, then ends. MTx resumes. Finally, MT Scope commits or rolls back MTx, then ends.
MT Scope MTx
AT Scope 1
AT Scope 2
AT Scope 3
AT Scope 4
Tx1.1 MTx
Tx2.1
Tx2.2
MTx
Tx3.1
Tx4.1
Tx3.1 MTx
Autonomous Transactions
MT Scope
AT Scope
ATx
5-32
Autonomous Transactions
Scenario 1: There are sufficient funds to cover the withdrawal and therefore the bank releases the funds Scenario 2: There are insufficient funds to cover the withdrawal, but the customer has overdraft protection. The bank therefore releases the funds. Scenario 3: There are insufficient funds to cover the withdrawal, the customer does not have overdraft protection, and the bank therefore withholds the requested funds.
Autonomous Transactions
Scenario 1
There are sufficient funds to cover the withdrawal and therefore the bank releases the funds. This is illustrated by Figure 57.
Figure 57 Example: Bank WithdrawalSufficient Funds
MTx generates a transaction ID.
MT Scope MTx
AT Scope 1
AT Scope 2
Tx1.1 inserts the transaction ID into the audit table and commits.
Tx1.1
MTx
Tx2.1, updates the audit table using the transaction ID generated above, then commits.
Tx2.1
MTx
5-34
Autonomous Transactions
Scenario 2
There are insufficient funds to cover the withdrawal, but the customer has overdraft protection. The bank therefore releases the funds. This is illustrated by Figure 58.
Figure 58 Example: Bank WithdrawalInsufficient Funds WITH Overdraft Protection
MT Scope MTx
AT Scope 1
AT Scope 2
Tx1.1
MTx discovers that there are insufficient funds to cover the withdrawal. It finds that the customer has overdraft protection and sets a flag to the appropriate value. Tx2.1, updates the audit table.
MTx
Tx2.1
MTx
Autonomous Transactions
Scenario 3
There are insufficient funds to cover the withdrawal, the customer does not have overdraft protection, and the bank therefore withholds the requested funds. This is illustrated by Figure 59.
Figure 59 Example: Bank WithdrawalInsufficient Funds WITHOUT Overdraft Protection
MT Scope MTx
AT Scope 1
AT Scope 2
Tx1.1
MTx discovers that there are insufficient funds to cover the withdrawal. It finds that the customer does not have overdraft protection and sets a flag to the appropriate value. Tx2.1, updates the audit table.
MTx
Tx2.1
MTx Scope rolls back MTx, denying the release of funds. MT Scope ends.
MTx
5-36
Autonomous Transactions
To define autonomous transactions, you use the pragma (compiler directive) AUTONOMOUS_TRANSACTION. The pragma instructs the PL/SQL compiler to mark the procedure, function, or PL/SQL block as autonomous (independent). You can code the pragma anywhere in the declarative section of a procedure, function, or PL/SQL block. But, for readability, code the pragma at the top of the section. The syntax follows:
PRAGMA AUTONOMOUS_TRANSACTION;
You cannot use the pragma to mark all subprograms in a package (or all methods in an object type) as autonomous. Only individual routines can be marked autonomous. For example, the following pragma is illegal:
CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE Banking AS PRAGMA AUTONOMOUS_TRANSACTION; -- illegal FUNCTION Balance (Acct_id INTEGER) RETURN REAL; END Banking;
You cannot execute a PIPE ROW statement in your autonomous routine while your autonomous transaction is open. You must close the autonomous transaction before executing the PIPE ROW statement. This is normally
accomplished by committing or rolling back the autonomous transaction before executing the PIPE ROW statement.
See Also: PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference
Out of space errors, such as ORA-01653. Space limit errors, such as ORA-01628. Space quota errors, such as ORA-01536.
5-38
Parse the error message with the DBMS_RESUMABLE.SPACE_ERROR_INFO function. For details about this function, see PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference. Set a new timeout value with the SET_TIMEOUT procedure.
Within the body of the trigger, you can perform any notifications, such as sending a mail message to alert an operator to the space problem. Alternatively, the DBA can periodically check for suspended statements using the data dictionary views DBA_RESUMABLE, USER_RESUMABLE, and V$_SESSION_ WAIT. When the space condition is corrected (usually by the DBA), the suspended statement automatically resumes execution. If it is not corrected before the timeout period expires, the operation causes a SERVERERROR exception. To reduce the chance of out-of-space errors within the trigger itself, you must declare it as an autonomous transaction so that it uses a rollback segment in the SYSTEM tablespace. If the trigger encounters a deadlock condition because of locks held by the suspended statement, the trigger is aborted and your application receives the original error condition, as if it was never suspended. If the trigger encounters an out-of-space condition, the trigger and the suspended statement are rolled back. You can prevent the rollback through an exception handler in the trigger, and just wait for the statement to be resumed.
See Also:
Oracle Database Reference for details on the DBA_ RESUMABLE, USER_RESUMABLE, and V$_SESSION_WAIT data dictionary views
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER suspend_example AFTER SUSPEND ON DATABASE DECLARE cur_sid NUMBER; cur_inst NUMBER; err_type VARCHAR2(64); object_owner VARCHAR2(64); object_type VARCHAR2(64); table_space_name VARCHAR2(64); object_name VARCHAR2(64); sub_object_name VARCHAR2(64); msg_body VARCHAR2(64); ret_value boolean; error_txt varchar2(64); mail_conn utl_smtp.connection; BEGIN SELECT DISTINCT(sid) INTO cur_sid FROM v$mystat; cur_inst := userenv('instance'); ret_value := dbms_resumable.space_error_info(err_type, object_owner, object_ type, table_space_name, object_name, sub_object_name); IF object_type = 'ROLLBACK SEGMENT' THEN INSERT INTO sys.rbs_error ( SELECT sql_text, error_msg, suspend_time FROM dba_ resumable WHERE session_id = cur_sid AND instance_id = cur_inst); SELECT error_msg into error_txt FROM dba_resumable WHERE session_id = cur_sid AND instance_id = cur_inst; msg_body := 'Subject: Space error occurred: Space limit reached for rollback segment '|| object_name || ' on ' || to_char(SYSDATE, 'Month dd, YYYY, HH:MIam') || '. Error message was: ' || error_txt; mail_conn := utl_smtp.open_connection('localhost', 25); utl_smtp.helo(mail_conn, 'localhost'); utl_smtp.mail(mail_conn, 'sender@localhost'); utl_smtp.rcpt(mail_conn, 'recipient@localhost'); utl_smtp.data(mail_conn, msg_body); utl_smtp.quit(mail_conn); dbms_resumable.abort(cur_sid); ELSE dbms_resumable.set_timeout(3600*8); END IF; COMMIT; END;
5-40
6
Coding Dynamic SQL Statements
Dynamic SQL is a programming technique that enables you to build SQL statements dynamically at runtime. You can create more general purpose, flexible applications by using dynamic SQL because the full text of a SQL statement may be unknown at compilation. For example, dynamic SQL lets you create a procedure that operates on a table whose name is not known until runtime. Oracle Database includes two ways to implement dynamic SQL in a PL/SQL application:
I
Native dynamic SQL, where you place dynamic SQL statements directly into PL/SQL blocks. Calling procedures in the DBMS_SQL package.
What Is Dynamic SQL? Why Use Dynamic SQL? A Dynamic SQL Scenario Using Native Dynamic SQL Choosing Between Native Dynamic SQL and the DBMS_SQL Package Using Dynamic SQL in Languages Other Than PL/SQL
You can find details about the DBMS_SQL package in the PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference.
6-1
Successful compilation verifies that the SQL statements reference valid database objects. Successful compilation verifies that the necessary privileges are in place to access the database objects. Performance of static SQL is generally better than dynamic SQL.
Because of these advantages, you should use dynamic SQL only if you cannot use static SQL to accomplish your goals, or if using static SQL is cumbersome compared to dynamic SQL. However, static SQL has limitations that can be overcome with dynamic SQL. You may not always know the full text of the SQL statements that must be executed in a PL/SQL procedure. Your program may accept user input that defines the SQL statements to execute, or your program may need to complete some processing work to determine the correct course of action. In such cases, you should use dynamic SQL. For example, a reporting application in a data warehouse environment might not know the exact table name until runtime. These tables might be named according to the starting month and year of the quarter, for example INV_01_1997, INV_04_ 1997, INV_07_1997, INV_10_1997, INV_01_1998, and so on. You can use dynamic SQL in your reporting application to specify the table name at runtime. You might also want to run a complex query with a user-selectable sort order. Instead of coding the query twice, with different ORDER BY clauses, you can construct the query dynamically to include a specified ORDER BY clause. Dynamic SQL programs can handle changes in data definitions, without the need to recompile. This makes dynamic SQL much more flexible than static SQL. Dynamic SQL lets you write reusable code because the SQL can be easily adapted for different environments. Dynamic SQL also lets you execute data definition language (DDL) statements and other SQL statements that are not supported in purely static SQL programs.
6-2
Data definition language (DDL) statements, such as CREATE, DROP, GRANT, and REVOKE Session control language (SCL) statements, such as ALTER SESSION and SET ROLE
See Also: Oracle Database SQL Reference for information about
DDL and SCL statements Also, you can only use the TABLE clause in the SELECT statement through dynamic SQL. For example, the following PL/SQL block contains a SELECT statement that uses the TABLE clause and native dynamic SQL:
CREATE TYPE t_emp AS OBJECT (id NUMBER, name VARCHAR2(20)) / CREATE TYPE t_emplist AS TABLE OF t_emp / CREATE TABLE dept_new (id NUMBER, emps t_emplist) NESTED TABLE emps STORE AS emp_table; INSERT INTO dept_new VALUES ( 10, t_emplist( t_emp(1, 'SCOTT'), t_emp(2, 'BRUCE'))); DECLARE deptid NUMBER; ename VARCHAR2(20);
6-3
BEGIN EXECUTE IMMEDIATE 'SELECT d.id, e.name FROM dept_new d, TABLE(d.emps) e -- not allowed in static SQL -- in PL/SQL WHERE e.id = 1' INTO deptid, ename; END; /
Applications that allow users to input or choose query search or sorting criteria at runtime Applications that allow users to input or choose optimizer hints at run time Applications that query a database where the data definitions of tables are constantly changing Applications that query a database where new tables are created often
I I
For examples, see "Querying Using Dynamic SQL: Example" on page 6-17, and see the query examples in "A Dynamic SQL Scenario Using Native Dynamic SQL" on page 6-7.
6-4
c cur_typ; query_str VARCHAR2(200); inv_num NUMBER; inv_cust VARCHAR2(20); inv_amt NUMBER; BEGIN query_str := 'SELECT num, cust, amt FROM inv_' || month ||'_'|| year || ' WHERE invnum = :id'; OPEN c FOR query_str USING inv_num; LOOP FETCH c INTO inv_num, inv_cust, inv_amt; EXIT WHEN c%NOTFOUND; -- process row here END LOOP; CLOSE c; END; /
In this example, the user can pass any of the following values for a_hint: a_hint = '/*+ ALL_ROWS */' a_hint = '/*+ FIRST_ROWS */' a_hint = '/*+ CHOOSE */'
6-5
6-6
Using native dynamic SQL, you can write a smaller, more flexible event dispatcher similar to the following:
CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE event_dispatcher (event NUMBER, param NUMBER) IS BEGIN EXECUTE IMMEDIATE 'BEGIN EVENT_HANDLER_' || to_char(event) || '(:1); END;' USING param; END; /
Execute DDL and DML operations Execute single row and multiple row queries
The database in this scenario is a company's human resources database (named hr) with the following data model: A master table named offices contains the list of all company locations. The offices table has the following definition:
6-7
Null? NOT_NULL
Type VARCHAR2(200)
Multiple emp_location tables contain the employee information, where location is the name of city where the office is located. For example, a table named emp_houston contains employee information for the company's Houston office, while a table named emp_boston contains employee information for the company's Boston office. Each emp_location table has the following definition:
Column Name EMPNO ENAME JOB SAL DEPTNO Null? NOT_NULL NOT_NULL NOT_NULL NOT_NULL NOT_NULL Type NUMBER(4) VARCHAR2(10) VARCHAR2(9) NUMBER(7,2) NUMBER(2)
The following sections describe various native dynamic SQL operations that can be performed on the data in the hr database.
6-8
6-9
RETURN NUMBER IS query_str VARCHAR2(1000); num_of_employees NUMBER; BEGIN query_str := 'SELECT COUNT(*) FROM ' || ' emp_' || loc || ' WHERE job = :job_title'; EXECUTE IMMEDIATE query_str INTO num_of_employees USING job; RETURN num_of_employees; END; / SHOW ERRORS;
6-10
parameter must be set to 8.1.0 or higher. See Oracle Database Upgrade Guide for more information about the COMPATIBLE parameter. The DBMS_SQL package is a PL/SQL library that offers an API to execute SQL statements dynamically. The DBMS_SQL package has procedures to open a cursor, parse a cursor, supply binds, and so on. Programs that use the DBMS_SQL package make calls to this package to perform dynamic SQL operations. The following sections provide detailed information about the advantages of both methods.
See Also:
I
The PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference for detailed information about using native dynamic SQL. Native dynamic SQL is referred to in that book as "dynamic SQL". PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference for detailed information about using the DBMS_SQL package
6-12
Table 61
Code Comparison of DBMS_SQL Package and Native Dynamic SQL Native Dynamic SQL
CREATE PROCEDURE insert_into_table ( table_name VARCHAR2, deptnumber NUMBER, deptname VARCHAR2, location VARCHAR2) IS stmt_str VARCHAR2(200); BEGIN stmt_str := 'INSERT INTO ' || table_name || ' values (:deptno, :dname, :loc)'; EXECUTE IMMEDIATE stmt_str USING deptnumber, deptname, location; END; / SHOW ERRORS;
DBMS_SQL Package
CREATE PROCEDURE insert_into_table ( table_name VARCHAR2, deptnumber NUMBER, deptname VARCHAR2, location VARCHAR2) IS cur_hdl INTEGER; stmt_str VARCHAR2(200); rows_processed BINARY_INTEGER; BEGIN stmt_str := 'INSERT INTO ' || table_name || ' VALUES (:deptno, :dname, :loc)'; -- open cursor cur_hdl := dbms_sql.open_cursor; -- parse cursor dbms_sql.parse(cur_hdl, stmt_str, dbms_sql.native); -- supply binds dbms_sql.bind_variable (cur_hdl, ':deptno', deptnumber); dbms_sql.bind_variable (cur_hdl, ':dname', deptname); dbms_sql.bind_variable (cur_hdl, ':loc', location); -- execute cursor rows_processed := dbms_sql.execute(cur_hdl); -- close cursor dbms_sql.close_cursor(cur_hdl); END; / SHOW ERRORS;
For each distinct my_deptno variable, a new cursor is created, causing resource contention and poor performance. Instead, bind my_deptno as a bind variable:
CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE del_dept ( my_deptno dept.deptno%TYPE) IS BEGIN EXECUTE IMMEDIATE 'DELETE FROM dept WHERE deptno = :1' USING my_deptno; END; / SHOW ERRORS;
6-14
Here, the same cursor is reused for different values of the bind my_deptno, improving performance and scalabilty.
arrays. See the PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference for information.
PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference for an example of using DESCRIBE_COLUMNS to create a query in a situation where the SELECT list is not known until runtime
6-16
In general, the native dynamic SQL code is more readable and compact, which can improve developer productivity.
This example queries for employees with the job description SALESMAN in the job column of the emp table. Table 62 shows sample code that accomplishes this query using the DBMS_SQL package and native dynamic SQL.
Table 62
Querying Using the DBMS_SQL Package and Native Dynamic SQL Native Dynamic SQL Query Operation
DECLARE TYPE EmpCurTyp IS REF CURSOR; cur EmpCurTyp; stmt_str VARCHAR2(200); name VARCHAR2(20); salary NUMBER; BEGIN stmt_str := 'SELECT ename, sal FROM emp WHERE job = :1'; OPEN cur FOR stmt_str USING 'SALESMAN'; LOOP FETCH cur INTO name, salary; EXIT WHEN cur%NOTFOUND; -- <process data> END LOOP; CLOSE cur; END; /
6-18
This example inserts a new row for which the column values are in the PL/SQL variables deptnumber, deptname, and location. Table 63 shows sample code that accomplishes this DML operation using the DBMS_SQL package and native dynamic SQL.
Table 63 DML Operation Using the DBMS_SQL Package and Native Dynamic SQL Native Dynamic SQL DML Operation
DECLARE stmt_str VARCHAR2(200); deptnumber NUMBER := 99; deptname VARCHAR2(20); location VARCHAR2(10); BEGIN stmt_str := 'INSERT INTO dept_new VALUES (:deptno, :dname, :loc)'; EXECUTE IMMEDIATE stmt_str USING deptnumber, deptname, location; END; /
Table 64 shows sample code that accomplishes this operation using both the DBMS_SQL package and native dynamic SQL.
Table 64 DML Returning Operation Using the DBMS_SQL Package and Native Dynamic SQL Native Dynamic SQL DML Returning Operation
DECLARE deptname_array dbms_sql.Varchar2_Table; stmt_str VARCHAR2(200); location VARCHAR2(20); deptnumber NUMBER := 10; deptname VARCHAR2(20); BEGIN stmt_str := 'UPDATE dept_new SET loc = :newloc WHERE deptno = :deptno RETURNING dname INTO :dname'; EXECUTE IMMEDIATE stmt_str USING location, deptnumber, OUT deptname; END; /
6-20
If you use C/C++, you can call dynamic SQL with the Oracle Call Interface (OCI), or you can use the Pro*C/C++ precompiler to add dynamic SQL extensions to your C code. If you use COBOL, you can use the Pro*COBOL precompiler to add dynamic SQL extensions to your COBOL code. If you use Java, you can develop applications that use dynamic SQL with JDBC.
If you have an application that uses OCI, Pro*C/C++, or Pro*COBOL to execute dynamic SQL, you should consider switching to native dynamic SQL inside PL/SQL stored procedures and functions. The network round-trips required to perform dynamic SQL operations from client-side applications might hurt performance. Stored procedures can reside on the server, eliminating the network overhead. You can call the PL/SQL stored procedures and stored functions from the OCI, Pro*C/C++, or Pro*COBOL application.
See Also: For information about calling Oracle Database stored procedures and stored functions from various languages:
I I I
Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide Pro*C/C++ Programmer's Guide Pro*COBOL Programmer's Guide
6-22
7
Using Procedures and Packages
This chapter describes some of the procedural capabilities of Oracle Database for application development, including:
I I I I I I I I I I I I I
Overview of PL/SQL Program Units Hiding PL/SQL Code with the PL/SQL Wrapper Compiling PL/SQL Procedures for Native Execution Remote Dependencies Cursor Variables Handling PL/SQL Compile-Time Errors Handling Run-Time PL/SQL Errors Debugging Stored Procedures Calling Stored Procedures Calling Remote Procedures Calling Stored Functions from SQL Expressions Returning Large Amounts of Data from a Function Coding Your Own Aggregate Functions
7-1
engine that lets you run PL/SQL locally. You can even use PL/SQL for some database applications in place of 3GL programs that use embedded SQL or Oracle Call Interface (OCI). PL/SQL program units include:
I I I
Anonymous Blocks Stored Program Units (Procedures, Functions, and Packages) Triggers
See Also:
I
PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference for syntax and examples of operations on PL/SQL packages PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference for information about the PL/SQL packages that come with Oracle Database
Anonymous Blocks
An anonymous block is a PL/SQL program unit that has no name and it does not require the explicit presence of the BEGIN and END keywords to enclose the executable statements. An anonymous block consists of an optional declarative part, an executable part, and one or more optional exception handlers.
7-2
The declarative part declares PL/SQL variables, exceptions, and cursors. The executable part contains PL/SQL code and SQL statements, and can contain nested blocks. Exception handlers contain code that is called when the exception is raised, either as a predefined PL/SQL exception (such as NO_DATA_FOUND or ZERO_ DIVIDE) or as an exception that you define. The following short example of a PL/SQL anonymous block prints the names of all employees in department 20 in the Emp_tab table, using the DBMS_OUTPUT package:
DECLARE Emp_name Cursor VARCHAR2(10); c1 IS SELECT Ename FROM Emp_tab WHERE Deptno = 20;
BEGIN OPEN c1; LOOP FETCH c1 INTO Emp_name; EXIT WHEN c1%NOTFOUND; DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE(Emp_name); END LOOP; END;
Note: If you test this block using SQL*Plus, then enter the
statement SET SERVEROUTPUT ON, so that output using the DBMS_ OUTPUT procedures (for example, PUT_LINE) is activated. Also, end the example with a slash (/) to activate it.
See Also: PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference for complete information about the DBMS_OUTPUT package
Exceptions let you handle Oracle Database error conditions within PL/SQL program logic. This allows your application to prevent the server from issuing an error that could cause the client application to end. The following anonymous block handles the predefined Oracle Database exception NO_DATA_FOUND (which would result in an ORA-01403 error if not handled):
DECLARE Emp_number INTEGER := 9999; Emp_name VARCHAR2(10); BEGIN SELECT Ename INTO Emp_name FROM Emp_tab
7-3
WHERE Empno = Emp_number; -- no such number DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('Employee name is ' || Emp_name); EXCEPTION WHEN NO_DATA_FOUND THEN DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('No such employee: ' || Emp_number); END;
You can also define your own exceptions, declare them in the declaration part of a block, and define them in the exception part of the block. An example follows:
DECLARE Emp_name VARCHAR2(10); Emp_number INTEGER; Empno_out_of_range EXCEPTION; BEGIN Emp_number := 10001; IF Emp_number > 9999 OR Emp_number < 1000 THEN RAISE Empno_out_of_range; ELSE SELECT Ename INTO Emp_name FROM Emp_tab WHERE Empno = Emp_number; DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('Employee name is ' || Emp_name); END IF; EXCEPTION WHEN Empno_out_of_range THEN DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('Employee number ' || Emp_number || ' is out of range.'); END;
See Also: PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference and "Handling Run-Time PL/SQL Errors" on page 7-35
Anonymous blocks are usually used interactively from a tool, such as SQL*Plus, or in a precompiler, OCI, or SQL*Module application. They are usually used to call stored procedures or to open cursor variables.
See Also: "Cursor Variables" on page 7-30
7-4
I I
for both stored procedures and stored functions. The only difference between procedures and functions is that functions always return a single value to the caller, while procedures do not return a value to the caller.
by SQL*Module, then the stored procedure name must also be a legal identifier in the calling host 3GL language, such as Ada or C.
PROCEDURE Get_emp_names (Dept_num IN NUMBER) IS Emp_name VARCHAR2(10); CURSOR c1 (Depno NUMBER) IS SELECT Ename FROM Emp_tab WHERE deptno = Depno; BEGIN OPEN c1(Dept_num); LOOP FETCH c1 INTO Emp_name; EXIT WHEN C1%NOTFOUND;
7-5
In this stored procedure example, the department number is an input parameter which is used when the parameterized cursor c1 is opened. The formal parameters of a procedure have three major attributes, described in Table 71.
Table 71 Attributes of Procedure Parameters Description
Parameter Attribute
Name Mode
This must be a legal PL/SQL identifier. This indicates whether the parameter is an input-only parameter (IN), an output-only parameter (OUT), or is both an input and an output parameter (IN OUT). If the mode is not specified, then IN is assumed. This is a standard PL/SQL datatype.
Datatype
Parameter Modes Parameter modes define the behavior of formal parameters. The three parameter modes, IN (the default), OUT, and IN OUT, can be used with any subprogram. However, avoid using the OUT and IN OUT modes with functions. The purpose of a function is to take no arguments and return a single value. It is poor programming practice to have a function return multiple values. Also, functions should be free from side effects, which change the values of variables not local to the subprogram. Table 72 summarizes the information about parameter modes.
Table 72 IN The default. Passes values to a subprogram. Parameter Modes OUT Must be specified. IN OUT Must be specified.
Returns values to the caller. Passes initial values to a subprogram; returns updated values to the caller. Formal parameter acts like an uninitialized variable. Formal parameter acts like an initialized variable.
7-6
Table 72 (Cont.) Parameter Modes IN Formal parameter cannot be assigned a value. Actual parameter can be a constant, initialized variable, literal, or expression. OUT Formal parameter cannot be used in an expression; must be assigned a value. Actual parameter must be a variable. IN OUT Formal parameter should be assigned a value. Actual parameter must be a variable.
See Also: PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference for details about parameter modes
Parameter Datatypes The datatype of a formal parameter consists of one of the following:
I I
An unconstrained type name, such as NUMBER or VARCHAR2. A type that is constrained using the %TYPE or %ROWTYPE attributes.
Note: Numerically constrained types such as NUMBER(2) or
VARCHAR2(20) are not allowed in a parameter list. %TYPE and %ROWTYPE Attributes Use the type attributes %TYPE and %ROWTYPE to constrain the parameter. For example, the Get_emp_names procedure specification in "Parameters for Procedures and Functions" on page 7-5 could be written as the following:
PROCEDURE Get_emp_names(Dept_num IN Emp_tab.Deptno%TYPE)
This has the Dept_num parameter take the same datatype as the Deptno column in the Emp_tab table. The column and table must be available when a declaration using %TYPE (or %ROWTYPE) is elaborated. Using %TYPE is recommended, because if the type of the column in the table changes, then it is not necessary to change the application code. If the Get_emp_names procedure is part of a package, then you can use previously-declared public (package) variables to constrain a parameter datatype. For example:
Dept_number number(2);
7-7
Use the %ROWTYPE attribute to create a record that contains all the columns of the specified table. The following example defines the Get_emp_rec procedure, which returns all the columns of the Emp_tab table in a PL/SQL record for the given empno:
Caution: To execute the following, use CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE...
PROCEDURE Get_emp_rec (Emp_number IN Emp_tab.Empno%TYPE, Emp_ret OUT Emp_tab%ROWTYPE) IS BEGIN SELECT Empno, Ename, Job, Mgr, Hiredate, Sal, Comm, Deptno INTO Emp_ret FROM Emp_tab WHERE Empno = Emp_number; END;
BEGIN Get_emp_rec(7499, Emp_row); DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT(Emp_row.Ename DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT(' ' DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT(' ' DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT(' ' DBMS_OUTPUT.NEW_LINE; END;
Stored functions can also return values that are declared using %ROWTYPE. For example:
FUNCTION Get_emp_rec (Dept_num IN Emp_tab.Deptno%TYPE) RETURN Emp_tab%ROWTYPE IS ...
Tables and Records You can pass PL/SQL tables as parameters to stored procedures and functions. You can also pass tables of records as parameters.
7-8
or record to a remote procedure, to make PL/SQL use the same definition so that the type checker can verify the source, you must create a redundant loop back DBLINK so that when the PL/SQL compiles, both sources pull from the same location. Default Parameter Values Parameters can take default values. Use the DEFAULT keyword or the assignment operator to give a parameter a default value. For example, the specification for the Get_emp_names procedure could be written as the following:
PROCEDURE Get_emp_names (Dept_num IN NUMBER DEFAULT 20) IS ...
or
PROCEDURE Get_emp_names (Dept_num IN NUMBER := 20) IS ...
When a parameter takes a default value, it can be omitted from the actual parameter list when you call the procedure. When you do specify the parameter value on the call, it overrides the default value.
Note: Unlike in an anonymous PL/SQL block, you do not use the
keyword DECLARE before the declarations of variables, cursors, and exceptions in a stored procedure. In fact, it is an error to use it.
For example, to use the example in "%TYPE and %ROWTYPE Attributes" on page 7-7, create a text (source) file called get_emp.sql containing the following code:
CREATE PROCEDURE Get_emp_rec (Emp_number IN Emp_tab.Empno%TYPE, Emp_ret OUT Emp_tab%ROWTYPE) AS BEGIN SELECT Empno, Ename, Job, Mgr, Hiredate, Sal, Comm, Deptno INTO Emp_ret FROM Emp_tab
7-9
Then, using an interactive tool such as SQL*Plus, load the text file containing the procedure by entering the following statement:
SQL> @get_emp
This loads the procedure into the current schema from the get_emp.sql file (.sql is the default file extension). Note the slash (/) at the end of the code. This is not part of the code; it just activates the loading of the procedure. Use the CREATE [OR REPLACE] FUNCTION... statement to store functions.
Caution: When developing a new procedure, it is usually much more convenient to use the CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE statement. This replaces any previous version of that procedure in the same schema with the newer version, but note that this is done without warning.
You can use either the keyword IS or AS after the procedure parameter list.
See Also: Oracle Database Reference for the complete syntax of the
CREATE PROCEDURE and CREATE FUNCTION statements Privileges to Create Procedures and Functions To create a standalone procedure or function, or package specification or body, you must meet the following prerequisites:
I
You must have the CREATE PROCEDURE system privilege to create a procedure or package in your schema, or the CREATE ANY PROCEDURE system privilege to create a procedure or package in another user's schema.
Note: To create without errors (to compile the procedure or
The owner of the procedure or package must be explicitly granted the necessary object privileges for all objects referenced within the body of the code. The owner cannot obtain required privileges through roles.
7-10
If the privileges of the owner of a procedure or package change, then the procedure must be reauthenticated before it is run. If a necessary privilege to a referenced object is revoked from the owner of the procedure or package, then the procedure cannot be run. The EXECUTE privilege on a procedure gives a user the right to run a procedure owned by another user. Privileged users run the procedure under the security domain of the owner of the procedure. Therefore, users never need to be granted the privileges to the objects referenced by a procedure. This allows for more disciplined and efficient security strategies with database applications and their users. Furthermore, all procedures and packages are stored in the data dictionary (in the SYSTEM tablespace). No quota controls the amount of space available to a user who creates procedures and packages.
Note: Package creation requires a sort. So the user creating the
package should be able to create a sort segment in the temporary tablespace with which the user is associated.
See Also: "Privileges Required to Execute a Procedure" on page 7-45
Privileges to Drop Procedures and Functions To drop a procedure, function, or package, the procedure or package must be in your schema, or you must have the DROP ANY PROCEDURE privilege. An individual procedure within a package cannot be dropped; the containing package specification and body must be re-created without the procedures to be dropped.
External Procedures
A PL/SQL procedure executing on an Oracle Database instance can call an external procedure written in a 3GL. The 3GL procedure runs in a separate address space from that of the database.
See Also: Chapter 8, "Calling External Procedures" for information about external procedures
PL/SQL Packages
A package is an encapsulated collection of related program objects (for example, procedures, functions, variables, constants, cursors, and exceptions) stored together in the database. Using packages is an alternative to creating procedures and functions as standalone schema objects. Packages have many advantages over standalone procedures and functions. For example, they:
I I I I I
Let you organize your application development more efficiently. Let you grant privileges more efficiently. Let you modify package objects without recompiling dependent schema objects. Enable Oracle Database to read multiple package objects into memory at once. Can contain global variables and cursors that are available to all procedures and functions in the package. Let you overload procedures or functions. Overloading a procedure means creating multiple procedures with the same name in the same package, each taking arguments of different number or datatype.
See Also: PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference for more information about subprogram name overloading
7-12
The specification part of a package declares the public types, variables, constants, and subprograms that are visible outside the immediate scope of the package. The body of a package defines the objects declared in the specification, as well as private objects that are not visible to applications outside the package. Example of a PL/SQL Package Specification and Body The following example shows a package specification for a package named Employee_management. The package contains one stored function and two stored procedures. The body for this package defines the function and the procedures:
CREATE PACKAGE BODY Employee_management AS FUNCTION Hire_emp (Name VARCHAR2, Job VARCHAR2, Mgr NUMBER, Hiredate DATE, Sal NUMBER, Comm NUMBER, Deptno NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER IS New_empno NUMBER(10); -----This function accepts all arguments for the fields in the employee table except for the employee number. A value for this field is supplied by a sequence. The function returns the sequence number generated by the call to this function. BEGIN SELECT Emp_sequence.NEXTVAL INTO New_empno FROM dual; INSERT INTO Emp_tab VALUES (New_empno, Name, Job, Mgr, Hiredate, Sal, Comm, Deptno); RETURN (New_empno); END Hire_emp; PROCEDURE fire_emp(emp_id IN NUMBER) AS -- This procedure deletes the employee with an employee -- number that corresponds to the argument Emp_id. If -- no employee is found, then an exception is raised. BEGIN DELETE FROM Emp_tab WHERE Empno = Emp_id; IF SQL%NOTFOUND THEN Raise_application_error(-20011, 'Invalid Employee Number: ' || TO_CHAR(Emp_id)); END IF; END fire_emp; PROCEDURE Sal_raise (Emp_id IN NUMBER, Sal_incr IN NUMBER) AS
------
This procedure accepts two arguments. Emp_id is a number that corresponds to an employee number. SAL_INCR is the amount by which to increase the employee's salary. If employee exists, then update salary with increase.
BEGIN UPDATE Emp_tab SET Sal = Sal + Sal_incr WHERE Empno = Emp_id; IF SQL%NOTFOUND THEN Raise_application_error(-20011, 'Invalid Employee Number: ' || TO_CHAR(Emp_id)); END IF; END Sal_raise; END Employee_management;
Note: If you want to try this example, then first create the
7-14
Creating Packages
Each part of a package is created with a different statement. Create the package specification using the CREATE PACKAGE statement. The CREATE PACKAGE statement declares public package objects. To create a package body, use the CREATE PACKAGE BODY statement. The CREATE PACKAGE BODY statement defines the procedural code of the public procedures and functions declared in the package specification. You can also define private, or local, package procedures, functions, and variables in a package body. These objects can only be accessed by other procedures and functions in the body of the same package. They are not visible to external users, regardless of the privileges they hold. It is often more convenient to add the OR REPLACE clause in the CREATE PACKAGE or CREATE PACKAGE BODY statements when you are first developing your application. The effect of this option is to drop the package or the package body without warning. The CREATE statements would then be the following:
CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE Package_name AS ...
and
CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE BODY Package_name AS ...
Procedures and functions declared in the package specification. Definitions of cursors declared in the package specification. Local procedures and functions, not declared in the package specification. Local variables.
Procedures, functions, cursors, and variables that are declared in the package specification are global. They can be called, or used, by external users that have EXECUTE permission for the package or that have EXECUTE ANY PROCEDURE privileges. When you create the package body, make sure that each procedure that you define in the body has the same parameters, by name, datatype, and mode, as the declaration in the package specification. For functions in the package body, the parameters and the return type must agree in name and type.
Privileges to Create or Drop Packages The privileges required to create or drop a package specification or package body are the same as those required to create or drop a standalone procedure or function.
See Also:
I I
"Privileges to Create Procedures and Functions" on page 7-10 "Privileges to Drop Procedures and Functions" on page 7-12
The second time a session makes such a package call, the package is reinstantiated for the session without error.
Note: For optimal performance, Oracle Database returns this error
message only onceeach time the package state is discarded. If you handle this error in your application, ensure that your error handling strategy can accurately handle this error. For example, when a procedure in one package calls a procedure in another package, your application should be aware that the session state is lost for both packages.
7-16
In most production environments, DDL operations that can cause invalidations are usually performed during inactive working hours; therefore, this situation might not be a problem for end-user applications. However, if package invalidations are common in your system during working hours, then you might want to code your applications to handle this error when package calls are made.
Binding is the assignment of values to PL/SQL variables in SQL statements. Bulk binding is binding an entire collection at once. Bulk binds pass the entire collection back and forth between the two engines in a single operation. Typically, using bulk binds improves performance for SQL statements that affect four or more database rows. The more rows affected by a SQL statement, the greater the performance gain from bulk binds.
decide if you should use them in your PL/SQL applications. For detailed information about using bulk binds, including ways to handle exceptions that occur in the middle of a bulk bind operation, see the PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference.
Without the bulk bind, PL/SQL sends a SQL statement to the SQL engine for each employee that is updated, leading to context switches that hurt performance. If you have a set of rows prepared in a PL/SQL table, you can bulk-insert or bulk-update the data using a loop like:
FORALL i in Emp_Data.FIRST..Emp_Data.LAST INSERT INTO Emp_tab VALUES(Emp_Data(i));
7-18
SELECT Statements that Reference Collections The BULK COLLECT INTO clause can improve the performance of queries that reference collections. For example, the following PL/SQL block queries multiple values into PL/SQL tables, both with and without bulk binds:
-- Find all employees whose manager's ID number is 7698. DECLARE TYPE Var_tab IS TABLE OF VARCHAR2(20) INDEX BY BINARY_INTEGER; Empno VAR_TAB; Ename VAR_TAB; Counter NUMBER; CURSOR C IS SELECT Empno, Ename FROM Emp_tab WHERE Mgr = 7698; BEGIN -- Efficient method, using a bulk bind SELECT Empno, Ename BULK COLLECT INTO Empno, Ename FROM Emp_Tab WHERE Mgr = 7698; -- Slower method, assigning each collection element within a loop. counter := 1; FOR rec IN C LOOP Empno(Counter) := rec.Empno; Ename(Counter) := rec.Ename; Counter := Counter + 1; END LOOP; END;
You can use BULK COLLECT INTO with tables of scalar values, or tables of %TYPE values. Without the bulk bind, PL/SQL sends a SQL statement to the SQL engine for each employee that is selected, leading to context switches that hurt performance. FOR Loops that Reference Collections and the Returning Into Clause You can use the FORALL keyword along with the BULK COLLECT INTO keywords to improve the performance of FOR loops that reference collections and return DML. For example, the following PL/SQL block updates the EMP_TAB table by computing bonuses for a collection of employees; then it returns the bonuses in a column called Bonlist. The actions are performed both with and without using bulk binds:
DECLARE TYPE Emplist IS VARRAY(100) OF NUMBER; Empids EMPLIST := EMPLIST(7369, 7499, 7521, 7566, 7654, 7698); TYPE Bonlist IS TABLE OF Emp_tab.sal%TYPE; Bonlist_inst BONLIST; BEGIN Bonlist_inst := BONLIST(1,2,3,4,5); FORALL i IN Empids.FIRST..empIDs.LAST UPDATE Emp_tab SET Bonus = 0.1 * Sal WHERE Empno = Empids(i) RETURNING Sal BULK COLLECT INTO Bonlist; FOR i IN Empids.FIRST..Empids.LAST LOOP UPDATE Emp_tab Set Bonus = 0.1 * sal WHERE Empno = Empids(i) RETURNING Sal INTO BONLIST(i); END LOOP; END;
Without the bulk bind, PL/SQL sends a SQL statement to the SQL engine for each employee that is updated, leading to context switches that hurt performance.
Triggers
A trigger is a special kind of PL/SQL anonymous block. You can define triggers to fire before or after SQL statements, either on a statement level or for each row that is affected. You can also define INSTEAD OF triggers or system triggers (triggers on DATABASE and SCHEMA).
See Also: Chapter 9, "Using Triggers"
See Also: PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference for complete instructions on using the PL/SQL Wrapper
7-20
Remote Dependencies
PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference for details on PL/SQL native compilation Oracle Database Java Developer's Guide for details on Java native compilation
Remote Dependencies
Dependencies among PL/SQL program units can be handled in two ways:
I I
Timestamps Signatures
Timestamps
If timestamps are used to handle dependencies among PL/SQL program units, then whenever you alter a program unit or a relevant schema object, all of its dependent units are marked as invalid and must be recompiled before they can be run. Each program unit carries a timestamp that is set by the server when the unit is created or recompiled. Figure 71 demonstrates this graphically. Procedures P1 and P2 call stored procedure P3. Stored procedure P3 references table T1. In this
Remote Dependencies
example, each of the procedures is dependent on table T1. P3 depends upon T1 directly, while P1 and P2 depend upon T1 indirectly.
Figure 71
P1
Dependency Relationships
P3 T1
P2
If P3 is altered, then P1 and P2 are marked as invalid immediately, if they are on the same server as P3. The compiled states of P1 and P2 contain records of the timestamp of P3. Therefore, if the procedure P3 is altered and recompiled, then the timestamp on P3 no longer matches the value that was recorded for P3 during the compilation of P1 and P2. If P1 and P2 are on a client system, or on another Oracle Database instance in a distributed environment, then the timestamp information is used to mark them as invalid at runtime.
7-22
Remote Dependencies
Signatures
To alleviate some of the problems with the timestamp-only dependency model, Oracle Database provides the additional capability of remote dependencies using signatures. The signature capability affects only remote dependencies. Local (same server) dependencies are not affected, as recompilation is always possible in this environment. A signature is associated with each compiled stored program unit. It identifies the unit using the following criteria:
I I I I I
The name of the unit (the package, procedure, or function name). The types of each of the parameters of the subprogram. The modes of the parameters (IN, OUT, IN OUT). The number of parameters. The type of the return value for a function.
The user has control over whether signatures or timestamps govern remote dependencies.
See Also: "Controlling Remote Dependencies" on page 7-28
When the signature dependency model is used, a dependency on a remote program unit causes an invalidation of the dependent unit if the dependent unit contains a call to a subprogram in the parent unit, and if the signature of this subprogram has been changed in an incompatible manner. For example, consider a procedure get_emp_name stored on a server in Boston (BOSTON_SERVER). The procedure is defined as the following:
Note: You may need to set up data structures, similar to the
CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE get_emp_name ( emp_number IN NUMBER, hire_date OUT VARCHAR2, emp_name OUT VARCHAR2) AS
Remote Dependencies
BEGIN SELECT ename, to_char(hiredate, 'DD-MON-YY') INTO emp_name, hire_date FROM emp WHERE empno = emp_number; END;
When get_emp_name is compiled on BOSTON_SERVER, its signature, as well as its timestamp, is recorded. Suppose that on another server in California, some PL/SQL code calls get_emp_ name identifying it using a DBlink called BOSTON_SERVER, as follows:
CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE print_ename (emp_number IN NUMBER) AS hire_date VARCHAR2(12); ename VARCHAR2(10); BEGIN get_emp_name@BOSTON_SERVER(emp_number, hire_date, ename); dbms_output.put_line(ename); dbms_output.put_line(hire_date); END;
When this California server code is compiled, the following actions take place:
I I I
A connection is made to the Boston server. The signature of get_emp_name is transferred to the California server. The signature is recorded in the compiled state of print_ename.
At runtime, during the remote procedure call from the California server to the Boston server, the recorded signature of get_emp_name that was saved in the compiled state of print_ename gets sent to the Boston server, regardless of whether or not there were any changes. If the timestamp dependency mode is in effect, then a mismatch in timestamps causes an error status to be returned to the calling procedure. However, if the signature mode is in effect, then any mismatch in timestamps is ignored, and the recorded signature of get_emp_name in the compiled state of Print_ename on the California server is compared with the current signature of get_emp_name on the Boston server. If they match, then the call succeeds. If they do not match, then an error status is returned to the print_name procedure. Note that the get_emp_name procedure on the Boston server could have been changed. Or, its timestamp could be different from that recorded in the print_ name procedure on the California server, possibly due to the installation of a new
7-24
Remote Dependencies
release of the server. As long as the signature remote dependency mode is in effect on the California server, a timestamp mismatch does not cause an error when get_ emp_name is called.
Note: DETERMINISTIC, PARALLEL_ENABLE, and purity information do not show in the signature mode. Optimizations based on these settings are not automatically reconsidered if a function on a remote system is redefined with different settings. This may lead to incorrect query results when calls to the remote function occur, even indirectly, in a SQL statement, or if the remote function is used, even indirectly, in a function-based index.
Remote Dependencies
does not change the signature. Any other change of parameter mode does change the signature. Default Parameter Values Changing the specification of a default parameter value does not change the signature. For example, procedure P1 has the same signature in the following two examples:
PROCEDURE P1 (Param1 IN NUMBER := 100); PROCEDURE P1 (Param1 IN NUMBER := 200);
An application developer who requires that callers get the new default value must recompile the called procedure, but no signature-based invalidation occurs when a default parameter value assignment is changed.
The specification of the procedure has not changed, so its signature has not changed. But if the procedure specification is changed to the following:
CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE Get_emp_name ( Emp_number IN NUMBER, Hire_date OUT DATE, Emp_name OUT VARCHAR2) AS
And if the body is changed accordingly, then the signature changes, because the parameter Hire_date has a different datatype.
7-26
Remote Dependencies
However, if the name of that parameter changes to When_hired, and the datatype remains VARCHAR2, and the mode remains OUT, the signature does not change. Changing the name of a formal parameter does not change the signature of the unit. Consider the following example:
CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE Emp_package AS TYPE Emp_data_type IS RECORD ( Emp_number NUMBER, Hire_date VARCHAR2(12), Emp_name VARCHAR2(10)); PROCEDURE Get_emp_data (Emp_data IN OUT Emp_data_type); END; CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE BODY Emp_package AS PROCEDURE Get_emp_data (Emp_data IN OUT Emp_data_type) IS BEGIN SELECT Empno, Ename, TO_CHAR(Hiredate, 'DD/MON/YY') INTO Emp_data FROM Emp_tab WHERE Empno = Emp_data.Emp_number; END; END;
If the package specification is changed so that the record's field names are changed, but the types remain the same, then this does not affect the signature. For example, the following package specification has the same signature as the previous package specification example:
CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE Emp_package AS TYPE Emp_data_type IS RECORD ( Emp_num NUMBER, -- was Emp_number Hire_dat VARCHAR2(12), -- was Hire_date Empname VARCHAR2(10)); -- was Emp_name PROCEDURE Get_emp_data (Emp_data IN OUT Emp_data_type); END;
Changing the name of the type of a parameter does not cause a change in the signature if the type remains the same as before. For example, the following package specification for Emp_package is the same as the first one:
CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE Emp_package AS TYPE Emp_data_record_type IS RECORD ( Emp_number NUMBER,
Remote Dependencies
Hire_date VARCHAR2(12), Emp_name VARCHAR2(10)); PROCEDURE Get_emp_data (Emp_data IN OUT Emp_data_record_type); END;
Then only timestamps are used to resolve dependencies (if this is not explicitly overridden dynamically).
I
Then signatures are used to resolve dependencies (if this not explicitly overridden dynamically).
I
You can alter the mode dynamically by using the DDL statements. For example, this example alters the dependency model for the current session:
ALTER SESSION SET REMOTE_DEPENDENCIES_MODE = {SIGNATURE | TIMESTAMP} Thise example alters the dependency model systemwide after startup: ALTER SYSTEM SET REMOTE_DEPENDENCIES_MODE = {SIGNATURE | TIMESTAMP}
If the REMOTE_DEPENDENCIES_MODE parameter is not specified, either in the init.ora parameter file or using the ALTER SESSION or ALTER SYSTEM DDL statements, then timestamp is the default value. Therefore, unless you explicitly use the REMOTE_DEPENDENCIES_MODE parameter, or the appropriate DDL statement, your server is operating using the timestamp dependency model. When you use REMOTE_DEPENDENCIES_MODE=SIGNATURE:
I
If you change the default value of a parameter of a remote procedure, then the local procedure calling the remote procedure is not invalidated. If the call to the
7-28
Remote Dependencies
remote procedure does not supply the parameter, then the default value is used. In this case, because invalidation/recompilation does not automatically occur, the old default value is used. If you want to see the new default values, then you must recompile the calling procedure manually.
I
If you add a new overloaded procedure in a package (a new procedure with the same name as an existing one), then local procedures that call the remote procedure are not invalidated. If it turns out that this overloading results in a rebinding of existing calls from the local procedure under the timestamp mode, then this rebinding does not happen under the signature mode, because the local procedure does not get invalidated. You must recompile the local procedure manually to achieve the new rebinding. If the types of parameters of an existing packaged procedure are changed so that the new types have the same shape as the old ones, then the local calling procedure is not invalidated or recompiled automatically. You must recompile the calling procedure manually to get the semantics of the new type.
Dependency Resolution
When REMOTE_DEPENDENCIES_MODE = TIMESTAMP (the default value), dependencies among program units are handled by comparing timestamps at runtime. If the timestamp of a called remote procedure does not match the timestamp of the called procedure, then the calling (dependent) unit is invalidated and must be recompiled. In this case, if there is no local PL/SQL compiler, then the calling application cannot proceed. In the timestamp dependency mode, signatures are not compared. If there is a local PL/SQL compiler, then recompilation happens automatically when the calling procedure is run. When REMOTE_DEPENDENCIES_MODE = SIGNATURE, the recorded timestamp in the calling unit is first compared to the current timestamp in the called remote unit. If they match, then the call proceeds. If the timestamps do not match, then the signature of the called remote subprogram, as recorded in the calling subprogram, is compared with the current signature of the called subprogram. If they do not match (using the criteria described in the section "When Does a Signature Change?" on page 7-25), then an error is returned to the calling session.
Cursor Variables
Server-side PL/SQL users can set the parameter to TIMESTAMP (or let it default to that) to get the timestamp dependency mode. Server-side PL/SQL users can choose to use the signature dependency mode if they have a distributed system and they want to avoid possible unnecessary recompilations. Client-side PL/SQL users should set the parameter to SIGNATURE. This allows: Installation of new applications at client sites, without the need to recompile procedures. Ability to upgrade the server, without encountering timestamp mismatches.
When using signature mode on the server side, add new procedures to the end of the procedure (or function) declarations in a package specification. Adding a new procedure in the middle of the list of declarations can cause unnecessary invalidation and recompilation of dependent procedures.
Cursor Variables
A cursor is a static object; a cursor variable is a pointer to a cursor. Because cursor variables are pointers, they can be passed and returned as parameters to procedures and functions. A cursor variable can also refer to different cursors in its lifetime. Some additional advantages of cursor variables include:
I
Encapsulation Queries are centralized in the stored procedure that opens the cursor variable. Ease of maintenance If you need to change the cursor, then you only need to make the change in one place: the stored procedure. There is no need to change each application. Convenient security The user of the application is the username used when the application connects to the server. The user must have EXECUTE permission on the stored procedure that opens the cursor. But, the user does not need to have READ permission on the tables used in the query. This capability can be used to limit access to the columns in the table, as well as access to other stored procedures.
See Also: PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference for details on cursor variables
7-30
Cursor Variables
Pro*C/C++ Programmer's Guide Pro*COBOL Programmer's Guide Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide Oracle SQL*Module for Ada Programmer's Guide
Fetching Data
The following package defines a PL/SQL cursor variable type Emp_val_cv_type, and two procedures. The first procedure, Open_emp_cv, opens the cursor variable using a bind variable in the WHERE clause. The second procedure, Fetch_emp_ data, fetches rows from the Emp_tab table using the cursor variable.
CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE Emp_data AS TYPE Emp_val_cv_type IS REF CURSOR RETURN Emp_tab%ROWTYPE; PROCEDURE Open_emp_cv (Emp_cv IN OUT Emp_val_cv_type, Dept_number IN INTEGER); PROCEDURE Fetch_emp_data (emp_cv IN Emp_val_cv_type, emp_row OUT Emp_tab%ROWTYPE); END Emp_data; CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE BODY Emp_data AS PROCEDURE Open_emp_cv (Emp_cv IN OUT Emp_val_cv_type, Dept_number IN INTEGER) IS BEGIN OPEN emp_cv FOR SELECT * FROM Emp_tab WHERE deptno = dept_number; END open_emp_cv; PROCEDURE Fetch_emp_data (Emp_cv IN Emp_val_cv_type,
Cursor Variables
Emp_row BEGIN FETCH Emp_cv INTO Emp_row; END Fetch_emp_data; END Emp_data;
OUT Emp_tab%ROWTYPE) IS
The following example shows how to call the Emp_data package procedures from a PL/SQL block:
DECLARE -- declare a cursor variable Emp_curs Emp_data.Emp_val_cv_type; Dept_number Dept_tab.Deptno%TYPE; Emp_row Emp_tab%ROWTYPE; BEGIN Dept_number := 20; -- open the cursor using a variable Emp_data.Open_emp_cv(Emp_curs, Dept_number); -- fetch the data and display it LOOP Emp_data.Fetch_emp_data(Emp_curs, Emp_row); EXIT WHEN Emp_curs%NOTFOUND; DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT(Emp_row.Ename || ' '); DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE(Emp_row.Sal); END LOOP; END;
7-32
ELSIF Discrim = 2 THEN OPEN Cv FOR SELECT * FROM Dept_tab; END IF; END Open_cv; END Emp_dept_data;
You can call the Open_cv procedure to open the cursor variable and point it to either a query on the Emp_tab table or the Dept_tab table. The following PL/SQL block shows how to fetch using the cursor variable, and then use the ROWTYPE_ MISMATCH predefined exception to handle either fetch:
DECLARE Emp_rec Emp_tab%ROWTYPE; Dept_rec Dept_tab%ROWTYPE; Cv Emp_dept_data.CV_TYPE; BEGIN Emp_dept_data.open_cv(Cv, 1); -- Open Cv For Emp_tab Fetch Fetch cv INTO Dept_rec; -- but fetch into Dept_tab record -- which raises ROWTYPE_MISMATCH DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT(Dept_rec.Deptno); DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE(' ' || Dept_rec.Loc); EXCEPTION WHEN ROWTYPE_MISMATCH THEN BEGIN DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE ('Row type mismatch, fetching Emp_tab data...'); FETCH Cv INTO Emp_rec; DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT(Emp_rec.Deptno); DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE(' ' || Emp_rec.Ename); END;
And, if there are one or more errors in the code, then you receive a notice such as the following:
MGR-00072: Warning: Procedure proc1 created with compilation errors
In this case, use the SHOW ERRORS statement in SQL*Plus to get a list of the errors that were found. SHOW ERRORS with no argument lists the errors from the most recent compilation. You can qualify SHOW ERRORS using the name of a procedure, function, package, or package body:
SQL> SHOW ERRORS PROC1 SQL> SHOW ERRORS PROCEDURE PROC1
Note: Before issuing the SHOW ERRORS statement, use the SET
LINESIZE statement to get long lines on output. The value 132 is usually a good choice. For example:
SET LINESIZE 132
Assume that you want to create a simple procedure that deletes records from the employee table using SQL*Plus:
CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE Fire_emp(Emp_id NUMBER) AS BEGIN DELETE FROM Emp_tab WHER Empno = Emp_id; END /
Notice that the CREATE PROCEDURE statement has two errors: the DELETE statement has an error (the E is absent from WHERE), and the semicolon is missing after END. After the CREATE PROCEDURE statement is entered and an error is returned, a SHOW ERRORS statement returns the following lines:
SHOW ERRORS; ERRORS FOR PROCEDURE Fire_emp: LINE/COL ERROR -------------- -------------------------------------------3/27 PL/SQL-00103: Encountered the symbol "EMPNO" wh. . . 5/0 PL/SQL-00103: Encountered the symbol "END" when . . .
7-34
2 rows selected.
Notice that each line and column number where errors were found is listed by the SHOW ERRORS statement. Alternatively, you can query the following data dictionary views to list errors when using any tool or application:
I I I
The error text associated with the compilation of a procedure is updated when the procedure is replaced, and it is deleted when the procedure is dropped. Original source code can be retrieved from the data dictionary using the following views: ALL_SOURCE, USER_SOURCE, and DBA_SOURCE.
See Also: Oracle Database Reference for more information about
This procedure stops procedure execution, rolls back any effects of the procedure, and returns a user-specified error number and message (unless the error is trapped by an exception handler). ERROR_NUMBER must be in the range of -20000 to -20999. Error number -20000 should be used as a generic number for messages where it is important to relay information to the user, but having a unique error number is not required. Text must be a character expression, 2 Kbytes or less (longer messages are ignored). Keep_error_stack can be TRUE if you want to add the error to any already on the stack, or FALSE if you want to replace the existing errors. By default, this option is FALSE.
OUTPUT, DBMS_DESCRIBE, and DBMS_ALERT, use application error numbers in the range -20000 to -20005. See the descriptions of these packages for more information. The RAISE_APPLICATION_ERROR procedure is often used in exception handlers or in the logic of PL/SQL code. For example, the following exception handler selects the string for the associated user-defined error message and calls the RAISE_ APPLICATION_ERROR procedure:
... WHEN NO_DATA_FOUND THEN SELECT Error_string INTO Message FROM Error_table, V$NLS_PARAMETERS V WHERE Error_number = -20101 AND Lang = v.value AND v.parameter = "NLS_LANGUAGE"; Raise_application_error(-20101, Message); ...
See Also: "Handling Errors in Remote Procedures" on page 7-38 for information on exception handling when calling remote procedures
The following section includes an example of passing a user-specified error number from a trigger to a procedure.
Enter a RAISE statement that names the appropriate exception. A RAISE statement stops the execution of the procedure, and control passes to an exception handler (if any).
7-36
Call the RAISE_APPLICATION_ERROR procedure to return a user-specified error number and message.
You can also define an exception handler to handle user-specified error messages. For example, Figure 72 on page 7-37 illustrates the following:
I I
An exception and associated exception handler in a procedure A conditional statement that checks for an error (such as transferring funds not available) and enters a user-specified error number and message within a trigger How user-specified error numbers are returned to the calling environment (in this case, a procedure), and how that application can define an exception that corresponds to the user-specified error number
Declare a user-defined exception in a procedure or package body (private exceptions), or in the specification of a package (public exceptions). Define an exception handler in the body of a procedure (standalone or package).
Figure 72 Exceptions and User-Defined Errors
Procedure fire_emp(empid NUMBER) IS invalid_empid EXCEPTION; PRAGMA EXCEPTION_INIT(invalid_empid, 20101); BEGIN DELETE FROM emp WHERE empno = empid; EXCEPTION WHEN invlid_empid THEN INSERT INTO emp_audit VALUES (empid, Fired before probation ended); END;
Table EMP
TRIGGER emp_probation BEFORE DELETE ON emp FOR EACH ROW BEGIN IF (sysdate:old.hiredate)<30 THEN raise_application_error(20101, Employee||old.ename|| on probation) END IF; END;
Unhandled Exceptions
In database PL/SQL program units, an unhandled user-error condition or internal error condition that is not trapped by an appropriate exception handler causes the implicit rollback of the program unit. If the program unit includes a COMMIT statement before the point at which the unhandled exception is observed, then the implicit rollback of the program unit can only be completed back to the previous COMMIT. Additionally, unhandled exceptions in database-stored PL/SQL program units propagate back to client-side applications that call the containing program unit. In such an application, only the application program unit call is rolled back (not the entire application program unit), because it is submitted to the database as a SQL statement. If unhandled exceptions in database PL/SQL program units are propagated back to database applications, then the database PL/SQL code should be modified to handle the exceptions. Your application can also trap for unhandled exceptions when calling database program units and handle such errors appropriately.
7-38
PL/SQL user-defined exceptions, which must be declared using the keyword EXCEPTION. PL/SQL predefined exceptions, such as NO_DATA_FOUND. SQL errors, such as ORA-00900 and ORA-02015. Application exceptions, which are generated using the RAISE_APPLICATION_ ERROR() procedure.
I I I
When using local procedures, all of these messages can be trapped by writing an exception handler, such as shown in the following example:
EXCEPTION WHEN ZERO_DIVIDE THEN /* ...handle the exception */
Notice that the WHEN clause requires an exception name. If the exception that is raised does not have a name, such as those generated with RAISE_APPLICATION_ ERROR, then one can be assigned using PRAGMA_EXCEPTION_INIT, as shown in the following example:
DECLARE ... Null_salary EXCEPTION; PRAGMA EXCEPTION_INIT(Null_salary, -20101); BEGIN ... RAISE_APPLICATION_ERROR(-20101, 'salary is missing'); ... EXCEPTION WHEN Null_salary THEN ...
When calling a remote procedure, exceptions are also handled by creating a local exception handler. The remote procedure must return an error number to the local calling procedure, which then handles the exception, as shown in the previous example. Because PL/SQL user-defined exceptions always return ORA-06510 to the local procedure, these exceptions cannot be handled. All other remote exceptions can be handled in the same manner as local exceptions.
Adding extra output statements to verify execution progress and check data values at certain points within the procedure. Running a separate debugger to analyze execution in greater detail.
Oracle JDeveloper
Recent releases of Oracle JDeveloper have extensive features for debugging PL/SQL, Java, and multi-language programs. You can get Oracle JDeveloper as part of various Oracle product suites. Often, a more recent release is available as a download at http://otn.oracle.com/.
DBMS_OUTPUT Package
You can also debug stored procedures and triggers using the DBMS_OUTPUT supplied package. Put PUT and PUT_LINE statements in your code to output the value of variables and expressions to your terminal.
7-40
When a debugger becomes connected to a session, the session login user and the currently enabled session-level roles are fixed as the privilege environment for that debugging connection. Any DEBUG or EXECUTE privileges needed for debugging must be granted to that combination of user and roles.
I
To be able to display and change Java public variables or variables declared in a PL/SQL package specification, the debugging connection must be granted either EXECUTE or DEBUG privilege on the relevant code. To be able to either display and change private variables or breakpoint and execute code lines step by step, the debugging connection must be granted DEBUG privilege on the relevant code
Caution: The DEBUG privilege effectively allows a debugging session to do anything that the procedure being debugged could have done if that action had been included in its code.
In addition to these privilege requirements, the ability to stop on individual code lines and debugger access to variables are allowed only in code compiled with debug information generated. The PLSQL_DEBUG parameter and the DEBUG keyword on commands such as ALTER PACKAGE can be used to control whether the PL/SQL compiler includes debug information in its results. If it does not, variables will not be accessible, and neither stepping nor breakpoints will stop on code lines. The PL/SQL compiler will never generate debug information for code that has been obfuscated using the PL/SQL wrap utility. The DEBUG ANY PROCEDURE system privilege is equivalent to the DEBUG privilege granted on all objects in the database. Objects owned by SYS are included if the value of the O7_DICTIONARY_ACCESSIBILITY parameter is TRUE. A debug role mechanism is available to carry privileges needed for debugging that are not normally enabled in the session. Refer to the documentation on the DBMS_ DEBUG and DBMS_DEBUG_JDWP packages for details on how to specify a debug role and any necessary related password. The JAVADEBUGPRIV role carries the DEBUG CONNECT SESSION and DEBUG ANY PROCEDURE privileges. Grant it only with the care those privileges warrant.
Caution: Granting DEBUG ANY PROCEDURE privilege, or granting DEBUG privilege on any object owned by SYS, means granting complete rights to the database.
Oracle Procedure Builder Developer's Guide PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference for more information about the DBMS_DEBUG and DBMS_OUTPUT packages and associated privileges The Oracle JDeveloper documentation for information on using package DBMS_DEBUG_JDWP Oracle Database SQL Reference for more details on privileges The PL/SQL page at http://otn.oracle.com/ for information about writing low-level debug code
I I
7-42
A procedure can be called within the body of another procedure or a trigger. A procedure can be interactively called by a user using an Oracle Database tool. A procedure can be explicitly called within an application, such as a SQL*Forms or a precompiler application. A stored function can be called from a SQL statement in a manner similar to calling a built-in SQL function, such as LENGTH or ROUND.
This section includes some common examples of calling procedures from within these environments.
See Also:
page 7-50
Sal_raise(Emp_id, 200); . . .
This line calls the Sal_raise procedure. Emp_id is a variable within the context of the procedure. Recursive procedure calls are allowed within PL/SQL: A procedure can call itself.
these lines with a slash (/) to run the PL/SQL block. An easier way to run a block is to use the SQL*Plus statement EXECUTE, which wraps BEGIN and END statements around the code you enter. For example:
EXECUTE Sal_raise(7369, 200);
Some interactive tools allow session variables to be created. For example, when using SQL*Plus, the following statement creates a session variable:
VARIABLE Assigned_empno NUMBER
After defined, any session variable can be used for the duration of the session. For example, you might run a function and capture the return value using a session variable:
EXECUTE :Assigned_empno := Hire_emp('JSMITH', 'President', 1032, SYSDATE, 5000, NULL, 10); PRINT Assigned_empno; ASSIGNED_EMPNO -------------2893
7-44
See Also:
I I
SQL*Plus User's Guide and Reference Your tools documentation for information about performing similar operations using your development tool
In this case, :Empno is a host (bind) variable within the context of the application. To run a procedure within the code of a precompiler application, you must use the EXEC call interface. For example, the following statement calls the Fire_emp procedure in the code of a precompiler application:
EXEC SQL EXECUTE BEGIN Fire_emp1(:Empnum); END; END-EXEC;
Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide Pro*C/C++ Programmer's Guide Oracle SQL*Module for Ada Programmer's Guide
procedure at any time, as described in the previous sections. If you want to run a standalone or packaged procedure owned by another user, then the following conditions apply:
I
You must have the EXECUTE privilege for the standalone procedure or package containing the procedure, or you must have the EXECUTE ANY PROCEDURE system privilege. If you are executing a remote procedure, then you must be granted the EXECUTE privilege or EXECUTE ANY PROCEDURE system privilege directly, not through a role. You must include the name of the owner in the call. For example:3
EXECUTE Jward.Fire_emp (1043); EXECUTE Jward.Hire_fire.Fire_emp (1043);
If the procedure is a definer's-rights procedure, then it runs with the privileges of the procedure owner. The owner must have all the necessary object privileges for any referenced objects. If the procedure is an invoker's-rights procedure, then it runs with your privileges (as the invoker). In this case, you also need privileges on all referenced objects; that is, all objects accessed by the procedure through external references that are resolved in your schema. You may hold these privileges directly or through a role. Roles are enabled unless an invoker's-rights procedure is called directly or indirectly by a definer's-rights procedure.
List the values in the order the arguments appear in the procedure declaration. Specify the argument names and corresponding values, in any order.
You may need to set up the following data structures for certain examples to work: CONNECT sys/change_on_install AS Sysdba; CREATE USER Jward IDENTIFIED BY Jward; GRANT CREATE ANY PACKAGE TO Jward; GRANT CREATE SESSION TO Jward; GRANT EXECUTE ANY PROCEDURE TO Jward; CONNECT Scott/Tiger
7-46
For example, these statements each call the procedure Sal_raise to increase the salary of employee number 7369 by 500:
Sal_raise(7369, 500); Sal_raise(Sal_incr=>500, Emp_id=>7369); Sal_raise(7369, Sal_incr=>500);
The first statement identifies the argument values by listing them in the order in which they appear in the procedure specification. The second statement identifies the argument values by name and in an order different from that of the procedure specification. If you use argument names, then you can list the arguments in any order. The third statement identifies the argument values using a combination of these methods. If you use a combination of order and argument names, then values identified in order must precede values identified by name. If you used the DEFAULT option to define default values for IN parameters to a subprogram (see the PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference),then you can pass different numbers of actual parameters to the first subprogram, accepting or overriding the default values as you please. If an actual value is not passed, then the corresponding default value is used. If you want to assign a value to an argument that occurs after an omitted argument (for which the corresponding default is used), then you must explicitly designate the name of the argument, as well as its value.
See Also: "Handling Errors in Remote Procedures" on page 7-38 for information on exception handling when calling remote procedures
The following list explains how to properly call remote procedures, depending on the calling environment.
I
Remote procedures (standalone and packaged) can be called from within a procedure, an OCI application, or a precompiler application by specifying the remote procedure name, a database link, and the arguments for the remote procedure.
CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE local_procedure(arg IN NUMBER) AS BEGIN fire_emp1@boston_server(arg); END;
In the previous example, you could create a synonym for FIRE_ EMP1@BOSTON_SERVER. This would enable you to call the remote procedure from an Oracle Database tool application, such as a SQL*Forms application, as well from within a procedure, OCI application, or precompiler application.
CREATE SYNONYM synonym1 for fire_emp1@boston_server; CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE local_procedure(arg IN NUMBER) AS BEGIN synonym1(arg); END;
If you do not want to use a synonym, then you could write a local cover procedure to call the remote procedure.
DECLARE arg NUMBER; BEGIN local_procedure(arg); END;
7-48
Caution: Unlike stored procedures, which use compile-time binding, runtime binding is used when referencing remote procedures. The user account to which you connect depends on the database link.
All calls to remotely stored procedures are assumed to perform updates; therefore, this type of referencing always requires two-phase commit of that transaction (even if the remote procedure is read-only). Furthermore, if a transaction that includes a remote procedure call is rolled back, then the work done by the remote procedure is also rolled back. A procedure called remotely can usually execute a COMMIT, ROLLBACK, or SAVEPOINT statement, the same as a local procedure. However, there are some differences in behavior:
I
If the transaction was originated by a non-Oracle database, as may be the case in XA applications, these operations are not allowed in the remote procedure. After doing one of these operations, the remote procedure cannot start any distributed transactions of its own. If the remote procedure does not commit or roll back its work, the commit is done implicitly when the database link is closed. In the meantime, further calls to the remote procedure are not allowed because it is still considered to be performing a transaction.
A distributed update modifies data on two or more nodes. A distributed update is possible using a procedure that includes two or more remote updates that access data on different nodes. Statements in the construct are sent to the remote nodes, and the execution of the construct succeeds or fails as a unit. If part of a distributed update fails and part succeeds, then a rollback (of the entire transaction or to a savepoint) is required to proceed. Consider this when creating procedures that perform distributed updates. Pay special attention when using a local procedure that calls a remote procedure. If a timestamp mismatch is found during execution of the local procedure, then the remote procedure is not run, and the local procedure is invalidated.
I I
Hide the identity of the name and owner of a procedure or package. Provide location transparency for remotely stored procedures (standalone or within a package).
When a privileged user needs to call a procedure, an associated synonym can be used. Because the procedures defined within a package are not individual objects (the package is the object), synonyms cannot be created for individual procedures within a package.
Increase user productivity by extending SQL. Expressiveness of the SQL statement increases where activities are too complex, too awkward, or unavailable with SQL. Increase query efficiency. Functions used in the WHERE clause of a query can filter data using criteria that would otherwise need to be evaluated by the application. Manipulate character strings to represent special datatypes (for example, latitude, longitude, or temperature). Provide parallel query execution: If the query is parallelized, then SQL statements in your PL/SQL function may also be run in parallel (using the parallel query option).
The select list of the SELECT statement. The condition of the WHERE and HAVING clause.
7-50
I I I
The CONNECT BY, START WITH, ORDER BY, and GROUP BY clauses. The VALUES clause of the INSERT statement. The SET clause of the UPDATE statement.
You cannot call stored PL/SQL functions from a CHECK constraint clause of a CREATE or ALTER TABLE statement or use them to specify a default value for a column. These situations require an unchanging definition.
Note: Unlike functions, which are called as part of an expression,
procedures are called as statements. Therefore, PL/SQL procedures are not directly callable from SQL statements. However, functions called from a PL/SQL statement or referenced in a SQL expression can call a PL/SQL procedure.
For example, to reference a function you created that is called My_func, in the My_ funcs_pkg package, in the Scott schema, that takes two numeric parameters, you could call the following:
SELECT Scott.My_funcs_pkg.My_func(10,20) FROM dual;
Naming Conventions
If only one of the optional schema or package names is given, then the first identifier can be either a schema name or a package name. For example, to determine whether Payroll in the reference Payroll.Tax_rate is a schema or package name, Oracle Database proceeds as follows:
I I
Oracle Database first checks for the Payroll package in the current schema. If the PAYROLL package is found in the current schema, then Oracle Database looks for a Tax_rate function in the Payroll package. If a Tax_rate function is not found in the Payroll package, then an error message is returned. If a Payroll package is not found, then Oracle Database looks for a schema named Payroll that contains a top-level Tax_rate function. If the Tax_rate
function is not found in the Payroll schema, then an error message is returned. You can also refer to a stored top-level function using any synonym that you have defined for it.
Name Precedence
In SQL statements, the names of database columns take precedence over the names of functions with no parameters. For example, if schema Scott creates the following two objects:
CREATE TABLE Emp_tab(New_sal NUMBER ...); CREATE FUNCTION New_sal RETURN NUMBER IS ...;
Then, in the following two statements, the reference to New_sal refers to the column Emp_tab.New_sal:
SELECT New_sal FROM Emp_tab; SELECT Emp_tab.New_sal FROM Emp_tab;
Example of Calling a PL/SQL Function from SQL For example, to call the Tax_rate PL/SQL function from schema Scott, run it against the Ss_no and sal columns in Tax_table, and place the results in the variable Income_tax, specify the following:
Note: You may need to set up data structures similar to the
7-52
DECLARE Tax_id NUMBER; Income_tax NUMBER; BEGIN SELECT scott.tax_rate (Ss_no, Sal) INTO Income_tax FROM Tax_table WHERE Ss_no = Tax_id; END;
Arguments
To pass any number of arguments to a function, supply the arguments within the parentheses. You must use positional notation; named notation is not supported. For functions that do not accept arguments, use ().
When calling Gross_pay from a procedural statement, you can always accept the default value of St_hrs. This is because you can use named notation, which lets you skip parameters. For example:
IF Gross_pay(Eenum, Ot_hrs => Otime) > Pay_limit THEN ...
However, when calling Gross_pay from a SQL expression, you cannot accept the default value of St_hrs, unless you accept the default value of Ot_hrs. This is because you cannot use named notation.
Privileges
To call a PL/SQL function from SQL, you must either own or have EXECUTE privileges on the function. To select from a view defined with a PL/SQL function, you must have SELECT privileges on the view. No separate EXECUTE privileges are necessary to select from the view.
It must be a stored function, not a function defined within a PL/SQL block or subprogram. It must be a row function, not a column (group) function; in other words, it cannot take an entire column of data as its argument. All its formal parameters must be IN parameters; none can be an OUT or IN OUT parameter. The datatypes of its formal parameters must be Oracle built-in types, such as CHAR, DATE, or NUMBER, not PL/SQL types, such as BOOLEAN, RECORD, or TABLE. Its return type (the datatype of its result value) must be an Oracle built-in type.
For example, the following stored function meets the basic requirements:
Note: You may need to set up the following data structures for
CREATE FUNCTION Gross_pay (Emp_id IN NUMBER, St_hrs IN NUMBER DEFAULT 40, Ot_hrs IN NUMBER DEFAULT 0) RETURN NUMBER AS St_rate NUMBER; Ot_rate NUMBER; BEGIN
7-54
SELECT Srate, Orate INTO St_rate, Ot_rate FROM Payroll WHERE Acctno = Emp_id; RETURN St_hrs * St_rate + Ot_hrs * Ot_rate; END Gross_pay;
runtime restrictions
Restrictions
When a SQL statement is run, checks are made to see if it is logically embedded within the execution of an already running SQL statement. This occurs if the statement is run from a trigger or from a subprogram that was in turn called from the already running SQL statement. In these cases, further checks occur to determine if the new SQL statement is safe in the specific context. The following restrictions are enforced on subprograms:
I
A subprogram called from a query or DML statement may not end the current transaction, create or rollback to a savepoint, or ALTER the system or session. A subprogram called from a query (SELECT) statement or from a parallelized DML statement may not execute a DML statement or otherwise modify the database. A subprogram called from a DML statement may not read or modify the particular table being modified by that DML statement.
These restrictions apply regardless of what mechanism is used to run the SQL statement inside the subprogram or trigger. For example:
I
They apply to a SQL statement called from PL/SQL, whether embedded directly in a subprogram or trigger body, run using the native dynamic mechanism (EXECUTE IMMEDIATE), or run using the DBMS_SQL package. They apply to statements embedded in Java with SQLJ syntax or run using JDBC. They apply to statements run with OCI using the callback context from within an "external" C function.
You can avoid these restrictions if the execution of the new SQL statement is not logically embedded in the context of the already running statement. PL/SQL's autonomous transactions provide one escape (see "Autonomous Transactions" on page 5-28). Another escape is available using Oracle Call Interface (OCI) from an external C function, if you create a new connection rather than using the handle available from the OCIExtProcContext argument.
Declaring a Function
The keywords DETERMINISTIC and PARALLEL_ENABLE can be used in the syntax for declaring a function. These are optimization hints, informing the query optimizer and other software components about those functions that need not be called redundantly and about those that may be used within a parallelized query or parallelized DML statement. Only functions that are DETERMINISTIC are allowed in function-based indexes and in certain snapshots and materialized views. A function that is dependent solely on the values passed into it as arguments, and does not reference or modify the contents of package variables or the database, or have any other side-effects, is called deterministic. Such a function reliably produces the exact same result value for any particular combination of argument values passed into it. The DETERMINISTIC keyword is placed after the return value type in a declaration of the function. For example:
CREATE FUNCTION F1 (P1 NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER DETERMINISTIC IS BEGIN RETURN P1 * 2; END;
This keyword may be placed on a function defined in a CREATE FUNCTION statement, in a function declaration in a CREATE PACKAGE statement, or on a method declaration in a CREATE TYPE statement. It should not be repeated on the
7-56
function's or method's body in a CREATE PACKAGE BODY or CREATE TYPE BODY statement. Certain performance optimizations occur on calls to functions that are marked DETERMINISTIC, without any other action being required. The database cannot recognize if the function's behavior is indeed deterministic. If the DETERMINISTIC keyword is applied to a function whose behavior is not truly deterministic, then the result of queries involving that function is unpredictable. The following features require that any function used with them be declared DETERMINISTIC.
I I
Any function used in a function-based index. Any function used in a materialized view, if that view is to qualify for Fast Refresh or is marked ENABLE QUERY REWRITE.
Both of these features attempt to use previously calculated results rather than calling the function when it is possible to do so. Functions that are used in a WHERE, ORDER BY, or GROUP BY clause, are MAP or ORDER methods of a SQL type, or in any other way are part of determining whether or where a row should appear in a result set also should be DETERMINISTIC as discussed previously. Oracle Database cannot require that they be explicitly declared DETERMINISTIC without breaking existing applications, but the use of the keyword might be a wise choice of style within your application.
For query (SELECT) statements in Oracle Database versions prior to 8.1.5, the parallel query optimization looked to see if a function was noted as RNPS and WNPS in a PRAGMA RESTRICT_REFERENCES declaration; those functions that were marked as both RNPS and WNPS could be run in parallel. Functions defined with a CREATE FUNCTION statement had their code implicitly examined to determine if they were pure enough; parallelized execution might occur even though a pragma cannot be specified on these functions.
See Also: "PRAGMA RESTRICT_REFERENCES for Backward Compatibility" on page 7-59
For DML statements in Oracle Database versions prior to 8.1.5, the parallelization optimization looked to see if a function was noted as having all four of RNDS, WNDS, RNPS and WNPS specified in a PRAGMA RESTRICT_REFERENCES declaration; those functions that were marked as neither reading nor writing to either the database or package variables could run in parallel. Again, those functions defined with a CREATE FUNCTION statement had their code implicitly examined to determine if they were actually pure enough; parallelized execution might occur even though a pragma cannot be specified on these functions. Oracle Database versions 8.1.5 and later continue to parallelize those functions that earlier versions recognize as parallelizable. The PARALLEL_ENABLE keyword is the preferred way to mark your code as safe for parallel execution. This keyword is syntactically similar to DETERMINISTIC as described previously; it is placed after the return value type in a declaration of the function, as in:
CREATE FUNCTION F1 (P1 NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER PARALLEL_ENABLE IS BEGIN RETURN P1 * 2; END;
This keyword may be placed on a function defined in a CREATE FUNCTION statement, in a function declaration in a CREATE PACKAGE statement, or on a method declaration in a CREATE TYPE statement. It should not be repeated on the function's or method's body in a CREATE PACKAGE BODY or CREATE TYPE BODY statement. Note that a PL/SQL function that is defined with CREATE FUNCTION may still be run in parallel without any explicit declaration that it is safe to do so, if the system can determine that it neither reads nor writes package variables nor calls any function that might do so. A Java method or C function is never seen by the system as safe to run in parallel, unless the programmer explicitly indicates PARALLEL_
7-58
ENABLE on the "call specification", or provides a PRAGMA RESTRICT_REFERENCES indicating that the function is sufficiently pure. An additional runtime restriction is imposed on functions run in parallel as part of a parallelized DML statement. Such a function is not permitted to in turn execute a DML statement; it is subject to the same restrictions that are enforced on functions that are run inside a query (SELECT) statement.
See Also: "Restrictions" on page 7-55
It is impossible or impractical to edit existing code to remove RESTRICT_ REFERENCES completely. If you do not remove it from a subprogram S1 that depends on another subprogram S2, then RESTRICT_REFERENCES might also be needed in S2, so that S1 will compile. Replacing RESTRICT_REFERENCES in existing code with hints parallel-enable and deterministic would negatively affect the behavior of new, dependent code. Use RESTRICT_REFERENCES to preserve the behavior of the existing code.
An existing PL/SQL application can thus continue using the pragma even on new functionality, to ease integration with the existing code. Do not use the pragma in a wholly new application. If you use the pragma RESTRICT_REFERENCES, place it in a package specification, not in a package body. It must follow the declaration of a subprogram (function or procedure), but it need not follow immediately. Only one pragma can reference a given subprogram declaration.
Note: The pragma RESTRICT_REFERENCES applies to both
functions and procedures. Purity levels are important for functions, but also for procedures that are called by functions.
Where:
Keyword Description WNDS RNDS WNPS RNPS TRUST The subprogram writes no database state (does not modify database tables). The subprogram reads no database state (does not query database tables). The subprogram writes no package state (does not change the values of packaged variables). The subprogram reads no package state (does not reference the values of packaged variables). The other restrictions listed in the pragma are not enforced; they are simply assumed to be true. This allows easy calling from functions that have RESTRICT_REFERENCES declarations to those that do not.
You can pass the arguments in any order. If any SQL statement inside the subprogram body violates a rule, then you get an error when the statement is parsed. In the following example, the function compound neither reads nor writes database or package state; therefore, you can assert the maximum purity level. Always assert the highest purity level that a subprogram allows. That way, the PL/SQL compiler never rejects the subprogram unnecessarily.
Note: You may need to set up the following data structures for
CREATE PACKAGE Finance AS -- package specification FUNCTION Compound (Years IN NUMBER, Amount IN NUMBER,
7-60
Rate IN NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER; PRAGMA RESTRICT_REFERENCES (Compound, WNDS, WNPS, RNDS, RNPS); END Finance; CREATE PACKAGE BODY Finance AS --package body FUNCTION Compound (Years IN NUMBER, Amount IN NUMBER, Rate IN NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER IS BEGIN RETURN Amount * POWER((Rate / 100) + 1, Years); END Compound; -- no pragma in package body END Finance;
-- function call
Using the Keyword TRUST The keyword TRUST in the RESTRICT_REFERENCES syntax allows easy calling from functions that have RESTRICT_REFERENCES declarations to those that do not. When TRUST is present, the restrictions listed in the pragma are not actually enforced, but rather are simply assumed to be true. When calling from a section of code that is using pragmas to one that is not, there are two likely usage styles. One is to place a pragma on the routine to be called, for example on a "call specification" for a Java method. Then, calls from PL/SQL to this method will complain if the method is less restricted than the calling subprogram. For example:
CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE P1 IS FUNCTION F1 (P1 NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER IS LANGUAGE JAVA NAME 'CLASS1.METHODNAME(int) return int'; PRAGMA RESTRICT_REFERENCES(F1,WNDS,TRUST); FUNCTION F2 (P1 NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER; PRAGMA RESTRICT_REFERENCES(F2,WNDS); END;
CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE BODY P1 IS FUNCTION F2 (P1 NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER IS BEGIN RETURN F1(P1); END; END;
Here, F2 can call F1, as F1 has been declared to be WNDS. The other approach is to mark only the caller, which may then make a call to any subprogram without complaint. For example:
CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE P1a IS FUNCTION F1 (P1 NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER IS LANGUAGE JAVA NAME 'CLASS1.METHODNAME(int) return int'; FUNCTION F2 (P1 NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER; PRAGMA RESTRICT_REFERENCES(F2,WNDS,TRUST); END; CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE BODY P1a IS FUNCTION F2 (P1 NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER IS BEGIN RETURN F1(P1); END; END;
Here, F2 can call F1 because while F2 is promised to be WNDS (because TRUST is specified), the body of F2 is not actually examined to determine if it truly satisfies the WNDS restriction. Because F2 is not examined, its call to F1 is allowed, even though there is no PRAGMA RESTRICT_REFERENCES for F1. Differences between Static and Dynamic SQL Statements. Static INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE statements do not violate RNDS if these statements do not explicitly read any database states, such as columns of a table. However, dynamic INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE statements always violate RNDS, regardless of whether or not the statements explicitly read database states. The following INSERT violates RNDS if it is executed dynamically, but it does not violate RNDS if it is executed statically.
INSERT INTO my_table values(3, 'SCOTT');
The following UPDATE always violates RNDS statically and dynamically, because it explicitly reads the column name of my_table.
7-62
Overloading Packaged PL/SQL Functions PL/SQL lets you overload packaged (but not standalone) functions: You can use the same name for different functions if their formal parameters differ in number, order, or datatype family. However, a RESTRICT_REFERENCES pragma can apply to only one function declaration. Therefore, a pragma that references the name of overloaded functions always applies to the nearest preceding function declaration. In this example, the pragma applies to the second declaration of valid:
CREATE PACKAGE Tests AS FUNCTION Valid (x NUMBER) RETURN CHAR; FUNCTION Valid (x DATE) RETURN CHAR; PRAGMA RESTRICT_REFERENCES (valid, WNDS); END;
Package States
The state of a nonreusable package (one not marked SERIALLY_REUSABLE) persists for the lifetime of a session. A package state includes global variables, cursors, and so on. The state of a serially reusable package persists only for the lifetime of a call to the server. On a subsequent call to the server, if a reference is made to the serially
reusable package, then Oracle Database creates a new instantiation of the serially reusable package and initializes all the global variables to NULL or to the default values provided. Any changes made to the serially reusable package state in the previous calls to the server are not visible.
Note: Creating a new instantiation of a serially reusable package
on a call to the server does not necessarily imply that Oracle Database allocates memory or configures the instantiation object. Oracle Database looks for an available instantiation work area (which is allocated and configured) for this package in a least-recently used (LRU) pool in the SGA. At the end of the call to the server, this work area is returned back to the LRU pool. The reason for keeping the pool in the SGA is that the work area can be reused across users who have requests for the same package.
A package specification can be marked serially reusable, whether or not it has a corresponding package body. If the package has a body, then the body must have the serially reusable pragma, if its corresponding specification has the pragma; it cannot have the serially reusable pragma unless the specification also has the pragma.
7-64
Its package variables are meant for use only within the work boundaries, which correspond to calls to the server (either OCI call boundaries or PL/SQL RPC calls to the server).
Note: If the application programmer makes a mistake and
depends on a package variable that is set in a previous unit of work, then the application program can fail. PL/SQL cannot check for such cases.
I
A pool of package instantiations is kept, and whenever a "unit of work" needs this package, one of the instantiations is "reused", as follows: The package variables are reinitialized (for example, if the package variables have default values, then those values are reinitialized). The initialization code in the package body is run again.
At the "end work" boundary, cleanup is done. If any cursors were left open, then they are silently closed. Some non-reusable secondary memory is freed (such as memory for collection variables or long VARCHAR2s). This package instantiation is returned back to the pool of reusable instantiations kept for this package.
Serially reusable packages cannot be accessed from database triggers or other PL/SQL subprograms that are called from SQL statements. If you try, then Oracle Database generates an error.
END Sr_pkg;
Suppose your Enterprise Manager (or SQL*Plus) application issues the following:
CONNECT Scott/Tiger # first CALL to server BEGIN Sr_pkg.N := 10; END; # second CALL to server BEGIN DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE(Sr_pkg.N); END;
REUSABLE, the program would have printed '10'. Example 2: How Package Variables Act Across Call Boundaries This example has both a package specification and package body, which are serially reusable.
CONNECT Scott/Tiger DROP PACKAGE Sr_pkg; CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE Sr_pkg IS PRAGMA SERIALLY_REUSABLE; TYPE Str_table_type IS TABLE OF VARCHAR2(200) INDEX BY BINARY_INTEGER; Num NUMBER := 10; Str VARCHAR2(200) := 'default-init-str'; Str_tab STR_TABLE_TYPE; PROCEDURE Print_pkg; PROCEDURE Init_and_print_pkg(N NUMBER, V VARCHAR2); END Sr_pkg; CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE BODY Sr_pkg IS -- the body is required to have the pragma because the -- specification of this package has the pragma PRAGMA SERIALLY_REUSABLE; PROCEDURE Print_pkg IS
7-66
BEGIN DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('num: ' || Sr_pkg.Num); DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('str: ' || Sr_pkg.Str); DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('number of table elems: ' || Sr_pkg.Str_tab.Count); FOR i IN 1..Sr_pkg.Str_tab.Count LOOP DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE(Sr_pkg.Str_tab(i)); END LOOP; END; PROCEDURE Init_and_print_pkg(N NUMBER, V VARCHAR2) IS BEGIN -- init the package globals Sr_pkg.Num := N; Sr_pkg.Str := V; FOR i IN 1..n LOOP Sr_pkg.Str_tab(i) := V || ' ' || i; END LOOP; -- print the package Print_pkg; END; END Sr_pkg; SET SERVEROUTPUT ON; Rem SR package access in a CALL: BEGIN -- initialize and print the package DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('Initing and printing pkg state..'); Sr_pkg.Init_and_print_pkg(4, 'abracadabra'); -- print it in the same call to the server. -- we should see the initialized values. DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('Printing package state in the same CALL...'); Sr_pkg.Print_pkg; END; Initing and printing pkg state.. num: 4 str: abracadabra number of table elems: 4 abracadabra 1 abracadabra 2 abracadabra 3 abracadabra 4 Printing package state in the same CALL... num: 4
str: abracadabra number of table elems: 4 abracadabra 1 abracadabra 2 abracadabra 3 abracadabra 4 REM SR package access in subsequent CALL: BEGIN -- print the package in the next call to the server. -- We should that the package state is reset to the initial (default) values. DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('Printing package state in the next CALL...'); Sr_pkg.Print_pkg; END; Statement processed. Printing package state in the next CALL... num: 10 str: default-init-str number of table elems: 0
Example 3: Open Cursors in Serially Reusable Packages at Call Boundaries This example demonstrates that any open cursors in serially reusable packages get closed automatically at the end of a work boundary (which is a call). Also, in a new call, these cursors need to be opened again.
REM REM REM REM REM REM For serially reusable pkg: At the end work boundaries (which is currently the OCI call boundary) all open cursors will be closed. Because the cursor is closed - every time we fetch we will start at the first row again.
CONNECT Scott/Tiger DROP PACKAGE Sr_pkg; DROP TABLE People; CREATE TABLE People (Name VARCHAR2(20)); INSERT INTO People VALUES ('ET'); INSERT INTO People VALUES ('RAMBO'); CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE Sr_pkg IS PRAGMA SERIALLY_REUSABLE; CURSOR C IS SELECT Name FROM People; END Sr_pkg; SQL> SET SERVEROUTPUT ON; SQL> CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE Fetch_from_cursor IS
7-68
Name VARCHAR2(200); BEGIN IF (Sr_pkg.C%ISOPEN) THEN DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('cursor is already open.'); ELSE DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('cursor is closed; opening now.'); OPEN Sr_pkg.C; END IF; -- fetching from cursor. FETCH sr_pkg.C INTO name; DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('fetched: ' || Name); FETCH Sr_pkg.C INTO name; DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE('fetched: ' || Name); -- Oops forgot to close the cursor (Sr_pkg.C). -- But, because it is a Serially Reusable pkg's cursor, -- it will be closed at the end of this CALL to the server. END; EXECUTE fetch_from_cursor; cursor is closed; opening now. fetched: ET fetched: RAMBO
The producer function uses the PIPELINED keyword in its declaration. The producer function uses an OUT parameter that is a record, corresponding to a row in the result set. As each output record is completed, it is sent to the consumer function using the PIPE ROW keyword. The producer function ends with a RETURN statement that does not specify any return value.
The consumer function or SQL statement uses the TABLE keyword to treat the resulting rows like a regular table.
For example:
CREATE FUNCTION StockPivot(p refcur_pkg.refcur_t) RETURN TickerTypeSet PIPELINED IS out_rec TickerType := TickerType(NULL,NULL,NULL); in_rec p%ROWTYPE; BEGIN LOOP -- Function accepts multiple rows through a REF CURSOR argument. FETCH p INTO in_rec; EXIT WHEN p%NOTFOUND; -- Return value is a record type that matches the table definition. out_rec.ticker := in_rec.Ticker; out_rec.PriceType := 'O'; out_rec.price := in_rec.OpenPrice; -- Once a result row is ready, we send it back to the calling program, -- and continue processing. PIPE ROW(out_rec); -- This function outputs twice as many rows as it receives as input. out_rec.PriceType := 'C'; out_rec.Price := in_rec.ClosePrice; PIPE ROW(out_rec); END LOOP; CLOSE p; -- The function ends with a RETURN statement that does not specify any value. RETURN; END; / -- Here we use the result of this function in a SQL query. SELECT * FROM TABLE(StockPivot(CURSOR(SELECT * FROM StockTable))); -- Here we use the result of this function in a PL/SQL block. DECLARE total NUMBER := 0; price_type VARCHAR2(1); BEGIN FOR item IN (SELECT * FROM TABLE(StockPivot(CURSOR(SELECT * FROM StockTable)))) LOOP -- Access the values of each output row. -- We know the column names based on the declaration of the output type. -- This computation is just for illustration.
7-70
Code the member functions. In particular, ODCIAggregateIterate accumulates the result as it is called once for each row that is processed. Store any intermediate results using the attributes of the object type. Create the aggregate function, and associate it with the new object type. Call the aggregate function from SQL queries, DML statements, or other places that you might use the built-in aggregates. You can include typical options such as DISTINCT and ALL in the calls to the aggregate function.
See Also: Oracle Data Cartridge Developer's Guide for complete details of this process and the requirements for the member functions
I I
7-72
8
Calling External Procedures
In situations where a particular language does not provide the features you need, or when you want to reuse existing code written in another language, you can use code written in some other language by calling external procedures. This chapter discusses the following topics:
I I I I I I I I I I I I I
Overview of Multi-Language Programs What Is an External Procedure? Overview of The Call Specification for External Procedures Loading External Procedures Publishing External Procedures Publishing Java Class Methods Publishing External C Procedures Locations of Call Specifications Passing Parameters to External C Procedures with Call Specifications Executing External Procedures with the CALL Statement Handling Errors and Exceptions in Multi-Language Programs Using Service Procedures with External C Procedures Doing Callbacks with External C Procedures
8-1
PL/SQL, as described in the PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference C, by means of the Oracle Call Interface (OCI), as described in the Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide C or C++, by means of the Pro*C/C++ precompiler, as described in the Pro*C/C++ Programmer's Guide COBOL, by means of the Pro*COBOL precompiler, as described in the Pro*COBOL Programmer's Guide Visual Basic, by means of Oracle Objects for OLE (OO4O), as described in Oracle Objects for OLE Developer's Guide. Java, by means of the JDBC Application Programmers Interface (API). See Oracle Database Java Developer's Guide.
How should you choose between these different implementation possibilities? Each of these languages offers different advantages: ease of use, the availability of programmers with specific expertise, the need for portability, and the existence of legacy code are powerful determinants. The choice may narrow depending on how your application needs to work with Oracle Database:
I
PL/SQL is a powerful development tool, specialized for SQL transaction processing. Some computation-intensive tasks are executed most efficiently in a lower level language, such as C. The need for portability, together with the need for security, may influence you to select Java.
Most significantly, from the point of view of performance, you should note that only PL/SQL and Java methods run within the address space of the server. C/C++ methods are dispatched as external procedures, and run on the server machine but outside the address space of the database server. Pro*COBOL and Pro*C are precompilers, and Visual Basic accesses Oracle Database through the OCI, which is implemented in C. Taking all these factors into account suggests that there may be a number of situations in which you may need to implement your application in more than one language. For instance, the introduction of Java running within the address space of
8-2
the server suggest that you may want to import existing Java applications into the database, and then leverage this technology by calling Java functions from PL/SQL and SQL. PL/SQL external procedures allow you to write C function calls as PL/SQL bodies. These C functions are callable directly from PL/SQL, and from SQL through PL/SQL procedure calls. The database provides a special-purpose interface, the call specification, that lets you call external procedures from other languages. While this service is designed for intercommunication between SQL, PL/SQL, C, and Java, it is accessible from any base language that can call these languages. For example, your procedure can be written in a language other than Java or C and still be usable by SQL or PL/SQL, as long as your procedure is callable by C. Therefore, if you have a candidate C++ procedure, you would use a C++ extern "C" statement in that procedure to make it callable by C. This means that the strengths and capabilities of different languages are available to you, regardless of your programmatic environment. You are not restricted to one language with its inherent limitations. External procedures promote reusability and modularity because you can deploy specific languages for specific purposes.
Isolate execution of client applications and processes from the database instance to ensure that any problems on the client side do not adversely impact the database. Move computation-bound programs from client to server where they execute faster (because they avoid the round-trips of network communication)
8-3
I I
Interface the database server with external systems and data sources Extend the functionality of the database server itself
To support legacy applications, call specifications also allow you to publish with the AS EXTERNAL clause. For new application development, however, using the AS LANGUAGE clause is recommended.
Dispatching the appropriate C or Java target procedure Datatype conversions Parameter mode mappings Automatic memory allocation and cleanup Purity constraints to be specified, where necessary, for packaged functions called from SQL. Calling Java methods or C procedures from database triggers Location flexibility: you can put AS LANGUAGE call specifications in package or type specifications, or package (or type) bodies to optimize performance and hide implementation details
I I
To use an already-existing program as an external procedure, load, publish, and then call it.
8-4
Creating a class libunit in schema scott from file Agent.class requires two steps: First, create a directory object on the server's file system. The name of the directory object is an alias for the directory path leading to Agent.class. To create the directory object, you must grant user scott the CREATE ANY DIRECTORY privilege, then execute the CREATE DIRECTORY statement, as follows:
CONNECT System/Manager GRANT CREATE ANY DIRECTORY TO Scott IDENTIFIED BY Tiger; CONNECT Scott/Tiger CREATE DIRECTORY Bfile_dir AS '/home/java/bin';
The name of the libunit is derived from the name of the class. Alternatively, you can use the command-line utility LoadJava. This uploads Java binaries and resources into a system-generated database table, then uses the CREATE JAVA statement to load the Java files into RDBMS libunits. You can upload Java files from file systems, Java IDEs, intranets, or the Internet.
8-5
Note:
I
This feature is available only on platforms that support dynamically linked libraries (DLLs) or dynamically loadable shared libraries such as Solaris .so libraries. The external procedure agent can call procedures in any library that complies with the calling standard used. The supported calling standard is C. See "CALLING STANDARD" on page 8-12 for more information on the calling standard sub clause used with external procedures in PL/SQL.
Step 1 Set Up the Environment Your database administrator must perform the following tasks to configure your database to use external procedures that are written in C, or can be called from C applications:
I
Set configuration parameters for the agent, named extproc by default, in the configuration files tnsnames.ora and listener.ora. This establishes the connection for the external procedure agent when the database is started. Start a listener process exclusively for external procedures. The Listener sets a few required environment variables (such as ORACLE_HOME, ORACLE_SID, and LD_LIBRARY_PATH) for the external procedure agent. It can also define specific environment variables in the ENVS section of its listener.ora entry, and these variables are passed to the agent process. Otherwise, it provides the agent with a "clean" environment. The environment variables set for the agent are independent of those set for the client and server. Therefore, external procedures, which run in the agent process, cannot read environment variables set for the client or server processes.
Note: It is possible for you to set and read environment variables
themselves by using the standard C procedures setenv() and getenv(), respectively. Environment variables, set this way, are specific to the agent process, which means that they can be read by all functions executed in that process, but not by any other process running on the same host.
I
Determine whether the agent for your external procedure will run in dedicated mode (the default mode) or multithreaded mode. In dedicated mode, one
8-6
"dedicated" agent is launched for each user. In multithreaded mode, a single multithreaded agent is launched. The multithreaded agent handles calls using different threads for different users. In a configuration where many users will call the external procedures, using a multithreaded agent is recommended to conserve system resources. If the agent will run in dedicated mode, additional configuration of the agent process is not necessary. If the agent will run in multithreaded mode, your database administrator must configure the database system to start the agent in multithreaded mode (as a multithreaded agent). This is done using the agent control utility agtctl. For example, start the agent using the agent control utility startup command:
agtctl startup extproc agent_sid
where agent_sid is the system identifier which this agent will service. An entry for this system identifier is typically added as an entry in the file tnsnames.ora. Details on the agent control utility are in the Oracle Database Heterogeneous Connectivity Administrator's Guide.
Note:
I
If you use a multithreaded agent, the library you call must be thread safeto avoid errors such as a corrupt call stack. The database server, the agent process, and the listener process that spawns the agent process must all reside on the same host. By default, the agent process runs on the same database instance as your main application. In situations where reliability is critical, you might want to run the agent process for the external procedure on a separate database instance (still on the same host), so that any problems in the agent do not affect the primary database server. To do so, specify the separate database instance using a database link.
Figure 81 illustrates the architecture of the multithreaded external procedure agent. User sessions 1 and 2 issue requests for callouts to functions in some DLLs. These requests get serviced through heterogeneous services to the multithreaded extproc agent. These requests get handled by the agent's dispatcher threads, which then pass them on to the task threads. The task thread that is actually handling a request is responsible for loading the respective DLL and calling the function therein.
8-7
All requests from a user session get handled by the same dispatcher thread. For example, dispatcher 1 handles communication with user session 1, and dispatcher 2 handles communication with user session 2. This is the case for the lifetime of the session. The individual requests can, however, be serviced by different task threads. For example, task thread 1 could handle the request from user session 1 at one time, and handle the request from user session 2 at another time.
Task Thread 1
Task Thread 2
Task Thread 3
DLLs
8-8
See Also:
I
Oracle Database Heterogeneous Connectivity Administrator's Guide for details on configuring the agent process for the external procedure to use multithreaded mode, architecture, and for additional details on multithreaded agents Oracle Database Administrator's Guide. for details on managing processes for external procedures
Step 2 Identify the DLL In this context, a DLL is any dynamically loadable operating-system file that stores external procedures. For security reasons, your DBA controls access to the DLL. Using the CREATE LIBRARY statement, the DBA creates a schema object called an alias library, which represents the DLL. Then, if you are an authorized user, the DBA grants you EXECUTE privileges on the alias library. Alternatively, the DBA may grant you CREATE ANY LIBRARY privileges, in which case you can create your own alias libraries using the following syntax:
CREATE LIBRARY [schema_name.]library_name {IS | AS} 'file_path' [AGENT 'agent_link'];
It is recommended that you specify the full path to the DLL, rather than just the DLL name. In the following example, you create alias library c_utils, which represents DLL utils.so:
CREATE LIBRARY C_utils AS '/DLLs/utils.so';
To allow flexibility in specifying the DLLs, you can specify the root part of the path as an environment variable using the notation ${VAR_NAME}, and set up that variable in the ENVS section of the listener.ora entry. In the following example, the agent specified by the name agent_link is used to run any external procedure in the library C_Utils. The environment variable EP_ LIB_HOME is expanded by the agent to the appropriate path for that instance, such as /usr/bin/dll. Variable EP_LIB_HOME must be set in the file listener.ora, for the agent to be able to access it.
create or replace database link agent_link using 'agent_tns_alias'; create or replace library C_utils is '${EP_LIB_HOME}/utils.so' agent 'agent_link';
8-9
For security reasons, EXTPROC, by default, will only load DLLs that are in directory $ORACLE_HOME/bin or $ORACLE_HOME/lib. Also, only local sessionsthat is, Oracle Database client processes that are running on the same machineare allowed to connect to EXTPROC. To load DLLs from other directories, the environment variable EXTPROC_DLLS should be set. The value for this environment variable is a colon- separated (:) list of DLL names qualified with the complete path. For example:
EXTPROC_DLLS=/private1/home/scott/dll/myDll.so:/private1/home/scott/dll/newDll.so
The preferred method to set this environment variable is through the ENVS parameter in the file listener.ora. Refer to the Oracle Net manual for more information on the EXTPROC feature. Note the following:
I
On a Windows system, you would specify the path using a drive letter and backslash characters (\) in the path. This technique is not applicable for VMS systems, where the ENVS section of listener.ora is not supported.
Step 3 Publish the External Procedure You find or write a new external C procedure, then add it to the DLL. When the procedure is in the DLL, you publish it using the call specification mechanism described in the following section.
For a C procedure:
8-10
I I I I
The alias library corresponding to the DLL for a C procedure. The name of the C procedure in a DLL. Various options for specifying how parameters are passed. Which parameter (if any) holds the name of the external procedure agent, for running the procedure on a different machine.
You begin the declaration using the normal CREATE OR REPLACE syntax for a procedure, function, package specification, package body, type specification, or type body. The call specification follows the name and parameter declarations. Its syntax is:
{IS | AS} LANGUAGE {C | JAVA}
External Procedure, but replaces the ANSI keyword AS EXTERNAL with this call specification syntax. This new syntax, first introduced for Java class methods, has been extended to C procedures. This is then followed by either:
NAME java_string_literal_name
Where library_name is the name of your alias library, c_string_literal_ name is the name of your external C procedure, and external_parameter stands for:
{ CONTEXT | SELF [{TDO | property}] | {parameter_name | RETURN} [property] [BY REFERENCE] [external_datatype]}
Note: Unlike Java, C does not understand SQL types; therefore, the
LIBRARY
Specifies a local alias library. (You cannot use a database link to specify a remote library.) The library name is a PL/SQL identifier. Therefore, if you enclose the name in double quotes, then it becomes case sensitive. (By default, the name is stored in upper case.) You must have EXECUTE privileges on the alias library.
NAME
Specifies the external C procedure to be called. If you enclose the procedure name in double quotes, then it becomes case sensitive. (By default, the name is stored in upper case.) If you omit this subclause, then the procedure name defaults to the upper-case name of the PL/SQL subprogram.
Note: The terms LANGUAGE and CALLING STANDARD apply
LANGUAGE
Specifies the third-generation language in which the external procedure was written. If you omit this subclause, then the language name defaults to C.
CALLING STANDARD
Specifies the calling standard under which the external procedure was compiled. The supported calling standard is C. If you omit this subclause, then the calling standard defaults to C.
8-12
WITH CONTEXT
Specifies that a context pointer will be passed to the external procedure. The context data structure is opaque to the external procedure but is available to service procedures called by the external procedure.
PARAMETERS
Specifies the positions and datatypes of parameters passed to the external procedure. It can also specify parameter properties, such as current length and maximum length, and the preferred parameter passing method (by value or by reference).
AGENT IN
Specifies which parameter holds the name of the agent process that should run this procedure. This is intended for situations where external procedure agents are run using multiple agent processes, to ensure robustness if the agent process of one external procedure fails. You can pass the name of the agent process (corresponding to the name of a database link), and if tnsnames.ora and listener.ora are set up properly across both instances, the external procedure is invoked on the other instance. Both instances must be on the same host. This is similar to the AGENT clause of the CREATE LIBRARY statement; specifying the value at runtime through AGENT IN allows greater flexibility. When the agent name is specified this way, it overrides any agent name declared in the alias library. If no agent name is specified, the default is the extproc agent on the same instance as the calling program.
When you load Java classes into the RDBMS, they are not published to SQL automatically. This is because the methods of many Java classes are called only from other Java classes, or take parameters for which there is no appropriate SQL type. Suppose you want to publish the following Java method named J_ calcFactorial, which returns the factorial of its argument:
package myRoutines.math; public class Factorial { public static int J_calcFactorial (int n) { if (n == 1) return 1; else return n * J_calcFactorial(n - 1); } }
The following call specification publishes Java method J_calcFactorial as PL/SQL stored function plsToJavaFac_func, using SQL*Plus:
CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION Plstojavafac_func (N NUMBER) RETURN NUMBER AS LANGUAGE JAVA NAME 'myRoutines.math.Factorial.J_calcFactorial(int) return int';
8-14
I I I
We have already shown an example of call specification located in a standalone PL/SQL function. Here are some examples showing some of the other locations.
Note: In the following examples, the AUTHID and SQL_NAME_RESOLVE
clauses may or may not be required to fully stipulate a call specification. See the PL/SQL User's Guide and Reference and the Oracle Database SQL Reference for more information.
CREATE OR REPLACE TYPE Demo_typ AUTHID DEFINER AS OBJECT (Attribute1 VARCHAR2(2000), SomeLib varchar2(20), MEMBER PROCEDURE plsToC_demoExternal_proc (x BINARY_INTEGER, y VARCHAR2, z DATE) AS LANGUAGE C NAME "C_demoExternal" LIBRARY SomeLib WITH CONTEXT -- PARAMETERS(CONTEXT, x INT, y STRING, z OCIDATE) PARAMETERS(CONTEXT, x INT, y STRING, z OCIDATE, SELF) );
8-16
NAME "C_demoExternal" LIBRARY SomeLib WITH CONTEXT PARAMETERS(CONTEXT, x INT, y STRING, z OCIDATE); END; CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE BODY Demo_pack AS PROCEDURE plsToC_InBodyOld_proc (x BINARY_INTEGER, y VARCHAR2, z DATE) AS EXTERNAL LANGUAGE C NAME "C_InBodyOld" LIBRARY SomeLib WITH CONTEXT PARAMETERS(CONTEXT, x INT, y STRING, z OCIDATE); PROCEDURE plsToC_demoExternal_proc (x BINARY_INTEGER, y VARCHAR2, z DATE) AS LANGUAGE C NAME "C_demoExternal" LIBRARY SomeLib WITH CONTEXT PARAMETERS(CONTEXT, x INT, y STRING, z OCIDATE); PROCEDURE plsToC_InBody_proc (x BINARY_INTEGER, y VARCHAR2, z DATE) AS LANGUAGE C NAME "C_InBody" LIBRARY SomeLib WITH CONTEXT PARAMETERS(CONTEXT, x INT, y STRING, z OCIDATE); PROCEDURE plsToJ_InBody_proc (x BINARY_INTEGER, y VARCHAR2, z DATE) IS LANGUAGE JAVA NAME 'pkg1.class4.J_InBody_meth(int,java.lang.String,java.sql.Date)'; END;
The available set of PL/SQL datatypes does not correspond one-to-one with the set of C datatypes.
8-18
Unlike C, PL/SQL includes the RDBMS concept of nullity. Therefore, PL/SQL parameters can be NULL, whereas C parameters cannot. The external procedure might need the current length or maximum length of CHAR, LONG RAW, RAW, and VARCHAR2 parameters. The external procedure might need character set information about CHAR, VARCHAR2, and CLOB parameters. PL/SQL might need the current length, maximum length, or null status of values returned by the external procedure.
In the following sections, you learn how to specify a parameter list that deals with these circumstances.
Note: The maximum number of parameters that you can pass to a C
external procedure is 128. However, if you pass float or double parameters by value, then the maximum is less than 128. How much less depends on the number of such parameters and your operating system. To get a rough estimate, count each float or double passed by value as two parameters.
Specifying Datatypes
Do not pass parameters to an external procedure directly. Instead, pass them to the PL/SQL subprogram that published the external procedure. Therefore, you must specify PL/SQL datatypes for the parameters. PL/SQL datatypes map to default external datatypes, as shown in Table 81.
Table 81 Parameter Datatype Mappings Supported External Types [UNSIGNED] CHAR [UNSIGNED] SHORT [UNSIGNED] INT [UNSIGNED] LONG SB1, SB2, SB4 UB1, UB2, UB4 SIZE_T Default External Type INT
Table 81 (Cont.) Parameter Datatype Mappings PL/SQL Datatype NATURAL NATURALN1 POSITIVE1 POSITIVEN1 SIGNTYPE1
1
Supported External Types [UNSIGNED] CHAR [UNSIGNED] SHORT [UNSIGNED] INT [UNSIGNED] LONG SB1, SB2, SB4 UB1, UB2, UB4 SIZE_T FLOAT DOUBLE STRING OCISTRING
FLOAT REAL DOUBLE PRECISION CHAR CHARACTER LONG NCHAR NVARCHAR2 ROWID VARCHAR VARCHAR2 LONG RAW RAW BFILE BLOB CLOB NCLOB NUMBER DEC1 DECIMAL1 INT1 INTEGER1 NUMERIC1 SMALLINT1 DATE TIMESTAMP TIMESTAMP WITH TIME ZONE TIMESTAMP WITH LOCAL TIME ZONE
RAW OCILOBLOCATOR
OCINUMBER
OCINUMBER
OCIDATE OCIDateTime
OCIDATE OCIDateTime
8-20
Table 81 (Cont.) Parameter Datatype Mappings PL/SQL Datatype INTERVAL DAY TO SECOND INTERVAL YEAR TO MONTH composite object types: ADTs composite object types: collections (varrays, nested tables)
1
This PL/SQL type will only compile if you use AS EXTERNAL in your callspec.
External Datatype Corresponding to PL/SL Type CHAR UNSIGNED CHAR SHORT UNSIGNED SHORT INT UNSIGNED INT LONG UNSIGNED LONG CHAR
unsigned char unsigned char * unsigned char * short unsigned short int unsigned int long short * unsigned short * int * unsigned int * long * short * unsigned short * int * unsigned int * long *
Table 82 (Cont.) External Datatype Mappings If Mode is IN by Reference or RETURN by Reference, Specify in C Prototype...
External Datatype Corresponding to PL/SL Type UNSIGNED CHAR SHORT UNSIGNED SHORT INT UNSIGNED INT LONG UNSIGNED LONG SIZE_T SB1 UB1 SB2 UB2 SB4 UB4 FLOAT DOUBLE STRING RAW OCILOBLOCATOR OCINUMBER OCISTRING OCIRAW
unsigned char unsigned char * unsigned char * short unsigned short int unsigned int long short * unsigned short * int * unsigned int * long * short * unsigned short * int * unsigned int * long *
unsigned long unsigned long * unsigned long * size_t sb1 ub1 sb2 ub2 sb4 ub4 float double char * size_t * sb1 * ub1 * sb2 * ub2 * sb4 * ub4 * float * double * char * size_t * sb1 * ub1 * sb2 * ub2 * sb4 * ub4 * float * double * char *
unsigned char unsigned char * unsigned char * * OCILobLocator OCILobLocator * ** OCINumber * OCIString * OCIRaw * OCINumber * OCIString * OCIRaw * OCILobLocator ** OCINumber * OCIString * OCIRaw *
8-22
Table 82 (Cont.) External Datatype Mappings If Mode is IN by Reference or RETURN by Reference, Specify in C Prototype... OCIDate *
If Mode is IN OUT or OUT, Specify in C Prototype... OCIDate * OCIColl ** or OCIArray **, or OCITable ** OCIType * OCIType * dvoid* dvoid**
OCIColl * or OCIColl ** or OCIArray *, OCIArray **, or or OCITable * OCITable ** OCIType * OCIType * dvoid* dvoid* OCIType * OCIType * dvoid* dvoid*
Composite object types are not self describing. Their description is stored in a Type Descriptor Object (TDO). Objects and indicator structs for objects have no predefined OCI datatype, but must use the datatypes generated by Oracle Database's Object Type Translator (OTT). The optional TDO argument for INDICATOR, and for composite objects, in general, has the C datatype, OCIType *. OCICOLL for REF and collection arguments is optional and only exists for the sake of completeness. You cannot map REFs or collections onto any other datatype and vice versa.
[UNSIGNED] SHORT [UNSIGNED] INT [UNSIGNED] LONG SIZE_T SB1 SB2 SB4 UB1 UB2 UB4 FLOAT DOUBLE
All IN and RETURN arguments of external types not on this list, all IN OUT arguments, and all OUT arguments are passed by reference.
CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION Interp_func ( /* Find the value of y at x degrees using Lagrange interpolation: */ x IN FLOAT, y IN FLOAT) RETURN FLOAT AS LANGUAGE C NAME "Interp_func" LIBRARY MathLib;
Each formal parameter declaration specifies a name, parameter mode, and PL/SQL datatype (which maps to the default external datatype). That might be all the information the external procedure needs. If not, then you can provide more information using the PARAMETERS clause, which lets you specify the following:
I I
8-24
I I I I
NULL/NOT NULL indicators for parameters Character set IDs and forms The position of parameters in the list How IN parameters are passed (by value or by reference)
For every formal parameter, there must be a corresponding parameter in the PARAMETERS clause. If you include the WITH CONTEXT clause, then you must specify the parameter CONTEXT, which shows the position of the context pointer in the parameter list. If the external procedure is a function, then you may specify the RETURN parameter, but it must be in the last position. If RETURN is not specified, the default external type is used.
Specifying Properties
You can also use the PARAMETERS clause to pass additional information about PL/SQL formal parameters and function results to an external procedure. Do this by specifying one or more of the following properties:
INDICATOR [{STRUCT | TDO}] LENGTH DURATION MAXLEN CHARSETID CHARSETFORM SELF
Table 83 shows the allowed and the default external datatypes, PL/SQL datatypes, and PL/SQL parameter modes allowed for a given property. Notice that MAXLEN (used to specify data returned from C back to PL/SQL) cannot be applied to an IN parameter.
Table 83
Properties and Datatypes Allowed Default External Types External Type (C) (C) SHORT SHORT Allowed PL/SQL Types all scalars Default PL/SQL Allowed Passing PL/SQL Modes Method IN IN OUT OUT RETURN IN IN OUT OUT RETURN IN OUT OUT RETURN BY BY BY BY BY BY BY BY VALUE REFERENCE REFERENCE REFERENCE VALUE REFERENCE REFERENCE REFERENCE
Property INDICATOR
LENGTH
[UNSIGNED] INT SHORT [UNSIGNED] INT [UNSIGNED] LONG [UNSIGNED] INT SHORT [UNSIGNED] INT [UNSIGNED] LONG
CHAR LONG RAW RAW VARCHAR2 CHAR LONG RAW RAW VARCHAR2 CHAR CLOB VARCHAR2
MAXLEN
CHARSETID UNSIGNED SHORT UNSIGNED INT CHARSETFORM UNSIGNED INT UNSIGNED LONG
BY BY BY BY
In the following example, the PARAMETERS clause specifies properties for the PL/SQL formal parameters and function result:
CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION plsToCparse_func x IN BINARY_INTEGER, Y IN OUT CHAR) RETURN CHAR AS LANGUAGE C LIBRARY c_utils NAME "C_parse" PARAMETERS ( x, -- stores value of x x INDICATOR, -- stores null status of y, -- stores value of y y LENGTH, -- stores current length y MAXLEN, -- stores maximum length RETURN INDICATOR, RETURN); (
x of y of y
8-26
char * C_parse(int x, short x_ind, char *y, int *y_len, int *y_maxlen, short *retind);
The additional parameters in the C prototype correspond to the INDICATOR (for x), LENGTH (of y), and MAXLEN (of y), as well as the INDICATOR for the function result in the PARAMETERS clause. The parameter RETURN corresponds to the C function identifier, which stores the result value.
INDICATOR
An INDICATOR is a parameter whose value indicates whether or not another parameter is NULL. PL/SQL does not need indicators, because the RDBMS concept of nullity is built into the language. However, an external procedure might need to know if a parameter or function result is NULL. Also, an external procedure might need to signal the server that a returned value is actually a NULL, and should be treated accordingly. In such cases, you can use the property INDICATOR to associate an indicator with a formal parameter. If the PL/SQL subprogram is a function, then you can also associate an indicator with the function result, as shown earlier. To check the value of an indicator, you can use the constants OCI_IND_NULL and OCI_IND_NOTNULL. If the indicator equals OCI_IND_NULL, then the associated parameter or function result is NULL. If the indicator equals OCI_IND_NOTNULL, then the parameter or function result is not NULL. For IN parameters, which are inherently read-only, INDICATOR is passed by value (unless you specify BY REFERENCE) and is read-only (even if you specify BY REFERENCE). For OUT, IN OUT, and RETURN parameters, INDICATOR is passed by reference by default. The INDICATOR can also have a STRUCT or TDO option. Because specifying INDICATOR as a property of an object is not supported, and because arguments of objects have complete indicator structs instead of INDICATOR scalars, you must specify this by using the STRUCT option. You must use the type descriptor object (TDO) option for composite objects and collections,
Note: With a parameter of type RAW or LONG RAW, you must use
the property LENGTH. Also, if that parameter is IN OUT and NULL or OUT and NULL, then you must set the length of the corresponding C parameter to zero. For IN parameters, LENGTH is passed by value (unless you specify BY REFERENCE) and is read-only. For OUT, IN OUT, and RETURN parameters, LENGTH is passed by reference. As mentioned earlier, MAXLEN does not apply to IN parameters. For OUT, IN OUT, and RETURN parameters, MAXLEN is passed by reference and is read-only.
8-28
See Also: Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide and the Oracle
Database Globalization Support Guide for more information about using national language data with the OCI
Repositioning Parameters
Remember, each formal parameter of the external procedure must have a corresponding parameter in the PARAMETERS clause. Their positions can differ, because PL/SQL associates them by name, not by position. However, the PARAMETERS clause and the C prototype for the external procedure must have the same number of parameters, and they must be in the same order.
Using SELF
SELF is the always-present argument of an object type's member function or procedure, namely the object instance itself. In most cases, this argument is implicit and is not listed in the argument list of the PL/SQL procedure. However, SELF must be explicitly specified as an argument of the PARAMETERS clause. For example, assume that a user wants to create a Person object, consisting of a person's name and date of birth, and then further a table of this object type. The user would eventually like to determine the age of each Person object in this table.
Note: You may need to set up data structures similar to the
This example is only for Solaris; other libraries and include paths might be needed for other platforms. In SQL*Plus, the Person object type can be created by:
CREATE OR REPLACE TYPE Person1_typ AS OBJECT ( Name VARCHAR2(30), B_date DATE, MEMBER FUNCTION calcAge_func RETURN NUMBER) );
Normally, the member function would be implemented in PL/SQL, but for this example, we make it an external procedure. To realize this, the body of the member function is declared as follows:
CREATE OR REPLACE TYPE BODY Person1_typ AS MEMBER FUNCTION calcAge_func RETURN NUMBER AS LANGUAGE C NAME "age" LIBRARY agelib WITH CONTEXT PARAMETERS ( CONTEXT, SELF, SELF INDICATOR STRUCT, SELF TDO, RETURN INDICATOR ); END;
Notice that the calcAge_func member function does not take any arguments, but only returns a number. A member function is always invoked on an instance of the associated object type. The object instance itself always is an implicit argument of the member function. To refer to the implicit argument, the SELF keyword is used. This is incorporated into the external procedure syntax by supporting references to SELF in the parameters clause. The matching table is created and populated.
CREATE TABLE Person_tab OF Person1_typ; INSERT INTO Person_tab VALUES ('SCOTT', TO_DATE('14-MAY-85')); INSERT INTO Person_tab VALUES ('TIGER', TO_DATE('22-DEC-71'));
8-30
The following is sample C code that implements the external member function and the Object-Type-Translator (OTT)-generated struct definitions:
#include <oci.h> struct PERSON { OCIString *NAME; OCIDate B_DATE; }; typedef struct PERSON PERSON; struct PERSON_ind { OCIInd _atomic; OCIInd NAME; OCIInd B_DATE; }; typedef struct PERSON_ind PERSON_ind; OCINumber *age (ctx, person_obj, person_obj_ind, tdo, ret_ind) OCIExtProcContext *ctx; PERSON *person_obj; PERSON_ind *person_obj_ind; OCIType *tdo; OCIInd *ret_ind; { sword err; text errbuf[512]; OCIEnv *envh; OCISvcCtx *svch; OCIError *errh; OCINumber *age; int inum = 0; sword status; /* get OCI Environment */ err = OCIExtProcGetEnv( ctx, &envh, &svch, &errh ); /* initialize return age to 0 */ age = (OCINumber *)OCIExtProcAllocCallMemory(ctx, sizeof(OCINumber)); status = OCINumberFromInt(errh, &inum, sizeof(inum), OCI_NUMBER_SIGNED, age); if (status != OCI_SUCCESS) {
OCIExtProcRaiseExcp(ctx, (int)1476); return (age); } /* return NULL if the person object is null or the birthdate is null */ if ( person_obj_ind->_atomic == OCI_IND_NULL || person_obj_ind->B_DATE == OCI_IND_NULL ) { *ret_ind = OCI_IND_NULL; return (age); } /* The actual implementation to calculate the age is left to the reader, but an easy way of doing this is a callback of the form: select trunc(months_between(sysdate, person_obj->b_date) / 12) from dual; */ *ret_ind = OCI_IND_NOTNULL; return (age); }
This is rather than the default, which would be used when there is no PARAMETERS clause:
void C_findRoot(float x);
8-32
WITH CONTEXT
By including the WITH CONTEXT clause, you can give an external procedure access to information about parameters, exceptions, memory allocation, and the user environment. The WITH CONTEXT clause specifies that a context pointer will be passed to the external procedure. For example, if you write the following PL/SQL function:
CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION getNum_func ( x IN REAL) RETURN BINARY_INTEGER AS LANGUAGE C LIBRARY c_utils NAME "C_getNum" WITH CONTEXT PARAMETERS ( CONTEXT, x BY REFERENCE, RETURN INDICATOR);
The context data structure is opaque to the external procedure; but, is available to service procedures called by the external procedure. If you also include the PARAMETERS clause, then you must specify the parameter CONTEXT, which shows the position of the context pointer in the parameter list. If you omit the PARAMETERS clause, then the context pointer is the first parameter passed to the external procedure.
Do not call an external procedure directly. Instead, use the CALL statement to call the PL/SQL subprogram that published the external procedure. See "CALL Statement Syntax". Such calls, which you code in the same manner as a call to a regular PL/SQL procedure or function, can appear in the following:
I I I I I
Anonymous blocks Standalone and packaged subprograms Methods of an object type Database triggers SQL statements (calls to packaged functions only).
Any PL/SQL block or subprogram executing on the server side, or on the client side, (for example, in a tool such as Oracle Forms) can call an external procedure. On the server side, the external procedure runs in a separate process address space, which safeguards your database. Figure 82 shows how Oracle Database and external procedures interact.
Figure 82 Oracle Database and External Procedures
Oracle Database Disk Storage Oracle Server Process Execution PL/SQL Interpreter PL/SQL Subprogram Java Method Java Virtual Machine SQL Engine External Process Execution DLL
External C Process
8-34
Managing Permissions
Note: You may need to set up the following data structures for
To call external procedures, a user must have the EXECUTE privilege on the call specification and on any resources used by the procedure. In SQL*Plus, you can use the GRANT and REVOKE data control statements to manage permissions. For example:
GRANT EXECUTE ON plsToJ_demoExternal_proc TO Public; REVOKE EXECUTE ON plsToJ_demoExternal_proc FROM Public; GRANT EXECUTE ON JAVA RESOURCE "appImages" TO Public; GRANT EXECUTE ON plsToJ_demoExternal_proc TO Scott; REVOKE EXECUTE ON plsToJ_demoExternal_proc FROM Scott;
DBA creates a public synonym, which is accessible to all users. If PUBLIC is not specified, then the synonym is private and accessible only within its schema.
CREATE PUBLIC SYNONYM Rfac FOR Scott.RecursiveFactorial;
This is essentially the same as executing a procedure foo() using a SQL statement of the form "SELECT foo(...) FROM dual," except that the overhead associated with performing the SELECT is not incurred. For example, here is an anonymous PL/SQL block that uses dynamic SQL to call plsToC_demoExternal_proc, which we published. PL/SQL passes three parameters to the external C procedure C_demoExternal_proc.
DECLARE xx NUMBER(4); yy VARCHAR2(10); zz DATE; BEGIN EXECUTE IMMEDIATE 'CALL plsToC_demoExternal_proc(:xxx, :yyy, :zzz)' USING xx,yy,zz; END;
The semantics of the CALL statement is identical to the that of an equivalent BEGIN..END block.
Note: CALL is the only SQL statement that cannot be put, by itself, in a PL/SQL BEGIN...END block. It can be part of an EXECUTE IMMEDIATE statement within a BEGIN...END block.
8-36
EXECUTE :x := 5;
Call J_calcFactorial:
CALL J_calcFactorial(:x) INTO :y; PRINT y
The result:
Y -----120
Although some DLL caching takes place, there is no guarantee that your DLL will remain in the cache; therefore, do not store global variables in your DLL.
After the external procedure completes, the agent remains active throughout your Oracle Database session; when you log off, the agent is killed. Consequently, you incur the cost of launching the agent only once, no matter how many calls you make. Still, you should call an external procedure only when the computational benefits outweigh the cost. Here, we call PL/SQL function plsCallsCdivisor_func, which we published previously, from an anonymous block. PL/SQL passes the two integer parameters to external function Cdivisor_func, which returns their greatest common divisor.
DECLARE g BINARY_INTEGER; a BINARY_INTEGER; b BINARY_INTEGER; CALL plsCallsCdivisor_func(a, b); IF g IN (2,4,8) THEN ...
C Exception Handling
C programs can raise exceptions through the OCIExtproc... functions.
OCIExtProcAllocCallMemory
This service routine allocates n bytes of memory for the duration of the external procedure call. Any memory allocated by the function is freed automatically as soon as control returns to PL/SQL.
8-38
Note: The external procedure does not need to (and should not)
call the C function free() to free memory allocated by this service routine as this is handled automatically. The C prototype for this function is as follows:
dvoid *OCIExtProcAllocCallMemory( OCIExtProcContext *with_context, size_t amount);
The parameters with_context and amount are the context pointer and number of bytes to allocate, respectively. The function returns an untyped pointer to the allocated memory. A return value of zero indicates failure. In SQL*Plus, suppose you publish external function plsToC_concat_func, as follows:
Note: You may need to set up data structures similar to the
CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION plsToC_concat_func ( str1 IN VARCHAR2, str2 IN VARCHAR2) RETURN VARCHAR2 AS LANGUAGE C NAME "concat" LIBRARY stringlib WITH CONTEXT PARAMETERS ( CONTEXT, str1 STRING, str1 INDICATOR short, str2 STRING, str2 INDICATOR short, RETURN INDICATOR short, RETURN LENGTH short,
RETURN STRING);
When called, C_concat concatenates two strings, then returns the result:
select plsToC_concat_func('hello ', 'world') from dual; PLSTOC_CONCAT_FUNC('HELLO','WORLD') ----------------------------------------------------------------------------hello world
If either string is NULL, the result is also NULL. As the following example shows, C_ concat uses OCIExtProcAllocCallMemory to allocate memory for the result string:
#include #include #include #include #include <stdio.h> <stdlib.h> <string.h> <oci.h> <ociextp.h>
char *concat(ctx, str1, str1_i, str2, str2_i, ret_i, ret_l) OCIExtProcContext *ctx; char *str1; short str1_i; char *str2; short str2_i; short *ret_i; short *ret_l; { char *tmp; short len; /* Check for null inputs. */ if ((str1_i == OCI_IND_NULL) || (str2_i == OCI_IND_NULL)) { *ret_i = (short)OCI_IND_NULL; /* PL/SQL has no notion of a NULL ptr, so return a zero-byte string. */ tmp = OCIExtProcAllocCallMemory(ctx, 1); tmp[0] = '\0'; return(tmp); } /* Allocate memory for result string, including NULL terminator. */ len = strlen(str1) + strlen(str2); tmp = OCIExtProcAllocCallMemory(ctx, len + 1); strcpy(tmp, str1); strcat(tmp, str2);
8-40
/* Set NULL indicator and length. */ *ret_i = (short)OCI_IND_NOTNULL; *ret_l = len; /* Return pointer, which PL/SQL frees later. */ return(tmp); } #ifdef LATER static void checkerr (/*_ OCIError *errhp, sword status _*/); void checkerr(errhp, status) OCIError *errhp; sword status; { text errbuf[512]; sb4 errcode = 0; switch (status) { case OCI_SUCCESS: break; case OCI_SUCCESS_WITH_INFO: (void) printf("Error - OCI_SUCCESS_WITH_INFO\n"); break; case OCI_NEED_DATA: (void) printf("Error - OCI_NEED_DATA\n"); break; case OCI_NO_DATA: (void) printf("Error - OCI_NODATA\n"); break; case OCI_ERROR: (void) OCIErrorGet((dvoid *)errhp, (ub4) 1, (text *) NULL, &errcode, errbuf, (ub4) sizeof(errbuf), OCI_HTYPE_ERROR); (void) printf("Error - %.*s\n", 512, errbuf); break; case OCI_INVALID_HANDLE: (void) printf("Error - OCI_INVALID_HANDLE\n"); break; case OCI_STILL_EXECUTING: (void) printf("Error - OCI_STILL_EXECUTE\n"); break; case OCI_CONTINUE: (void) printf("Error - OCI_CONTINUE\n"); break; default:
break; } } char *concat(ctx, str1, str1_i, str2, str2_i, ret_i, ret_l) OCIExtProcContext *ctx; char *str1; short str1_i; char *str2; short str2_i; short *ret_i; short *ret_l; { char *tmp; short len; /* Check for null inputs. */ if ((str1_i == OCI_IND_NULL) || (str2_i == OCI_IND_NULL)) { *ret_i = (short)OCI_IND_NULL; /* PL/SQL has no notion of a NULL ptr, so return a zero-byte string. */ tmp = OCIExtProcAllocCallMemory(ctx, 1); tmp[0] = '\0'; return(tmp); } /* Allocate memory for result string, including NULL terminator. */ len = strlen(str1) + strlen(str2); tmp = OCIExtProcAllocCallMemory(ctx, len + 1); strcpy(tmp, str1); strcat(tmp, str2); /* Set NULL indicator and length. */ *ret_i = (short)OCI_IND_NOTNULL; *ret_l = len; /* Return pointer, which PL/SQL frees later. */ return(tmp); } /*======================================================================*/ int main(char *argv, int argc) { OCIExtProcContext *ctx; char *str1; short str1_i; char *str2;
8-42
short str2_i; short *ret_i; short *ret_l; /* OCI Handles */ OCIEnv *envhp; OCIServer *srvhp; OCISvcCtx *svchp; OCIError *errhp; OCISession *authp; OCIStmt *stmthp; OCILobLocator *clob, *blob; OCILobLocator *Lob_loc; /* Initialize and Logon */ (void) OCIInitialize((ub4) OCI_DEFAULT, (dvoid * (*)(dvoid (dvoid * (*)(dvoid (void (*)(dvoid *,
(void) OCIEnvInit( (OCIEnv **) &envhp, OCI_DEFAULT, (size_t) 0, (dvoid **) 0 ); (void) OCIHandleAlloc( (dvoid *) envhp, (dvoid **) &errhp, OCI_HTYPE_ERROR, (size_t) 0, (dvoid **) 0); /* Server contexts */ (void) OCIHandleAlloc( (dvoid *) envhp, (dvoid **) &srvhp, OCI_HTYPE_SERVER, (size_t) 0, (dvoid **) 0); /* Service context */ (void) OCIHandleAlloc( (dvoid *) envhp, (dvoid **) &svchp, OCI_HTYPE_SVCCTX, (size_t) 0, (dvoid **) 0); /* Attach to Oracle Database */ (void) OCIServerAttach( srvhp, errhp, (text *)"", strlen(""), 0); /* Set attribute server context in the service context */ (void) OCIAttrSet ((dvoid *) svchp, OCI_HTYPE_SVCCTX, (dvoid *)srvhp, (ub4) 0, OCI_ATTR_SERVER, (OCIError *) errhp); (void) OCIHandleAlloc((dvoid *) envhp, (dvoid **)&authp, (ub4) OCI_HTYPE_SESSION, (size_t) 0, (dvoid **) 0);
(void) OCIAttrSet((dvoid *) authp, (ub4) OCI_HTYPE_SESSION, (dvoid *) "samp", (ub4)4, (ub4) OCI_ATTR_USERNAME, errhp); (void) OCIAttrSet((dvoid *) authp, (ub4) OCI_HTYPE_SESSION, (dvoid *) "samp", (ub4) 4, (ub4) OCI_ATTR_PASSWORD, errhp); /* Begin a User Session */ checkerr(errhp, OCISessionBegin ( svchp, errhp, authp, OCI_CRED_RDBMS, (ub4) OCI_DEFAULT)); (void) OCIAttrSet((dvoid *) svchp, (ub4) OCI_HTYPE_SVCCTX, (dvoid *) authp, (ub4) 0, (ub4) OCI_ATTR_SESSION, errhp); /* -----------------------User Logged In------------------------------*/ printf ("user logged in \n"); /* allocate a statement handle */ checkerr(errhp, OCIHandleAlloc( (dvoid *) envhp, (dvoid **) &stmthp, OCI_HTYPE_STMT, (size_t) 0, (dvoid **) 0)); checkerr(errhp, OCIDescriptorAlloc((dvoid *)envhp, (dvoid **) &Lob_loc, (ub4) OCI_DTYPE_LOB, (size_t) 0, (dvoid **) 0)); /* ------- subroutine called here-----------------------*/ printf ("calling concat...\n"); concat(ctx, str1, str1_i, str2, str2_i, ret_i, ret_l); return 0; } #endif
OCIExtProcRaiseExcp
This service routine raises a predefined exception, which must have a valid Oracle Database error number in the range 1..32767. After doing any necessary cleanup, your external procedure must return immediately. (No values are assigned to OUT or IN OUT parameters.) The C prototype for this function follows:
int OCIExtProcRaiseExcp(
8-44
The parameters with_context and error_number are the context pointer and Oracle Database error number. The return values OCIEXTPROC_SUCCESS and OCIEXTPROC_ERROR indicate success or failure. In SQL*Plus, suppose you publish external procedure plsTo_divide_proc, as follows:
CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE plsTo_divide_proc ( dividend IN BINARY_INTEGER, divisor IN BINARY_INTEGER, result OUT FLOAT) AS LANGUAGE C NAME "C_divide" LIBRARY MathLib WITH CONTEXT PARAMETERS ( CONTEXT, dividend INT, divisor INT, result FLOAT);
When called, C_divide finds the quotient of two numbers. As the following example shows, if the divisor is zero, C_divide uses OCIExtProcRaiseExcp to raise the predefined exception ZERO_DIVIDE:
void C_divide (ctx, dividend, divisor, result) OCIExtProcContext *ctx; int dividend; int divisor; float *result; { /* Check for zero divisor. */ if (divisor == (int)0) { /* Raise exception ZERO_DIVIDE, which is Oracle error 1476. */ if (OCIExtProcRaiseExcp(ctx, (int)1476) == OCIEXTPROC_SUCCESS) { return; } else { /* Incorrect parameters were passed. */
OCIExtProcRaiseExcpWithMsg
This service routine raises a user-defined exception and returns a user-defined error message. The C prototype for this function follows:
int OCIExtProcRaiseExcpWithMsg( OCIExtProcContext *with_context, size_t error_number, text *error_message, size_t len);
The parameters with_context, error_number, and error_message are the context pointer, Oracle Database error number, and error message text. The parameter len stores the length of the error message. If the message is a null-terminated string, then len is zero. The return values OCIEXTPROC_SUCCESS and OCIEXTPROC_ERROR indicate success or failure. In the previous example, we published external procedure plsTo_divide_proc. In the following example, you use a different implementation. With this version, if the divisor is zero, then C_divide uses OCIExtProcRaiseExcpWithMsg to raise a user-defined exception:
void C_divide (ctx, dividend, divisor, result) OCIExtProcContext *ctx; int dividend; int divisor; float *result; /* Check for zero divisor. */ if (divisor == (int)0) { /* Raise a user-defined exception, which is Oracle error 20100, and return a null-terminated error message. */ if (OCIExtProcRaiseExcpWithMsg(ctx, (int)20100, "divisor is zero", 0) == OCIEXTPROC_SUCCESS) { return; } else { /* Incorrect parameters were passed. */
8-46
The parameter with_context is the context pointer, and the parameters envh, svch, and errh are the OCI environment, service, and error handles, respectively. The return values OCIEXTPROC_SUCCESS and OCIEXTPROC_ERROR indicate success or failure. Both external C procedures and Java class methods can call-back to the database to do SQL operations. For a working example, see "Demo Program" on page 8-51.
Note: Callbacks are not necessarily a same-session phenomenon; you
may execute an SQL statement in a different session through OCIlogon. An external C procedure executing on Oracle Database can call a service routine to obtain OCI environment and service handles. With the OCI, you can use callbacks to execute SQL statements and PL/SQL subprograms, fetch data, and manipulate LOBs. Callbacks and external procedures operate in the same user session and transaction context, and so have the same user privileges. In SQL*Plus, suppose you run the following script:
CREATE TABLE Emp_tab (empno NUMBER(10)) CREATE PROCEDURE plsToC_insertIntoEmpTab_proc ( empno BINARY_INTEGER) AS LANGUAGE C NAME "C_insertEmpTab" LIBRARY insert_lib WITH CONTEXT PARAMETERS ( CONTEXT, empno LONG);
Later, you might call service routine OCIExtProcGetEnv from external procedure plsToC_insertIntoEmpTab_proc, as follows:
#include <stdio.h> #include <stdlib.h> #include <oratypes.h> #include <oci.h> /* includes ociextp.h */ ... void C_insertIntoEmpTab (ctx, empno) OCIExtProcContext *ctx; long empno; { OCIEnv *envhp; OCISvcCtx *svchp; OCIError *errhp; int err; ... err = OCIExtProcGetEnv(ctx, &envhp, &svchp, &errhp); ... }
If you do not use callbacks, you do not need to include oci.h; instead, just include ociextp.h.
8-48
structs for the appropriate object types, and then use conventional C code to access the object attributes. For those objects whose types are unknown at external procedure creation time, an alternative, dynamic, way of accessing objects is first to invoke OCIDescribeAny() to obtain attribute and method information about the type. Then, OCIObjectGetAttr() and OCIObjectSetAttr() can be called to retrieve and set attribute values. Because the current external procedure model is stateless, OCIExtProcGetEnv() must be called in every external procedure that wants to execute callbacks, or invoke OCIExtProc...() service routines. After every external procedure invocation, the callback mechanism is cleaned up and all OCI handles are freed.
Restrictions on Callbacks
With callbacks, the following SQL commands and OCI procedures are not supported:
I I I
Transaction control commands such as COMMIT Data definition commands such as CREATE The following object-oriented OCI procedures:
OCIObjectNew OCIObjectPin OCIObjectUnpin OCIObjectPinCountReset OCIObjectLock OCIObjectMarkUpdate OCIObjectUnmark OCIObjectUnmarkByRef OCIObjectAlwaysLatest OCIObjectNotAlwaysLatest OCIObjectMarkDeleteByRef OCIObjectMarkDelete OCIObjectFlush OCIObjectFlushRefresh OCIObjectGetTypeRef OCIObjectGetObjectRef OCIObjectExists OCIObjectIsLocked OCIObjectIsDirtied OCIObjectIsLoaded OCIObjectRefresh
OCIObjectPinTable OCIObjectArrayPin OCICacheFlush, OCICacheFlushRefresh, OCICacheRefresh OCICacheUnpin OCICacheFree OCICacheUnmark OCICacheGetObjects OCICacheRegister
I I
Also, with OCI procedure OCIHandleAlloc, the following handle types are not supported:
OCI_HTYPE_SERVER OCI_HTYPE_SESSION OCI_HTYPE_SVCCTX OCI_HTYPE_TRANS
8-50
This error, which means that agent extproc terminated abnormally because the external procedure caused a core dump. To avoid errors when declaring C prototype parameters, refer to the preceding tables.
Demo Program
Also in the PL/SQL demo directory is the script extproc.sql, which demonstrates the calling of an external procedure. The companion file extproc.c contains the C source code for the external procedure. To run the demo, follow the instructions in extproc.sql. You must use the SCOTT/TIGER account, which must have CREATE LIBRARY privileges.
Threading: In the non-threaded configuration of the agent process, there is only one function active at a time. However, in the case of multithreaded agents, multiple functions can be active at the same time. In that case, it is possible that
two or more functions would try to access the global variable concurrently, with unsuccessful results.
I
DLL caching: Global variables are also used to store data that is intended to persist beyond the lifetime of a function. For example, consider two functions func1() and func2() trying to pass data to each other. Because of the DLL caching feature, it is possible that after func1()'s completion, the DLL will be unloaded, which results in all global variables losing their values. When func2() is executed, the DLL is reloaded, and all globals are initialized to 0, which will be inconsistent with their values at the completion of func1().
/public for help creating a dynamic link library Guidelines for Call Specifications and CALL Statements When calling external procedures:
I
Never write to IN parameters or overflow the capacity of OUT parameters. (PL/SQL does no run time checks for these error conditions.) Never read an OUT parameter or a function result. Always assign a value to IN OUT and OUT parameters and to function results. Otherwise, your external procedure will not return successfully. If you include the WITH CONTEXT and PARAMETERS clauses, then you must specify the parameter CONTEXT, which shows the position of the context pointer in the parameter list. If you include the PARAMETERS clause, and if the external procedure is a function, then you must specify the parameter RETURN in the last position.
I I
8-52
For every formal parameter, there must be a corresponding parameter in the PARAMETERS clause. Also, make sure that the datatypes of parameters in the PARAMETERS clause are compatible with those in the C prototype, because no implicit conversions are done. With a parameter of type RAW or LONG RAW, you must use the property LENGTH. Also, if that parameter is IN OUT or OUT and null, then you must set the length of the corresponding C parameter to zero.
This feature is available only on platforms that support DLLs. Only C procedures and procedures callable from C code are supported. You cannot pass PL/SQL cursor variables or records to an external procedure. For records, use instances of object types instead. In the LIBRARY subclause, you cannot use a database link to specify a remote library. The maximum number of parameters that you can pass to a external procedure is 128. However, if you pass float or double parameters by value, then the maximum is less than 128. How much less depends on the number of such parameters and your operating system. To get a rough estimate, count each float or double passed by value as two parameters.
8-54
Part III
The Active Database
To take advantage of the reliability and performance of the database server, and to reuse program logic across all the applications in a database, you can move some of your program logic into the database itself, so that the database does cleanup operations and responds to events without the need for a separate application. This part contains the following chapters:
I I I
Chapter 9, "Using Triggers" Chapter 10, "Working With System Events" Chapter 11, "Using the Publish-Subscribe Model for Applications"
9
Using Triggers
Triggers are procedures that are stored in the database and implicitly run, or fired, when something happens. Traditionally, triggers supported the execution of a PL/SQL block when an INSERT, UPDATE, or DELETE occurred on a table or view. Starting with Oracle8i, triggers support system and other data events on DATABASE and SCHEMA. Oracle Database also supports the execution of a PL/SQL or Java procedure. This chapter discusses DML triggers, INSTEAD OF triggers, and system triggers (triggers on DATABASE and SCHEMA). Topics include:
I I I I I I I I I
Designing Triggers Creating Triggers Coding the Trigger Body Compiling Triggers Modifying Triggers Enabling and Disabling Triggers Viewing Information About Triggers Examples of Trigger Applications Responding to System Events through Triggers
Using Triggers
9-1
Designing Triggers
Designing Triggers
Use the following guidelines when designing your triggers:
I
Use triggers to guarantee that when a specific operation is performed, related actions are performed. Do not define triggers that duplicate features already built into Oracle Database. For example, do not define triggers to reject bad data if you can do the same checking through declarative integrity constraints. Limit the size of triggers. If the logic for your trigger requires much more than 60 lines of PL/SQL code, it is better to include most of the code in a stored procedure and call the procedure from the trigger. Use triggers only for centralized, global operations that should be fired for the triggering statement, regardless of which user or database application issues the statement. Do not create recursive triggers. For example, creating an AFTER UPDATE statement trigger on the Emp_tab table that itself issues an UPDATE statement on Emp_tab, causes the trigger to fire recursively until it has run out of memory. Use triggers on DATABASE judiciously. They are executed for every user every time the event occurs on which the trigger is created.
Creating Triggers
Triggers are created using the CREATE TRIGGER statement. This statement can be used with any interactive tool, such as SQL*Plus or Enterprise Manager. When using an interactive tool, a single slash (/) on the last line is necessary to activate the CREATE TRIGGER statement. The following statement creates a trigger for the Emp_tab table.
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Print_salary_changes BEFORE DELETE OR INSERT OR UPDATE ON Emp_tab FOR EACH ROW WHEN (new.Empno > 0) DECLARE sal_diff number; BEGIN sal_diff := :new.sal - :old.sal; dbms_output.put('Old salary: ' || :old.sal); dbms_output.put(' New salary: ' || :new.sal);
9-2
Creating Triggers
dbms_output.put_line(' END; /
The trigger is fired when DML operations (INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE statements) are performed on the table. You can choose what combination of operations should fire the trigger. Because the trigger uses the BEFORE keyword, it can access the new values before they go into the table, and can change the values if there is an easily-corrected error by assigning to :NEW.column_name. You might use the AFTER keyword if you want the trigger to query or change the same table, because triggers can only do that after the initial changes are applied and the table is back in a consistent state. Because the trigger uses the FOR EACH ROW clause, it might be executed multiple times, such as when updating or deleting multiple rows. You might omit this clause if you just want to record the fact that the operation occurred, but not examine the data for each row. Once the trigger is created, entering the following SQL statement:
UPDATE Emp_tab SET sal = sal + 500.00 WHERE deptno = 10;
fires the trigger once for each row that is updated, in each case printing the new salary, old salary, and the difference. The CREATE (or CREATE OR REPLACE) statement fails if any errors exist in the PL/SQL block.
Note: The size of the trigger cannot be more than 32K.
The following sections use this example to illustrate the way that parts of a trigger are specified.
See Also: "Examples of Trigger Applications" on page 9-31 for more realistic examples of CREATE TRIGGER statements
Types of Triggers
A trigger is either a stored PL/SQL block or a PL/SQL, C, or Java procedure associated with a table, view, schema, or the database itself. Oracle Database automatically executes a trigger when a specified event takes place, which may be in the form of a system event or a DML statement being issued against the table.
Using Triggers
9-3
Creating Triggers
DML triggers on tables. INSTEAD OF triggers on views. System triggers on DATABASE or SCHEMA: With DATABASE, triggers fire for each event for all users; with SCHEMA, triggers fire for each event for that specific user.
See Also: Oracle Database SQL Reference for information on trigger creation syntax
DML statements (DELETE, INSERT, UPDATE) DDL statements (CREATE, ALTER, DROP) Database operations (SERVERERROR, LOGON, LOGOFF, STARTUP, SHUTDOWN)
Creating a trigger on DATABASE implies that the triggering event is outside the scope of a user (for example, database STARTUP and SHUTDOWN), and it applies to all users (for example, a trigger created on LOGON event by the DBA). Creating a trigger on SCHEMA implies that the trigger is created in the current user's schema and is fired only for that user. For each trigger, publication can be specified on DML and system events.
See Also: "Responding to System Events through Triggers" on page 9-50
Naming Triggers
Trigger names must be unique with respect to other triggers in the same schema. Trigger names do not need to be unique with respect to other schema objects, such
9-4
Creating Triggers
as tables, views, and procedures. For example, a table and a trigger can have the same name (however, to avoid confusion, this is not recommended).
The SQL statement or the system event, database event, or DDL event that fires the trigger body. The options include DELETE, INSERT, and UPDATE. One, two, or all three of these options can be included in the triggering statement specification. The table, view, DATABASE, or SCHEMA associated with the trigger.
Note: Exactly one table or view can be specified in the triggering
statement. If the INSTEAD OF option is used, then the triggering statement may only specify a view; conversely, if a view is specified in the triggering statement, then only the INSTEAD OF option may be used. For example, the PRINT_SALARY_CHANGES trigger fires after any DELETE, INSERT, or UPDATE on the Emp_tab table. Any of the following statements trigger the PRINT_SALARY_CHANGES trigger given in the previous example:
DELETE INSERT INSERT UPDATE FROM Emp_tab; INTO Emp_tab VALUES ( ... ); INTO Emp_tab SELECT ... FROM ... ; Emp_tab SET ... ;
If IGNORE=N (default) and the table already exists, then import does not change the table and no existing triggers fire. If the table does not exist, then import creates and loads it before any triggers are defined, so again no triggers fire.
Using Triggers
9-5
Creating Triggers
If IGNORE=Y, then import loads rows into existing tables. Any existing triggers fire, and indexes are updated to account for the imported data.
Notes:
I I
You cannot specify a column list for UPDATE with INSTEAD OF triggers. If the column specified in the UPDATE OF clause is an object column, then the trigger is also fired if any of the attributes of the object are modified. You cannot specify UPDATE OF clauses on collection columns.
Use BEFORE row triggers to modify the row before the row data is written to disk. Use AFTER row triggers to obtain, and perform operations, using the row ID.
9-6
Creating Triggers
Note: BEFORE row triggers are slightly more efficient than AFTER
row triggers. With AFTER row triggers, affected data blocks must be read (logical read, not physical read) once for the trigger and then again for the triggering statement. Alternatively, with BEFORE row triggers, the data blocks must be read only once for both the triggering statement and the trigger.
Ordering of Triggers
A relational database does not guarantee the order of rows processed by a SQL statement. Therefore, do not create triggers that depend on the order in which rows are processed. For example, do not assign a value to a global package variable in a row trigger if the current value of the global variable is dependent on the row being processed by the row trigger. Also, if global package variables are updated within a trigger, then it is best to initialize those variables in a BEFORE statement trigger. When a statement in a trigger body causes another trigger to be fired, the triggers are said to be cascading. Oracle Database allows up to 32 triggers to cascade at any one time. However, you can effectively limit the number of trigger cascades using the initialization parameter OPEN_CURSORS, because a cursor must be opened for every execution of a trigger.
Using Triggers
9-7
Creating Triggers
firing order of triggers Each subsequent trigger sees the changes made by the previously fired triggers. Each trigger can see the old and new values. The old values are the original values, and the new values are the current values, as set by the most recently fired UPDATE or INSERT trigger. To ensure that multiple triggered actions occur in a specific order, you must consolidate these actions into a single trigger (for example, by having the trigger call a series of procedures).
9-8
Creating Triggers
Note:
I
The INSTEAD OF option can only be used for triggers created over views. The BEFORE and AFTER options cannot be used for triggers created over views. The CHECK option for views is not enforced when inserts or updates to the view are done using INSTEAD OF triggers. The INSTEAD OF trigger body must enforce the check.
A set operator A DISTINCT operator An aggregate or analytic function A GROUP BY, ORDER BY, MODEL, CONNECT BY, or START WITH clause A collection expression in a SELECT list A subquery in a SELECT list A subquery designated WITH READ ONLY Joins, with some exceptions, as documented in Oracle Database Administrator's Guide
If a view contains pseudocolumns or expressions, then you can only update the view with an UPDATE statement that does not refer to any of the pseudocolumns or expressions.
Using Triggers
9-9
Creating Triggers
The following example shows an INSTEAD OF trigger for inserting rows into the MANAGER_INFO view.
CREATE OR REPLACE VIEW manager_info AS SELECT e.ename, e.empno, d.dept_type, d.deptno, p.prj_level, p.projno FROM Emp_tab e, Dept_tab d, Project_tab p WHERE e.empno = d.mgr_no AND d.deptno = p.resp_dept; CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER manager_info_insert INSTEAD OF INSERT ON manager_info REFERENCING NEW AS n -- new manager information FOR EACH ROW DECLARE rowcnt number; BEGIN
9-10
Creating Triggers
SELECT COUNT(*) INTO rowcnt FROM Emp_tab WHERE empno = :n.empno; IF rowcnt = 0 THEN INSERT INTO Emp_tab (empno,ename) VALUES (:n.empno, :n.ename); ELSE UPDATE Emp_tab SET Emp_tab.ename = :n.ename WHERE Emp_tab.empno = :n.empno; END IF; SELECT COUNT(*) INTO rowcnt FROM Dept_tab WHERE deptno = :n.deptno; IF rowcnt = 0 THEN INSERT INTO Dept_tab (deptno, dept_type) VALUES(:n.deptno, :n.dept_type); ELSE UPDATE Dept_tab SET Dept_tab.dept_type = :n.dept_type WHERE Dept_tab.deptno = :n.deptno; END IF; SELECT COUNT(*) INTO rowcnt FROM Project_tab WHERE Project_tab.projno = :n.projno; IF rowcnt = 0 THEN INSERT INTO Project_tab (projno, prj_level) VALUES(:n.projno, :n.prj_level); ELSE UPDATE Project_tab SET Project_tab.prj_level = :n.prj_level WHERE Project_tab.projno = :n.projno; END IF; END;
The actions shown for rows being inserted into the MANAGER_INFO view first test to see if appropriate rows already exist in the base tables from which MANAGER_INFO is derived. The actions then insert new rows or update existing rows, as appropriate. Similar triggers can specify appropriate actions for UPDATE and DELETE.
To modify an object materialized by an object view in the client-side object cache and flush it back to the persistent store, you must specify INSTEAD OF triggers, unless the object view is modifiable. If the object is read only, then it is not necessary to define triggers to pin it.
Creating Triggers
Can only be defined over nested table columns in views. Fire only when the nested table elements are modified using the THE() or TABLE() clauses. They do not fire when a DML statement is performed on the view.
For example, consider a department view that contains a nested table of employees.
CREATE OR REPLACE VIEW Dept_view AS SELECT d.Deptno, d.Dept_type, d.Dept_name, CAST (MULTISET ( SELECT e.Empno, e.Empname, e.Salary) FROM Emp_tab e WHERE e.Deptno = d.Deptno) AS Amp_list_ Emplist FROM Dept_tab d;
The CAST (MULTISET..) operator creates a multi-set of employees for each department. If you want to modify the emplist column, which is the nested table of employees, then you can define an INSTEAD OF trigger over the column to handle the operation. The following example shows how an insert trigger might be written:
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Dept_emplist_tr INSTEAD OF INSERT ON NESTED TABLE Emplist OF Dept_view REFERENCING NEW AS Employee PARENT AS Department FOR EACH ROW BEGIN -- The insert on the nested table is translated to an insert on the base table: INSERT INTO Emp_tab VALUES ( :Employee.Empno, :Employee.Empname,:Employee.Salary, :Department.Deptno); END;
9-12
Creating Triggers
Any INSERT into the nested table fires the trigger, and the Emp_tab table is filled with the correct values. For example:
INSERT INTO TABLE (SELECT d.Emplist FROM Dept_view d WHERE Deptno = 10) VALUES (1001, 'John Glenn', 10000);
The :department.deptno correlation variable in this example would have a value of 10.
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Log_salary_increase AFTER UPDATE ON Emp_tab FOR EACH ROW WHEN (new.Sal > 1000) BEGIN INSERT INTO Emp_log (Emp_id, Log_date, New_salary, Action) VALUES (:new.Empno, SYSDATE, :new.SAL, 'NEW SAL'); END;
Creating Triggers
If there are five employees in department 20, then the trigger fires five times when this statement is entered, because five rows are affected. The following trigger fires only once for each UPDATE of the Emp_tab table:
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Log_emp_update AFTER UPDATE ON Emp_tab BEGIN INSERT INTO Emp_log (Log_date, Action) VALUES (SYSDATE, 'Emp_tab COMMISSIONS CHANGED'); END;
See Also: Oracle Database Concepts for the order of trigger firing
The statement level triggers are useful for performing validation checks for the entire statement.
If included, then the expression in the WHEN clause is evaluated for each row that the trigger affects. If the expression evaluates to TRUE for a row, then the trigger body is fired on behalf of that row. However, if the expression evaluates to FALSE or NOT TRUE for a row (unknown, as with nulls), then the trigger body is not fired for that row. The evaluation of the WHEN clause does not have an effect on the execution of the triggering SQL statement (in other words, the triggering statement is not rolled back if the expression in a WHEN clause evaluates to FALSE). For example, in the PRINT_SALARY_CHANGES trigger, the trigger body is not run if the new value of Empno is zero, NULL, or negative. In more realistic examples, you might test if one column value is less than another. The expression in a WHEN clause of a row trigger can include correlation names, which are explained later. The expression in a WHEN clause must be a SQL expression, and it cannot include a subquery. You cannot use a PL/SQL expression (including user-defined functions) in the WHEN clause.
9-14
Note: You cannot specify the WHEN clause for INSTEAD OF triggers.
predicates cannot be used for the CALL procedures; they can only be used in a PL/SQL block. Example: Monitoring Logons with a Trigger
Note: You may need to set up data structures similar to the
CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE foo (c VARCHAR2) AS BEGIN INSERT INTO Audit_table (user_at) VALUES(c);
END; CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER logontrig AFTER LOGON ON DATABASE -- Just call an existing procedure. The ORA_LOGIN_USER is a function -- that returns information about the event that fired the trigger. CALL foo (ora_login_user) /
Example: Calling a Java Procedure from a Trigger Although triggers are declared using PL/SQL, they can call procedures in other languages, such as Java:
CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE Before_delete (Id IN NUMBER, Ename VARCHAR2) IS language Java name 'thjvTriggers.beforeDelete (oracle.sql.NUMBER, oracle.sql.CHAR)'; CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Pre_del_trigger BEFORE DELETE ON Tab FOR EACH ROW CALL Before_delete (:old.Id, :old.Ename) /
9-16
A trigger fired by an INSERT statement has meaningful access to new column values only. Because the row is being created by the INSERT, the old values are null. A trigger fired by an UPDATE statement has access to both old and new column values for both BEFORE and AFTER row triggers. A trigger fired by a DELETE statement has meaningful access to :old column values only. Because the row no longer exists after the row is deleted, the :new values are NULL. However, you cannot modify :new values: ORA-4084 is raised if you try to modify :new values.
The new column values are referenced using the new qualifier before the column name, while the old column values are referenced using the old qualifier before the column name. For example, if the triggering statement is associated with the Emp_ tab table (with the columns SAL, COMM, and so on), then you can include statements in the trigger body. For example:
IF :new.Sal > 10000 ... IF :new.Sal < :old.Sal ...
Old and new values are available in both BEFORE and AFTER row triggers. A new column value can be assigned in a BEFORE row trigger, but not in an AFTER row trigger (because the triggering statement takes effect before an AFTER row trigger is fired). If a BEFORE row trigger changes the value of new.column, then an AFTER row trigger fired by the same statement sees the change assigned by the BEFORE row trigger. Correlation names can also be used in the Boolean expression of a WHEN clause. A colon (:) must precede the old and new qualifiers when they are used in a trigger body, but a colon is not allowed when using the qualifiers in the WHEN clause or the REFERENCING option.
9-18
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Print_salary_changes BEFORE UPDATE ON new REFERENCING new AS Newest FOR EACH ROW BEGIN :Newest.Field2 := TO_CHAR (:newest.field1); END;
Notice that the new qualifier is renamed to newest using the REFERENCING option, and it is then used in the trigger body.
The first condition evaluates to TRUE only if the statement that fired the trigger is an INSERT statement; the second condition evaluates to TRUE only if the statement that fired the trigger is an UPDATE statement. In an UPDATE trigger, a column name can be specified with an UPDATING conditional predicate to determine if the named column is being updated. For example, assume a trigger is defined as the following:
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER ... ... UPDATE OF Sal, Comm ON Emp_tab ... BEGIN ... IF UPDATING ('SAL') THEN ... END IF; END;
The code in the THEN clause runs only if the triggering UPDATE statement updates the SAL column. This way, the trigger can minimize its overhead when the column of interest is not being changed.
9-20
A trigger is compiled when it is created. Thus, if a remote site is unavailable when the trigger must compile, then Oracle Database cannot validate the statement accessing the remote database, and the compilation fails. The previous example exception statement cannot run, because the trigger does not complete compilation. Because stored procedures are stored in a compiled form, the work-around for the previous example is as follows:
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Example AFTER INSERT ON Emp_tab FOR EACH ROW BEGIN Insert_row_proc; END; CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE Insert_row_proc AS BEGIN INSERT INTO Emp_tab@Remote VALUES ('x'); EXCEPTION WHEN OTHERS THEN INSERT INTO Emp_log VALUES ('x'); END;
The trigger in this example compiles successfully and calls the stored procedure, which already has a validated statement for accessing the remote database; thus, when the remote INSERT statement fails because the link is down, the exception is caught.
transaction control statements, because the procedure runs within the context of the trigger body. Statements inside a trigger can reference remote schema objects. However, pay special attention when calling remote procedures from within a local trigger. If a timestamp or signature mismatch is found during execution of the trigger, then the remote procedure is not run, and the trigger is invalidated.
A SQL statement within a trigger can insert data into a column of LONG or LONG RAW datatype. If data from a LONG or LONG RAW column can be converted to a constrained datatype (such as CHAR and VARCHAR2), then a LONG or LONG RAW column can be referenced in a SQL statement within a trigger. The maximum length for these datatypes is 32000 bytes. Variables cannot be declared using the LONG or LONG RAW datatypes. :NEW and :PARENT cannot be used with LONG or LONG RAW columns.
I I
9-22
This restriction applies to all triggers that use the FOR EACH ROW clause. Views being modified in INSTEAD OF triggers are not considered mutating. When a trigger encounters a mutating table, a runtime error occurs, the effects of the trigger body and triggering statement are rolled back, and control is returned to the user or application. Consider the following trigger:
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Emp_count AFTER DELETE ON Emp_tab FOR EACH ROW DECLARE n INTEGER; BEGIN SELECT COUNT(*) INTO n FROM Emp_tab; DBMS_OUTPUT.PUT_LINE(' There are now ' || n || ' employees.'); END;
An error is returned because the table is mutating when the row is deleted:
ORA-04091: table SCOTT.Emp_tab is mutating, trigger/function may not see it
If you delete the line "FOR EACH ROW" from the trigger, it becomes a statement trigger which is not subject to this restriction, and the trigger. If you need to update a mutating table, you could bypass these restrictions by using a temporary table, a PL/SQL table, or a package variable. For example, in place of a single AFTER row trigger that updates the original table, resulting in a mutating table error, you might use two triggersan AFTER row trigger that updates a temporary table, and an AFTER statement trigger that updates the original table with the values from the temporary table. Declarative integrity constraints are checked at various times with respect to row triggers.
See Also: Oracle Database Concepts for information about the interaction of triggers and integrity constraints
Because declarative referential integrity constraints are not supported between tables on different nodes of a distributed database, the mutating table restrictions
do not apply to triggers that access remote nodes. These restrictions are also not enforced among tables in the same database that are connected by loop-back database links. A loop-back database link makes a local table appear remote by defining an Oracle Net path back to the database that contains the link. Restrictions on Mutating Tables Relaxed The mutating error, discussed earlier in this section, still prevents the trigger from reading or modifying the table that the parent statement is modifying. However, starting in Oracle Database release 8.1, a delete against the parent table causes before/after statement triggers to be fired once. That way, you can create triggers (just not row triggers) to read and modify the parent and child tables. This allows most foreign key constraint actions to be implemented through their obvious after-row trigger, providing the constraint is not self-referential. Update cascade, update set null, update set default, delete set default, inserting a missing parent, and maintaining a count of children can all be implemented easily. For example, this is an implementation of update cascade:
create table p create table f create trigger update f set end; / (p1 number constraint ppk primary key); (f1 number constraint ffk references p); pt after update on p for each row begin f1 = :new.p1 where f1 = :old.p1;
This implementation requires care for multirow updates. For example, if a table p has three rows with the values (1), (2), (3), and table f also has three rows with the values (1), (2), (3), then the following statement updates p correctly but causes problems when the trigger updates f:
update p set p1 = p1+1;
The statement first updates (1) to (2) in p, and the trigger updates (1) to (2) in f, leaving two rows of value (2) in f. Then the statement updates (2) to (3) in p, and the trigger updates both rows of value (2) to (3) in f. Finally, the statement updates (3) to (4) in p, and the trigger updates all three rows in f from (3) to (4). The relationship of the data in p and f is lost. To avoid this problem, you must forbid multirow updates to p that change the primary key and reuse existing primary key values. It could also be solved by tracking which foreign key values have already been updated, then modifying the trigger so that no row is updated twice.
9-24
That is the only problem with this technique for foreign key updates. The trigger cannot miss rows that have been changed but not committed by another transaction, because the foreign key constraint guarantees that no matching foreign key rows are locked before the after-row trigger is called.
Then, trigger foo is not fired after the creation of foo. Oracle Database does not fire a trigger that is not committed. Foreign Function Callouts All restrictions on foreign function callouts also apply.
Compiling Triggers
Own the table specified in the triggering statement, or Have the ALTER privilege for the table in the triggering statement, or Have the ALTER ANY TABLE system privilege
To create a trigger in another user's schema, or to reference a table in another schema from a trigger in your schema, you must have the CREATE ANY TRIGGER system privilege. With this privilege, the trigger can be created in any schema and can be associated with any user's table. In addition, the user creating the trigger must also have EXECUTE privilege on the referenced procedures, functions, or packages. To create a trigger on DATABASE, you must have the ADMINISTER DATABASE TRIGGER privilege. If this privilege is later revoked, then you can drop the trigger, but not alter it. The object privileges to the schema objects referenced in the trigger body must be granted to the trigger owner explicitly (not through a role). The statements in the trigger body operate under the privilege domain of the trigger owner, not the privilege domain of the user issuing the triggering statement. This is similar to the privilege model for stored procedures.
Compiling Triggers
Triggers are similar to PL/SQL anonymous blocks with the addition of the :new and :old capabilities, but their compilation is different. A PL/SQL anonymous block is compiled each time it is loaded into memory. Compilation involves three stages:
1. 2. 3.
Syntax checking: PL/SQL syntax is checked, and a parse tree is generated. Semantic checking: Type checking and further processing on the parse tree. Code generation: The pcode is generated.
Triggers, in contrast, are fully compiled when the CREATE TRIGGER statement is entered, and the pcode is stored in the data dictionary. Hence, firing the trigger no longer requires the opening of a shared cursor to run the trigger action. Instead, the trigger is executed directly. If errors occur during the compilation of a trigger, then the trigger is still created. If a DML statement fires this trigger, then the DML statement fails. (Runtime that
9-26
Compiling Triggers
trigger errors always cause the DML statement to fail.) You can use the SHOW ERRORS statement in SQL*Plus or Enterprise Manager to see any compilation errors when you create a trigger, or you can SELECT the errors from the USER_ERRORS view.
Triggers may depend on other functions or packages. If the function or package specified in the trigger is dropped, then the trigger is marked invalid. An attempt is made to validate the trigger on occurrence of the event. If the trigger cannot be validated successfully, then it is marked VALID WITH ERRORS, and the event fails.
Note:
I
There is an exception for STARTUP events: STARTUP events succeed even if the trigger fails. There are also exceptions for SHUTDOWN events and for LOGON events if you login as SYSTEM. Because the DBMS_AQ package is used to enqueue a message, dependency between triggers and queues cannot be maintained.
Recompiling Triggers
Use the ALTER TRIGGER statement to recompile a trigger manually. For example, the following statement recompiles the PRINT_SALARY_CHANGES trigger:
ALTER TRIGGER Print_salary_changes COMPILE;
Modifying Triggers
To recompile a trigger, you must own the trigger or have the ALTER ANY TRIGGER system privilege.
Modifying Triggers
Like a stored procedure, a trigger cannot be explicitly altered: It must be replaced with a new definition. (The ALTER TRIGGER statement is used only to recompile, enable, or disable a trigger.) When replacing a trigger, you must include the OR REPLACE option in the CREATE TRIGGER statement. The OR REPLACE option is provided to allow a new version of an existing trigger to replace the older version, without affecting any grants made for the original version of the trigger. Alternatively, the trigger can be dropped using the DROP TRIGGER statement, and you can rerun the CREATE TRIGGER statement. To drop a trigger, the trigger must be in your schema, or you must have the DROP ANY TRIGGER system privilege.
Debugging Triggers
You can debug a trigger using the same facilities available for stored procedures.
See Also: "Debugging Stored Procedures" on page 7-40
Enabling Triggers
By default, a trigger is automatically enabled when it is created; however, it can later be disabled. After you have completed the task that required the trigger to be disabled, re-enable the trigger, so that it fires when appropriate.
9-28
Enable a disabled trigger using the ALTER TRIGGER statement with the ENABLE option. To enable the disabled trigger named REORDER of the INVENTORY table, enter the following statement:
ALTER TRIGGER Reorder ENABLE;
All triggers defined for a specific table can be enabled with one statement using the ALTER TABLE statement with the ENABLE clause with the ALL TRIGGERS option. For example, to enable all triggers defined for the INVENTORY table, enter the following statement:
ALTER TABLE Inventory ENABLE ALL TRIGGERS;
Disabling Triggers
You might temporarily disable a trigger if:
I I
An object it references is not available. You need to perform a large data load, and you want it to proceed quickly without firing triggers. You are reloading data.
By default, triggers are enabled when first created. Disable a trigger using the ALTER TRIGGER statement with the DISABLE option. For example, to disable the trigger named REORDER of the INVENTORY table, enter the following statement:
ALTER TRIGGER Reorder DISABLE;
All triggers associated with a table can be disabled with one statement using the ALTER TABLE statement with the DISABLE clause and the ALL TRIGGERS option. For example, to disable all triggers defined for the INVENTORY table, enter the following statement:
ALTER TABLE Inventory DISABLE ALL TRIGGERS;
USER_TRIGGERS
I I
ALL_TRIGGERS DBA_TRIGGERS
The new column, BASE_OBJECT_TYPE, specifies whether the trigger is based on DATABASE, SCHEMA, table, or view. The old column, TABLE_NAME, is null if the base object is not table or view. The column ACTION_TYPE specifies whether the trigger is a call type trigger or a PL/SQL trigger. The column TRIGGER_TYPE includes two additional values: BEFORE EVENT and AFTER EVENT, applicable only to system events. The column TRIGGERING_EVENT includes all system and DML events.
See Also: Oracle Database Reference for a complete description of
these data dictionary views For example, assume the following statement was used to create the REORDER trigger:
Caution: You may need to set up data structures for certain examples to work:
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Reorder AFTER UPDATE OF Parts_on_hand ON Inventory FOR EACH ROW WHEN(new.Parts_on_hand < new.Reorder_point) DECLARE x NUMBER; BEGIN SELECT COUNT(*) INTO x FROM Pending_orders WHERE Part_no = :new.Part_no; IF x = 0 THEN INSERT INTO Pending_orders VALUES (:new.Part_no, :new.Reorder_quantity, sysdate); END IF; END;
The following two queries return information about the REORDER trigger:
9-30
SELECT Trigger_type, Triggering_event, Table_name FROM USER_TRIGGERS WHERE Trigger_name = 'REORDER'; TYPE TRIGGERING_STATEMENT TABLE_NAME ---------------- -------------------------- -----------AFTER EACH ROW UPDATE INVENTORY SELECT Trigger_body FROM USER_TRIGGERS WHERE Trigger_name = 'REORDER'; TRIGGER_BODY -------------------------------------------DECLARE x NUMBER; BEGIN SELECT COUNT(*) INTO x FROM Pending_orders WHERE Part_no = :new.Part_no; IF x = 0 THEN INSERT INTO Pending_orders VALUES (:new.Part_no, :new.Reorder_quantity, sysdate); END IF; END;
Provide sophisticated auditing Prevent invalid transactions Enforce referential integrity (either those actions not supported by declarative integrity constraints or across nodes in a distributed database) Enforce complex business rules Enforce complex security authorizations Provide transparent event logging Automatically generate derived column values
I I I I
I I
Enable building complex views that are updatable Track system events
This section provides an example of each of these trigger applications. These examples are not meant to be used exactly as written: They are provided to assist you in designing your own triggers.
Audit Feature
Standard auditing options permit auditing of DML and DDL statements regarding all types of schema objects and structures. Comparatively, triggers permit auditing of DML statements entered against tables, and DDL auditing at SCHEMA or DATABASE level. All database audit information is recorded centrally and automatically using the auditing features of Oracle Database. Auditing features enabled using the standard Oracle Database features are easier to declare and maintain, and less prone to errors, when compared to auditing functions defined by triggers. Any changes to existing auditing options can also be audited to guard against malicious database activity.
9-32
Table 91 (Cont.) Comparison of Built-in Auditing and Trigger-Based Auditing Audit Feature Description
Session and Execution Using the database auditing features, records can be time Auditing generated once every time an audited statement is entered (BY ACCESS) or once for every session that enters an audited statement (BY SESSION). Triggers cannot audit by session; an audit record is generated each time a trigger-audited table is referenced. Auditing of Unsuccessful Data Access Database auditing can be set to audit when unsuccessful data access occurs. However, unless autonomous transactions are used, any audit information generated by a trigger is rolled back if the triggering statement is rolled back. For more information on autonomous transactions, see Oracle Database Concepts. Connections and disconnections, as well as session activity (physical I/Os, logical I/Os, deadlocks, and so on), can be recorded using standard database auditing.
When using triggers to provide sophisticated auditing, AFTER triggers are normally used. By using AFTER triggers, auditing information is recorded after the triggering statement is subjected to any applicable integrity constraints, preventing cases where the audit processing is carried out unnecessarily for statements that generate exceptions to integrity constraints. Choosing between AFTER row and AFTER statement triggers depends on the information being audited. For example, row triggers provide value-based auditing for each table row. Triggers can also require the user to supply a "reason code" for issuing the audited SQL statement, which can be useful in both row and statement-level auditing situations. The following example demonstrates a trigger that audits modifications to the Emp_ tab table for each row. It requires that a "reason code" be stored in a global package variable before the update. This shows how triggers can be used to provide value-based auditing and how to use public package variables.
Note: You may need to set up the following data structures for the
examples to work:
CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE Auditpackage AS Reason VARCHAR2(10); PROCEDURE Set_reason(Reason VARCHAR2); END; CREATE TABLE Emp99 ( Empno NOT NULL NUMBER(4), Ename VARCHAR2(10), Job VARCHAR2(9), Mgr NUMBER(4), Hiredate DATE, Sal NUMBER(7,2), Comm NUMBER(7,2), Deptno NUMBER(2), Bonus NUMBER, Ssn NUMBER, Job_classification NUMBER); CREATE TABLE Audit_employee ( Oldssn NUMBER, Oldname VARCHAR2(10), Oldjob VARCHAR2(2), Oldsal NUMBER, Newssn NUMBER, Newname VARCHAR2(10), Newjob VARCHAR2(2), Newsal NUMBER, Reason VARCHAR2(10), User1 VARCHAR2(10), Systemdate DATE);
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Audit_employee AFTER INSERT OR DELETE OR UPDATE ON Emp99 FOR EACH ROW BEGIN /* AUDITPACKAGE is a package with a public package variable REASON. REASON could be set by the application by a command such as EXECUTE AUDITPACKAGE.SET_REASON(reason_string). Note that a package variable has state for the duration of a session and that each session has a separate copy of
9-34
all package variables. */ IF Auditpackage.Reason IS NULL THEN Raise_application_error(-20201, 'Must specify reason' || ' with AUDITPACKAGE.SET_REASON(Reason_string)'); END IF; /* If the preceding conditional evaluates to TRUE, the user-specified error number and message is raised, the trigger stops execution, and the effects of the triggering statement are rolled back. Otherwise, a new row is inserted into the predefined auditing table named AUDIT_EMPLOYEE containing the existing and new values of the Emp_tab table and the reason code defined by the REASON variable of AUDITPACKAGE. Note that the "old" values are NULL if triggering statement is an INSERT and the "new" values are NULL if the triggering statement is a DELETE. */ INSERT INTO Audit_employee VALUES (:old.Ssn, :old.Ename, :old.Job_classification, :old.Sal, :new.Ssn, :new.Ename, :new.Job_classification, :new.Sal, auditpackage.Reason, User, Sysdate ); END;
Optionally, you can also set the reason code back to NULL if you wanted to force the reason code to be set for every update. The following simple AFTER statement trigger sets the reason code back to NULL after the triggering statement is run:
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Audit_employee_reset AFTER INSERT OR DELETE OR UPDATE ON Emp_tab BEGIN auditpackage.set_reason(NULL); END;
Notice that the previous two triggers are both fired by the same type of SQL statement. However, the AFTER row trigger is fired once for each row of the table affected by the triggering statement, while the AFTER statement trigger is fired only once after the triggering statement execution is completed. This next trigger also uses triggers to do auditing. It tracks changes made to the Emp_tab table and stores this information in AUDIT_TABLE and AUDIT_TABLE_ VALUES.
Note: You may need to set up the following data structures for the
example to work:
CREATE TABLE Audit_table ( Seq NUMBER, User_at VARCHAR2(10), Time_now DATE, Term VARCHAR2(10), Job VARCHAR2(10), Proc VARCHAR2(10), enum NUMBER); CREATE SEQUENCE Audit_seq; CREATE TABLE Audit_table_values ( Seq NUMBER, Dept NUMBER, Dept1 NUMBER, Dept2 NUMBER);
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Audit_emp AFTER INSERT OR UPDATE OR DELETE ON Emp_tab FOR EACH ROW DECLARE Time_now DATE; Terminal CHAR(10); BEGIN -- get current time, and the terminal of the user: Time_now := SYSDATE; Terminal := USERENV('TERMINAL'); -- record new employee primary key IF INSERTING THEN INSERT INTO Audit_table VALUES (Audit_seq.NEXTVAL, User, Time_now, Terminal, 'Emp_tab', 'INSERT', :new.Empno); -- record primary key of the deleted row: ELSIF DELETING THEN INSERT INTO Audit_table VALUES (Audit_seq.NEXTVAL, User, Time_now, Terminal, 'Emp_tab', 'DELETE', :old.Empno); -- for updates, record the primary key -- of the row being updated: ELSE INSERT INTO Audit_table VALUES (audit_seq.NEXTVAL, User, Time_now,
9-36
Terminal, 'Emp_tab', 'UPDATE', :old.Empno); -- and for SAL and DEPTNO, record old and new values: IF UPDATING ('SAL') THEN INSERT INTO Audit_table_values VALUES (Audit_seq.CURRVAL, 'SAL', :old.Sal, :new.Sal); ELSIF UPDATING ('DEPTNO') THEN INSERT INTO Audit_table_values VALUES (Audit_seq.CURRVAL, 'DEPTNO', :old.Deptno, :new.DEPTNO); END IF; END IF; END;
Triggers constrain what a transaction can do. A trigger does not apply to data loaded before the definition of the trigger; therefore, it is not known if all data in a table conforms to the rules established by an associated trigger. Although triggers can be written to enforce many of the same rules supported by Oracle Database's declarative integrity constraint features, triggers should only be used to enforce complex business rules that cannot be defined using standard integrity constraints. The declarative integrity constraint features provided with Oracle Database offer the following advantages when compared to constraints defined by triggers: Centralized integrity checks. All points of data access must adhere to the global set of rules defined by the integrity constraints corresponding to each schema object. Declarative method. Constraints defined using the standard integrity constraint features are much easier to write and are less prone to errors, when compared with comparable constraints defined by triggers.
While most aspects of data integrity can be defined and enforced using declarative integrity constraints, triggers can be used to enforce complex business constraints not definable using declarative integrity constraints. For example, triggers can be used to enforce:
I I
UPDATE SET NULL, and UPDATE and DELETE SET DEFAULT referential actions. Referential integrity when the parent and child tables are on different nodes of a distributed database. Complex check constraints not definable using the expressions allowed in a CHECK constraint.
A trigger must be defined for the child table that guarantees values inserted or updated in the foreign key correspond to values in the parent key. One or more triggers must be defined for the parent table. These triggers guarantee the desired referential action (RESTRICT, CASCADE, or SET NULL) for values in the foreign key when values are updated or deleted in the parent key. No action is required for inserts into the parent table (no dependent foreign keys exist).
The following sections provide examples of the triggers necessary to enforce referential integrity. The Emp_tab and Dept_tab table relationship is used in these examples. Several of the triggers include statements that lock rows (SELECT... FOR UPDATE). This operation is necessary to maintain concurrency as the rows are being processed.
9-38
Foreign Key Trigger for Child Table The following trigger guarantees that before an INSERT or UPDATE statement affects a foreign key value, the corresponding value exists in the parent key. The mutating table exception included in the following example allows this trigger to be used with the UPDATE_SET_DEFAULT and UPDATE_CASCADE triggers. This exception can be removed if this trigger is used alone.
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Emp_dept_check BEFORE INSERT OR UPDATE OF Deptno ON Emp_tab FOR EACH ROW WHEN (new.Deptno IS NOT NULL) -- Before a row is inserted, or DEPTNO is updated in the Emp_tab -- table, fire this trigger to verify that the new foreign -- key value (DEPTNO) is present in the Dept_tab table. DECLARE Dummy INTEGER; -- to be used for cursor fetch Invalid_department EXCEPTION; Valid_department EXCEPTION; Mutating_table EXCEPTION; PRAGMA EXCEPTION_INIT (Mutating_table, -4091); -- Cursor used to verify parent key value exists. -- present, lock parent key's row so it can't be -- deleted by another transaction until this -- transaction is committed or rolled back. CURSOR Dummy_cursor (Dn NUMBER) IS SELECT Deptno FROM Dept_tab WHERE Deptno = Dn FOR UPDATE OF Deptno; BEGIN OPEN Dummy_cursor (:new.Deptno); FETCH Dummy_cursor INTO Dummy; ---IF If
Verify parent key. If not found, raise user-specified error number and message. If found, close cursor before allowing triggering statement to complete: Dummy_cursor%NOTFOUND THEN RAISE Invalid_department; ELSE RAISE valid_department; END IF; CLOSE Dummy_cursor; EXCEPTION WHEN Invalid_department THEN CLOSE Dummy_cursor;
Raise_application_error(-20000, 'Invalid Department' || ' Number' || TO_CHAR(:new.deptno)); WHEN Valid_department THEN CLOSE Dummy_cursor; WHEN Mutating_table THEN NULL; END;
UPDATE and DELETE RESTRICT Trigger for Parent Table The following trigger is defined on the DEPT_TAB table to enforce the UPDATE and DELETE RESTRICT referential action on the primary key of the DEPT_TAB table:
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Dept_restrict BEFORE DELETE OR UPDATE OF Deptno ON Dept_tab FOR EACH ROW -- Before a row is deleted from Dept_tab or the primary key -- (DEPTNO) of Dept_tab is updated, check for dependent -- foreign key values in Emp_tab; rollback if any are found. DECLARE Dummy INTEGER; -- to be used for cursor fetch Employees_present EXCEPTION; employees_not_present EXCEPTION; -- Cursor used to check for dependent foreign key values. CURSOR Dummy_cursor (Dn NUMBER) IS SELECT Deptno FROM Emp_tab WHERE Deptno = Dn; BEGIN OPEN Dummy_cursor (:old.Deptno); FETCH Dummy_cursor INTO Dummy; -- If dependent foreign key is found, raise user-specified -- error number and message. If not found, close cursor -- before allowing triggering statement to complete. IF Dummy_cursor%FOUND THEN RAISE Employees_present; -- dependent rows exist ELSE RAISE Employees_not_present; -- no dependent rows END IF; CLOSE Dummy_cursor; EXCEPTION WHEN Employees_present THEN CLOSE Dummy_cursor; Raise_application_error(-20001, 'Employees Present in'
9-40
|| ' Department ' || TO_CHAR(:old.DEPTNO)); WHEN Employees_not_present THEN CLOSE Dummy_cursor; END;
Caution: This trigger does not work with self-referential tables (tables with both the primary/unique key and the foreign key). Also, this trigger does not allow triggers to cycle (such as, A fires B fires A).
UPDATE and DELETE SET NULL Triggers for Parent Table: Example The following trigger is defined on the DEPT_TAB table to enforce the UPDATE and DELETE SET NULL referential action on the primary key of the DEPT_TAB table:
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Dept_set_null AFTER DELETE OR UPDATE OF Deptno ON Dept_tab FOR EACH ROW -- Before a row is deleted from Dept_tab or the primary key -- (DEPTNO) of Dept_tab is updated, set all corresponding -- dependent foreign key values in Emp_tab to NULL: BEGIN IF UPDATING AND :OLD.Deptno != :NEW.Deptno OR DELETING THEN UPDATE Emp_tab SET Emp_tab.Deptno = NULL WHERE Emp_tab.Deptno = :old.Deptno; END IF; END;
DELETE Cascade Trigger for Parent Table: Example The following trigger on the DEPT_ TAB table enforces the DELETE CASCADE referential action on the primary key of the DEPT_TAB table:
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Dept_del_cascade AFTER DELETE ON Dept_tab FOR EACH ROW -- Before a row is deleted from Dept_tab, delete all -- rows from the Emp_tab table whose DEPTNO is the same as -- the DEPTNO being deleted from the Dept_tab table: BEGIN DELETE FROM Emp_tab WHERE Emp_tab.Deptno = :old.Deptno; END;
the code for UPDATE SET NULL or UPDATE SET DEFAULT to account for both updates and deletes. UPDATE Cascade Trigger for Parent Table: Example The following trigger ensures that if a department number is updated in the Dept_tab table, then this change is propagated to dependent foreign keys in the Emp_tab table:
-- Generate a sequence number to be used as a flag for -- determining if an update has occurred on a column: CREATE SEQUENCE Update_sequence INCREMENT BY 1 MAXVALUE 5000 CYCLE; CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE Integritypackage AS Updateseq NUMBER; END Integritypackage; CREATE OR REPLACE PACKAGE BODY Integritypackage AS END Integritypackage; -- create flag col: ALTER TABLE Emp_tab ADD Update_id NUMBER; CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Dept_cascade1 BEFORE UPDATE OF Deptno ON Dept_tab DECLARE Dummy NUMBER; -- Before updating the Dept_tab table (this is a statement -- trigger), generate a new sequence number and assign -- it to the public variable UPDATESEQ of a user-defined -- package named INTEGRITYPACKAGE: BEGIN SELECT Update_sequence.NEXTVAL INTO Dummy FROM dual; Integritypackage.Updateseq := Dummy; END; CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Dept_cascade2 AFTER DELETE OR UPDATE OF Deptno ON Dept_tab FOR EACH ROW -- For each department number in Dept_tab that is updated, -- cascade the update to dependent foreign keys in the
9-42
-- Emp_tab table. Only cascade the update if the child row -- has not already been updated by this trigger: BEGIN IF UPDATING THEN UPDATE Emp_tab SET Deptno = :new.Deptno, Update_id = Integritypackage.Updateseq --from 1st WHERE Emp_tab.Deptno = :old.Deptno AND Update_id IS NULL; /* only NULL if not updated by the 3rd trigger fired by this same triggering statement */ END IF; IF DELETING THEN -- Before a row is deleted from Dept_tab, delete all -- rows from the Emp_tab table whose DEPTNO is the same as -- the DEPTNO being deleted from the Dept_tab table: DELETE FROM Emp_tab WHERE Emp_tab.Deptno = :old.Deptno; END IF; END; CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Dept_cascade3 AFTER UPDATE OF Deptno ON Dept_tab BEGIN UPDATE Emp_tab SET Update_id = NULL WHERE Update_id = Integritypackage.Updateseq; END;
Note: Because this trigger updates the Emp_tab table, the Emp_
dept_check trigger, if enabled, is also fired. The resulting mutating table error is trapped by the Emp_dept_check trigger. You should carefully test any triggers that require error trapping to succeed to ensure that they always work properly in your environment.
Note: You may need to set up the following data structures for the
example to work:
CREATE TABLE Salgrade ( Grade Losal Hisal Job_classification NUMBER, NUMBER, NUMBER, NUMBER)
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Salary_check BEFORE INSERT OR UPDATE OF Sal, Job ON Emp99 FOR EACH ROW DECLARE Minsal NUMBER; Maxsal NUMBER; Salary_out_of_range EXCEPTION; BEGIN /* Retrieve the minimum and maximum salary for the employee's new job classification from the SALGRADE table into MINSAL and MAXSAL: */ SELECT Minsal, Maxsal INTO Minsal, Maxsal FROM Salgrade WHERE Job_classification = :new.Job;
/* If the employee's new salary is less than or greater than the job classification's limits, the exception is raised. The exception message is returned and the pending INSERT or UPDATE statement that fired the trigger is rolled back:*/ IF (:new.Sal < Minsal OR :new.Sal > Maxsal) THEN RAISE Salary_out_of_range; END IF; EXCEPTION WHEN Salary_out_of_range THEN Raise_application_error (-20300, 'Salary '||TO_CHAR(:new.Sal)||' out of range for ' ||'job classification '||:new.Job ||' for employee '||:new.Ename); WHEN NO_DATA_FOUND THEN Raise_application_error(-20322,
9-44
The security check is done before the triggering statement is allowed to run, so that no wasted work is done by an unauthorized statement. The security check is performed only once for the triggering statement, not for each row affected by the triggering statement.
example to work:
CREATE TABLE Company_holidays (Day DATE);
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Emp_permit_changes BEFORE INSERT OR DELETE OR UPDATE ON Emp99 DECLARE Dummy INTEGER; Not_on_weekends EXCEPTION; Not_on_holidays EXCEPTION; Non_working_hours EXCEPTION; BEGIN /* check for weekends: */ IF (TO_CHAR(Sysdate, 'DY') = 'SAT' OR TO_CHAR(Sysdate, 'DY') = 'SUN') THEN RAISE Not_on_weekends; END IF; /* check for company holidays:*/ SELECT COUNT(*) INTO Dummy FROM Company_holidays WHERE TRUNC(Day) = TRUNC(Sysdate); /* TRUNC gets rid of time parts of dates: */
IF dummy > 0 THEN RAISE Not_on_holidays; END IF; /* Check for work hours (8am to 6pm): */ IF (TO_CHAR(Sysdate, 'HH24') < 8 OR TO_CHAR(Sysdate, 'HH24') > 18) THEN RAISE Non_working_hours; END IF; EXCEPTION WHEN Not_on_weekends THEN Raise_application_error(-20324,'May not change ' ||'employee table during the weekend'); WHEN Not_on_holidays THEN Raise_application_error(-20325,'May not change ' ||'employee table during a holiday'); WHEN Non_working_hours THEN Raise_application_error(-20326,'May not change ' ||'Emp_tab table during non-working hours'); END;
See Also: Oracle Database Security Guide for details on database security features
The dependent values must be derived before the INSERT or UPDATE occurs, so that the triggering statement can use the derived values. The trigger must fire for each row affected by the triggering INSERT or UPDATE statement.
9-46
The following example illustrates how a trigger can be used to derive new column values for a table whenever a row is inserted or updated.
Note: You may need to set up the following data structures for the
example to work:
ALTER TABLE Emp99 ADD( Uppername VARCHAR2(20), Soundexname VARCHAR2(20));
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Derived BEFORE INSERT OR UPDATE OF Ename ON Emp99 /* Before updating the ENAME field, derive the values for the UPPERNAME and SOUNDEXNAME fields. Users should be restricted from updating these fields directly: */ FOR EACH ROW BEGIN :new.Uppername := UPPER(:new.Ename); :new.Soundexname := SOUNDEX(:new.Ename); END;
You can define a complex view over these tables to create a logical view of the library with sections and a collection of books in each section.
CREATE OR REPLACE VIEW Library_view AS SELECT i.Section, CAST (MULTISET ( SELECT b.Booknum, b.Title, b.Author, b.Available FROM Book_table b WHERE b.Section = i.Section) AS Book_list_t) BOOKLIST FROM Library_table i;
Make this view updatable by defining an INSTEAD OF trigger over the view.
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Library_trigger INSTEAD OF INSERT ON Library_view FOR EACH ROW Bookvar BOOK_T; i INTEGER; BEGIN INSERT INTO Library_table VALUES (:NEW.Section); FOR i IN 1..:NEW.Booklist.COUNT LOOP Bookvar := Booklist(i); INSERT INTO book_table VALUES ( Bookvar.booknum, :NEW.Section, Bookvar.Title, Bookvar.Author, bookvar.Available); END LOOP; END; /
9-48
The library_view is an updatable view, and any INSERTs on the view are handled by the trigger that gets fired automatically. For example:
INSERT INTO Library_view VALUES ('History', book_list_t(book_t(121330, 'Alexander', 'Mirth', 'Y');
Similarly, you can also define triggers on the nested table booklist to handle modification of the nested table element.
WHERE Last_name = SYS_CONTEXT('userenv', 'session_user'); DBMS_SESSION.SET_CONTEXT('expenses_reporting','emp_number', Empnum); -- SET ROLE: SELECT COUNT (*) INTO Countrec FROM Cost_center WHERE Manager_id=Empnum; IF (countrec > 0) THEN DBMS_SESSION.SET_CONTEXT('expenses_reporting','exp_role','MANAGER'); ELSE DBMS_SESSION.SET_CONTEXT('expenses_reporting','exp_role','EMPLOYEE'); END IF; -- SET cc_number: SELECT Cost_center_id INTO Cc FROM Employee WHERE Last_name = SYS_CONTEXT('userenv','session_user'); DBMS_SESSION.SET_CONTEXT(expenses_reporting','cc_number',Cc); END; END;
CALL Syntax
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER Secdemo.Setexpseetx AFTER LOGON ON DATABASE CALL Secdemo.Exprep_etx.Set_otx
Oracle Database's system events publication framework includes the following features:
I
Infrastructure for publish/subscribe, by making the database an active publisher of events. Integration of data cartridges in the server. The system events publication can be used to notify cartridges of state changes in the server. Integration of fine-grained access control in the server.
By creating a trigger, you can specify a procedure that runs when an event occurs. DML events are supported on tables, and system events are supported on
9-50
DATABASE and SCHEMA. You can turn notification on and off by enabling and disabling the trigger using the ALTER TRIGGER statement. This feature is integrated with the Advanced Queueing engine. Publish/subscribe applications use the DBMS_AQ.ENQUEUE() procedure, and other applications such as cartridges use callouts.
See Also:
I I
Oracle Database SQL Reference Oracle Streams Advanced Queuing User's Guide and Reference for details on how to subscribe to published events
way. You cannot define your own event conditions. When an event occurs, all triggers that are enabled on that event are fired, with some exceptions:
I
If the trigger is actually the target of the triggering event, it is not fired. For example, a trigger for all DROP events is not fired when it is dropped itself. If a trigger is not fired if it has been modified but not committed within the same transaction as the firing event. For example, recursive DDL within a system trigger might modify a trigger, which prevents the modified trigger from being fired by events within the same transaction.
More than one trigger can be created on an object. When an event fires more than one trigger, the order is not defined and you should not rely on the triggers being fired in a particular order.
Publication Context
When an event is published, certain runtime context and attributes, as specified in the parameter list, are passed to the callout procedure. A set of functions called event attribute functions are provided.
information on event-specific attributes For each system event supported, event-specific attributes are identified and predefined for the event. You can choose the parameter list to be any of these attributes, along with other simple expressions. For callouts, these are passed as IN arguments.
Error Handling
Return status from publication callout functions for all events are ignored. For example, with SHUTDOWN events, the server cannot do anything with the return status.
See Also: "List of Database Events" on page 10-7 for details on return status
Execution Model
Traditionally, triggers execute as the definer of the trigger. The trigger action of an event is executed as the definer of the action (as the definer of the package or function in callouts, or as owner of the trigger in queues). Because the owner of the trigger must have EXECUTE privileges on the underlying queues, packages, or procedure, this behavior is consistent.
9-52
10
Working With System Events
System events, like LOGON and SHUTDOWN, provide a mechanism for tracking system changes. Oracle Database lets you combine this tracking with database event notification, which provides a simple and elegant method of delivering asynchronous messaging to an application. This chapter includes descriptions of the various events on which triggers can be created. It also provides the list of event attribute functions. Topics include the following:
I I
Chapter 9, "Using Triggers" for background information useful for understanding the information in this chapter. You access event information inside a trigger body. Oracle 2 Day DBA for information on Oracle Enterprise Manager. You can set up a flexible system for handling events using the Event panels in Enterprise Manager. This technique lets you detect more conditions than the system events in this chapter, and it lets you set up actions such as invoking shell scripts.
To make these attributes available, you must first run the CATPROC.SQL script. The trigger dictionary object maintains metadata about events that will be published and their corresponding attributes. In earlier releases, these functions were accessed through the SYS package. We recommend you use these public synonyms whose names begin with ora_.
System-Defined Event Attributes Type VARCHAR2 Description Returns the IP address of the client in a LOGON event, when the underlying protocol is TCP/IP Database name. Example if (ora_sysevent = 'LOGON') then addr := ora_client_ip_ address; end if;
ora_client_ip_address
ora_database_name
VARCHAR2(50)
DECLARE db_name VARCHAR2(50); BEGIN db_name := ora_database_name; END; IF (ora_dict_obj_type = 'USER') THEN INSERT INTO event_table (ora_des_encrypted_password); END IF;
ora_des_encrypted_password
VARCHAR2
10-2
(Cont.) System-Defined Event Attributes Type VARCHAR(30) Description Name of the dictionary object on which the DDL operation occurred. Example INSERT INTO event_table ('Changed object is ' || ora_ dict_obj_name');
ora_dict_obj_name
BINARY_INTEGER Return the list of object names of objects being modified in the event. VARCHAR(30) Owner of the dictionary object on which the DDL operation occurred.
if (ora_sysevent = 'ASSOCIATE STATISTICS') then number_modified := ora_ dict_obj_name_list (name_list); end if; INSERT INTO event_table ('object owner is' || ora_dict_obj_ owner');
ora_dict_obj_owner
BINARY_INTEGER Returns the list of object owners of objects being modified in the event. Type of the dictionary object on which the DDL operation occurred.
if (ora_sysevent = 'ASSOCIATE STATISTICS') then number_of_modified_ objects := ora_dict_obj_owner_ list(owner_list); end if; INSERT INTO event_table ('This object is a ' || ora_dict_obj_ type);
ora_dict_obj_type
VARCHAR(20)
BINARY_INTEGER Returns the grantees of a grant event in the OUT parameter; returns the number of grantees in the return value. NUMBER
ora_instance_num
Instance number. IF (ora_instance_num = 1) THEN INSERT INTO event_table ('1'); END IF;
(Cont.) System-Defined Event Attributes Type Description Returns true if the specified column is altered. Example if (ora_sysevent = 'ALTER' and ora_dict_obj_type = 'TABLE') then alter_column := ora_is_ alter_column('FOO'); end if;
ora_is_creating_nested_table BOOLEAN
Returns true if if (ora_sysevent = 'CREATE' and the current event ora_dict_obj_type = 'TABLE' and is creating a ora_is_creating_nested_table) nested table then insert into event_tab values ('A nested table is created'); end if; Returns true if the specified column is dropped. Returns TRUE if given error is on error stack, FALSE otherwise. if (ora_sysevent = 'ALTER' and ora_dict_obj_type = 'TABLE') then drop_column := ora_is_ drop_column('FOO'); end if; IF (ora_is_servererror(error_ number)) THEN INSERT INTO event_table ('Server error!!'); END IF;
BOOLEAN
ora_is_servererror
BOOLEAN
ora_login_user ora_partition_pos
VARCHAR2(30)
Login user name. SELECT ora_login_user FROM dual; -- Retrieve ora_sql_txt into -- sql_text variable first. n := ora_partition_pos; new_stmt := substr(sql_text, 1, n-1) || ' ' || my_partition_clause || ' ' || substr(sql_text, n));
BINARY_INTEGER In an INSTEAD OF trigger for CREATE TABLE, the position within the SQL text where you could insert a PARTITION clause.
10-4
(Cont.) System-Defined Event Attributes Type Description Example if (ora_sysevent = 'GRANT' or ora_sysevent = 'REVOKE') then number_of_privileges := ora_privilege_list(priv_list); end if;
ora_privilege_list( BINARY_INTEGER Returns the list of privileges privilege_list OUT ora_name_ being granted by list_t) the grantee or the list of privileges revoked from the revokees in the OUT parameter; returns the number of privileges in the return value. ora_revokee ( BINARY_INTEGER Returns the revokees of a user_list OUT ora_name_list_ revoke event in t) the OUT parameter; returns the number of revokees in the return value. ora_server_error NUMBER
Given a position INSERT INTO event_table ('top (1 for top of stack error ' || ora_server_ stack), it returns error(1)); the error number at that position on error stack n := ora_server_error_depth; -- This value is used with -- other functions such as -- ora_server_error
ora_server_error_depth
BINARY_INTEGER Returns the total number of error messages on the error stack.
Given a position INSERT INTO event_table ('top (1 for top of stack error message' || ora_ stack), it returns server_error_msg(1)); the error message at that position on error stack
ora_server_error_num_params BINARY_INTEGER Given a position (1 for top of (position in binary_integer) stack), it returns the number of strings that have been substituted into the error message using a format like "%s". ora_server_error_param (position in binary_integer, param in binary_integer) VARCHAR2 Given a position (1 for top of stack) and a parameter number, returns the matching "%s", "%d", and so on substitution value in the error message.
-- E.g. the 2rd %s in a message -- like "Expected %s, found %s" param := ora_server_error_ param(1,2);
BINARY_INTEGER Returns the SQL text of the triggering statement in the OUT parameter. If the statement is long, it is broken up into multiple PL/SQL table elements. The function return value specifies how many elements are in the PL/SQL table.
sql_text ora_name_list_t; stmt VARCHAR2(2000); ... n := ora_sql_txt(sql_text); FOR i IN 1..n LOOP stmt := stmt || sql_text(i); END LOOP; INSERT INTO event_table ('text of triggering statement: ' || stmt);
10-6
System event INSERT INTO event_table (ora_ firing the trigger: sysevent); Event name is same as that in the syntax. Returns true if if (ora_sysevent = 'GRANT' and the privileges are ora_with_grant_option = TRUE) granted with then insert into event_table grant option. ('with grant option'); end if; Returns true if the error is related to an out-of-space condition, and fills in the OUT parameters with information about the object that caused the error. if (space_error_info(eno, typ, owner, ts, obj, subobj) = TRUE) then dbms_output.put_line('The object ' || obj || ' owned by ' || owner || ' has run out of space.'); end if;
ora_with_grant_option
BOOLEAN
space_error_info( error_number OUT NUMBER, error_type OUT VARCHAR2, object_owner OUT VARCHAR2, table_space_name OUT VARCHAR2, object_name OUT VARCHAR2, sub_object_name OUT VARCHAR2)
BOOLEAN
System Manager Events When Fired? When the database is opened. Conditions Restrictions None allowed No database operations allowed in the trigger. Return status ignored. Transaction Starts a separate transaction and commits it after firing the triggers. Starts a separate transaction and commits it after firing the triggers. Attribute Functions ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name
SHUTDOWN
Just before the server starts None the shutdown of an allowed instance. This lets the cartridge shutdown completely. For abnormal instance shutdown, this event may not be fired.
SERVERERROR
When the error eno occurs. If no condition is given, then this event fires when any error occurs. Does not apply to ORA-1034, ORA-1403, ORA-1422, ORA-1423, and ORA-4030 conditions, because they are not true errors or are too serious to continue processing.
ERRNO = eno
Client Events
Client events are the events related to user logon/logoff, DML, and DDL operations. For example:
CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER On_Logon AFTER LOGON ON The_user.Schema BEGIN Do_Something; END;
10-8
The LOGON and LOGOFF events allow simple conditions on UID( ) and USER( ). All other events allow simple conditions on the type and name of the object, as well as functions like UID( ) and USER( ). The LOGON event starts a separate transaction and commits it after firing the triggers. All other events fire the triggers in the existing user transaction. The LOGON and LOGOFF events can operate on any objects. For all other events, the corresponding trigger cannot perform any DDL operations, such as DROP and ALTER, on the object that caused the event to be generated. The DDL allowed inside these triggers is altering, creating, or dropping a table, creating a trigger, and compile operations. If an event trigger becomes the target of a DDL operation (such as CREATE TRIGGER), it cannot be fired later during the same transaction Table 103 contains a list of client events.
Client Events When Fired? When a catalog object is altered. Attribute Functions ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_type ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_owner ora_des_encrypted_password (for ALTER USER events) ora_is_alter_column, ora_is_ drop_column (for ALTER TABLE events) ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_type ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_owner ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_type ora_dict_obj_owner ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_type ora_dict_obj_owner ora_dict_obj_name_list ora_dict_obj_owner_list ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name
(Cont.) Client Events (Cont.) When Fired? When an object is commented Attribute Functions ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_type ora_dict_obj_owner ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_type ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_owner ora_is_creating_nested_table (for CREATE TABLE events) ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_type ora_dict_obj_owner ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_type ora_dict_obj_owner ora_dict_obj_name_list ora_dict_obj_owner_list
When most SQL DDL statements are issued. Not fired for ALTER DATABASE, CREATE CONTROLFILE, CREATE DATABASE, and DDL issued through the PL/SQL procedure interface, such as creating an advanced queue. When a disassociate statistics statement is issued
10-11
(Cont.) Client Events (Cont.) When Fired? When a grant statement is issued Attribute Functions ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_type ora_dict_obj_owner ora_grantee ora_with_grant_option ora_privileges ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_client_ip_address ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_owner ora_dict_obj_type
BEFORE LOGOFF
AFTER LOGON
When a revoke statement is issued ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_type ora_dict_obj_owner ora_revokee ora_privileges After a SQL statement is suspended because of an out-of-space condition. The trigger should correct the condition so the statement can be resumed. ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_server_error ora_is_servererror space_error_info ora_sysevent ora_login_user ora_instance_num ora_database_name ora_dict_obj_name ora_dict_obj_type ora_dict_obj_owner
AFTER SUSPEND
10-13
11
Using the Publish-Subscribe Model for Applications
Because the database is the most significant resource of information within the enterprise, Oracle created a publish-subscribe solution for enterprise information delivery and messaging to complement this role. Topics in this chapter include:
I I I I
Introduction to Publish-Subscribe
Introduction to Publish-Subscribe
Networking technologies and products enable a high degree of connectivity across a large number of computers, applications, and users. In these environments, it is important to provide asynchronous communications for the class of distributed systems that operate in a loosely-coupled and autonomous fashion, and which require operational immunity from network failures. This requirement has been filled by various middleware products that are characterized as messaging, message oriented middleware (MOM), message queuing, or publish-subscribe. Applications that communicate through a publish and subscribe paradigm require the sending applications (publishers) to publish messages without explicitly specifying recipients or having knowledge of intended recipients. Similarly, receiving applications (subscribers) must receive only those messages that the subscriber has registered an interest in. This decoupling between senders and recipients is usually accomplished by an intervening entity between the publisher and the subscriber, which serves as a level of indirection. This intervening entity is a queue that represents a subject or channel. Figure 111 illustrates publish and subscribe functionality.
Figure 111 Oracle Publish-Subscribe Functionality
Rules
Subscriptions Topic Publisher Agent receive notification/ message Subject, Channel subscribe register
Subscriber Agent
A subscriber subscribes to a queue by expressing interest in messages enqueued to that queue and by using a subject- or content-based rule as a filter. This results in a set of rule-based subscriptions associated with a given queue. At runtime, publishers post messages to various queues. The queue (in other words, the delivery mechanisms of the underlying infrastructure) then delivers messages that match the various subscriptions to the appropriate subscribers.
11-2
Publish-Subscribe Concepts
Publish-Subscribe Architecture
Oracle Database includes the following features to support database-enabled publish-subscribe messaging:
I I I
Database Events Database events support declarative definitions for publishing database events, detection, and run-time publication of such events. This feature enables active publication of information to end-users in an event-driven manner, to complement the traditional pull-oriented approaches to accessing information.
See Also: Chapter 10, "Working With System Events"
Advanced Queuing Oracle Advanced Queuing (AQ) supports a queue-based publish-subscribe paradigm. Database queues serve as a durable store for messages, along with capabilities to allow publish and subscribe based on queues. A rules-engine and subscription service dynamically route messages to recipients based on expressed interest. This allows decoupling of addressing between senders and receivers to complement the existing explicit sender-receiver message addressing.
See Also: Oracle Streams Advanced Queuing User's Guide and Reference
Client Notifications Client notifications support asynchronous delivery of messages to interested subscribers. This enables database clients to register interest in certain queues, and it enables these clients to receive notifications when publications on such queues occur. Asynchronous delivery of messages to database clients is in contrast to the traditional polling techniques used to retrieve information.
See Also: Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide
Publish-Subscribe Concepts
This section describes various concepts related to publish-subscribe.
Publish-Subscribe Concepts
queue A queue is an entity that supports the notion of named subjects of interest. Queues can be characterized as: non-persistent queue (lightweight queue) The underlying queue infrastructure pushes the messages published to connected clients in a lightweight, at-best-once, manner. persistent queue Queues serve as durable containers for messages. Messages are delivered in a deferred and reliable mode. agent Publishers and subscribers are internally represented as agents. There is a distinction between an agent and a client. An agent is a persistent logical subscribing entity that expresses interest in a queue through a subscription. An agent has properties, such as an associated subscription, an address, and a delivery mode for messages. In this context, an agent is an electronic proxy for a publisher or subscriber. A client is a transient physical entity. The attributes of a client include the physical process where the client programs run, the node name, and the client application logic. There could be several clients acting on behalf of a single agent. Also, the same client, if authorized, can act on behalf of multiple agents. rule on a queue A rule on a queue is specified as a conditional expression using a predefined set of operators on the message format attributes or on the message header attributes. Each queue has an associated message content format that describes the structure of the messages represented by that queue. The message format may be unstructured (RAW) or it may have a well-defined structure (ADT). This allows both subject- or content-based subscriptions. subscriber Subscribers (agents) may specify subscriptions on a queue using a rule. Subscribers are durable and are stored in a catalog.
11-4
Publish-Subscribe Concepts
database event publication framework The database represents a significant source for publishing information. An event framework is proposed to allow declarative definition of database event publication. As these pre-defined events occur, the framework detects and publishes such events. This allows active delivery of information to end-users in an event-driven manner as part of the publish-subscribe capability. registration Registration is the process of associated delivery information by a given client, acting on behalf of an agent. There is an important distinction between the subscription and registration related to the agent/client separation. Subscription indicates an interest in a particular queue by an agent. It does not specify where and how delivery must occur. Delivery information is a physical property that is associated with a client, and it is a transient manifestation of the logical agent (the subscriber). A specific client process acting on behalf of an agent registers delivery information by associating a host and port, indicating where the delivery should be done, and a callback, indicating how there delivery should be done. publishing a message Publishers publish messages to queues by using the appropriate queuing interfaces. The interfaces may depend on which model the queue is implemented on. For example, an enqueue call represents the publishing of a message. rules engine When a message is posted or published to a given queue, a rules engine extracts the set of candidate rules from all rules defined on that queue that match the published message. subscription services Corresponding to the list of candidate rules on a given queue, the set of subscribers that match the candidate rules can be evaluated. In turn, the set of agents corresponding to this subscription list can be determined and notified. posting The queue notifies all registered clients of the appropriate published messages. This concept is called posting. When the queue needs to notify all interested clients, it posts the message to all registered clients.
receive a message A subscriber may receive messages through any of the following mechanisms:
I
A client process acting on behalf of the subscriber specifies a callback using the registration mechanism. The posting mechanism then asynchronously invokes the callback when a message matches the subscriber's subscription. The message content may be passed to the callback function (non-persistent queues only). A client process acting on behalf of the subscriber specifies a callback using the registration mechanism. The posting mechanism then asynchronously invokes the callback function, but without the full message content. This serves as a notification to the client, which subsequently retrieves the message content in a pull fashion (persistent queues only). A client process acting on behalf of the subscriber simply retrieves messages from the queue in a periodic, or some other appropriate, manner. While the messages are deferred, there is no asynchronous delivery to the end-client.
Scenario: This example shows how system events, client notification, and AQ work together to implement publish-subscribe.
I
Create under the user schema, pubsub, with all objects necessary to support a publish-subscribe mechanism. In this particular code, the Agent snoop subscribe to messages that are published at logon events. Note that the user pubsub needs AQ_ADMINISTRATOR_ROLE privileges to use AQ functionality.
11-6
Rem -----------------------------------------------------CONNECT pubsub/pubsub; Rem Create or replace a queue table BEGIN DBMS_AQADM.CREATE_QUEUE_TABLE( Queue_table => 'Pubsub.Raw_msg_table', Multiple_consumers => TRUE, Queue_payload_type => 'RAW', Compatible => '8.1'); END; / Rem -----------------------------------------------------Rem Create a persistent queue for publishing messages: Rem -----------------------------------------------------Rem Create a queue for logon events begin BEGIN DBMS_AQADM.CREATE_QUEUE( Queue_name => 'Pubsub.Logon', Queue_table => 'Pubsub.Raw_msg_table', Comment => 'Q for error triggers'); END; / Rem -----------------------------------------------------Rem Start the queue: Rem -----------------------------------------------------BEGIN DBMS_AQADM.START_QUEUE('pubsub.logon'); END; / Rem -----------------------------------------------------Rem define new_enqueue for convenience: Rem -----------------------------------------------------CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE New_enqueue( Queue_name IN VARCHAR2, Payload IN RAW , Correlation IN VARCHAR2 := NULL, Exception_queue IN VARCHAR2 := NULL)
BEGIN Msg_prop.Exception_queue := Exception_queue; Msg_prop.Correlation := Correlation; Userdata := Payload; DBMS_AQ.ENQUEUE(Queue_name, Enq_ct, Msg_prop, Userdata, Enq_msgid); END; / Rem -----------------------------------------------------Rem add subscriber with rule based on current user name, Rem using correlation_id Rem ------------------------------------------------------
DECLARE Subscriber Sys.Aq$_agent; BEGIN Subscriber := sys.aq$_agent('SNOOP', NULL, NULL); DBMS_AQADM.ADD_SUBSCRIBER( Queue_name => 'Pubsub.logon', Subscriber => subscriber, Rule => 'CORRID = ''SCOTT'' '); END; / Rem -----------------------------------------------------Rem create a trigger on logon on database: Rem ------------------------------------------------------
Rem create trigger on after logon: CREATE OR REPLACE TRIGGER pubsub.Systrig2 AFTER LOGON ON DATABASE BEGIN New_enqueue('Pubsub.Logon', HEXTORAW('9999'), Dbms_standard.login_user); END;
11-8
/
I
After subscriptions are created, the next step is for the client to register for notification using callback functions. This is done using the Oracle Call Interface (OCI). The following code performs necessary steps for registration. The initial steps of allocating and initializing session handles are omitted here for sake of clarity.
ub4 namespace = OCI_SUBSCR_NAMESPACE_AQ; /* callback function for notification of logon of user 'scott' on database: */ ub4 notifySnoop(ctx, subscrhp, pay, payl, desc, mode) dvoid *ctx; OCISubscription *subscrhp; dvoid *pay; ub4 payl; dvoid *desc; ub4 mode; { printf("Notification : User Scott Logged on\n"); } int main() { OCISession *authp = (OCISession *) 0; OCISubscription *subscrhpSnoop = (OCISubscription *)0; /***************************************************** Initialize OCI Process/Environment Initialize Server Contexts Connect to Server Set Service Context ******************************************************/ /* Registration Code Begins */ /* Each call to initSubscriptionHn allocates and Initialises a Registration Handle */
initSubscriptionHn( &subscrhpSnoop, /* subscription handle */ "ADMIN:PUBSUB.SNOOP", /* subscription name */ /* <agent_name>:<queue_name> */ (dvoid*)notifySnoop); /* callback function */
/***************************************************** The Client Process does not need a live Session for Callbacks End Session and Detach from Server ******************************************************/ OCISessionEnd ( svchp, errhp, authp, (ub4) OCI_DEFAULT);
/* detach from server */ OCIServerDetach( srvhp, errhp, OCI_DEFAULT); while (1) /* wait for callback */ sleep(1); } void initSubscriptionHn (subscrhp, subscriptionName, func) OCISubscription **subscrhp; char* subscriptionName; dvoid * func; { /* allocate subscription handle: */ (void) OCIHandleAlloc((dvoid *) envhp, (dvoid **)subscrhp, (ub4) OCI_HTYPE_SUBSCRIPTION, (size_t) 0, (dvoid **) 0); /* set subscription name in handle: */ (void) OCIAttrSet((dvoid *) *subscrhp, (ub4) OCI_HTYPE_SUBSCRIPTION, (dvoid *) subscriptionName, (ub4) strlen((char *)subscriptionName), (ub4) OCI_ATTR_SUBSCR_NAME, errhp); /* set callback function in handle: */ (void) OCIAttrSet((dvoid *) *subscrhp, (ub4) OCI_HTYPE_SUBSCRIPTION, (dvoid *) func, (ub4) 0, (ub4) OCI_ATTR_SUBSCR_CALLBACK, errhp); (void) OCIAttrSet((dvoid *) *subscrhp, (ub4) OCI_HTYPE_SUBSCRIPTION,
(dvoid *) 0, (ub4) 0, (ub4) OCI_ATTR_SUBSCR_CTX, errhp); /* set namespace in handle: */ (void) OCIAttrSet((dvoid *) *subscrhp, (ub4) OCI_HTYPE_SUBSCRIPTION, (dvoid *) &namespace, (ub4) 0, (ub4) OCI_ATTR_SUBSCR_NAMESPACE, errhp); checkerr(errhp, OCISubscriptionRegister(svchp, subscrhp, 1, errhp, OCI_DEFAULT)); }
If user SCOTT logs on to the database, the client is notified, and the call back function notifySnoop is called.
11-11
Part IV
Developing Specialized Applications
This part deals with application development scenarios that not every developer faces. Oracle Database provides a range of features to help with each kind of application. This part contains:
I I I I I
Chapter 12, "Using Regular Expressions With Oracle Database" Chapter 13, "Developing Web Applications with PL/SQL" Chapter 14, "Porting Non-Oracle Applications to Oracle Database 10g" Chapter 15, "Using Flashback Features" Chapter 16, "Using Oracle XA with Transaction Monitors"
12
Using Regular Expressions With Oracle Database
This chapter introduces regular expression support for Oracle Database. This chapter covers the following topics:
I I I I I
What are Regular Expressions? Oracle Database Regular Expression Support Oracle Database SQL Functions for Regular Expressions Metacharacters Supported in Regular Expressions Constructing Regular Expressions
See Also:
I
Oracle Database SQL Reference for additional details on Oracle Database SQL functions for regular expressions Oracle Database Globalization Support Guide for details on using SQL regular expression functions in a multilingual environment Mastering Regular Expressions published by O'Reilly & Associates, Inc.
searches for the pattern: 'a', followed by either 'b' or 'c', then followed by 'd'. This regular expression matches both 'abd' and 'acd'. A regular expression is specified using two types of characters:
I I
Metacharactersoperators that specify algorithms for performing the search. Literalsthe actual characters to search for.
that support regular expressions in the industry. If you are porting regular expressions from another environment to Oracle Database, ensure that the regular expression syntax is supported and the behavior is what you expect.
12-2
datatype that holds character data such as CHAR, NCHAR, CLOB, NCLOB, NVARCHAR2, and VARCHAR2. A regular expression must be enclosed or wrapped between single quotes. Doing so, ensures that the entire expression is interpreted by the SQL function and can improve the readability of your code. Table 121 gives a brief description of each regular expression function.
Note: As with all text literals used in SQL functions, regular
expressions must be enclosed or wrapped between single quotes. If your regular expression includes the single quote character, enter two single quotation marks to represent one single quotation mark within your expression.
SQL Regular Expression Functions Description This function searches a character column for a pattern. Use this function in the WHERE clause of a query to return rows matching the regular expression you specify. See the Oracle Database SQL Reference for syntax details on the REGEXP_LIKE function.
REGEXP_LIKE
REGEXP_REPLACE
This function searches for a pattern in a character column and replaces each occurrence of that pattern with the pattern you specify. See the Oracle Database SQL Reference for syntax details on the REGEXP_REPLACE function.
REGEXP_INSTR
This function searches a string for a given occurrence of a regular expression pattern. You specify which occurrence you want to find and the start position to search from. This function returns an integer indicating the position in the string where the match is found. See the Oracle Database SQL Reference for syntax details on the REGEXP_INSTR function.
REGEXP_SUBSTR
This function returns the actual substring matching the regular expression pattern you specify. See the Oracle Database SQL Reference for syntax details on the REGEXP_SUBSTR function.
Metacharacter Syntax . + ?
One or More Plus Matches one or more occurrences of the Quantifier preceding subexpression Zero or One Question Mark Quantifier Zero or More Star Quantifier IntervalExact Count IntervalAt Least Count IntervalBetween Count Matches zero or one occurrence of the preceding subexpression Matches zero or more occurrences of the preceding subexpression Matches exactly m occurrences of the preceding subexpression Matches at least m occurrences of the preceding subexpression Matches at least m, but not more than n occurrences of the preceding subexpression
Matching Character Matches any character in list ... List Non-Matching Character List Or Subexpression or Grouping Backreference Escape Character Beginning of Line Anchor Matches any character not in list ... 'a|b' matches character 'a' or 'b'. Treat expression ... as a unit. The subexpression can be a string of literals or a complex expression containing operators. Matches the nth preceding subexpression, where n is an integer from 1 to 9. Treat the subsequent metacharacter in the expression as a literal. Match the subsequent expression only when it occurs at the beginning of a line.
\n \ ^
12-4
Table 122
(Cont.) Metacharacters Supported in Regular Expressions Operator Name End of Line Anchor POSIX Character Class POSIX Collating Sequence Description Match the preceding expression only when it occurs at the end of a line. Match any character belonging to the specified character class. Can be used inside any list expression. Specifies a collating sequence to use in the regular expression. The element you use must be a defined collating sequence, in the current locale. Match characters having the same base character as the character you specify.
[.element.]
[=character=]
One or MorePlus
The one or more operator '+' matches one or more occurrences of the preceding expression. For example, to find one or more occurrences of the character 'a', you use the regular expression:
a+
12-6
ab?c
Zero or MoreStar
The zero or more operator '*', matches zero or more occurrences of the preceding character or subexpression. For example, to find'a', followed by zero or more occurrences of 'b', then followed by 'c'use the regular expression:
ab*c
IntervalExact Count
The exact-count interval operator is specified with a single digit enclosed in braces. You use this operator to search for an exact number of occurrences of the preceding character or subexpression. For example, to find where 'a' occurs exactly 5 times, you specify the regular expression:
a{5}
IntervalBetween Count
You use the between-count interval operator to search for a number of occurrences within a specified range. For example, to find where 'a' occurs at least 3 times and no more than 5 times, you use the following regular expression:
a{3,5}
12-8
This expression matches the first character in each of the following strings:
at bet cot
The following regular expression operators are allowed within the character list, any other metacharacters included in a character list lose their special meaning (are treated as literals):
I I I I
Range operator '-' POSIX character class [: :] POSIX collating sequence [. .] POSIX character equivalence class [= =]
This expression matches characters 'd' and 'g' in the following strings:
abcdef ghi
As with the matching character list, the following regular expression operators are allowed within the non-matching character list (any other metacharacters included in a character list are ignored):
I I I
For example, the following regular expression excludes any character between 'a' and 'i' from the search result:
[^a-i]
This expression matches the characters 'j' and 'l' in the following strings:
hijk lmn
Or
Use the Or operator '|' to specify an alternate expression. For example to match 'a' or 'b', use the following regular expression:
a|b
Subexpression
You can use the subexpression operator to group characters that you want to find as a string or to create a complex expression. For example, to find the optional string 'abc', followed by 'def', use the following regular expression:
(abc)?def
This expression matches strings 'abcdef' and 'def' in the following strings:
abcdefghi defghi
Backreference
The backreference lets you search for a repeated expression. You specify a backreference with '\n', where n is an integer from 1 to 9 indicating the nth preceding subexpression in your regular expression.
For example, to find a repeated occurrence of either string 'abc' or 'def', use the following regular expression:
(abc|def)\1
The backreference counts subexpressions from left to right starting with the opening parenthesis of each preceding subexpression. The backreference lets you search for a repeated string without knowing the actual string ahead of time. For example, the regular expression:
^(.*)\1$
Escape Character
Use the escape character '\' to search for a character that is normally treated as a metacharacter. For example to search for the '+' character, use the following regular expression:
\+
This expression matches the plus character '+' in the following string:
abc+def
12-11
^def
The expression does not return a match for the following string:
abcdefghi
Note that the character class must occur within a character list, so the character class is always nested within the brackets for the character list in the regular expression.
See Also: Mastering Regular Expressions published by O'Reilly & Associates, Inc. for more information on POSIX character classes
You can use the collating sequence operator in any regular expression where collation is needed. For example, to specify the range from 'a' to 'ch', you can use the following expression:
[a-[.ch.]]
12-13
This expression matches both 'N' and '' in the following string:
El Nio
Note:
I
The character equivalence class must occur within a character list, so the character equivalence class is always nested within the brackets for the character list in the regular expression. Usage of character equivalents depends on how canonical rules are defined for your database locale. See the Oracle Database Globalization Support Guide for more information on linguistic sorting and string searching.
13
Developing Web Applications with PL/SQL
If you think that only new languages such as Java and JavaScript can do network operations and produce dynamic Web content, think again. PL/SQL has a number of features that you can use to Web-enable your database and make your back-office data interactive and accessible to intranet users or your customers. This chapter discusses the following topics:
I I I I I I I I
PL/SQL Web Applications PL/SQL Gateway PL/SQL Web Toolkit Generating HTML Output from PL/SQL Passing Parameters to a PL/SQL Web Application Performing Network Operations within PL/SQL Stored Procedures Embedding PL/SQL Code in Web Pages (PL/SQL Server Pages) Enabling PL/SQL Web Applications for XML
13-2
PL/SQL Gateway
PL/SQL Gateway a set of Web-server features that let you use PL/SQL stored procedures to process Web-browser (HTTP) requests and generate responses. A browser request in this context is a URL that represents a PL/SQL procedure call with actual parameter values. PL/SQL Gateway translates the URL, calls the stored procedure with the parameters, and returns output (typically HTML) from the procedure to the client Web browser. In Oracle Database 10g, mod_plsql is a plug-in to Oracle HTTP Server that implements PL/SQL Gateway (mod_plsql is also supplied as part of Oracle Application Server).
PL/SQL Web Toolkit a set of PL/SQL packages that application programmers can use to develop stored procedures that are called by PL/SQL Gateway at runtime. In response to a Web-browser request (URL), such a procedure accesses Oracle Database according to the browser-user input, updating or retrieving database information. It then generates an HTTP response to the browser, typically in the form of a file download or a web page (HTML) to be displayed. The Toolkit API provides ways for a stored procedure to obtain information about an HTTP request, generate HTTP headers such as content-type and mime-type, set browser cookies, and generate HTML pages.
PL/SQL Gateway
PL/SQL Gateway provides support for deploying PL/SQL-based database applications on the World-Wide Web. It is part of Oracle HTTP Server (OHS), which ships with Oracle Application Server and Oracle Database. As part of the Oracle HTTP Server, it is the job of PL/SQL Gateway to interpret a URL sent by a Web browser to a Web server, call the appropriate PL/SQL subprograms to treat the browser request, then return the generated response to the browser. Typically, PL/SQL Gateway responds to a Web-browser HTTP request by constructing an HTML page to display. There are additional uses for the gateway, however. Here are two:
I
Transfer files from a client machine to or from Oracle Database. You can upload and download text files or binary files. See "Uploading and Downloading Files With PL/SQL Gateway". Perform custom user authentication in Web applications. See "Custom Authentication With PL/SQL Gateway".
PL/SQL Gateway
Configuring mod_plsql
As a plug-in to Oracle HTTP Server, mod_plsql causes stored procedures to be executed in response to HTTP requests. For each URL that is processed, mod_plsql either uses a database session from its connection pool, or creates a new session on the fly and pools it. In order that mod_ plsql can invoke the appropriate database PL/SQL procedure in a URL-processing session, you must first configure a virtual path and associate that path with a Database Access Descriptor (DAD). A DAD is a named set of configuration values that specify the information necessary to create a session for a specific database and a specific database user/password. This includes the database service name and the Globalization Support setting (language, currency symbol, and so on) for the session.
See Also:
I I
mod_plsql User's Guide Oracle HTTP Server Administrator's Guide for information on mod_plsql configuration parameters "Using Caching with PL/SQL Web Applications" in Oracle Application Server 10g Performance Guide for information on caching dynamically generated HTML pages to improve performance
13-4
PL/SQL Gateway
Define a PL/SQL procedure that calls wpg_docload.download_ file(file_name) to download file file_name. Define a virtual path for document downloads in the DAD configuration, and associate a user-defined procedure with that path. When PL/SQL Gateway detects the virtual path it automatically invokes the user-defined procedure, which in turn must call wpg_docload.download_file(file_name) to download file file_name. Use the Direct BLOB Download mechanism to download a BLOB from any database table. You do this by calling a PL/SQL procedure that streams the standard HTTP headers, such as mime-type and content-length, and then invokes wpg_docload.download_file(blob_name) to download BLOB blob_name.
See Also: RFC 1867, "Form-Based File Upload in HTML" (IETF)
Once mod_plsql is logged in, authentication control is passed back to the application, by calling an application-level PL/SQL hook. This callback function is implemented by the application developers. The value returned by the callback function determines whether authentication succeeds or fails: TRUE means success; FALSE means failure. Depending on what kind of custom authentication is desired, you can place the authentication function in different locations:
I
Global OWA invokes the same authentication function for all users and all procedures. Custom OWA invokes a different authentication function for each user and for each procedure. Individual-Package OWA invokes the same authentication function for all users, but only for anonymous procedures or procedures in a specific package. For example, using Custom OWA, an authorization function might verify that a user has logged in as user guest with password welcome, or it might check the user's IP address to determine access.
See Also: mod_plsql User's Guide
htf
13-6
(Cont.) Some Packages in PL/SQL Toolkit Description Functions and procedures that enable the PL/SQL Gateway cache feature, to improve the performance of your PL/SQL Web application. You can use this package to enable expires-based and validation-based caching using the PL/SQL Gateway file system.
owa_cookie
Subprograms that send and retrieve HTTP cookies to and from a client Web browser. Cookies are strings a browser uses to maintain state between HTTP calls. State can be maintained throughout a client session or longer if a cookie expiration date is included. The authorize function used by cookies. See "Uploading and Downloading Files With PL/SQL Gateway". Subprograms that obtain the coordinates where a user clicked an image. Use this package when you have an image map whose destination links invoke a PL/SQL Gateway. Subprograms that impose database optimistic locking strategies, to prevent lost updates. Lost updates can otherwise occur if a user selects, and then attempts to update, a row whose values have been changed in the meantime by another user.
owa_custom owa_image
owa_opt_lock
Subprograms that perform string matching and string manipulation with regular expression functionality. Subprograms used by the PL/SQL Gateway for authenticating requests. Subprograms used by package owa_pattern for manipulating strings. You can also use them directly. Utility subprograms:
I
Dynamic SQL utilities to produce pages with dynamically generated SQL code. HTML utilities to retrieve the values of CGI environment variables and perform URL redirects. Date utilities for correct date-handling. Date values are simple strings in HTML, but must be properly treated as an Oracle Database datatype.
(Cont.) Some Packages in PL/SQL Toolkit Description Subprograms that download documents from a document repository that you define using the DAD configuration. See "Uploading and Downloading Files With PL/SQL Gateway".
wpg_docload
You can learn the API calls corresponding to each tag, or just use some of the basic ones like HTP.PRINT to print the text and tags together:
htp.print('<html>'); htp.print('<head>'); htp.print('<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html">'); htp.print('<title>Title of the HTML File</title>'); htp.print('</head>'); htp.print('<body TEXT="#000000" BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF">'); htp.print('<h1>Heading in the HTML File</h1>'); htp.print('<p>Some text in the HTML file.'); htp.print('</body>');
13-8
htp.print('</html>');
This chapter introduces an additional method, PL/SQL server pages, that lets you build on your knowledge of HTML tags, rather than learning a new set of function calls. In an application written as a set of PL/SQL server pages, you can still use functions from the PL/SQL Web toolkit to simplify the processing involved in displaying tables, storing persistent data (cookies), and working with CGI protocol internals.
Using HTML form tags. The user fills in a form on one Web page, and all the data and choices are transmitted to a stored procedure when the user clicks the Submit button on the page. Hard-coded in the URL. The user clicks on a link, and a set of predefined parameters are transmitted to a stored procedure. Typically, you would include separate links on your Web page for all the choices that the user might want.
side using dynamic HTML or Java, and format it correctly for the user or prompt them to enter it again. For example:
I
You might prevent the user from entering alphabetic characters in a numeric entry field, or from entering characters once a length limit is reached. You might silently remove spaces and dashes from a credit card number if the stored procedure expects the value in that format. You might inform the user immediately when they type a number that is too large, so that they can retype it.
Because you cannot always rely on such validation to succeed, code the stored procedures to deal with these cases anyway. Rather than forcing the user to use the Back button when they enter wrong data, display a single page with an error message and the original form with all the other values filled in. For sensitive information such as passwords, a special form of the entry field, <INPUT TYPE=PASSWORD>, hides the text as it is typed in. For example, the following procedure accepts two strings as input. The first time it is called, the user sees a simple form prompting for the input values. When the user submits the information, the same procedure is called again to check if the input is correct. If the input is OK, the procedure processes it. If not, the procedure prompts for new input, filling in the original values for the user.
-- Store a name and associated zip code in the database. CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE associate_name_with_zipcode ( name VARCHAR2 DEFAULT NULL, zip VARCHAR2 DEFAULT NULL ) AS booktitle VARCHAR2(256); BEGIN -- Both entry fields must contain a value. The zip code must be 6 characters. -- (In a real program you would perform more extensive checking.) IF name IS NOT NULL AND zip IS NOT NULL AND length(zip) = 6 THEN store_name_and_zipcode(name, zip); htp.print(<p>The person || name || has the zip code || zip || .); -- If the input was OK, we stop here and the user does not see the form again. RETURN; END IF; -- If some data was entered, but it is not correct, show the error message.
13-11
IF (name IS NULL AND zip IS NOT NULL) OR (name IS NOT NULL AND zip IS NULL) OR (zip IS NOT NULL AND length(zip) != 6) THEN htp.print(<p><b>Please re-enter the data. Fill in all fields, and use a 6-digit zip code.</b>); END IF; -- If the user has not entered any data, or entered bad data, prompt for -- input values. -- Make the form call the same procedure to check the input values. htp.formOpen( scott.associate_name_with_zipcode, GET); htp.print(<p>Enter your name:</td>); htp.print(<td valign=center><input type=text name=name value=" || name || ">); htp.print(<p>Enter your zip code:</td>); htp.print(<td valign=center><input type=text name=zip value=" || zip || ">); htp.formSubmit(NULL, Submit); htp.formClose; END; / show errors;
Sending a "cookie" containing the persistent information to the browser. The browser then sends this same information back to the server when accessing other Web pages from the same site. Cookies are set and retrieved through the HTTP headers that are transferred between the browser and the Web server before the HTML text of each Web page.
Storing the information in the database itself, where later stored procedures can retrieve it. This technique involves some extra overhead on the database server, and you must still find a way to keep track of each user as multiple users access the server at the same time.
Use a DEFAULT clause in all parameter declarations, to prevent an exception when the stored procedure is called with a missing form parameter. You can set the default to zero for numeric values (when that makes sense), and use
13-13
DEFAULT NULL when you want to check whether or not the user actually specifies a value.
I
Before using an input parameter value that has a DEFAULT NULL declaration, check if it is null. Make the procedure generate sensible results even when not all input parameters are specified. You might leave some sections out of a report, or display a text string or image in a report to indicate where parameters were not specified. Provide a way to fill in the missing values and run the stored procedure again, directly from the results page. For example, you could include a link that calls the same stored procedure with an additional parameter, or display the original form with its values filled in as part of the output.
13-15
Control the details of the HTTP session, including header lines, cookies, redirects, proxy servers, IDs and passwords for protected sites, and CGI parameters through the GET or POST methods. Speed up multiple accesses to the same Web site using HTTP 1.1 persistent connections. Construct and interpret URLs for use with UTL_HTTP through the ESCAPE and UNESCAPE functions in the UTL_URL package.
Typically, developers have used Java or Perl to perform these operations; this package lets you do them with PL/SQL.
CREATE OR REPLACE PROCEDURE show_url ( url IN VARCHAR2, username IN VARCHAR2 DEFAULT NULL, password IN VARCHAR2 DEFAULT NULL ) AS req utl_http.req; resp utl_http.resp; name VARCHAR2(256); value VARCHAR2(1024); data VARCHAR2(255);
my_scheme VARCHAR2(256); my_realm VARCHAR2(256); my_proxy BOOLEAN; BEGIN -- When going through a firewall, pass requests through this host. -- Specify sites inside the firewall that don't need the proxy host. utl_http.set_proxy('proxy.my-company.com', 'corp.my-company.com'); -- Ask UTL_HTTP not to raise an exception for 4xx and 5xx status codes, -- rather than just returning the text of the error page. utl_http.set_response_error_check(FALSE); -- Begin retrieving this Web page. req := utl_http.begin_request(url); -- Identify ourselves. Some sites serve special pages for particular browsers. utl_http.set_header(req, 'User-Agent', 'Mozilla/4.0'); -- Specify a user ID and password for pages that require them. IF (username IS NOT NULL) THEN utl_http.set_authentication(req, username, password); END IF; BEGIN -- Start receiving the HTML text. resp := utl_http.get_response(req); -- Show the status codes and reason phrase of the response. dbms_output.put_line('HTTP response status code: ' || resp.status_code); dbms_output.put_line('HTTP response reason phrase: ' || resp.reason_phrase); -- Look for client-side error and report it. IF (resp.status_code >= 400) AND (resp.status_code <= 499) THEN -- Detect whether the page is password protected, and we didn't supply -- the right authorization. IF (resp.status_code = utl_http.HTTP_UNAUTHORIZED) THEN utl_http.get_authentication(resp, my_scheme, my_realm, my_proxy); IF (my_proxy) THEN dbms_output.put_line('Web proxy server is protected.'); dbms_output.put('Please supply the required ' || my_scheme || ' authentication username/password for realm ' || my_realm || ' for the proxy server.'); ELSE dbms_output.put_line('Web page ' || url || ' is protected.');
13-17
dbms_output.put('Please supplied the required ' || my_scheme || ' authentication username/password for realm ' || my_realm || ' for the Web page.'); END IF; ELSE dbms_output.put_line('Check the URL.'); END IF; utl_http.end_response(resp); RETURN; -- Look for server-side error and report it. ELSIF (resp.status_code >= 500) AND (resp.status_code <= 599) THEN dbms_output.put_line('Check if the Web site is up.'); utl_http.end_response(resp); RETURN; END IF; -- The HTTP header lines contain information about cookies, character sets, -- and other data that client and server can use to customize each session. FOR i IN 1..utl_http.get_header_count(resp) LOOP utl_http.get_header(resp, i, name, value); dbms_output.put_line(name || ': ' || value); END LOOP; -- Keep reading lines until no more are left and an exception is raised. LOOP utl_http.read_line(resp, value); dbms_output.put_line(value); END LOOP; EXCEPTION WHEN utl_http.end_of_body THEN utl_http.end_response(resp); END; END; / SET serveroutput ON -- The following URLs illustrate the use of this procedure, -- but these pages do not actually exist. To test, substitute -- URLs from your own Web server. exec show_url('http://www.oracle.com/no-such-page.html') exec show_url('http://www.oracle.com/protected-page.html')
Working with Tables, Image Maps, Cookies, and CGI Variables from PL/SQL
Packages for all of these functions are supplied with Oracle8i and higher. You use these packages in combination with the mod_plsql plug-in of Oracle HTTP Server (OHS). You can format the results of a query in an HTML table, produce an image map, set and get HTTP cookies, check the values of CGI variables, and combine other typical Web operations with a PL/SQL program. Documentation for these packages is not part of the database documentation library. The location of the documentation depends on the particular application server you are running. To get started with these packages, look at their procedure names and parameters using the SQL*Plus DESCRIBE command:
DESCRIBE HTP; DESCRIBE HTF; DESCRIBE OWA_UTIL;
13-19
I I
Writing the Code and Content for the PL/SQL Server Page Loading the PL/SQL Server Page into the Database as a Stored Procedure
By writing an HTML page with embedded PL/SQL code and compiling it as a PL/SQL server page. You may call procedures from the PL/SQL Web Toolkit, but not to generate every line of HTML output. By writing a complete stored procedure that produces HTML by calling the HTP and OWA_* packages in the PL/SQL Web Toolkit.
If you have a large body of HTML, and want to include dynamic content or make it the front end of a database application, use PSP. If you have a large body of PL/SQL code that produces formatted output, you may find it more convenient to produce HTML tags by changing your print statements to call the HTP package of the PL/SQL Web Toolkit.
What is the fastest and most convenient authoring environment for your group?
I I
If most work is done using HTML authoring tools, use PSP. If you use authoring tools that produce PL/SQL code, such as the page-building wizards in Oracle Application Server Portal, then it might be less convenient to use PSP.
PSP uses the same script tag syntax as Java Server Pages (JSP), to make it easy to switch back and forth. PSP uses syntax similar to that of Active Server Pages (ASP), although the syntax is not identical and you must typically translate from VBScript or JScript to PL/SQL. The best candidates for migration are pages that use the Active Data Object (ADO) interface to do database operations.
Writing the Code and Content for the PL/SQL Server Page
You can start with an existing Web page, or with an existing stored procedure. Either way, with a few additions and changes you can create dynamic Web pages that perform database operations and display the results.
In the simplest case, it is nothing more than an HTML file. Compiling it as a PL/SQL server page produces a stored procedure that outputs the exact same HTML file. In the most complex case, it is a PL/SQL procedure that generates all the content of the Web page, including the tags for title, body, and headings. In the typical case, it is a mix of HTML (providing the static parts of the page) and PL/SQL (filling in the dynamic content).
The order and placement of the PSP directives and declarations is not significant in most cases -- only when another file is being included. For ease of maintenance, we recommend placing the directives and declarations together near the beginning of the file. The following sections discuss the way to produce various results using the PSP scripting elements. If you are familiar with dynamic HTML and want to start coding right away, you can jump forward to Syntax of PL/SQL Server Page Elements on page 13-27 and "Examples of PL/SQL Server Pages" on page 13-31.
13-21
Displaying HTML
The PL/SQL parts of the page are enclosed within special delimiters. All other content is passed along verbatim -- including any whitespace -- to the browser. To display text or HTML tags, write it as you would a typical Web page. You do not need to call any output function. Sometimes you might want to display one line of output or another, or change the value of an attribute, based on some condition. You can include IF/THEN logic and variable substitution inside the PSP delimiters, as shown in subsequent sections.
browser, include a <%@ page charset="encoding" %> directive. Specify Shift_JIS, Big5, UTF-8, or another encoding that the browser or other client program recognizes. You must also configure the character set setting in the database accessor descriptor (DAD) of the Web gateway. Users may have to select the same encoding in their browsers to see the data displayed properly. For example, a database in Japan might have a database character set that uses the EUC encoding, while the Web browsers are set up to display Shift_JIS encoding.
13-23
<%@ include file="filename" %> directive at the point where the other file's content should appear. Because the files are processed at the point where you load the stored procedure into the database, the substitution is done only once, not whenever the page is served. You can use any names and extensions for the included files. If the included files contain PL/SQL scripting code, they do not need their own set of directives to identify the procedure name, character set, and so on. When specifying the names of files to the PSP loader, you must include the names of all included files also. Specify the names of included files before the names of any .psp files. You can use this feature to pull in the same content, such as a navigation banner, into many different files. Or, you can use it as a macro capability to include the same section of script code in more than one place in a page.
The content between the <%= %> delimiters is processed by the HTP.PRN function, which trims any leading or trailing whitespace and requires that you quote any literal strings.
These comments do not appear in the HTML output from the PSP. To create a comment that is visible in the HTML output, place the comment in the HTML portion and use the regular HTML comment syntax:
<!-- Comment text -->
To include a comment inside a PL/SQL block within a PSP, you can use the normal PL/SQL comment syntax. For example, here is part of a PSP file showing several kinds of comments:
<p>Today we introduce our new model XP-10. <%-This is the project with code name "Secret Project". People viewing the HTML page will not see this comment. --%> <!-Some pictures of the XP-10. People viewing the HTML page will see this comment. --> <%
13-25
for image_file in (select pathname, width, height, description from image_library where model_num = 'XP-10') -- Comments interspersed with PL/SQL statements. -- People viewing the HTML page will not see this comment. loop %> <img src="<%= image_file.pathname %>" width=<% image_file.width %> height=<% image_file.height %> alt="<% image_file.description %>"> <br> <% end loop; %>
If you want to print out an entire database table in one operation, you can call the OWA_UTIL.TABLEPRINT or OWA_UTIL.CELLSPRINT procedures from the PL/SQL Web toolkit:
<% OWA_UTIL.TABLEPRINT(CTABLE => 'some_table', CATTRIBUTES => 'border=2', CCOLUMNS => 'col1, col2', CCLAUSES => 'WHERE col1 > 5'); %> htp.tableOpen('border=2'); owa_util.cellsprint( 'select col1, col2 from some_table where col1 > 5'); htp.tableClose;
Page Directive
Specifies characteristics of the PL/SQL server page:
I I I
What scripting language it uses. What type of information (MIME type) it produces. What code to run to handle all uncaught exceptions. This might be an HTML file with a friendly message, renamed to a .psp file. You must specify this same file name in the loadpsp command that compiles the main PSP file. You must specify exactly the same name in both the errorPage directive and in the loadpsp command, including any relative path name such as ../include/.
Note that the attribute names contentType and errorPage are case-sensitive. Syntax
<%@ page [language="PL/SQL"] [contentType="content type string"] charset="encoding" [errorPage="file.psp"] %>
Procedure Directive
Specifies the name of the stored procedure produced by the PSP file. By default, the name is the filename without the .psp extension. Syntax
<%@ plsql procedure="procedure name" %>
13-27
Parameter Directive
Specifies the name, and optionally the type and default, for each parameter expected by the PSP stored procedure. The parameters are passed using name-value pairs, typically from an HTML form. To specify a default value of a character type, use single quotes around the value, inside the double quotes required by the directive. For example:
<%@ parameter="username" type="varchar2" default="'nobody'" %>
Syntax
<%@ plsql parameter="parameter name" [type="PL/SQL type"] [default="value"] %>
Include Directive
Specifies the name of a file to be included at a specific point in the PSP file. The file must have an extension other than .psp. It can contain HTML, PSP script elements, or a combination of both. The name resolution and file inclusion happens when the PSP file is loaded into the database as a stored procedure, so any changes to the file after that are not reflected when the stored procedure is run. You must specify exactly the same name in both the include directive and in the loadpsp command, including any relative path name such as ../include/. Syntax
<%@ include file="path name" %>
Declaration Block
Declares a set of PL/SQL variables that are visible throughout the page, not just within the next BEGIN/END block. This element typically spans multiple lines, with individual PL/SQL variable declarations ended by semicolons. Syntax
<%! PL/SQL declaration; [ PL/SQL declaration; ] ... %>
by semicolons. The statements can include complete blocks, or can be the bracketing parts of IF/THEN/ELSE or BEGIN/END blocks. When a code block is split into multiple scriptlets, you can put HTML or other directives in the middle, and those pieces are conditionally executed when the stored procedure is run. Syntax
<% PL/SQL statement; [ PL/SQL statement; ] ... %>
Expression Block
Specifies a single PL/SQL expression, such as a string, arithmetic expression, function call, or combination of those things. The result is substituted as a string at that spot in the HTML page that is produced by the stored procedure. You do not need to end the PL/SQL expression with a semicolon. Syntax
<%= PL/SQL expression %>
Loading the PL/SQL Server Page into the Database as a Stored Procedure
You load one or more PSP files into the database as stored procedures. Each .psp file corresponds to one stored procedure. The pages are compiled and loaded in one step, to speed up the development cycle:
loadpsp [ -replace ] -user username/password[@connect_string] [ include_file_name ... ] [ error_file_name ] psp_file_name ...
To do a "create and replace" on the stored procedures, include the -replace flag. The loader logs on to the database using the specified user name, password, and connect string. The stored procedures are created in the corresponding schema. Include the names of all the include files (whose names do not have the .psp extension) before the names of the PL/SQL server pages (whose names have the .psp extension). Also include the name of the file specified in the errorPage attribute of the page directive. These filenames on the loadpsp command line must match exactly the names specified within the PSP include and page directives, including any relative path name such as ../include/. For example:
13-29
In this example:
I
The stored procedure is created in the database orcl. The database is accessed as user scott with password tiger, both to create the stored procedure and when the stored procedure is executed. banner.inc is a file containing boilerplate text and script code, that is included by the .psp file. The inclusion happens when the PSP is loaded into the database, not when the stored procedure is executed. error.psp is a file containing code, text, or both that is processed when an unhandled exception occurs, to present a friendly page rather than an internal error message. display_order.psp contains the main code and text for the Web page. By default, the corresponding stored procedure is named DISPLAY_ORDER.
The METHOD=GET format is more convenient for debugging and allows visitors to pass exactly the same parameters when they return to the page through a bookmark. The METHOD=POST format allows a larger volume of parameter data, and is suitable for passing sensitive information that should not be displayed in the URL. (URLs linger on in the browser's history list and in the HTTP headers that are passed to the next-visited page.) It is not practical to bookmark pages that are called this way.
Sample Table
In this example, we use a very small table representing a product catalog. It holds the name of an item, the price, and URLs for a description and picture of the item.
Name ---------PRODUCT PRICE URL PICTURE Type ------------VARCHAR2(100) NUMBER(7,2) VARCHAR2(200) VARCHAR2(200)
13-31
http://promo.fictional_site.com/alarmclock.jpg
We could adjust the SELECT statement to retrieve only a subset of the rows or columns. We could change the HTML or the location of the expressions to change the appearance of each item, or the order in which the columns are shown. At this early stage, we pick a very simple presentation, a set of list items, to avoid any problems from mismatched or unclosed table tags.
<%@ plsql procedure="show_catalog_raw" %> <HTML> <HEAD><TITLE>Show Contents of Catalog (Raw Form)</TITLE></HEAD> <BODY> <UL> <% for item in (select * from catalog order by price desc) loop %> <LI>
Item = <%= item.product %><BR> price = <%= item.price %><BR> URL = <I><%= item.url %></I><BR> picture = <I><%= item.picture %></I> <% end loop; %> </UL> </BODY> </HTML>
Once the previous simple example is working, we can display the contents in a more usable format.
I I
We use some HTML tags around certain values for emphasis. Instead of printing the URLs for the description and picture, we plug them into link and image tags so that the reader can see the picture and follow the link.
<%@ plsql procedure="show_catalog_pretty" %> <HTML> <HEAD><TITLE>Show Contents of Catalog (Better Form)</TITLE></HEAD> <BODY> <UL> <% for item in (select * from catalog order by price desc) loop %> <LI> Item = <A HREF="<%= item.url %>"><%= item.product %></A><BR> price = <BIG><%= item.price %></BIG><BR> <IMG SRC="<%= item.picture %>"> <% end loop; %> </UL> </BODY> </HTML>
To liven up the page, we can make it accept a minimum price, and present only the items that are more expensive. (Your customers' buying criteria may vary.) When the page is displayed in a browser, by default the minimum price is 100 units of the appropriate currency. Later, we will see how to allow the user to pick a minimum price.
13-33
<%@ plsql parameter="minprice" default="100" %> <HTML> <HEAD><TITLE>Show Items Greater Than Specified Price</TITLE></HEAD> <BODY> <P>This report shows the items whose price is greater than <%= minprice %>. <UL> <% for item in (select * from catalog where price > minprice order by price desc) loop %> <LI> Item = <A HREF="<%= item.url %>"><%= item.product %></A><BR> price = <BIG><%= item.price %></BIG><BR> <IMG SRC="<%= item.picture %>"> <% end loop; %> </UL> </BODY> </HTML>
This technique of filtering results is fine for some applications, such as search results, where users might worry about being overwhelmed by choices. But in a retail situation, you might want to use an alternative technique so that customers can still choose to purchase other items.
I
Instead of filtering the results through a WHERE clause, we can retrieve the entire result set, then take different actions for different returned rows. We can change the HTML to highlight the output that meets their criteria. In this case, we use the background color for an HTML table row. We could also insert a special icon, increase the font size, or use some other technique to call attention to the most important rows. At this point, where we want to present a specific user experience, it becomes worth the trouble to lay out the results in an HTML table.
<%@ plsql procedure="show_catalog_highlighted" %> <%@ plsql parameter="minprice" default="100" %> <%! color varchar2(7); %> <HTML> <HEAD><TITLE>Show Items Greater Than Specified Price</TITLE></HEAD> <BODY> <P>This report shows all items, highlighting those whose price is greater than <%= minprice %>. <TABLE BORDER> <TR> <TH>Product</TH>
<TH>Price</TH> <TH>Picture</TH> </TR> <% for item in (select * from catalog order by price desc) loop if item.price > minprice then color := #CCCCFF; else color := #CCCCCC; end if; %> <TR BGCOLOR="<%= color %>"> <TD><A HREF="<%= item.url %>"><%= item.product %></A></TD> <TD><BIG><%= item.price %></BIG></TD> <TD><IMG SRC="<%= item.picture %>"></TD> </TR> <% end loop; %> </TABLE> </BODY> </HTML>
13-35
produce with tools and programming languages. It is part of an HTML file, delimited by <FORM> and </FORM> tags, where someone can make choices and enter data, then transmit those choices to a server-side program using the CGI protocol. To produce a complete application using PSP, you might need to learn the syntax of <INPUT>, <SELECT>, and other HTML tags related to forms.
// --> </script> </head> <body text="#000000" bgcolor="#FFFFFF"> <h1>Usage Statistics</h1> <table border=1> <% -- For each day, count how many times each procedure was called. for item in (select trunc(time_stamp) t, count(*) n, procname p from audit_table group by trunc(time_stamp), procname order by trunc(time_stamp) desc, procname) loop -- At the start of each day's data, print the date. if item.t != last_timestamp then htp.print('<tr><td colspan=2><font size="+2">'); htp.print(htf.bold(item.t)); htp.print('</font></td></tr>'); last_timestamp := item.t; end if; %> <tr><td><%= item.p %></a>: <td> <!-- Render an image of variable width to represent the data value. --> <script language="JavaScript"> <!-graph(<%= item.n %>) // --> </script> </td> </tr> <% end loop; %> </table> </body> </html>
13-37
Coding this procedure as a regular PL/SQL stored procedure would result in convoluted lines with doubled apostrophes, such as this:
htp.print('preamble = "<img src=''/images/graph_line.gif'' height=''8'' width=''"');
The first step is to get all the PL/SQL syntax and PSP directive syntax right. If you make a mistake here, the file does not compile.
I I
Make sure you use semicolons to terminate lines where required. If a value must be quoted, quote it. You might need to enclose a single-quoted value (needed by PL/SQL) inside double quotes (needed by PSP). Mistakes in the PSP directives are usually reported through PL/SQL syntax messages. Check that your directives use the right syntax, that directives are closed properly, and that you are using the right element (declaration, expression, or code block) depending on what goes inside it. PSP attribute names are case-sensitive. Most are specified in all lowercase; contentType and errorPage must be specified as mixed-case.
The next step is to run the PSP file by requesting its URL in a Web browser. At this point, you might get an error that the file is not found.
I
Make sure you are requesting the right virtual path, depending on the way the Web gateway is configured. Typically, the path includes the hostname, optionally a port number, the schema name, and the name of the stored procedure (with no .psp extension). Remember, if you use the -replace option when compiling the file, the old version of the stored procedure is erased. So, after a failed compilation, you must fix the error or the page is not available. You might want to test new scripts in a separate schema until they are ready, then load them into the production schema. If you copied the file from another file, remember to change any procedure name directives in the source to match the new file name. Once you get one file-not-found error, make sure to request the latest version of the page the next time. The error page might be cached by the
browser. You might need to press Shift-Reload in the browser to bypass its cache.
I
When the PSP script is run, and the results come back to the browser, use standard debugging techniques to check for and correct wrong output. The tricky part is to set up the interface between different HTML forms, scripts, and CGI programs so that all the right values are passed into your page. The page might return an error because of a parameter mismatch.
I
To see exactly what is being passed to your page, use METHOD=GET in the calling form so that the parameters are visible in the URL. Make sure that the form or CGI program that calls your page passes the correct number of parameters, and that the names specified by the NAME= attributes on the form match the parameter names in the PSP file. If the form includes any hidden input fields, or uses the NAME= attribute on the Submit or Reset buttons, the PSP file must declare equivalent parameters. Make sure that the parameters can be cast from string into the correct PL/SQL types. For example, do not include alphabetic characters if the parameter in the PSP file is declared as a NUMBER. Make sure that the query string of the URL consists of name-value pairs, separated by equals signs, especially if you are passing parameters by constructing a hard-coded link to the page. If you are passing a lot of parameter data, such as large strings, you might exceed the volume that can be passed with METHOD=GET. You can switch to METHOD=POST in the calling form without changing your PSP file. Although the loadpsp command reports line numbers correctly when there is a syntax error in your source file, line numbers reported for runtime errors refer to a transformed version of the source and do not match the line numbers in the original source. When you encounter errors like these, that produce an error trace instead of the expected Web page, you will need to locate the error through exception handlers and by printing debug output.
Pages can be rendered faster in the browser if the HEIGHT= and WIDTH= attributes are specified for all images. You might standardize on picture sizes, or
13-39
store the height and width of images in the database along with the data or URL.
I
For viewers who turn off graphics, or who use alternative browsers that read the text out loud, include a description of significant images using the ALT= attribute. You might store the description in the database along with the image. Although an HTML table provides a good way to display data, a large table can make your application seem slow. Often, the reader sees a blank page until the entire table is downloaded. If the amount of data in an HTML table is large, consider splitting the output into multiple tables. If you set text, font, or background colors, test your application with different combinations of browser color settings:
I
Test what happens if you override just the foreground color in the browser, or just the background color, or both. Generally, if you set one color (such as the foreground text color), you should set all the colors through the <BODY> tag, to avoid hard-to-read combinations like white text on a white background. If you use a background image, specify a similar background color to provide proper contrast for viewers who do not load graphics. If the information conveyed by different colors is crucial, consider using some other method instead of or in addition to the color change. For example, you might put a graphic icon next to special items in a table. Some of your viewers may see your page on a monochrome screen, or on browsers that cannot represent different colors. (Such browsers might fit in a shirt pocket and use a stylus for input.)
Providing context information prevents users from getting lost. Include a descriptive <TITLE> tag for your page. If the user is partway through a procedure, indicate which step is represented by your page. Provide links to logical points to continue with the procedure, return to a previous step, or cancel the procedure completely. Many pages might use a standard set of links that you embed using the include directive. In any entry fields, users might enter incorrect values. Where possible, use select lists to present a set of choices. Validate any text entered in a field before passing it to SQL. The earlier you can validate, the better; a JavaScript routine can detect incorrect data and prompt the user to correct it before they press the Submit button and make a call to the database.
Browsers tend to be lenient when displaying incorrect HTML. But what looks OK in one browser might look bad or might not display at all in another browser.
I
Pay attention to HTML rules for quotation marks, closing tags, and especially for anything to do with tables. Minimize the dependence on tags that are only supported by a single browser. Sometimes you can provide an extra bonus using such tags, but your application should still be usable with other browsers. You can check the validity, and even in some cases the usability, of your HTML for free at many sites on the World Wide Web.
13-41
14
Porting Non-Oracle Applications to Oracle Database 10g
Often, a programming project requires adapting existing code rather than writing new code. When that code comes from some other database platform, it is important to understand the Oracle Database features that are designed to make porting easy. Topics include the following:
I I I
Performing Natural Joins and Inner Joins Migrating a Schema and Data from Another Database System Performing Several Comparisons within a Query
The standard notation makes the relations between the tables explicit, and saves you from coding equality tests for join conditions in the WHERE clause. Support for full outer joins also eliminates the need for complex workarounds to do those queries. Because different vendors support varying amounts of standard join syntax, and some vendors introduce their own syntax extensions, you might still need to rewrite some join queries. See Oracle Database SQL Reference for full syntax of the SELECT statement and the support for join notation.
14-2
This technique helps performance when you can replace a call to a PL/SQL function with a test done directly in SQL. Oracle Database supports the SQL-92 notation for searched case, simple case, NULLIF, and COALESCE.
I
This construct lets you test a variable against a number of different alternatives, and return a different value in each case. The final value is used when none of the alternatives is matched. The CASE technique is more portable, and is preferable for new code.
14-4
15
Using Flashback Features
This chapter discusses the following flashback topics:
I I I I I I I I
Overview of Flashback Features Database Administration Tasks Before Using Flashback Features Using Flashback Query (SELECT ... AS OF) Using the DBMS_FLASHBACK Package Using ORA_ROWSCN Using Flashback Version Query Using Flashback Transaction Query Flashback Tips
See Also:
I
Oracle Database Backup and Recovery Advanced User's Guide and Oracle Database Administrator's Guide for information on flashback features designed for database administration tasks, such as Oracle Flashback Database and Oracle Flashback Table Oracle Database SQL Reference for the syntax of SQL extensions for flashback features
Perform queries that return past data. Perform queries that return metadata showing a detailed history of changes to the database. Recover tables or individual rows to a previous point in time.
Flashback features use the Automatic Undo Management system to obtain metadata and historical data for transactions. They rely on undo data: records of the effects of individual transactions. Undo data is persistent and survives a database malfunction or shutdown. Using flashback features, you employ undo data to query past data or recover from logical corruptions. Besides your use of it in flashback operations, undo data is used by Oracle Database to do the following:
I I I
rollback active transactions recover terminated transactions using database or process recovery provide read consistency for SQL queries
See Also: Oracle Database Concepts for more information about flashback features and automatic undo management
Oracle Flashback Query - retrieve data for a time in the past that you specify using the AS OF clause of the SELECT statement. Oracle Flashback Version Query - retrieve metadata and historical data for a specific time interval. You can view all the rows of a table that ever existed during a given time interval. Metadata about the different versions of rows includes start and end time, type of change operation, and identity of the transaction that created the row version. You use the VERSIONS BETWEEN clause of the SELECT statement to create a Flashback Version Query.
15-2
Oracle Flashback Transaction Query - retrieve metadata and historical data for a given transaction, or for all transactions within a given time interval. You can also obtain the SQL code to undo the changes to particular rows affected by a transaction. You typically use Flashback Transaction Query in conjunction with a Flashback Version Query that provides the transaction IDs for the rows of interest. To perform a Flashback Transaction Query, you select from the FLASHBACK_TRANSACTION_QUERY view. DBMS_FLASHBACK package set the clock back to a time in the past, to examine data current at that time.
Oracle Flashback Table - recover a table to its state at a previous point in time. You can restore table data while the database is on line, undoing changes to only the specified table. Oracle Flashback Drop - recover a dropped table. This reverses the effects of a DROP TABLE statement. Oracle Flashback Database quickly return the database to an earlier point in time, by undoing all of the changes that have taken place since then. This is fast, because you do not have to restore database backups.
Flashback Database, Flashback Table, and Flashback Drop are primarily provided as data recovery mechanisms and are therefore documented elsewhere. The other flashback features, while valuable in data recovery scenarios, are also used in contexts such as application development. They are therefore the focus of this chapter.
See Also:
I I
Oracle Database Backup and Recovery Advanced User's Guide Oracle Database Administrator's Guide, Chapter "Using Flashback Drop and Managing the Recycle Bin", for information on the Flashback Drop feature Oracle Database Administrator's Guide, Chapter "Recovering Tables Using the Flashback Table Feature", for information on the Flashback Table feature Oracle Database Administrator's Guide, Chapter "Auditing Table Changes Using Flashback Transaction Query", for information on Automatic Undo Management
Create an undo tablespace with enough space to keep the required data for flashback operations. The more often the data is updated, the more space is required. Calculating the space requirements is usually performed by a database administrator; you can find the calculation formula in the Oracle Database Administrator's Guide. Enable Automatic Undo Management see Oracle Database Administrator's Guide. In particular, this involves setting the following database configuration parameters: UNDO_MANAGEMENT, UNDO_TABLESPACE, and UNDO_RETENTION. Set the RETENTION GUARANTEE clause for the undo tablespace, to ensure that unexpired undo is not discarded UNDO_RETENTION is not, by itself, a strict guarantee. If the system is under space pressure, then unexpired undo may be overwritten with freshly generated undo; RETENTION GUARANTEE prevents this. Grant flashback privileges to users, roles, or applications that need to use flashback features, as follows:
I
DBMS_FLASHBACK package Grant EXECUTE privilege on DBMS_ FLASHBACK to provide access to the features in this package.
15-4
Flashback Query and Flashback Version Query Grant FLASHBACK and SELECT privileges on specific objects to be accessed during queries, or grant the FLASHBACK ANY TABLE privilege to allow queries on all tables. Flashback Transaction Query Grant the SELECT ANY TRANSACTION privilege. Execution of undo SQL code Grant SELECT, UPDATE, DELETE, and INSERT privileges for specific tables, as appropriate, to permit execution of undo SQL code retrieved by a Flashback Transaction Query.
To enable flashback operations on specific LOB columns of a table, use the ALTER TABLE command with the RETENTION option. Because undo data for LOB columns can be voluminous, you must define which LOB columns to use with flashback operations.
See Also:
I
Oracle Database Backup and Recovery Advanced User's Guide and Oracle Database Administrator's Guide for information on DBA tasks such as setting up automatic undo management and granting privileges Oracle Database Application Developer's Guide - Large Objects for information on LOB storage and the RETENTION parameter
Recovering lost data or undoing incorrect, committed changes. For example, if you mistakenly delete or update rows, and then commit them, you can immediately repair the mistake. Comparing current data with the corresponding data at some time in the past. For example, you might run a daily report that shows the change in data from yesterday. You can compare individual rows of table data, or find intersections or unions of sets of rows. Checking the state of transactional data at a particular time. For example, you could verify the account balance of a certain day.
Simplifying application design, by removing the need to store some kinds of temporal data. Using a Flashback Query, you can retrieve past data directly from the database. Applying packaged applications, such as report generation tools, to past data. Providing self-service error correction for an application, enabling users to undo and correct their errors.
See Also: Oracle Database SQL Reference for details on the syntax
I I
You can specify or omit the AS OF clause for each table, and specify different times for different tables. Use an AS OF clause in a query to perform DDL operations (such as creating and truncating tables) or DML operations (such as inserting and deleting) in the same session as the query.
15-6
To use the results of a Flashback Query in a DDL or DML statement that affects the current state of the database, use an AS OF clause inside an INSERT or CREATE TABLE AS SELECT statement. When choosing whether to use a timestamp or an SCN in Flashback Query, remember that Oracle Database uses SCNs internally and maps these to timestamps at a granularity of 3 seconds. If a possible 3-second error (maximum) is important to a Flashback Query in your application, use an SCN instead of a timestamp. See "Flashback Tips General". You can create a view that refers to past data by using the AS OF clause in the SELECT statement that defines the view. If you specify a relative time by subtracting from SYSDATE, the past time is recalculated for each query. For example:
CREATE VIEW hour_ago AS SELECT * FROM employee AS OF TIMESTAMP (SYSTIMESTAMP - INTERVAL '60' MINUTE);
Note that shortly after a change in daylight savings time, SYSDATE - 1 might refer to either 23 or 25 hours ago, not 24.
I
You can use the AS OF clause in self-joins, or in set operations such as INTERSECT and MINUS, in order to extract or compare data from two different times. You can store the results by preceding a Flashback Query with a CREATE TABLE AS SELECT or INSERT INTO TABLE SELECT statement. For example, this query re-inserts into table employee the rows that were present there an hour ago:
INSERT INTO employee (SELECT * FROM employee AS OF TIMESTAMP (SYSTIMESTAMP - INTERVAL '60' MINUTE)) MINUS SELECT * FROM employee);
reuse existing PL/SQL code, without change, to interrogate the database at times in the past. You must have the EXECUTE privilege on the DBMS_FLASHBACK package. To use the DBMS_FLASHBACK package in your PL/SQL code:
1.
Call DBMS_FLASHBACK.ENABLE_AT_TIME or DBMS_FLASHBACK.ENABLE_ AT_SYSTEM_CHANGE_NUMBER to turn back the clock to a given time in the past. After this, all queries retrieve data that was current at the specified time. Perform normal queries (that is, without any special flashback-feature syntax, such as AS OF). The database is automatically queried at the specified past time. Perform only queries; do not try to perform DDL or DML operations. Call DBMS_FLASHBACK.DISABLE to return to the present. (You must call DISABLE before calling ENABLE... again for a different time. You cannot nest ENABLE /DISABLE pairs.)
2.
3.
You can use a cursor to store the results of queries into the past. To do this, open the cursor before calling DBMS_FLASHBACK.DISABLE. After storing the results and then calling DISABLE, you can do the following:
I
Perform INSERT or UPDATE operations, to modify the current database state using the stored results from the past. Compare current data with the past data: After calling DISABLE, open a second cursor. Fetch from the first cursor to retrieve past data; fetch from the second cursor to retrieve current data. You can store the past data in a temporary table, and then use set operators such as MINUS or UNION to contrast or combine the past and current data.
You can call DBMS_FLASHBACK.GET_SYSTEM_CHANGE_NUMBER at any time to obtain the current System Change Number (SCN). Note that the current SCN is always returned; this takes no account of previous calls to DBMS_ FLASHBACK.ENABLE*.
See Also:
I
PL/SQL Packages and Types Reference for details about the DBMS_ FLASHBACK package Oracle Database Reference and Oracle Database Recovery Manager Reference for information about SCNs
15-8
Using ORA_ROWSCN
Using ORA_ROWSCN
ORA_ROWSCN is a pseudocolumn of any table that is not fixed or external. It represents the SCN of the most recent change to a given row; that is, the latest COMMIT operation for the row. For example:
SQL> SELECT ora_rowscn, name, salary FROM employee WHERE empno = 7788; ORA_ROWSCN ---------202553 NAME ---Fudd SALARY -----3000
The latest COMMIT operation for the row took place at approximately SCN 202553. (You can use function SCN_TO_TIMESTAMP to convert an SCN, like ORA_ROWSCN, to the corresponding TIMESTAMP value.) ORA_SCN is in fact a conservative upper bound of the latest commit time: the actual commit SCN can be somewhat earlier. ORA_SCN is more precise (closer to the actual commit SCN) for a row-dependent table (created using CREATE TABLE with the ROWDEPENDENCIES clause). Noteworthy uses of ORA_ROWSCN in application development include concurrency control and client cache invalidation. To see how you might use it in concurrency control, consider the following scenario. Your application examines a row of data, and records the corresponding ORA_ ROWSCN as 202553. Later, the application needs to update the row, but only if its record of the data is still accurate. That is, this particular update operation depends, logically, on the row not having been changed. The operation is therefore made conditional on the ORA_ROWSCN being still 202553. Here is an equivalent interactive command:
SQL> UPDATE employee SET salary = salary + 100 WHERE empno = 7788 AND ora_rowscn = 202553; 0 rows updated.
The conditional update fails in this case, because the ORA_ROWSCN is no longer 202553. This means that some user or another application changed the row and performed a COMMIT more recently than the recorded ORA_ROWSCN. Your application queries again to obtain the new row data and ORA_ROWSCN. Suppose that the ORA_ROWSCN is now 415639. The application tries the conditional update again, using the new ORA_ROWSCN. This time, the update succeeds, and it is committed. Here is an interactive equivalent:
SQL> UPDATE employee SET salary = salary + 100 WHERE empno = 7788 AND ora_rowscn = 415639; 1 row updated. SQL> COMMIT; Commit complete. SQL> SELECT ora_rowscn, name, salary FROM employee WHERE empno = 7788; ORA_ROWSCN ---------465461 NAME ---Fudd SALARY -----3100
The SCN corresponding to the new COMMIT is 465461. Besides using ORA_ROWSCN in an UPDATE statement WHERE clause, you can use it in a DELETE statement WHERE clause or the AS OF clause of a Flashback Query.
See Also:
I
where start and end are expressions representing the start and end of the time interval to be queried, respectively. The interval is closed at both ends: the upper and lower limits specified (start and end) are both included in the time interval. The Flashback Version Query returns a table with a row for each version of the row that existed at any time during the time interval you specify. Each row in the table includes pseudocolumns of metadata about the row version, described in Table 151. This information can reveal when and how a particular change (perhaps erroneous) occurred to your database.
Table 151
Flashback Version Query Row Data Pseudocolumns Description Starting System Change Number (SCN) or TIMESTAMP when the row version was created. This identifies the time when the data first took on the values reflected in the row version. You can use this to identify the past target time for a Flashback Table or Flashback Query operation. If this is NULL, then the row version was created before the lower time bound of the query BETWEEN clause.
VERSIONS_ENDSCN, VERSIONS_ENDTIME
SCN or TIMESTAMP when the row version expired. This identifies the row expiration time. If this is NULL, then either the row version was still current at the time of the query or the row corresponds to a DELETE operation.
VERSIONS_XID VERSIONS_OPERATION
Identifier of the transaction that created the row version. Operation performed by the transaction: I for insertion, D for deletion, or U for update. The version is that of the row that was inserted, deleted, or updated; that is, the row after an INSERT operation, the row before a DELETE operation, or the row affected by an UPDATE operation. Note: For user updates of an index key, a Flashback Version Query may treat an UPDATE operation as two operations, DELETE plus INSERT, represented as two version rows with a D followed by an I VERSIONS_OPERATION.
A given row version is valid starting at its time VERSIONS_START* up to, but not including, its time VERSIONS_END*. That is, it is valid for any time t such that VERSIONS_START* <= t < VERSIONS_END*. For example, the following output indicates that the salary was 10243 from September 9, 2002, included, to November 25, 2003, not included.
VERSIONS_START_TIME ------------------09-SEP-2003 VERSIONS_END_TIME ----------------25-NOV-2003 SALARY -----10243
15-11
VERSIONS BETWEEN TIMESTAMP TO_TIMESTAMP('2003-07-18 14:00:00', 'YYYY-MM-DD HH24:MI:SS') AND TO_TIMESTAMP('2003-07-18 17:00:00', 'YYYY-MM-DD HH24:MI:SS') WHERE name = 'JOE';
Pseudocolumn VERSIONS_XID provides a unique identifier for the transaction that put the data in that state. You can use this value in connection with a Flashback Transaction Query to locate metadata about this transaction in the FLASHBACK_ TRANSACTION_QUERY view, including the SQL required to undo the row change and the user responsible for the change see "Using Flashback Transaction Query" on page 15-12.
See Also: Oracle Database SQL Reference for information on the
Flashback Version Query pseudocolumns and the syntax of the VERSIONS clause
As an example, the following statement queries the FLASHBACK_TRANSACTION_ QUERY view for transaction information, including the transaction ID, the operation, the operation start and end SCNs, the user responsible for the operation, and the SQL code to undo the operation:
SELECT xid, operation, start_scn,commit_scn, logon_user, undo_sql FROM flashback_transaction_query WHERE xid = HEXTORAW('000200030000002D');
As another example, the following query uses a Flashback Version Query as a subquery to associate each row version with the LOGON_USER responsible for the row data change.
SELECT xid, logon_user FROM flashback_transaction_query WHERE xid IN (SELECT versions_xid FROM employee VERSIONS BETWEEN TIMESTAMP
At this point, emp and dept have one row each. In terms of row versions, each table has one version of one row. Next, suppose that an erroneous transaction deletes employee id 111 from table emp:
UPDATE emp SET salary = salary + 100 where empno = 111; INSERT INTO dept VALUES (20, 'Finance'); DELETE FROM emp WHERE empno = 111; COMMIT;
Subsequently, a new transaction reinserts employee id 111 with a new employee name into the emp table.
INSERT INTO emp VALUES (111, 'Tom', 777); UPDATE emp SET salary = salary + 100 WHERE empno = 111; UPDATE emp SET salary = salary + 50 WHERE empno = 111; COMMIT;
At this point, the DBA detects the application error and needs to diagnose the problem. The DBA issues the following query to retrieve versions of the rows in the emp table that correspond to empno 111. The query uses Flashback Version Query pseudocolumns.
connect dba_name/password SELECT versions_xid XID, versions_startscn START_SCN, versions_endscn END_SCN, versions_operation OPERATION,
15-13
empname, salary FROM hr.emp VERSIONS BETWEEN SCN MINVALUE AND MAXVALUE where empno = 111; XID ---------------0004000700000058 000200030000002D 000200030000002E 3 rows selected START_SCN END_SCN ---------- --------113855 113564 112670 113564 OPERATION ---------I D I EMPNAME ---------Tom Mike Mike SALARY ---------927 555 555
The results table reads chronologically, from bottom to top. The third row corresponds to the version of the row in emp that was originally inserted in the table when the table was created. The second row corresponds to the row in emp that was deleted by the erroneous transaction. The first row corresponds to the version of the row in emp that was reinserted with a new employee name. The DBA identifies transaction 000200030000002D as the erroneous transaction and issues the following Flashback Transaction Query to audit all changes made by this transaction:
SELECT xid, start_scn START, commit_scn COMMIT, operation OP, logon_user USER, undo_sql FROM flashback_transaction_query WHERE xid = HEXTORAW('000200030000002D');
XID START COMMIT OP USER UNDO_SQL ---------------- ---------- ------------------------------000200030000002D 195243 195244 DELETE HR insert into "HR"."EMP" ("EMPNO","EMPNAME","SALARY") values ('111','Mike','655'); 000200030000002D 195243 195244 INSERT where ROWID = 'AAAKD4AABAAAJ3BAAB'; HR delete from "HR"."DEPT"
000200030000002D 195243 195244 UPDATE HR update "HR"."EMP" set "SALARY" = '555' where ROWID = 'AAAKD2AABAAAJ29AAA'; 000200030000002D 4 rows selected 195243 113565 BEGIN HR
The rightmost column (undo_sql) contains the SQL code that will undo the corresponding change operation. The DBA can execute this code to undo the changes made by that transaction. The USER column (logon_user) shows the user responsible for the transaction.
Flashback Tips
A DBA might also be interested in knowing all changes made in a certain time window. In our scenario, the DBA performs the following query to view the details of all transactions that executed since the erroneous transaction identified earlier (including the erroneous transaction itself):
SELECT xid, start_scn, commit_scn, operation, table_name, table_owner FROM flashback_transaction_query WHERE table_owner = 'HR' AND start_timestamp >= TO_TIMESTAMP ('2002-04-16 11:00:00','YYYY-MM-DD HH:MI:SS'); XID ---------------0004000700000058 0004000700000058 0004000700000058 000200030000002D 000200030000002D 000200030000002D 6 rows selected START_SCN --------195245 195245 195245 195243 195243 195243 COMMIT_SCN ---------195246 195246 195246 195244 195244 195244 OPERATION --------UPDATE UPDATE INSERT DELETE INSERT UPDATE TABLE_NAME ---------EMP EMP EMP EMP DEPT EMP TABLE_OWNER ----------HR HR HR HR HR HR
Flashback Tips
The following tips and restrictions apply to using flashback features.
For better performance, generate statistics on all tables involved in a Flashback Query by using the DBMS_STATS package, and keep the statistics current. Flashback Query always uses the cost-based optimizer, which relies on these statistics. The performance of a query into the past depends on how much undo data must be accessed. For better performance, use queries to select small sets of past data using indexes, not to scan entire tables. If you must do a full table scan, consider adding a parallel hint to the query. The performance cost in I/O is the cost of paging in data and undo blocks that are not already in the buffer cache. The performance cost in CPU use is the cost of applying undo information to affected data blocks. When operating on changes in the recent past, flashback features essentially CPU bound.
15-15
Flashback Tips
Use index structures for Flashback Version Query: the database keeps undo data for index changes as well as data changes. Performance of index lookup-based Flashback Version Query is an order of magnitude faster than the full table scans that are otherwise needed. In a Flashback Transaction Query, the type of the xid column is RAW(8). To take advantage of the index built on the xid column, use the HEXTORAW conversion function: HEXTORAW(xid). Flashback Query against a materialized view does not take advantage of query rewrite optimizations.
See Also: Oracle Database Performance Tuning Guide
Use the DBMS_FLASHBACK package or other flashback features? Use ENABLE/DISABLE calls to the DBMS_FLASHBACK package around SQL code that you do not control, or when you want to use the same past time for several consecutive queries. Use Flashback Query, Flashback Version Query, or Flashback Transaction Query for SQL that you write, for convenience. A Flashback Query, for example, is flexible enough to do comparisons and store results in a single query. To obtain an SCN to use later with a flashback feature, use DBMS_ FLASHBACK.GET_SYSTEM_CHANGE_NUMBER. You can compute or retrieve a past time to use in a query by using a function return value as a timestamp or SCN argument. For example, you can perform date and time calculations by adding or subtracting an INTERVAL value to the value of the SYSTIMESTAMP function. You can query locally or remotely (Flashback Query, Flashback Version Query, or Flashback Transaction Query). for example here is a remote Flashback Query:
(SELECT * FROM employee@some_remote_host AS OF TIMESTAMP (SYSTIMESTAMP - INTERVAL '60' MINUTE);
To ensure database consistency, always perform a COMMIT or ROLLBACK operation before querying past data. Remember that all flashback processing is done using the current session settings, such as national language and character set, not the settings that were in effect at the time being queried.
Flashback Tips
Some DDLs that alter the structure of a table, such as drop/modify column, move table, drop partition, and truncate table/partition, invalidate any existing undo data for the table. It is not possible to retrieve data from a point earlier than the time such DDLs were executed. Trying such a query results in error ORA-1466. This restriction does not apply to DDL operations that alter the storage attributes of a table, such as PCTFREE, INITTRANS and MAXTRANS. Use an SCN to query past data at a precise time. If you use a timestamp, the actual time queried might be up to 3 seconds earlier than the time you specify. Internally, Oracle Database uses SCNs; these are mapped to timestamps at a granularity of every 3 seconds. For example, assume that the SCN values 1000 and 1005 are mapped to the times 8:41 and 8:46 AM respectively. A query for a time between 8:41:00 and 8:45:59 AM is mapped to SCN 1000; a Flashback Query for 8:46 AM is mapped to SCN 1005. Due to this time-to-SCN mapping, if you specify a time that is slightly after a DDL operation (such as a table creation) the database might actually use an SCN that is just before the DDL operation. This can result in error ORA-1466.
You cannot retrieve past data from a V$ view in the data dictionary. Performing a query on such a view always returns the current data. You can, however, perform queries on past data in other views of the data dictionary, such as USER_TABLES.
15-17
Flashback Tips
16
Using Oracle XA with Transaction Monitors
This chapter describes how to use the Oracle XA library, which is typically used in applications that work with transaction monitors. The XA features are most useful in applications where transactions interact with more than one database. The Oracle XA library is an external interface that allows global transactions to be coordinated by a transaction manager other than that of Oracle Database. This allows inclusion of non-Oracle Database entities called resource managers (RM) in distributed transactions. The Oracle XA library conforms to the X/Open Distributed Transaction Processing (DTP) software architecture's XA interface specification. The chapter includes the following topics:
I I I I I I I I I
X/Open Distributed Transaction Processing (DTP) XA and the Two-Phase Commit Protocol Transaction Processing Monitors (TPMs) Support for Dynamic and Static Registration Oracle XA Library Interface Subroutines Developing and Installing Applications That Use the XA Libraries Troubleshooting XA Applications XA Issues and Restrictions Changes to Oracle XA Support
See Also:
I
X/Open CAE Specification - Distributed Transaction Processing: The XA Specification for a general overview of XA, including basic architecture. You can obtain a copy of this document by requesting X/Open Document No. XO/CAE/91/300 or ISBN 1 872630 24 3 from X/Open Company, Ltd., 1010 El Camino Real, Suite 380, Menlo Park, CA 94025, U.S.A. Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide for background and reference information about the Oracle XA library The Oracle Database platform-specific documentation for information on library linking filenames File README.doc, located in a directory specified in the Oracle Database platform-specific documentation for a description of changes, bugs, and restrictions in the Oracle XA library for your platform. Various XA files can be found at %ORACLE_ HOME%/rdbms/demo.
16-2
A TM is usually a component provided by a transaction processing monitor (TPM) vendor. The TM assigns identifiers to transactions, and monitors and coordinates their progress. It uses Oracle XA library subroutines to tell Oracle Database how to process the transaction, based on its knowledge of all RMs in the transaction. You can find a list of the XA subroutines and their descriptions later in this section. An application program (AP) defines transaction boundaries and specifies actions that constitute a transaction. For example, an AP can be a precompiler or OCI program. The AP operates on the RM's resource through the RM's native interface, for example SQL. However, it starts and completes all transaction operations through the transaction manager through an interface called TX. The AP itself does not directly use the XA interface
Figure 161 One Possible DTP Model
TX Interface Application Program
Oracle
Other Resources
subroutines are vendor-specific, and may differ from those used here. For example, you may find that the tx_open call is referred to as tp_open on your system. To check terminology, see the documentation supplied with the transaction processing monitor.
xa_switch_t structures
The Oracle Database xa_switch_t structure name for static registration is xaosw. The Oracle Database xa_ switch_t structure name for dynamic registration is xaoswd. These structures contain entry points and other information for the resource manager. The Oracle Database resource manager name within the xa_switch_t structure is Oracle_XA. The close string used by xa_close() is ignored and is allowed to be null. The format of the open string used by xa_open() is described in detail in "Defining the xa_open String" on page 16-9. Libraries needed to link applications using Oracle XA have platform-specific names. It is similar to linking an ordinary precompiler or OCI program except you may have to link any TPM-specific libraries. If you are not using sqllib, then be sure to link with $ORACLE_ HOME/lib/xaonsl.o. None. The functionality to support XA is part of both Standard Edition and Enterprise Edition.
libraries
requirements
16-4
static registration, you must call xa_start for each RM before starting any work, even if some RMs are not involved. To use dynamic registration, both client and server must be at Oracle Database 8.0 or later. Otherwise, you can only use static registration.
Starting a new transaction and associating it with an ID Rolling back a transaction Preparing and committing a transaction
XA Library Subroutines
Available XA Library subroutines are described in Table 161.
Table 161 XA Library Subroutines Description Connects to the resource manager. Disconnects from the resource manager. Starts a new transaction and associate it with the given transaction ID (XID), or associates the process with an existing transaction. Disassociates the process from the given XID. Rolls back the transaction associated with the given XID. Prepares the transaction associated with the given XID. This is the first phase of the two-phase commit protocol. Commits the transaction associated with the given XID. This is the second phase of the two-phase commit protocol.
16-6
Table 161
(Cont.) XA Library Subroutines Description Retrieves a list of prepared, heuristically committed or heuristically rolled back transaction. Forgets the heuristic transaction associated with the given XID.
In general, the AP does not need to worry about these subroutines except to understand the role played by the xa_open string.
OCISvcCtx *xaoSvcCtx(text *dbname): This function returns the OCI service handle for a given XA connection. The dbname parameter must be the same as the dbname parameter passed in the xa_open string. OCI applications can use this routing instead of the sqlld2 calls to obtain the connection handle. Hence, OCI applications need not link with the SQLLIB library. The service handle can be converted to the Version 7 OCI logon data area (LDA) using OCISvcCtxToLda() [Version 8 OCI]. Client applications must remember to convert the Version 7 LDA to a service handle using OCILdaToSvcCtx() after completing the OCI calls.
2.
OCIEnv *xaoEnv(text *dbname): This function returns the OCI environment handle for a given XA connection. The dbname parameter must be the same as the dbname parameter passed in the xa_open string.
3.
int xaosterr(OCISvcCtx *SvcCtx, sb4 error): This function, only applicable to dynamic registration, converts an Oracle Database error code to an XA error code. The first parameter is the service handle used to execute the work in the database. The second parameter is the error code that was returned from Oracle Database. Use this function to determine if the error returned from an OCI command was caused because the xa_start failed. The function returns XA_OK if the error was not generated by the XA module and a valid XA error if the error was generated by the XA module.
Responsibilities of the DBA or System Administrator on page 16-8 Responsibilities of the Application Developer on page 16-9 Defining the xa_open String on page 16-9 Interfacing XA with Precompilers and OCIs on page 16-16 Transaction Control using XA on page 16-19 Migrating Precompiler or OCI Applications to TPM Applications on page 16-21 XA Library Thread Safety on page 16-23
Define the open string, with help from the application developer. This is described in "Defining the xa_open String" on page 16-9.
2.
For Oracle Database Release 8.0: Grant the select privilege to the DBA_PENDING_TRANSACTIONS view for all Oracle Database user(s) specified in the xa_open string.
For Oracle Database Release 7.3: Make sure V$XATRANS$ exists. This view should have been created during the XA library installation. You can manually create the view, if needed, by running the SQL script XAVIEW.SQL. This SQL script should be executed as the Oracle Database user SYS. Grant the SELECT privilege to the V$XATRANS$ view for all Oracle Database accounts which will be used by Oracle XA library applications.
See Also: Your Oracle Database platform-specific documentation for the location of the XAVIEW.SQL script
3.
Install the resource manager, using the open string information, into the TPM configuration, following the TPM vendor instructions.
16-8
The DBA or system administrator should be aware that a TPM system starts the process that connects to Oracle Database. See your TPM documentation to determine what environment exists for the process and what user ID it will have. Be sure that correct values are set for ORACLE_HOME and ORACLE_SID. Next, grant the user ID write permission to the directory in which the XA trace file will be written.
See Also: "Defining the xa_open String" on page 16-9 for
information on how to specify a sid or a trace directory that is different from the defaults Also be sure to grant the user the SELECT privilege on DBA_PENDING_ TRANSACTIONS.
4.
Start up the relevant databases to bring Oracle XA applications on-line. This should be done before starting any TPM servers.
Define the open string with help from the DBA or system administrator. Defining the open string is described later in this section.
2.
Develop the applications. Observe special restrictions on transaction-oriented SQL statements for precompilers.
See Also: "Interfacing XA with Precompilers and OCIs" on page 16-16
3.
I I I
where required_fields is a set of any of the following: Acc=P// Acc=P/user/password SesTm=session_time_limit and where optional_fields is a set of any of the following: NoLocal=true | false RAC_FAILOVER=true | false DB=db_name LogDir=log_dir MaxCur=maximum_#_of_open_cursors Objects=true | false SqlNet=connect_string Loose_Coupling=true | false SesWt=session_wait_limit Threads=true | false
Note:
I
You can enter the required fields and optional fields in any order when constructing the open string. All field names are case insensitive. Their values may or may not be case-sensitive depending on the platform. There is no way to use the plus character (+) as part of the actual information string.
Required Fields
Required fields for the open string are described in this section. Acc=P// or Acc=P/user/password
Syntax Element Acc P P// Description Specifies user access information Indicates that explicit user and password information is provided. Indicates that no explicit user or password information is provided, and that the operating system authentication form will be used. For more information see Oracle Database Administrator's Guide. user password A valid Oracle Database account. The corresponding current password.
For example, Acc=P/scott/tiger indicates that user and password information is provided. In this case, the user is scott and the password is tiger. As previously mentioned, make sure that scott has the SELECT privilege on the DBA_PENDING_TRANSACTIONS table. Acc=P// indicates that no user or password information is provided, thus defaulting to operating system authentication. SesTm=session_time_limit
Syntax Element SesTm Description Specifies the maximum length of time a transaction can be inactive before it is automatically aborted by the system.
16-11
Description This value should be the maximum time allowed in a transaction between one service and the next, or a service and the commit or rollback of the transaction. For example, if the TPM uses remote procedure calls between the client and the servers, then SesTM applies to the time between the completion of one RPC and the initiation of the next RPC, or the tx_commit, or the tx_rollback. The unit for this time limit is in seconds. The value of 0 indicates no limit. For example, SesTM=15 indicates that the session idle time limit is 15 seconds. Entering a value of 0 is strongly discouraged. It might tie up resources for a long time if something goes wrong. Also, if a child process has SesTM=0, the SesTM setting is not effective after the parent process is terminated.
Optional Fields
This section describes optional fields. NoLocal=true | false
Syntax Element Description Specifies whether local transactions are allowed. The default value is false. If the application needs to disallow local transactions, then set the value to true.
RAC_FAILOVER=true | false
Syntax Element Description Specifies whether XA_RECOVER waits until instance recovery finishes. The default value is false (no wait). To force XA_RECOVER to wait until SMON finishes cache recovery, identifies in-doubt transactions, and adds them to the table DBA_2PC_PENDING, set the value to true.
DB=db_name
Syntax Element DB Description Specifies the database name. Indicates the name used by Oracle Database precompilers to identify the database. Application programs that use only the default database for the Oracle Database precompiler (that is, they do not use the AT clause in their SQL statements) should omit the DB=db_name clause in the open string. Applications that use explicitly named databases should indicate that database name in their DB=db_name field. Version 7 OCI programs need to call the sqlld2() function to obtain the correct lda_def, which is the equivalent of a service context. Version 8 OCI programs need to call the xaoSvcCtx function to get the OCISvcCtx service context. The db_name is not the sid and is not used to locate the database to be opened. Rather, it correlates the database opened by this open string with the name used in the application program to execute SQL statements. The sid is set from either the environment variable ORACLE_SID of the TPM application server or the sid given in the Oracle Net clause in the open string. The Oracle Net clause is described later in this section. (Oracle Net was formerly known as SQL*Net and Net8.) Some TPM vendors provide a way to name a group of servers that use the same open string. The DBA may find it convenient to choose the same name both for that purpose and for db_ name.
db_name
For example, DB=payroll indicates that the database name is "payroll", and that the application server program will use that name in AT clauses. LogDir=log_dir
Syntax Element Description Specifies the directory on a local machine where the Oracle XA library error and tracing information may be logged. Indicates the path name of the directory where the tracing information should be stored. The default is $ORACLE_ HOME/rdbms/log if ORACLE_HOME is set; otherwise, it is the current directory.
LogDir log_dir
16-13
For example, LogDir=/xa_trace indicates that the error and tracing information is located under the /xa_trace directory.
Note: Ensure that the directory you specify for logging exists and
MaxCur=maximum_#_of_open_cursors
Syntax Element Description Specifies the number of cursors to be allocated when the database is opened. It serves the same purpose as the precompiler option maxopencursors.
MaxCur
For example, MaxCur=5 indicates that the precompiler should try to keep five open cursors cached.
Note: This parameter overrides the precompiler option
maxopencursors that you might have specified in your source code or at compile time.
See Also: Pro*C/C++ Programmer's Guide
SqlNet=db_link
Syntax Element SqlNet db_link Description Specifies the Oracle Net database link. (Oracle Net was formerly known as SQL*Net and Net8.) Indicates the string to use to log on to the system. The syntax for this string is the same as that used to set the TWO-TASK environment variable.
For example, SqlNet=hqfin@NEWDB indicates the database with sid NEWDB accessed at host hqfin by TCP/IP. The SqlNet parameter can be used to specify the ORACLE_SID in cases where you cannot control the server environment variable. It must also be used when the server needs to access more than one Oracle Database instance. To use the Oracle Net string without actually accessing a remote database, use the Pipe driver. For example:
SqlNet=localsid1
localsid1 is an alias defined in the tnsnames.ora file. Make sure that all databases to be accessed with a Oracle Net database link have an entry in /etc/oratab. SesWt=session_wait_limit
Syntax Element SesWt Description Specifies the time-out limit when waiting for a transaction branch that is being used by another session. The default value is 60 seconds. The number of seconds Oracle Database waits before XA_RETRY is returned.
session_wait_limit
16-15
Threads=true | false
Syntax Element Threads Description Specifies whether the application is multithreaded. The default value is false. If the application is multithreaded, then the setting is true.
true | false
Using precompilers with the default database Using precompilers with a named database
Note that the DB=db_name is absent, indicating an empty database ID string. The syntax of a SQL statement would be:
EXEC SQL UPDATE Emp_tab SET Sal = Sal*1.5;
Note that there is no DB=db_name field in the last open string. In the application server program, you would enter declarations, such as:
EXEC SQL DECLARE PAYROLL DATABASE; EXEC SQL DECLARE MANAGERS DATABASE;
Again, the default connection (corresponding to the third open string that does not contain the db_name field) needs no declaration. When doing the update, you would enter statements similar to the following:
EXEC SQL AT PAYROLL UPDATE Emp_Tab SET Sal=4500 WHERE Empno=7788; EXEC SQL AT MANAGERS UPDATE Emp_Tab SET Mgr=7566 WHERE Empno=7788; EXEC SQL UPDATE Emp_Tab SET Deptno=30 WHERE Empno=7788;
There is no AT clause in the last statement because it is referring to the default database. In Oracle Database precompilers release 1.5.3 or later, you can use a character host variable in the AT clause, as the following example shows:
EXEC SQL BEGIN DECLARE SECTION; DB_NAME1 CHARACTER(10); DB_NAME2 CHARACTER(10); EXEC SQL END DECLARE SECTION; ... SET DB_NAME1 = 'PAYROLL'
16-17
SET DB_NAME2 = 'MANAGERS' ... EXEC SQL AT :DB_NAME1 UPDATE... EXEC SQL AT :DB_NAME2 UPDATE...
Caution: Do not use XA applications to create connections. Any work performed would be outside the global transaction and would have to be committed separately.
This obtains the lda for this resource manager. Alternatively, if DB=db_name is present in the open string, then execute:
sqlld2(lda, db_name, strlen(db_name));
This obtains the lda for this resource manager. Release 8.0 If DB=db_name is not present in the open string, then execute:
xaoSvcCtx(NULL);
xaoSvcCtx(db_name);
This gets the server context for this resource manager. In the same way, you can execute:
xaoEnv(NULL);
or:
xaoEnv(db_name);
Oracle Call Interface Programmer's Guide for more information about using the OCISvcCtx
Most TPM applications are written using a client/server architecture where an application client requests services and an application server provides services. The examples that follow use such a client/server model. A service is a logical unit of
16-19
work, which in the case of Oracle Database as the resource manager, comprises a set of SQL statements that perform a related unit of work. For example, when a service named "credit" receives an account number and the amount to be credited, it executes SQL statements to update information in certain tables in the database. In addition, a service might request other services. For example, a "transfer fund" service might request services from a "credit" and "debit" service. Usually application clients request services from the application servers to perform tasks within a transaction. However, for some TPM systems, the application client itself can offer its own local services. You can encode transaction control statements within either the client or the server; as shown in the examples. To have more than one process participating in the same transaction, the TPM provides a communication API that allows transaction information to flow between the participating processes. Examples of communications APIs include RPC, pseudo-RPC functions, and send/receive functions. Because the leading vendors support different communication functions, the examples that follow use the communication pseudo-function tpm_service to generalize the communications API. X/Open has included several alternative methods for providing communication functions in their preliminary specification. At least one of these alternatives is supported by each of the leading TPM vendors.
Server:
ServiceName()
/*This application server temporarily becomes*/ /*a client and requests another service.*/ tpm_service("AnotherService"); tx_commit(); /*Commit the transaction*/ <return service status back to the client> }
Server:
Service1() { <get service specific data> EXEC SQL UPDATE ....; <return service status back to the client> } Service2() { <get service specific data> EXEC SQL UPDATE ....; ... <return service status back to client> }
Reorganize the application into a framework of "services". This means that application clients request services from application servers.
16-21
Some TPMs require the application to use the tx_open and tx_close functions, whereas other TPMs do the logon and logoff implicitly. If you do not specify the sqlnet parameter in your open string, then the application uses the default Oracle Net driver. Thus, you must be sure that the application server is brought up with the ORACLE_HOME and ORACLE_SID environment variables properly defined. This is accomplished in a TPM-specific fashion. See your TPM vendor documentation for instructions on how to accomplish this.
2.
Ensure that the application replaces the regular connect and disconnect statements. For example, replace the connect statements EXEC SQL CONNECT (for precompilers) or OCISessionBegin() (for OCIs) by tx_open(). Replace the disconnect statements EXEC SQL COMMIT/ROLLBACK WORK RELEASE (for precompilers), or OCISessionEnd() (for OCIs) by tx_close(). The V7 equivalent for OCISessionBegin() was olon() and for OCISessionEnd(), ologof().
3.
Ensure that the application replaces the regular commit/rollback statements and begins the transaction explicitly. For example, replace the commit/rollback statements EXEC SQL COMMIT/ROLLBACK WORK (for precompilers), or ocom()/orol() (for OCIs) by tx_commit()/tx_rollback() and start the transaction by calling tx_begin().
4.
Ensure that the application resets the fetch state before ending a transaction. In general, release_cursor=no should be used. Use release_cursor=yes only when you are certain that a statement will be executed only once.
Table 163 lists the TPM functions that replace regular Oracle Database commands when migrating precompiler or OCI applications to TPM applications.
Table 163 TPM Replacement Commands TPM Functions tx_open (possibly implicit) tx_begin Service that executes the SQL tx_commit tx_rollback tx_close (possibly implicit)
Regular Oracle Database Commands CONNECT user/password implicit start of transaction SQL COMMIT ROLLBACK disconnect
Table 163
establishes a connection, only that thread can use that connection. No other thread can make a call on that connection.
Restrictions on Threading in XA
The following restrictions apply when using threads:
I
Any Pro* or OCI code that executes as part of the application server process on the transaction monitor cannot be threaded unless the transaction monitor is
16-23
Troubleshooting XA Applications
explicitly told when each new application thread is started. This is typically accomplished by using a special C compiler provided by the transaction monitor vendor.
I
The Pro* statements, EXEC SQL ALLOCATE and EXEC SQL USE are not supported. Therefore, when threading is enabled, embedded SQL statements cannot be used across non-XA connections. If one thread in a process connects to Oracle Database through XA, all other threads in the process that connect to Oracle Database must also connect through XA. You cannot connect through EXEC SQL in one thread and through XA in another thread.
Troubleshooting XA Applications
This section discusses how to find information in case of problems or system failure. It also discusses trace files and recovery of pending transactions.
XA Trace Files
The Oracle XA library logs any error and tracing information to its trace file. This information is useful in supplementing the XA error codes. For example, it can indicate whether an xa_open failure is caused by an incorrect open string, failure to find the Oracle Database instance, or a logon authorization failure. The name of the trace file is: xa_db_namedate.trc where db_name is the database name you specified in the open string field DB=db_ name, and date is the date when the information is logged to the trace file. If you do not specify DB=db_name in the open string, then it automatically defaults to the name NULL.
Troubleshooting XA Applications
0x1 Trace the entry and exit to each procedure in the XA interface. This can be useful in seeing exactly what XA calls the TP Monitor is making and what transaction identifier it is generating. 0x2 Trace the entry to and exit from other non-public XA library routines. This is generally of use only to Oracle Database developers. 0x4 Trace various other "interesting" calls made by the XA library, such as specific calls to the Oracle Call Interface. This is generally of use only to Oracle Database developers.
The trace file can be created in the LogDir directory as specified in the open string. If you do not specify LogDir in the open string, then the Oracle XA application attempts to create the trace file in the following directory (provided$ORACLE_ HOME can be located):
I I
If the Oracle XA application cannot determine where $ORACLE_HOME is located, then the trace file is created in the current working directory.
same DB field and LogDir field in their open strings log all trace information that occurs on the same day to the same trace file.
16-25
Troubleshooting XA Applications
Each entry in the trace file contains information that looks like this:
1032.12345.2: 1032.12345.2: ORA-01017: invalid username/password; xaolgn: XAER_INVAL; logon denied logon denied
Where 1032 is the time when the information is logged, 12345 is the process ID (PID), 2 is the resource manager ID, xaolgn is the module name, XAER_INVAL was the error returned as specified in the XA standard, and ORA-1017 is the Oracle Database information that was returned.
Locking data that is required by other transactions Not resolved in a reasonable amount of time
For more information about overriding in-doubt transactions in such circumstances, and about how to decide whether the in-doubt transaction should be committed or rolled back, see the TPM documentation.
The DBID column is always xa_orcl The DBUSER_OWNER column is always db_namexa.oracle.com
Remember that the db_name is always specified as DB=db_name in the open string. If you do not specify this field in the open string, then the value of this column is NULLxa.oracle.com for transactions generated by Oracle XA applications.
For example, you could use the following SQL statement to obtain more information about in-doubt transactions generated by Oracle XA applications.
SELECT * FROM Dba_2pc_pending p, Dba_2pc_neighbors n WHERE p.Local_tran_id = n.Local_tran_id AND n.Dbid = 'xa_orcl';
Alternatively, if you know the format ID used by the transaction processing monitor, then you can use DBA_PENDING_TRANSACTIONS or V$GLOBAL_ TRANSACTIONS. While DBA_PENDING_TRANSACTIONS gives a list of both active and failed prepared transactions, V$GLOBAL_TRANSACTIONS gives a list of all active global transactions.
Use the shared server (formerly known as Multi-Threaded Server) configuration. This means that the transaction processing monitors (TPMs) use shared servers to open the connection to Oracle Database. The operating system network connection required for the database link is opened by the dispatcher, instead of the Oracle Database process. Thus, when a particular service or RPC completes, the transaction can be detached from the server so that it can be used by other services or RPCs.
Access to the other database must use SQL*Net Version 2, Net8, or Oracle Net. (SQL*Net and Net8 are former names of Oracle Net.) The other database being accessed should be another Oracle Database instance.
Assuming that these restrictions are satisfied, Oracle Database allows such links and propagates the transaction protocol (prepare, rollback, and commit) to the other Oracle Database instances.
16-27
Caution: If these restrictions are not satisfied, then when you use database links within an XA transaction, it creates an O/S network connection in the Oracle Database instance that is connected to the TPM server process. Because this O/S network connection cannot be moved from one process to another, you cannot detach from this server. When you access a database through a database link, you receive an ORA#24777 error.
If using the shared server configuration is not possible, then access the remote database through the Pro*C/C++ application using EXEC SQL AT syntax. The parameter open_links_per_instance specifies the number of migratable open database link connections. These dblink connections are used by XA transactions so that the connections are cached after a transaction is committed. Another transaction is free to use the dblink connection provided the user that created the connection is the same as the user who created the transaction. This parameter is different from the open_links parameter, which is the number of dblink connections from a session. The open_links parameter is not applicable to XA applications.
Under normal circumstances, an xa_prepare, xa_rollback, or xa_commit operation performed on a branch must be performed on the same instance that created the branch. This restriction affects load balancing. If load balancing is enabled, it is possible for sequences like the following to be performed on two
different nodes. For this reason, load balancing must not be used for the XA connection. Node 1 1. xa_start
2. 3.
1. 2. 3.
If an error occurs, xa_recover must be performed before any other XA operations. You should open the XA connection with xa_open using option RAC_ FAILOVER=true.
Note: The operation xa_recover cannot be used for switchover in normal operation.
Global uniqueness of transaction IDs (XIDs) is not guaranteed; the TM must maintain the global uniqueness of XIDs. According to the XA specification, the RM must accept XIDs from the TM. However, XA on RAC cannot determine if a given XID is unique throughout the cluster. Suppose, for example, there is a Tx(1).Br(1) on Node 1, and another Tx(1).Br(1) on Node 2. Each of these can start and execute SQL, even though the XID is not unique.
See Also: X/OPEN CAE Specification Distributed Transaction Processing: The XA Specification, ISBN 1 872630 24 3, XOPEN Document Number XO/CAE/91/300
SQL-Based Restrictions
Rollbacks and Commits Because the transaction manager is responsible for coordinating and monitoring the progress of the global transaction, the application should not contain any Oracle
16-29
Database-specific statement that independently rolls back or commits a global transaction. However, you can use rollbacks and commits in a local transaction. Do not use EXEC SQL ROLLBACK WORK for precompiler applications when you are in the middle of a global transaction. Similarly, an OCI application should not execute OCITransRollback(), or the Version 7 equivalent orol(). You can roll back a global transaction by calling tx_rollback(). Similarly, a precompiler application should not have the EXEC SQL COMMIT WORK statement in the middle of a global transaction. An OCI application should not execute OCITransCommit() or the Version 7 equivalent ocom(). Instead, use tx_ commit() or tx_rollback() to end a global transaction. DDL Statements Because a DDL SQL statement, such as CREATE TABLE, implies an implicit commit, the Oracle XA application cannot execute any DDL SQL statements. Session State Oracle Database does not guarantee that session state will be valid between services. For example, if a service updates a session variable (such as a global package variable), then another service that executes as part of the same global transaction may not see the change. Use savepoints only within a service. The application must not refer to a savepoint that was created in another service. Similarly, an application must not attempt to fetch from a cursor that was executed in another service. SET TRANSACTION Do not use the SET TRANSACTION READ ONLY | READ WRITE | USE ROLLBACK SEGMENT SQL statement. Connecting or Disconnecting with EXEC SQL Do not use the EXEC SQL command to connect or disconnect. That is, do not use EXEC SQL COMMIT WORK RELEASE or EXEC SQL ROLLBACK WORK RELEASE.
Transaction Branches
Oracle Database transaction branches within the same global transaction can be coupled tightly or loosely. If they are tightly coupled, then they share locks. However, if the branches are on different instances when running Oracle Real Application Clusters, then they are loosely coupled, and they do not share locks.
In tightly coupled transaction branches, the locks are shared between the transaction branches. This means that updates performed in one transaction branch can be seen in other branches that belong to the same global transaction before the update is committed. Oracle Database obtains the DX lock before executing any statement in a tightly coupled branch. Hence, the advantage of using loosely coupled transaction branches is that there is more concurrency (because a lock is not obtained before the statement is executed). The disadvantage is that all the transaction branches must go through the two phases of commit, that is, XA one phase optimization cannot be used. These trade-offs between tightly coupled branches and loosely coupled branches are described in Table 164.
Table 164 Attribute Two Phase Commit Tightly and Loosely Coupled Transaction Branches Tightly Coupled Branches Loosely Coupled Branches Read-only Optimization [prepare for all branches, commit for last branch] Serialization Database Call Two phases [prepare and commit for all branches] None
Association Migration
Oracle Database does not support association migration (a means whereby a transaction manager may resume a suspended branch association in another branch).
Asynchronous Calls
The optional XA feature asynchronous XA calls is not supported.
Initialization Parameters
Set the transactions init.ora parameter to the expected number of concurrent global transactions. The parameter open_links_per_instance specifies the number of migratable open database link connections. These dblink connections are used by XA transactions so that the connections are cached after a transaction is committed.
See Also: "Database Links" on page 16-27
16-31
Installation
No scripts need be executed to use XA. It is necessary, however, to run the xaview.sql script to run Release 7.3 applications with Oracle Database version 8.X. Grant the SELECT privilege on SYS.DBA_PENDING_TRANSACTIONS to all users that connect to Oracle Database through the XA interface.
Library Compatibility
The XA library supplied with Oracle Database Release 7.3 can be used with Oracle Database Release 8.0 or later. You must use the Release 7.2 XA library with Oracle Database Release 7.2. You can use the 8.0 library with Oracle Database Release 7.3. There is only one case of backward compatibility: an XA application that uses Release 8.0 OCI works with Oracle Database Release 7.3, but only if you use sqlld2 and obtain an lda_def before executing SQL statements. Client applications must remember to convert the Version 7 LDA to a service handle using OCILdaToSvcCtx() after completing the OCI calls. Oracle Database version 8.X does not support 7.1.6 XA calls (although it does support 7.3 XA calls). Thus, 7.1.6 XA calls need to relink Tuxedo applications with XA libraries of Oracle Database version 8.X.
I I I I I I I
Loosely Coupled Transaction Branches Are Supported SQLLIB Is Not Needed for OCI Applications No Installation Script Is Needed to Run XA XA Library Use with Oracle Real Application Clusters Option on All Platforms Transaction Recovery for Oracle Real Application Clusters Has Been Improved Both Global and Local Transactions Are Possible The xa_open String Has Been Modified
16-33
XA Library Use with Oracle Real Application Clusters Option on All Platforms
It was not possible with Version 7 to use the Oracle XA library together with the Oracle Real Application Clusters option on certain platforms. (Only if the platform's implementation of the distributed lock manager supported transaction-based rather than process-based locking would the two work together.) This limitation is no longer the case; if you can run the Oracle Real Application Clusters option, then you can run the Oracle XA library.
Transaction Recovery for Oracle Real Application Clusters Has Been Improved
All transactions can be recovered from any instance of Oracle Real Application Clusters. Use the xa_recover call to provide a snapshot of the pending transactions.
Global transactions, on the other hand, are coordinated by an external transaction manager such as a transaction processing monitor. In these transactions, Oracle Database acts as a subordinate and processes the XA commands issued by the transaction manager. The following update belongs to a global transaction.
xa_open(oracle_xa+acc=p/SCOTT/TIGER+sestm=10", 1, TMNOFLAGS);
/* Transaction manager opens */ /* connection to Oracle Database */ tpbegin(); /* begin global transaction, the transaction*/ /* manager issues XA commands to Oracle Database */ /* to start a global transaction */ UPDATE Emp_tab SET Sal = Sal + 1; /* Update is performed in the */ /* global transaction*/ tpcommit(); /* commit global transaction, */ /* the transaction manager issues XA commands*/ /* to Oracle Database to commit */ /* the global transaction */
The database server for Oracle Database version 7 forbids a local transaction from being started in an XA connection. The following update would return an ORA-2041 error code.
xa_open("oracle_xa+acc=p/SCOTT/TIGER+sestm=10" , 1, /* Transaction manager /*connection to Oracle UPDATE Emp_tab SET Sal = Sal + 1; /* Oracle Databse TMNOFLAGS); opens */ Database */ version 7 returns error */
Oracle Database version 8.X and later allows local transactions to be started in an XA connection. The only restriction is that the local transaction must be committed or rolled back before starting a global transaction in the connection.
Loose_Coupling This parameter has a Boolean value and should be set to false when connected to Oracle Database version 7. If set to true, then global transaction branches are loosely coupled; in other words, locks are not shared between branches.
SesWt This parameter value indicates the time-out limit when waiting for a transaction branch that is being used by another session. If Oracle Database cannot switch to the transaction branch within SesWt seconds, then XA_RETRY is returned.
Two parameters have been made obsolete and should only be used when connected to Oracle Database Release 7.3.
I
GPWD
16-35
The group password is not used by Oracle Database version 8.X or later. A session that is logged in with the same user name as the session that created a transaction branch is allowed to switch to the transaction branch.
I
SesCacheSz This parameter is not used by Oracle Database version 8.X or later because session caching has been eliminated.
Index
Symbols
%ROWTYPE attribute, 7-7 used in stored functions, 7-8 %TYPE attribute, 7-7 ALTER TABLE statement (continued) INITRANS parameter, 5-23 RETENTION option, for flashback, 15-5 ALTER TRIGGER statement DISABLE clause, 9-29 ENABLE clause, 9-29 anonymous PL/SQL blocks about, 7-2 compared to triggers, 7-20 ANSI SQL92 FIPS flagger, 5-2 AnyData datatype, 2-44 AnyDataSet datatype, 2-44 AnyType datatype, 2-44 applications calling stored procedures and packages, 7-45 unhandled exceptions in, 7-38 attributes %rowtype, PL/SQL, 1-5 %type, PL/SQL, 1-5 auditing, triggers and, 9-32 autonomous routine, 5-29 autonomous scope, definition, 5-29 autonomous transactions, 5-28 to 5-36 AUTONOMOUS_TRANSACTION pragma, 5-29
Numerics
3GL, definition, 4GL, definition, 1-4 1-3
A
Active Data Object, translating to PSP, 13-20 Active Server Pages, translating to PSP, 13-20 AFTER SUSPEND event, handling suspended storage allocation, 5-39 AFTER triggers auditing and, 9-33, 9-35 correlation names and, 9-17 specifying, 9-6 agent, definition, 11-4 ALL_ERRORS view, debugging stored procedures, 7-35 ALL_SOURCE view, 7-35 ALTER SESSION statement, SERIALIZABLE clause, 5-23 ALTER TABLE statement defining integrity constraints, 3-18 DISABLE ALL TRIGGERS clause, 9-29 DISABLE CONSTRAINT clause, 3-22 DROP CONSTRAINT clause, 3-25 ENABLE ALL TRIGGERS clause, 9-29 ENABLE CONSTRAINT clause, 3-21
B
BEFORE triggers complex security authorizations, 9-45 correlation names and, 9-17 derived column values, 9-46 specifying, 9-6 BFILE datatype, 2-7, 2-34
Index-1
binary data, RAW and LONG RAW, 2-35 Binary Large Object, 2-34 BINARY_DOUBLE datatype, 2-5, 2-11 BINARY_FLOAT datatype, 2-5, 2-11 binding, bulk, definition, 7-17 blank-padded comparison, 2-10 BLOB datatype, 2-7, 2-34 body of package, definition, 7-13 Boolean expressions, 2-43 bulk binding, definition, 7-17 bulk binds, 7-17 DML statements, 7-18 FOR loops, 7-19 SELECT statements, 7-19 usage, 7-18 BY REF phrase, 8-32 BYTE qualifier for column lengths, 2-9
C
call specifications, 8-4 to 8-53 callbacks, 8-47 to 8-49 canceling a cursor, 5-10 CATPROC.SQL script, 10-2 CC datetime format element, 2-27 century, 2-25 date format masks, 2-21 CGI variables, 13-19 CHAR datatype, 2-4 CHAR qualifier for column lengths, 2-9 character data, 2-8 Character Large Object, 2-34 CHARSETFORM property, 8-28 CHARSETID property, 8-28 CHARTOROWID function, 2-41 CHECK constraint, triggers and, 9-38, 9-43 check constraints, how to use, 3-15 client, definition, 11-4 client events, 10-8 CLOB datatype, 2-5, 2-34 column type attribute, PL/SQL, 1-5 columns accessing in triggers, 9-17 default values, 3-5, 7-51 generating derived values with triggers, 9-46
columns (continued) listing in an UPDATE trigger, 9-6, 9-20 multiple foreign key constraints, 3-11 number of CHECK constraints limit, 3-17 specifying length in bytes or characters, 2-9 COMMIT statement, 5-5 comparison operators blank-padded and non-padded data, 2-10 dates, 2-21 compile-time errors, 7-33 compiling PL/SQL procedures to native code, 7-21 composite keys foreign, 3-8 restricting nulls in, 3-17 concurrency, 5-19 conditional expressions, in WHERE clause, 2-32 conditional predicates, trigger bodies, 9-15, 9-19 connection pooling, 1-23 consistency, read-only transactions, 5-7 constraining tables, 9-22 constraints, See integrity constraints context switches, reducing with bulk binds, 7-17 converting data, 2-40 ANSI datatypes, 2-39 assignments, 2-41 expression evaluation, 2-43 SQL/DS and DB2 datatypes, 2-40 year and century considerations, 2-26 cookies, 13-19 correlation names, 9-14 to 9-19 NEW, 9-17 OLD, 9-17 REFERENCING option and, 9-19 when preceded by a colon, 9-17 CREATE INDEX statement, 4-7 CREATE PACKAGE BODY statement, 7-15 CREATE PACKAGE statement, 7-15 CREATE TABLE statement defining integrity constraints, 3-18 INITRANS parameter in, 5-23 CREATE TRIGGER statement, 9-2 REFERENCING option, 9-19 cursor and cursor variable, definitions, 5-8 cursors, 5-8 canceling, 5-10
Index-2
cursors, 5-8 (continued) closing, 5-10 declaring and opening cursor variables, maximum number of, 5-9 pointers to, 7-30 private SQL areas and, 5-8 custom OWA, definition, 13-6
7-31
D
DAD, definition, 13-4 data blocks, shown in ROWIDs, 2-37 data conversion, See converting data data dictionary compile-time errors, 7-35 integrity constraints in, 3-28 procedure source code, 7-35 data object number, extended ROWID, 2-36, 2-37 data recovery using flashback features, 15-3 Database Access Descriptor, 13-4 datafiles, shown in ROWIDs, 2-37 datatypes, 2-2 ANSI/ISO, 2-39 BFILE, 2-7 BINARY_DOUBLE, 2-5, 2-11 BINARY_FLOAT, 2-5, 2-11 BLOB, 2-7 CHAR, 2-4, 2-8 column length, 2-9 character, 2-8 CLOB, 2-5 column lengths for character types, 2-9 conversion, 2-40 DATE, 2-6, 2-25 DB2, 2-39 INTERVAL DAY TO SECOND, 2-6 INTERVAL YEAR TO MONTH, 2-6 LONG, 2-5, 2-8 LONG RAW, 2-8 MDSYS.SDO_GEOMETRY, 2-33 native floating point, 2-11 native floating-point, IEEE 754 exceptions not raised, 2-15 NCHAR, 2-4, 2-8 NCLOB, 2-5
datatypes, 2-2 (continued) NUMBER, 2-5, 2-11 numeric, 2-11 NVARCHAR2, 2-4, 2-8 RAW, 2-7 ROWID, 2-8, 2-36 SQL/DS, 2-39 TIMESTAMP, 2-6 TIMESTAMP WITH LOCAL TIME ZONE, 2-7 TIMESTAMP WITH TIME ZONE, 2-7 UROWID, 2-8 VARCHAR, See datatypes, VARCHAR2 VARCHAR2, 2-4, 2-8 column length, 2-9 date and time data, representing, 2-20 date arithmetic, 2-43 functions for, 2-22 DATE datatype, 2-6, 2-20 centuries, 2-25 data conversion, 2-41 DB2 datatypes, 2-39 DBA_ERRORS view, debugging stored procedures, 7-35 DBA_SOURCE view, 7-35 DBMS_FLASHBACK package, 15-7 DBMS_LOCK package, 5-17 DBMS_RESUMABLE package, handling suspended storage allocation, 5-39 DBMS_SQL package advantages of, 6-16 client-side programs, 6-16 DESCRIBE, 6-16 differences with native dynamic SQL, 6-11 See also dynamic SQL DBMS_STATS package and Flashback Query, 15-15 DBMS_TYPES package, 2-44 DBMS_XMLGEN package, 2-47 DBMS_XMLQUERY package, 2-47 DBMS_XMLSAVE package, 2-47 DDL statements, package state and, 7-16 DEBUG_EXTPROC package, 8-51 debugging stored procedures, 7-40 triggers, 9-28
Index-3
dedicated external procedure agents, 8-6 default parameters in stored functions, 7-53 definer's-rights procedure, 7-46 DELETE statement column values and triggers, 9-17 data consistency, 5-10 triggers for referential integrity, 9-40, 9-41 denormal floating-point numbers, 2-13 dependencies among PL/SQL library objects, 7-21 in stored triggers, 9-27 schema objects, trigger management, 9-22 timestamp model, 7-22 DESC function, 4-9 deterministic function, definition, 7-56 DETERMINISTIC keyword, 7-56 dictionary_obj_owner event attribute, 10-3 dictionary_obj_owner_list event attribute, 10-3 dictionary_obj_type event attribute, 10-3 disabled integrity constraint, definition, 3-19 disabled trigger, definition, 9-28 disabling integrity constraints, 3-20 triggers, 9-28, 9-29 distributed databases referential integrity and, 3-15 remote stored procedures, 7-47, 7-48 triggers and, 9-22 distributed queries flashback features, 15-16 handling errors, 7-38 distributed transaction processing architecture, 16-2 distributed update, definition, 7-49 DML_LOCKS parameter, 5-11 double datatype, native in C and C++, 2-19 DROP INDEX statement, 4-6 DROP TRIGGER statement, 9-28 dropping indexes, 4-6 integrity constraints, 3-25 packages, 7-11 procedures, 7-11 triggers, 9-28
dynamic SQL application development languages, 6-20 invoker's rights, 6-7 invoking PL/SQL blocks, 6-6 optimization, 6-5 queries, 6-4 scenario, 6-7 usage, 6-3 See also DBMS_SQL package native dynamic SQL dynamic Web pages, 13-19 dynamically typed data, representing, 2-44
E
e-mail, sending from PL/SQL, 13-15 embedded SQL, 7-2 enabled integrity constraint, definition, 3-19 enabled trigger, definition, 9-28 enabling integrity constraints, 3-20 triggers, 9-28 errors application errors raised by Oracle Database packages, 7-36 remote procedures, 7-38 user-defined, 7-35, 7-37 event attribute functions, 10-2 event notification, 10-1, 11-5 event publication, 9-50 to 9-52, 10-1 triggering, 9-50 events attribute, 10-2 client, 10-8 resource manager, 10-7 system, 10-1 tracking, 9-49, 10-1 exception handlers, in PL/SQL, 7-2 exception to a constraint, 3-20 exceptions anonymous blocks, 7-3 during trigger execution, 9-20 effects on applications, 7-38 remote procedures, 7-38
Index-4
exceptions (continued) unhandled, 7-38 exclusive locks, LOCK TABLE statement, 5-15 explicit locks, 5-10 expression filtering, 2-32 expressions, conditional in WHERE clause, 2-32 extended ROWID format, 2-36 external LOB, definition, 2-34 external procedure, 8-3 DBA tasks required, 8-6 DEBUG_EXTPROC package, 8-51 debugging, 8-50 definition, 8-3 maximum number of parameters, 8-53 specifying datatypes, 8-19 extproc process, 8-6, 8-37
fourth-generation computing language, definition, 1-3 full-text search, using Oracle9i Text, 2-34 functions, See PL/SQL functions
G
geographic coordinate data, representing, 2-33 global entity, definition, 7-15 global OWA, definition, 13-6 grantee event attribute, 10-3
H
HEXTORAW function, 2-41 hiding PL/SQL code, 7-20 hostname, 13-16 HTML displaying within PSP files, 13-22 retrieving from PL/SQL, 13-16 HTP and HTF packages, 13-19 HTTP URLs, 13-16
F
features, new, i-xxxvii FIPS flagger, interactive SQL statements and, 5-2 firing of triggers, 9-1 FIXED_DATE initialization parameter, 2-21 flashback features, 15-2 performance, 15-15 flashback privileges, 15-4 Flashback Query, 15-5 DBMS_STATS package, 15-15 Flashback Transaction Query, 15-12 Flashback Version Query, 15-10 FLASHBACK_TRANSACTION_QUERY view, 15-12 float datatype, native in C and C++, 2-19 floating-point numbers, 2-11 FOR EACH ROW clause, 9-13 FORALL statement, using, 7-17 foreign key constraints defining, 3-27 enabling, 3-20, 3-26 NOT NULL constraint and, 3-10 one-to-many relationship, 3-10 one-to-n relationships, 3-10 UNIQUE key constraint and, 3-11 format mask, definition, 2-28 format masks, TO_DATE function, 2-21
I
IBM datatypes, 2-39 IEEE 754 standard for floating-point numbers, image maps, 13-19 IN OUT parameter mode, 7-6 IN parameter mode, 7-6 indexes creating, 4-6 dropping, 4-6 function-based, 4-8 guidelines, 4-3 order of columns, 4-4 privileges, 4-6 SQL*Loader and, 4-3 temporary segments and, 4-3 when to create, 4-2 INDICATOR property, 8-27 -INF and +INF, 2-14 infinity values, 2-14 initialization parameters DML_LOCKS, 5-11 2-12
Index-5
initialization parameters (continued) OPEN_CURSORS, 5-9 REMOTE_DEPENDENCIES_MODE, 7-28 INITRANS parameter, 5-23 INSERT statement column values and triggers, 9-17 read consistency, 5-10 instance_num event attribute, 10-3 INSTEAD OF triggers, 9-8 on nested table view columns, 9-18 integrity constraints CHECK, 3-15 composite UNIQUE keys, 3-7 defining, 3-17 disabling, 3-20, 3-21, 3-22 dropping, 3-25 enabling, 3-19 examples, 3-2 exceptions to, 3-23 listing definitions of, 3-28 naming, 3-19 NOT NULL, 3-3 performance considerations, 3-3 PRIMARY KEY, 3-5 privileges required for creating, 3-19 renaming, 3-24 triggers vs., 9-2, 9-37 UNIQUE, 3-6 violations, 3-20 when to use, 3-2 interactive block execution, 7-44 INTERVAL DAY TO SECOND datatype, 2-6, 2-20 INTERVAL YEAR TO MONTH datatype, 2-6, 2-20 invoker's-rights procedure, 7-46 is_alter_column event attribute, 10-3 ISOLATION LEVEL changing, 5-23 SERIALIZABLE, 5-23
Java (continued) generating wrapper classes with JPublisher, 1-16 JDBC, overview, 1-9 loading into the database, 8-5 SQLJ, overview, 1-13 Java Server Pages, translating to PSP, Javascript, translating to PSP, 13-20 JDBC, See Oracle JDBC JScript, translating to PSP, 13-20
13-20
K
keys foreign, 3-26 unique, composite, 3-7
L
large data, representing with LOBs, 2-34 Large Objects (LOBs), 2-34 libraries, 1-41 library units, remote dependencies, 7-21 loadjava utility, 1-16 loadpsp command, 13-29 LOB datatypes, 1-38, 2-34 external, definition, 2-34 support in OO4O, 1-37 use in triggers, 9-18 LOCK TABLE statement, 5-11 locks explicit, 5-10 LOCK TABLE statement, 5-11, 5-12 privileges for manual acquirement, 5-15 user, 5-17 UTLLOCKT.SQL script, 5-19 LONG datatype, 2-5, 2-8 use in triggers, 9-22 LONG RAW datatype, 2-8, 2-35 LOWER function, 4-9
J
Java calling methods through call specifications, compared to PL/SQL, 1-41 8-4
M
mail, sending from PL/SQL, 13-15 main transaction, definition, 5-29
Index-6
manual locks, 5-10 LOCK TABLE statement, 5-11 mask, format, definition, 2-28 match full rule for NULL values, 3-10 match partial rule for NULL values, 3-10 MDSYS.SDO_GEOMETRY datatype, 2-33 memory, scalability, 7-63 migration, ROWID format, 2-38 mod_plsql, definition, 13-3 modes, parameter, 7-6 mutating table, definition, 9-22 mutating tables, trigger restrictions, 9-22
NOT NULL constraint (continued) when to use, 3-3 notification, event, 10-1, 11-5 NOWAIT option, 5-12 NUMBER datatype, 2-5, 2-11, 2-19 numeric datatypes, 2-11 NVARCHAR2 datatype, 2-4, 2-8
O
OAS, 13-19 object columns, indexes on, 4-9 object support in OO4O, 1-37 OCCI, overview, 1-25 OCI, 7-2 applications, 7-4 cancelling cursors, 5-10 closing cursors, 5-10 overview, 1-25 parts of, 1-27 vs precompilers, 1-40 OLD correlation name, 9-17 one-to-many relationship, with foreign keys, 3-10 one-to-one relationship, with foreign keys, 3-11 OO4O, See Oracle Objects for OLE open string for XA, 16-9 OPEN_CURSORS parameter, 5-9 OR REPLACE clause, for creating packages, 7-15 ora_dictionary_obj_owner event attribute, 10-3 ora_dictionary_obj_owner_list event attribute, 10-3 ora_dictionary_obj_type event attribute, 10-3 ora_grantee event attribute, 10-3 ora_instance_num event attribute, 10-3 ora_is_alter_column event attribute, 10-3 ora_is_creating_nested_table event attribute, 10-4 ora_is_drop_column event attribute, 10-4 ora_is_servererror event attribute, 10-4 ora_login_user event attribute, 10-4 ora_privileges event attribute, 10-4 ora_revokee event attribute, 10-4 ORA_ROWSCN pseudocolumn, 15-9 ora_server_error event attribute, 10-4 ora_sysevent event attribute, 10-4 ora_with_grant_option event attribute, 10-7 ORA-21301 error, fixing, 16-12, 16-14
N
NaN (not a number value), 2-14 National Character Set Large Object, 2-34 native dynamic SQL advantages of, 6-11 differences with DBMS_SQL package, 6-11 fetching into records, 6-15 performance, 6-14 user-defined types, 6-15 See also dynamic SQL native execution, of PL/SQL procedures, 7-21 native float and native double datatypes in C and C++, 2-19 native floating-point datatypes, 2-11 arithmetic, rounding behavior, 2-16 IEEE 754 exceptions not raised, 2-15 infinity values, 2-14 NCHAR datatype, 2-4, 2-8 NCLOB datatype, 2-5, 2-34 negative infinity value, 2-14 negative zero value, 2-14 NEW correlation name, 9-17 new features, i-xxxvii NLS_DATE_FORMAT parameter, 2-21 NLSSORT order, and indexes, 4-9 non-padded comparison, 2-10 normalization of floating-point numbers, 2-13 not a number (NaN) value, 2-14 NOT NULL constraint CHECK constraint and, 3-17 data integrity, 3-20
Index-7
OraAQ object, 1-36 OraAQAgent object, 1-37 OraAQMsg object, 1-37 OraBFILE object, 1-38 OraBLOB object, 1-38 Oracle Application Server (OAS), 13-19 Oracle Call Interface, See OCI Oracle Data Control (ODC), 1-39 Oracle Data Provider for .NET, overview, 1-29 Oracle Database 10g, new application development features, i-xxxvii Oracle Database errors, 7-3 Oracle JDBC definition, 1-9 example, 1-12 OCI driver, 1-10 Oracle Database extensions, 1-11 server driver, 1-11 stored procedures, 1-19 thin driver, 1-10 Oracle JDeveloper, definition, 1-15 Oracle JPublisher, definition, 1-17 Oracle Objects for OLE automation server, 1-31 C++ Class Library, 1-39 LOB and object support, 1-37 object model, 1-32 overview, 1-30 Oracle SQLJ advantages over JDBC, 1-15 definition, 1-13 design, 1-15 in the server, 1-16 stored programs, 1-16 OraCLOB object, 1-38 OraDatabase object, 1-34 OraDynaset object, 1-34 OraField object, 1-35 OraMDAttribute object, 1-35 OraMetaData object, 1-35 OraParamArray object, 1-36 OraParameter object, 1-35 OraServer object, 1-33 OraSession object, 1-33 OraSQLStmt object, 1-36
OUT parameter mode, 7-6 overloading packaged functions, 7-63 procedures and functions, definition, 7-12 using RESTRICT_REFERENCES, 7-63 OWA function invocation types, 13-6 OWA* packages, 13-19
P
package, definition, 7-12 package body, 7-12 package OWA, definition, 13-6 package specification, 7-12 packages, 1-41 creating, 7-15 DBMS_OUTPUT, example of use, 7-3 DEBUG_EXTPROC, 8-51 dropping, 7-11 in PL/SQL, 7-12 naming of, 7-16 Oracle Database, 7-17 privileges for execution, 7-45 privileges required to create, 7-16 privileges required to create procedures in, 7-10 serially reusable packages, 7-63 session state and, 7-16 synonyms, 7-49 where documented, 7-17 parallel server, distributed locks, 5-10 PARALLEL_ENABLE keyword, 7-56 parameters default values, 7-9 with stored functions, 7-53 modes, 7-6 parse tree, 9-26 pcode, when generated for triggers, 9-26 performance index column order, 4-4 native dynamic SQL, 6-14 permanent and temporary LOB instances, 2-34 platform-specific Oracle Database documentation, PL/SQL wrapper, 7-20 PL/SQL, 7-2 anonymous blocks, 7-2
Index-8
PL/SQL, 7-2 (continued) calling remote stored procedures, 7-48 compared to Java, 1-41 cursor variables, 7-30 dependencies among library units, 7-21 exception handlers, 7-2 functions arguments, 7-53 overloading, 7-63 parameter default values, 7-53 purity level, 7-62 RESTRICT_REFERENCES pragma, 7-59 using, 7-50 hiding source code, 7-20 invoking with dynamic SQL, 6-6 objects, 1-6 overview, 1-3 packages, 7-12 program units, 7-2 RAISE statement, 7-36 sample code, 1-4 serially reusable packages, 7-63 server pages, 13-19 to 13-30 tables, 7-8 of records, 7-8 trigger bodies, 9-15, 9-17 user-defined errors, 7-36 Web toolkit, 13-19 wrapper to hide code, 7-20 PL/SQL Gateway, definition, 13-3 PL/SQL Web Toolkit, definition, 13-3 PLSQL_COMPILER_FLAGS initialization parameter, 7-21 positive infinity value, 2-14 positive zero value, 2-14 posting, message, definition, 11-5 pragma, 5-37 RESTRICT_REFERENCES, 7-59 SERIALLY_REUSABLE pragma, 7-63, 7-64 precompilers, 7-45 applications, 7-4 calling stored procedures and packages, 7-45 vs OCI, 1-40 PRIMARY KEY constraints choosing a primary key, 3-5
PRIMARY KEY constraints (continued) disabling, 3-21 enabling, 3-20 multiple columns in, 3-6 UNIQUE key constraint vs., 3-6 private SQL areas, cursors and, 5-8 privileges creating integrity constraints, 3-19 creating triggers, 9-26 dropping triggers, 9-28 flashback, 15-4 index creation, 4-6 manually acquiring locks, 5-15 recompiling triggers, 9-28 stored procedure execution, 7-45 triggers, 9-26 Pro*C/C++, overview of application development, 1-20 Pro*COBOL, overview of application development, 1-23 procedure external, definition, 8-3 procedures called by triggers, 9-22 external, 8-3 program units in PL/SQL, 7-2 property CHARSETFORM, 8-28 CHARSETID, 8-28 INDICATOR, 8-27 pseudocolumns, modifying views, 9-9 PSP, See PL/SQL server pages .psp files, 13-21 publish-subscribe, 11-2 to 11-6 purity of stored function, definition, 7-55
Q
queries dynamic, 6-4 errors in distributed queries, 7-38
R
RAISE statement, 7-36
Index-9
RAISE_APPLICATION_ERROR procedure, 7-35 remote procedures, 7-38 raising exceptions, triggers, 9-20 RAW datatype, 2-7, 2-35 RAWTOHEX function, 2-41 RAWTONHEX function, 2-41 read-only transactions, 5-7 recovery, data, using flashback features, 15-3 REF column, indexes on, 4-9 REFERENCING option, 9-19 referential integrity distributed databases and, 3-15 one-to-many relationship, 3-10 one-to-one relationship, 3-11 privileges required to create foreign keys, 3-27 self-referential constraints, 9-41 triggers and, 9-38 to 9-42 remote dependencies, 7-21 signatures, 7-23 specifying timestamps or signatures, 7-28 remote exception handling, 7-38, 9-20 remote queries, flashback features, 15-16 REMOTE_DEPENDENCIES_MODE parameter, 7-28 repeatable reads, 5-7, 5-10 resource manager, 16-2 events, 10-7 RESTRICT_REFERENCES pragma, 7-59 syntax for, 7-60 restrictions, system triggers, 9-25 resumable storage allocation, 5-38 definition, 5-38 examples, 5-39 RETENTION GUARANTEE clause for undo tablespace, 15-4 reusable packages, 7-63 RM (resource manager), 16-2 RNDS argument, 7-60 RNPS argument, 7-60 ROLLBACK statement, 5-5 rolling back transactions, to savepoints, 5-6 rounding modes for native floating-point numbers, 2-15 routine autonomous scope, definition, 5-29
routine (continued) external, definition, 8-3 routines external, 8-3 service, 8-38 row locking, manual, 5-16 row triggers defining, 9-13 REFERENCING option, 9-19 timing, 9-6 UPDATE statements and, 9-6, 9-20 ROWID, definition, 2-37 ROWID datatype, 2-8, 2-36 extended ROWID format, 2-36 migration, 2-38 ROWIDTOCHAR function, 2-41 ROWIDTONCHAR function, 2-41 rows shown in ROWIDs, 2-37 violating integrity constraints, 3-20 rowtype attribute, PL/SQL, 1-5 ROWTYPE_MISMATCH exception, 7-33 RR date format, 2-26 RS locks, LOCK TABLE statement, 5-12 run-time error handling, 7-35 RX locks, LOCK TABLE statement, 5-12
S
S locks, LOCK TABLE statement, 5-12 SAVEPOINT statement, 5-6 savepoints maximum number of, 5-6 rolling back to, 5-6 scalability, serially reusable packages, 7-63 scope autonomous, definition, 5-29 scripting, 13-19 scrollable cursors, 1-23 search data, representing, 2-34 secure application roles, i-xlv SELECT statement AS OF clause, 15-5 FOR UPDATE clause, 5-16 read consistency, 5-10
Index-10
SELECT statement (continued) VERSIONS BETWEEN...AND clause, 15-10 SERIALIZABLE option, for ISOLATION LEVEL, 5-23 serializable transactions, 5-19 serially reusable PL/SQL packages, 7-63 SERIALLY_REUSABLE pragma, 7-64 service routine, 8-38 sessions, package state and, 7-16 SET TRANSACTION statement, 5-8 ISOLATION LEVEL clause, 5-23 SERIALIZABLE, 5-23 share locks (S), LOCK TABLE statement, 5-12 share row exclusive locks (SRX), LOCK TABLE statement, 5-14 side effects, subprogram, 7-6, 7-55 signatures PL/SQL library unit dependencies, 7-21 to manage remote dependencies, 7-23 SORT_AREA_SIZE parameter, index creation and, 4-3 sorting, with function-based indexes, 4-8 specification part of package, definition, 7-13 SQL statements execution, 5-2 in trigger bodies, 9-17, 9-22 not allowed in triggers, 9-22 SQL*Loader, indexes and, 4-3 SQL*Module, applications, 7-4 SQL*Plus anonymous blocks, 7-4 compile-time errors, 7-33 invoking stored procedures, 7-43 loading a procedure, 7-10 SET SERVEROUTPUT ON command, 7-3 SHOW ERRORS command, 7-34 SQL/DS datatypes, 2-39 SRX locks, LOCK Table statement, 5-14 standards, IEEE 754, 2-11 state package, definition, 7-63 session, package objects, 7-16 Web application, definition, 13-14 stateful and stateless user interfaces, definitions, 1-3
statement triggers conditional code for statements, 9-19 row evaluation order, 9-7 specifying SQL statement, 9-5 timing, 9-6 trigger evaluation order, 9-7 UPDATE statements and, 9-6, 9-20 valid SQL statements, 9-22 storage allocation errors, resuming execution after, 5-38 stored functions, 7-4 creating, 7-9 restrictions, 7-51 stored procedure, definition, 7-5 stored procedures, 7-4 argument values, 7-46 creating, 7-9 distributed query creation, 7-38 exceptions, 7-35, 7-37 invoking, 7-43 names of, 7-5 overloading names of, 7-12 parameter, default values, 7-9 privileges, 7-45 remote, 7-47 remote objects and, 7-48 storing, 7-9 synonyms, 7-49 turning into a Web page, 13-19 subnormal floating-point numbers, 2-13 synonyms, stored procedures and packages, 7-49 SYS_XMLAGG function, 2-47 SYS_XMLGEN function, 2-47 SYSDATE function, 2-21 system events, 10-1 attributes, 10-2 client, 10-8 resource manager, 10-7 tracking, 9-49, 10-1
T
table, mutating, definition, 9-22 tables constraining, 9-22
Index-11
tables (continued) in PL/SQL, 7-8 mutating, 9-22 TCP/IP, 13-16 temporary and permanent LOB instances, 2-34 temporary segments, index creation and, 4-3 text search, using Oracle9i Text, 2-34 third-generation computing language, definition, 1-4 time and date data, representing, 2-20 time zones, functions, 2-23 TIMESTAMP datatype, 2-6, 2-20 TIMESTAMP WITH LOCAL TIME ZONE datatype, 2-7, 2-20 TIMESTAMP WITH TIME ZONE datatype, 2-7, 2-20 timestamps, PL/SQL library unit dependencies, 7-21 TM (transaction manager), 16-2 TO_CHAR function, 2-41 CC date format, 2-27 RR date format, 2-26 TO_CLOB function, 2-41 TO_DATE function, 2-21, 2-41 RR date format, 2-26 TO_NCHAR function, 2-41 TO_NCLOB function, 2-41 TO_NUMBER function, 2-41 tracking system events, 9-49, 10-1 transaction manager, 16-2 transaction set consistency, definition, 5-25 transaction, main, definition, 5-29 transactions autonomous, 5-28 to 5-36 read-only, 5-8 serializable, 5-19 SET TRANSACTION statement, 5-8 trigger disabled, definition, 9-28 enabled, definition, 9-28 triggering statement, definition, 9-5 triggers about, 7-20 accessing column values, 9-17 AFTER, 9-6, 9-17, 9-33, 9-35
triggers (continued) auditing with, 9-32, 9-33 BEFORE, 9-6, 9-17, 9-45, 9-46 body, 9-15, 9-19, 9-20, 9-22 check constraints, 9-43, 9-45 client events, 10-8 column list in UPDATE, 9-6, 9-20 compiled, 9-26 conditional predicates, 9-15, 9-19 creating, 9-2, 9-21, 9-26 data access restrictions, 9-45 debugging, 9-28 designing, 9-2 disabling, 9-28, 9-29 distributed query creation, 7-38 enabling, 9-28 error conditions and exceptions, 9-20 events, 9-5 examples, 9-31 to 9-47 firing, 9-1 FOR EACH ROW clause, 9-13 generating derived column values, 9-46 illegal SQL statements, 9-22 INSTEAD OF triggers, 9-8 integrity constraints vs., 9-2, 9-37 listing information about, 9-29 modifying, 9-28 multiple same type, 9-7 mutating tables and, 9-22 naming, 9-4 package variables and, 9-7 privileges, 9-26 to drop, 9-28 procedures and, 9-22 recompiling, 9-27 REFERENCING option, 9-19 referential integrity and, 9-38 to 9-42 remote dependencies and, 9-22 remote exceptions, 9-20 resource manager events, 10-7 restrictions, 9-14, 9-21 row, 9-13 row evaluation order, 9-7 scan order, 9-7 stored, 9-26
Index-12
triggers (continued) system triggers, 9-4 on DATABASE, 9-4 on SCHEMA, 9-4 trigger evaluation order, 9-7 use of LONG and LONG RAW datatypes, 9-22 username reported in, 9-25 WHEN clause, 9-14 TRUNC function, 2-21 TRUST keyword, 7-61 type attribute, PL/SQL, 1-5
usernames, as reported in a trigger, UTL_HTTP package, 13-16 UTL_INADDR package, 13-16 UTL_SMTP package, 13-15 UTL_TCP package, 13-16 UTLLOCKT.SQL script, 5-19
9-25
V
VARCHAR datatype, See VARCHAR2 datatype VARCHAR2 datatype, 2-4, 2-8 column length, 2-9 VBScript, translating to PSP, 13-20 VERSIONS_ENDSCN pseudocolumn, 15-11 VERSIONS_ENDTIME pseudocolumn, 15-11 VERSIONS_OPERATION pseudocolumn, 15-11 VERSIONS_STARTSCN pseudocolumn, 15-11 VERSIONS_STARTTIME pseudocolumn, 15-11 VERSIONS_XID pseudocolumn, 15-11 views containing expressions, 9-9 FLASHBACK_TRANSACTION_QUERY, 15-12 inherently modifiable, 9-9 modifiable, 9-9 pseudocolumns, 9-9
U
undo data, 15-2 UNDO_MANAGEMENT configuration parameter, 15-4 UNDO_RETENTION configuration parameter, 15-4 UNDO_TABLESPACE configuration parameter, 15-4 unhandled exceptions, 7-38 UNIQUE key constraints combining with NOT NULL constraint, 3-5 composite keys and nulls, 3-7 disabling, 3-21 enabling, 3-20 PRIMARY KEY constraint vs., 3-6 when to use, 3-6 updatable view, definition, 9-8 UPDATE statement column values and triggers, 9-17 data consistency, 5-10 triggers and, 9-6, 9-20 triggers for referential integrity, 9-40, 9-41 update, distributed, definition, 7-49 UPPER function, 4-9 URLs, 13-16 UROWID datatype, 2-8 USER function, 3-5 user locks, requesting, 5-17 USER_ERRORS view, debugging stored procedures, 7-35 USER_SOURCE view, 7-35 user-defined errors, 7-35, 7-37
W
Web pages, dynamic, 13-19 WHEN clause, 9-14 cannot contain PL/SQL expressions, 9-14 correlation names, 9-17 examples, 9-2, 9-13, 9-38 EXCEPTION examples, 9-20, 9-38, 9-43, 9-45 WITH CONTEXT clause, 8-33 WNDS argument, 7-60 WNPS argument, 7-60 wrapper to hide PL/SQL code, 7-20
X
X locks, LOCK TABLE statement, XA library, 16-1 to 16-36 xa_open string, 16-9 5-15
Index-13
XML as document type for PSP file, 13-22 searching with Oracle9i Text, 2-34 XML data, representing, 2-47 X/Open distributed transaction processing architecture, 16-2
Y
year 2000, 2-25
Z
zero values, 2-14
Index-14